MC9S08DZ128 MC9S08DZ96 MC9S08DV128 MC9S08DV96
Data Sheet
HCS08 Microcontrollers
MC9S08DZ128 Rev. 1 5/2008
freescale.com
MC9S08DZ128 Series Features
8-Bit HCS08 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
• 40-MHz HCS08 CPU (20-MHz bus) • HC08 instruction set with added BGND instruction • Support for up to 32 interrupt/reset sources
Peripherals
• ADC — 24-channel, 12-bit resolution, 2.5 μs conversion time, automatic compare function, temperature sensor, internal bandgap reference channel • ACMPx — Two analog comparators with selectable interrupt on rising, falling, or either edge of comparator output; compare option to fixed internal bandgap reference voltage; runs in stop3 mode • MSCAN — CAN protocol - Version 2.0 A, B; standard and extended data frames; Support for remote frames; Five receive buffers with FIFO storage scheme; Flexible identifier acceptance filters programmable as: 2 x 32-bit, 4 x 16-bit, or 8 x 8-bit • SCIx — Two SCIs supporting LIN 2.0 Protocol and SAE J2602 protocols; Full duplex non-return to zero (NRZ); Master extended break generation; Slave extended break detection; Wakeup on active edge • SPIx — Up to two SPIs; Full-duplex or single-wire bidirectional; Double-buffered transmit and receive; Master or Slave mode; MSB-first or LSB-first shifting • IICx — Up to two IICs; Up to 100 kbps with maximum bus loading; Multi-master operation; Programmable slave address; General Call Address; Interrupt driven byte-by-byte data transfer • TPMx — One 6-channel (TPM1), one 2-channel (TPM2) and one 4-channel (TPM3); Selectable input capture, output compare, or buffered edge- and center-aligned PWM on each channel. • RTC — (Real-time counter) 8-bit modulus counter with binary or decimal based prescaler; Real-time clock capabilities using external crystal and RTC for precise time base, time-of-day, calendar or task scheduling functions; Free running on-chip low power oscillator (1 kHz) for cyclic wake-up without external components
On-Chip Memory
• FLASH read/program/erase over full operating voltage and temperature • EEPROM in-circuit programmable memory; 8-byte single-page or 4-byte dual-page erase sector; Program and Erase while executing FLASH; Erase abort • Random-access memory (RAM)
MC9S08 DZ128 FLASH EEPROM RAM 128K 2K 8K MC9S08 DZ96 96K 2K 6K MC9S08 DV128 128K — 6K MC9S08 DV96 96K — 4K
Power-Saving Modes
• Two very low power stop modes • Reduced power wait mode • Very low power real time interrupt for use in run, wait, and stop
Clock Source Options
• Oscillator (XOSC) — Loop-control Pierce oscillator; Crystal or ceramic resonator range of 31.25 kHz to 38.4 kHz or 1 MHz to 16 MHz • Multi-purpose Clock Generator (MCG) — PLL and FLL modes; reference clock with nonvolatile trim (0.2% resolution, 1.5% tolerance over temperature with internal temperature compensation); External reference with oscillator/resonator options
System Protection
• Watchdog computer operating properly (COP) reset with option to run from backup dedicated 1-kHz internal clock source or bus clock; with optional windowed operation • Low-voltage detection with reset or interrupt; selectable trip points • Illegal opcode detection with reset • Illegal address detection with reset • FLASH and EEPROM block protect • Loss-of-lock protection
Input/Output
• Up to 87 general-purpose input/output (I/O) pins and 1 input-only pin • Up to 32 interrupt pins with selectable polarity on each pin • Hysteresis and configurable pull device on all input pins. • Configurable slew rate and drive strength on all output pins.
Development Support
• Single-wire background debug interface • On-chip, in-circuit emulation (ICE) with real-time bus capture
Package Options
• 100-pin low-profile quad flat-pack(LQFP) — 14x14 mm • 64-pin low-profile quad flat-pack (LQFP) — 10x10 mm • 48-pin low-profile quad flat-pack (LQFP) — 7x7 mm
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet
Covers: MC9S08DZ128 MC9S08DZ96 MC9S08DV128 MC9S08DV96
MC9S08DZ128 Rev. 1 5/2008
Freescale™ and the Freescale logo are trademarks of Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. © Freescale Semiconductor, Inc., 2007, 2008. All rights reserved.
Revision History
To provide the most up-to-date information, the revision of our documents on the World Wide Web will be the most current. Your printed copy may be an earlier revision. To verify you have the latest information available, refer to: http://freescale.com/
The following revision history table summarizes changes contained in this document.
Revision Number
1
Revision Date
4/2008 Initial Release
Description of Changes
© Freescale Semiconductor, Inc., 2007, 2008. All rights reserved. This product incorporates SuperFlash® Technology licensed from SST.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 6 Freescale Semiconductor
List of Chapters
Chapter Title Page
Chapter 1 Chapter 2 Chapter 3 Chapter 4 Chapter 5 Chapter 6 Chapter 7 Chapter 8 Chapter 9 Chapter 10 Chapter 11 Chapter 12 Chapter 13 Chapter 14 Chapter 15 Chapter 16 Chapter 17 Chapter 18 Appendix A Appendix B
Device Overview .............................................................................. 21 Pins and Connections ..................................................................... 27 Modes of Operation ......................................................................... 39 Memory ............................................................................................. 45 Resets, Interrupts, and General System Control.......................... 85 Parallel Input/Output Control........................................................ 101 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV5) ............................................ 143 Multi-Purpose Clock Generator (S08MCGV2) ............................. 165 5-V Analog Comparator (S08ACMPV3)........................................ 199 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)................................ 207 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV2) ............................................... 233 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1) ............... 253 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3) ........................................ 307 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV4)............................. 323 Real-Time Counter (S08RTCV1) ................................................... 343 Timer Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV3) ................................. 353 Development Support ................................................................... 379 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K).............................................. 393 Electrical Characteristics.............................................................. 419 Ordering Information and Mechanical Drawings........................ 447
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 7
Contents
Section Number Title Page
Chapter 1 Device Overview
1.1 1.2 1.3 Devices in the MC9S08DZ128 Series..............................................................................................21 MCU Block Diagram .......................................................................................................................23 System Clock Distribution ...............................................................................................................25
Chapter 2 Pins and Connections
2.1 2.2 Device Pin Assignment ....................................................................................................................27 Recommended System Connections ................................................................................................31 2.2.1 Power ................................................................................................................................32 2.2.2 Oscillator ...........................................................................................................................32 2.2.3 RESET ..............................................................................................................................32 2.2.4 Background / Mode Select (BKGD/MS) ..........................................................................33 2.2.5 ADC Reference (VREFH, VREFL) Pins ..............................................................................33 2.2.6 General-Purpose I/O and Peripheral Ports ........................................................................33
Chapter 3 Modes of Operation
3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 3.6 Introduction ......................................................................................................................................39 Features ............................................................................................................................................39 Run Mode.........................................................................................................................................39 Active Background Mode.................................................................................................................39 Wait Mode ........................................................................................................................................40 Stop Modes.......................................................................................................................................41 3.6.1 Stop3 Mode .......................................................................................................................41 3.6.2 Stop2 Mode .......................................................................................................................42 3.6.3 On-Chip Peripheral Modules in Stop Modes ....................................................................42
Chapter 4 Memory
4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 MC9S08DZ128 Series Memory Map ..............................................................................................45 Reset and Interrupt Vector Assignments ..........................................................................................49 Register Addresses and Bit Assignments.........................................................................................51 Memory Management Unit ..............................................................................................................61 4.4.1 Features .............................................................................................................................61 4.4.2 Memory Expansion ...........................................................................................................61
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 9
Section Number
4.5 4.6
Title
Page
4.4.3 MMU Registers and Control Bits .....................................................................................63 RAM.................................................................................................................................................66 FLASH and EEPROM .....................................................................................................................67 4.6.1 Features .............................................................................................................................67 4.6.2 Program and Erase Times .................................................................................................67 4.6.3 Program and Erase Command Execution .........................................................................68 4.6.4 Burst Program Execution ..................................................................................................69 4.6.5 Sector Erase Abort ............................................................................................................72 4.6.6 Access Errors ....................................................................................................................73 4.6.7 Block Protection ................................................................................................................74 4.6.8 Vector Redirection ............................................................................................................74 4.6.9 Security .............................................................................................................................74 4.6.10 EEPROM Mapping ...........................................................................................................76 4.6.11 FLASH and EEPROM Registers and Control Bits ...........................................................76
Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and General System Control
5.1 5.2 5.3 5.4 5.5 Introduction ......................................................................................................................................85 Features ............................................................................................................................................85 MCU Reset.......................................................................................................................................85 Computer Operating Properly (COP) Watchdog..............................................................................86 Interrupts ..........................................................................................................................................87 5.5.1 Interrupt Stack Frame .......................................................................................................88 5.5.2 External Interrupt Request (IRQ) Pin ...............................................................................88 5.5.3 Interrupt Vectors, Sources, and Local Masks ....................................................................89 Low-Voltage Detect (LVD) System .................................................................................................91 5.6.1 Power-On Reset Operation ...............................................................................................91 5.6.2 Low-Voltage Detection (LVD) Reset Operation ...............................................................91 5.6.3 Low-Voltage Warning (LVW) Interrupt Operation ...........................................................92 MCLK Output ..................................................................................................................................92 Reset, Interrupt, and System Control Registers and Control Bits ....................................................92 5.8.1 Interrupt Pin Request Status and Control Register (IRQSC) ............................................92 5.8.2 System Reset Status Register (SRS) .................................................................................94 5.8.3 System Background Debug Force Reset Register (SBDFR) ............................................95 5.8.4 System Options Register 1 (SOPT1) ................................................................................96 5.8.5 System Options Register 2 (SOPT2) ................................................................................97 5.8.6 System Device Identification Register (SDIDH, SDIDL) ................................................98 5.8.7 System Power Management Status and Control 1 Register (SPMSC1) ...........................99 5.8.8 System Power Management Status and Control 2 Register (SPMSC2) .........................100
5.6
5.7 5.8
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 10 Freescale Semiconductor
Section Number
Title Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output Control
Page
6.1 6.2 6.3
6.4 6.5
Port Data and Data Direction .........................................................................................................101 Pull-up, Slew Rate, and Drive Strength..........................................................................................102 Pin Interrupts ..................................................................................................................................103 6.3.1 Edge Only Sensitivity .....................................................................................................103 6.3.2 Edge and Level Sensitivity ..............................................................................................103 6.3.3 Pull-up/Pull-down Resistors ...........................................................................................104 6.3.4 Pin Interrupt Initialization ...............................................................................................104 Pin Behavior in Stop Modes...........................................................................................................104 Parallel I/O and Pin Control Registers ...........................................................................................104 6.5.1 Port A Registers ..............................................................................................................105 6.5.2 Port B Registers ..............................................................................................................109 6.5.3 Port C Registers ..............................................................................................................113 6.5.4 Port D Registers ..............................................................................................................116 6.5.5 Port E Registers ...............................................................................................................120 6.5.6 Port F Registers ...............................................................................................................123 6.5.7 Port G Registers ..............................................................................................................126 6.5.8 Port H Registers ..............................................................................................................129 6.5.9 Port J Registers ...............................................................................................................132 6.5.10 Port K Registers ..............................................................................................................136 6.5.11 Port L Registers ...............................................................................................................139
Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV5)
7.1 7.2 Introduction ....................................................................................................................................143 7.1.1 Features ...........................................................................................................................143 Programmer’s Model and CPU Registers ......................................................................................144 7.2.1 Accumulator (A) .............................................................................................................144 7.2.2 Index Register (H:X) .......................................................................................................144 7.2.3 Stack Pointer (SP) ...........................................................................................................145 7.2.4 Program Counter (PC) ....................................................................................................145 7.2.5 Condition Code Register (CCR) .....................................................................................145 Addressing Modes..........................................................................................................................147 7.3.1 Inherent Addressing Mode (INH) ...................................................................................147 7.3.2 Relative Addressing Mode (REL) ...................................................................................147 7.3.3 Immediate Addressing Mode (IMM) ..............................................................................147 7.3.4 Direct Addressing Mode (DIR) ......................................................................................148 7.3.5 Extended Addressing Mode (EXT) ................................................................................148 7.3.6 Indexed Addressing Mode ..............................................................................................148 Special Operations..........................................................................................................................149 7.4.1 Reset Sequence ...............................................................................................................149
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 11
7.3
7.4
Section Number
Title
Page
7.5 7.6
7.4.2 Interrupt Sequence ..........................................................................................................149 7.4.3 Wait Mode Operation ......................................................................................................150 7.4.4 Stop Mode Operation ......................................................................................................150 7.4.5 BGND Instruction ...........................................................................................................151 CALL and RTC Instructions ..........................................................................................................151 HCS08 Instruction Set Summary ...................................................................................................153
Chapter 8 Multi-Purpose Clock Generator (S08MCGV2)
8.1 Introduction ....................................................................................................................................165 8.1.1 Features ...........................................................................................................................167 8.1.2 Modes of Operation ........................................................................................................169 External Signal Description ...........................................................................................................169 Register Definition .........................................................................................................................170 8.3.1 MCG Control Register 1 (MCGC1) ...............................................................................170 8.3.2 MCG Control Register 2 (MCGC2) ...............................................................................172 8.3.3 MCG Trim Register (MCGTRM) ...................................................................................173 8.3.4 MCG Status and Control Register (MCGSC) .................................................................174 8.3.5 MCG Control Register 3 (MCGC3) ...............................................................................175 8.3.6 MCG Test and Control Register (MCGT) ......................................................................177 Functional Description ...................................................................................................................178 8.4.1 Operational Modes ..........................................................................................................178 8.4.2 Mode Switching ..............................................................................................................182 8.4.3 Bus Frequency Divider ...................................................................................................183 8.4.4 Low Power Bit Usage .....................................................................................................183 8.4.5 Internal Reference Clock ................................................................................................183 8.4.6 External Reference Clock ...............................................................................................183 8.4.7 Fixed Frequency Clock ...................................................................................................184 Initialization / Application Information .........................................................................................185 8.5.1 MCG Module Initialization Sequence ............................................................................185 8.5.2 Using a 32.768 kHz Reference .......................................................................................186 8.5.3 MCG Mode Switching ....................................................................................................187 8.5.4 Calibrating the Internal Reference Clock (IRC) .............................................................195
8.2 8.3
8.4
8.5
Chapter 9 5-V Analog Comparator (S08ACMPV3)
9.1 Introduction ....................................................................................................................................199 9.1.1 ACMP Configuration Information ..................................................................................199 9.1.2 Features ...........................................................................................................................201 9.1.3 Modes of Operation ........................................................................................................201 9.1.4 Block Diagram ................................................................................................................201 External Signal Description ...........................................................................................................203
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 12 Freescale Semiconductor
9.2
Section Number
9.3 9.4
Title
Page
Memory Map .................................................................................................................................203 9.3.1 Register Descriptions ......................................................................................................203 Functional Description ...................................................................................................................205
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
10.1 Introduction ....................................................................................................................................207 10.1.1 Channel Assignments ......................................................................................................207 10.1.2 Analog Power and Ground Signal Names ......................................................................207 10.1.3 Alternate Clock ...............................................................................................................208 10.1.4 Hardware Trigger ............................................................................................................208 10.1.5 Temperature Sensor ........................................................................................................209 10.1.6 Features ...........................................................................................................................211 10.1.7 ADC Module Block Diagram .........................................................................................211 10.2 External Signal Description ...........................................................................................................212 10.2.1 Analog Power (VDDAD) ..................................................................................................213 10.2.2 Analog Ground (VSSAD) .................................................................................................213 10.2.3 Voltage Reference High (VREFH) ...................................................................................213 10.2.4 Voltage Reference Low (VREFL) .....................................................................................213 10.2.5 Analog Channel Inputs (ADx) ........................................................................................213 10.3 Register Definition .........................................................................................................................213 10.3.1 Status and Control Register 1 (ADCSC1) ......................................................................213 10.3.2 Status and Control Register 2 (ADCSC2) ......................................................................215 10.3.3 Data Result High Register (ADCRH) .............................................................................215 10.3.4 Data Result Low Register (ADCRL) ..............................................................................216 10.3.5 Compare Value High Register (ADCCVH) ....................................................................216 10.3.6 Compare Value Low Register (ADCCVL) .....................................................................217 10.3.7 Configuration Register (ADCCFG) ................................................................................217 10.3.8 Pin Control 1 Register (APCTL1) ..................................................................................218 10.3.9 Pin Control 2 Register (APCTL2) ..................................................................................219 10.3.10Pin Control 3 Register (APCTL3) ..................................................................................220 10.4 Functional Description ...................................................................................................................221 10.4.1 Clock Select and Divide Control ....................................................................................222 10.4.2 Input Select and Pin Control ...........................................................................................222 10.4.3 Hardware Trigger ............................................................................................................222 10.4.4 Conversion Control .........................................................................................................222 10.4.5 Automatic Compare Function .........................................................................................225 10.4.6 MCU Wait Mode Operation ............................................................................................225 10.4.7 MCU Stop3 Mode Operation ..........................................................................................226 10.4.8 MCU Stop2 Mode Operation ..........................................................................................226 10.5 Initialization Information ...............................................................................................................227 10.5.1 ADC Module Initialization Example .............................................................................227
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 13
Section Number
Title
Page
10.6 Application Information .................................................................................................................229 10.6.1 External Pins and Routing ..............................................................................................229 10.6.2 Sources of Error ..............................................................................................................230
Chapter 11 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV2)
11.1 Introduction ....................................................................................................................................233 11.1.1 IIC1 Configuration Information ......................................................................................233 11.1.2 Features ...........................................................................................................................235 11.1.3 Modes of Operation ........................................................................................................235 11.1.4 Block Diagram ................................................................................................................236 11.2 External Signal Description ...........................................................................................................236 11.2.1 SCL — Serial Clock Line ...............................................................................................236 11.2.2 SDA — Serial Data Line ................................................................................................236 11.3 Register Definition .........................................................................................................................236 11.3.1 IIC Address Register (IICxA) .........................................................................................237 11.3.2 IIC Frequency Divider Register (IICxF) .........................................................................237 11.3.3 IIC Control Register (IICxC1) ........................................................................................240 11.3.4 IIC Status Register (IICxS) .............................................................................................241 11.3.5 IIC Data I/O Register (IICxD) ........................................................................................242 11.3.6 IIC Control Register 2 (IICxC2) .....................................................................................242 11.4 Functional Description ...................................................................................................................243 11.4.1 IIC Protocol .....................................................................................................................243 11.4.2 10-bit Address .................................................................................................................247 11.4.3 General Call Address ......................................................................................................248 11.5 Resets .............................................................................................................................................248 11.6 Interrupts ........................................................................................................................................248 11.6.1 Byte Transfer Interrupt ....................................................................................................248 11.6.2 Address Detect Interrupt .................................................................................................248 11.6.3 Arbitration Lost Interrupt ................................................................................................248 11.7 Initialization/Application Information ...........................................................................................250
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
12.1 Introduction ....................................................................................................................................253 12.1.1 Features ...........................................................................................................................255 12.1.2 Modes of Operation ........................................................................................................255 12.1.3 Block Diagram ................................................................................................................256 12.2 External Signal Description ...........................................................................................................256 12.2.1 RXCAN — CAN Receiver Input Pin .............................................................................256 12.2.2 TXCAN — CAN Transmitter Output Pin .....................................................................256 12.2.3 CAN System ...................................................................................................................256
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 14 Freescale Semiconductor
Section Number
Title
Page
12.3 Register Definition .........................................................................................................................257 12.3.1 MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0) ......................................................................257 12.3.2 MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1) ......................................................................260 12.3.3 MSCAN Bus Timing Register 0 (CANBTR0) ...............................................................261 12.3.4 MSCAN Bus Timing Register 1 (CANBTR1) ...............................................................262 12.3.5 MSCAN Receiver Interrupt Enable Register (CANRIER) .............................................265 12.3.6 MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG) ..........................................................266 12.3.7 MSCAN Transmitter Interrupt Enable Register (CANTIER) ........................................267 12.3.8 MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Request Register (CANTARQ) ...........................268 12.3.9 MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Acknowledge Register (CANTAAK) .................269 12.3.10MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL) .........................................269 12.3.11MSCAN Identifier Acceptance Control Register (CANIDAC) ......................................270 12.3.12MSCAN Miscellaneous Register (CANMISC) ..............................................................271 12.3.13MSCAN Receive Error Counter (CANRXERR) ............................................................272 12.3.14MSCAN Transmit Error Counter (CANTXERR) ..........................................................273 12.3.15MSCAN Identifier Acceptance Registers (CANIDAR0-7) ............................................273 12.3.16MSCAN Identifier Mask Registers (CANIDMR0–CANIDMR7) .................................274 12.4 Programmer’s Model of Message Storage .....................................................................................275 12.4.1 Identifier Registers (IDR0–IDR3) ...................................................................................278 12.4.2 IDR0–IDR3 for Standard Identifier Mapping .................................................................280 12.4.3 Data Segment Registers (DSR0-7) .................................................................................281 12.4.4 Data Length Register (DLR) ...........................................................................................282 12.4.5 Transmit Buffer Priority Register (TBPR) ......................................................................283 12.4.6 Time Stamp Register (TSRH–TSRL) .............................................................................283 12.5 Functional Description ...................................................................................................................284 12.5.1 General ............................................................................................................................284 12.5.2 Message Storage .............................................................................................................285 12.5.3 Identifier Acceptance Filter .............................................................................................288 12.5.4 Modes of Operation ........................................................................................................295 12.5.5 Low-Power Options ........................................................................................................296 12.5.6 Reset Initialization ..........................................................................................................302 12.5.7 Interrupts .........................................................................................................................302 12.6 Initialization/Application Information ...........................................................................................304 12.6.1 MSCAN initialization .....................................................................................................304 12.6.2 Bus-Off Recovery ...........................................................................................................305
Chapter 13 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)
13.1 Introduction ....................................................................................................................................307 13.1.1 Features ...........................................................................................................................309 13.1.2 Block Diagrams ..............................................................................................................309 13.1.3 SPI Baud Rate Generation ..............................................................................................311
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 15
Section Number
Title
Page
13.2 External Signal Description ...........................................................................................................312 13.2.1 SPSCK — SPI Serial Clock ............................................................................................312 13.2.2 MOSI — Master Data Out, Slave Data In ......................................................................312 13.2.3 MISO — Master Data In, Slave Data Out ......................................................................312 13.2.4 SS — Slave Select ...........................................................................................................312 13.3 Modes of Operation........................................................................................................................313 13.3.1 SPI in Stop Modes ..........................................................................................................313 13.4 Register Definition .........................................................................................................................313 13.4.1 SPI Control Register 1 (SPIxC1) ....................................................................................313 13.4.2 SPI Control Register 2 (SPIxC2) ....................................................................................314 13.4.3 SPI Baud Rate Register (SPIxBR) ..................................................................................315 13.4.4 SPI Status Register (SPIxS) ............................................................................................316 13.4.5 SPI Data Register (SPIxD) ..............................................................................................317 13.5 Functional Description ...................................................................................................................318 13.5.1 SPI Clock Formats ..........................................................................................................318 13.5.2 SPI Interrupts ..................................................................................................................321 13.5.3 Mode Fault Detection .....................................................................................................321
Chapter 14 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV4)
14.1 Introduction ....................................................................................................................................323 14.1.1 SCI2 Configuration Information .....................................................................................323 14.1.2 Features ...........................................................................................................................325 14.1.3 Modes of Operation ........................................................................................................325 14.1.4 Block Diagram ................................................................................................................326 14.2 Register Definition .........................................................................................................................328 14.2.1 SCI Baud Rate Registers (SCIxBDH, SCIxBDL) ..........................................................328 14.2.2 SCI Control Register 1 (SCIxC1) ...................................................................................329 14.2.3 SCI Control Register 2 (SCIxC2) ...................................................................................330 14.2.4 SCI Status Register 1 (SCIxS1) ......................................................................................331 14.2.5 SCI Status Register 2 (SCIxS2) ......................................................................................333 14.2.6 SCI Control Register 3 (SCIxC3) ...................................................................................334 14.2.7 SCI Data Register (SCIxD) .............................................................................................335 14.3 Functional Description ...................................................................................................................335 14.3.1 Baud Rate Generation .....................................................................................................335 14.3.2 Transmitter Functional Description ................................................................................336 14.3.3 Receiver Functional Description .....................................................................................337 14.3.4 Interrupts and Status Flags ..............................................................................................339 14.3.5 Additional SCI Functions ...............................................................................................340
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 16 Freescale Semiconductor
Section Number
Title Chapter 15 Real-Time Counter (S08RTCV1)
Page
15.1 Introduction ....................................................................................................................................343 15.1.1 RTC Clock Signal Names ...............................................................................................343 15.1.2 Features ...........................................................................................................................345 15.1.3 Modes of Operation ........................................................................................................345 15.1.4 Block Diagram ................................................................................................................346 15.2 External Signal Description ...........................................................................................................346 15.3 Register Definition .........................................................................................................................346 15.3.1 RTC Status and Control Register (RTCSC) ....................................................................347 15.3.2 RTC Counter Register (RTCCNT) ..................................................................................348 15.3.3 RTC Modulo Register (RTCMOD) ................................................................................348 15.4 Functional Description ...................................................................................................................348 15.4.1 RTC Operation Example .................................................................................................349 15.5 Initialization/Application Information ...........................................................................................350
Chapter 16 Timer Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV3)
16.1 Introduction ....................................................................................................................................353 16.1.1 Features ...........................................................................................................................355 16.1.2 Modes of Operation ........................................................................................................355 16.1.3 Block Diagram ................................................................................................................356 16.2 Signal Description ..........................................................................................................................358 16.2.1 Detailed Signal Descriptions ...........................................................................................358 16.3 Register Definition .........................................................................................................................362 16.3.1 TPM Status and Control Register (TPMxSC) ................................................................362 16.3.2 TPM-Counter Registers (TPMxCNTH:TPMxCNTL) ....................................................363 16.3.3 TPM Counter Modulo Registers (TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL) ....................................364 16.3.4 TPM Channel n Status and Control Register (TPMxCnSC) ..........................................365 16.3.5 TPM Channel Value Registers (TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL) ..........................................367 16.4 Functional Description ...................................................................................................................368 16.4.1 Counter ............................................................................................................................369 16.4.2 Channel Mode Selection .................................................................................................371 16.5 Reset Overview ..............................................................................................................................374 16.5.1 General ............................................................................................................................374 16.5.2 Description of Reset Operation .......................................................................................374 16.6 Interrupts ........................................................................................................................................374 16.6.1 General ............................................................................................................................374 16.6.2 Description of Interrupt Operation ..................................................................................375 16.7 The Differences from TPM v2 to TPM v3.....................................................................................376
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 17
Section Number
Title Chapter 17 Development Support
Page
17.1 Introduction ....................................................................................................................................379 17.1.1 Forcing Active Background ............................................................................................379 17.1.2 Features ...........................................................................................................................380 17.2 Background Debug Controller (BDC) ...........................................................................................380 17.2.1 BKGD Pin Description ...................................................................................................381 17.2.2 Communication Details ..................................................................................................381 17.2.3 BDC Commands .............................................................................................................385 17.2.4 BDC Hardware Breakpoint .............................................................................................387 17.3 Register Definition .........................................................................................................................387 17.3.1 BDC Registers and Control Bits .....................................................................................388 17.3.2 System Background Debug Force Reset Register (SBDFR) ..........................................390
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
18.1 Introduction ....................................................................................................................................393 18.1.1 Features ...........................................................................................................................393 18.1.2 Modes of Operation ........................................................................................................394 18.1.3 Block Diagram ................................................................................................................394 18.2 Signal Description ..........................................................................................................................394 18.3 Memory Map and Registers ...........................................................................................................395 18.3.1 Module Memory Map .....................................................................................................395 18.3.2 396 18.3.3 Register Descriptions ......................................................................................................397 18.4 Functional Description ...................................................................................................................410 18.4.1 Comparator .....................................................................................................................410 18.4.2 Breakpoints .....................................................................................................................411 18.4.3 Trigger Selection .............................................................................................................411 18.4.4 Trigger Break Control (TBC) .........................................................................................412 18.4.5 FIFO ................................................................................................................................415 18.4.6 Interrupt Priority .............................................................................................................416 18.5 Resets .............................................................................................................................................416 18.6 Interrupts ........................................................................................................................................417 18.7 Electrical Specifications .................................................................................................................417
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
A.1 A.2 A.3 A.4 Introduction ...................................................................................................................................419 Parameter Classification ................................................................................................................419 Absolute Maximum Ratings ..........................................................................................................419 Thermal Characteristics .................................................................................................................420
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 18 Freescale Semiconductor
Section Number
A.5 A.6 A.7 A.8 A.9 A.10 A.11 A.12
Title
Page
ESD Protection and Latch-Up Immunity ......................................................................................422 DC Characteristics .........................................................................................................................423 Supply Current Characteristics ......................................................................................................427 Analog Comparator (ACMP) Electricals ......................................................................................429 ADC Characteristics ......................................................................................................................431 External Oscillator (XOSC) Characteristics .................................................................................435 MCG Specifications ......................................................................................................................436 AC Characteristics .........................................................................................................................438 A.12.1 Control Timing ...............................................................................................................438 A.12.2 Timer/PWM ....................................................................................................................440 A.12.3 MSCAN ..........................................................................................................................441 A.12.4 SPI ...................................................................................................................................442 A.13 FLASH and EEPROM ..................................................................................................................445 A.14 EMC Performance .........................................................................................................................446 A.14.1 Radiated Emissions .........................................................................................................446
Appendix B Ordering Information and Mechanical Drawings
B.1 Ordering Information ....................................................................................................................447 B.1.1 MC9S08DZ128 Series Devices ......................................................................................447 B.2 Mechanical Drawings ....................................................................................................................448
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 19
Chapter 1 Device Overview
MC9S08DZ128 Series devices are members of the low-cost, high-performance HCS08 Family of 8-bit microcontroller units (MCUs). All MCUs in the family use the enhanced HCS08 core and are available with a variety of modules, memory sizes, memory types, and package types.
1.1
Devices in the MC9S08DZ128 Series
This data sheet covers members of the MC9S08DZ128 Series of MCUs: • MC9S08DZ128 • MC9S08DZ96 • MC9S08DV128 • MC9S08DV96 Table 1-1 summarizes the feature set available in the MC9S08DZ128 Series.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 21
Chapter 1 Device Overview
t
Table 1-1. MC9S08DZ128 Series Features by MCU and Pin Count
Feature FLASH (bytes) RAM (bytes) EEPROM (bytes) Pin quantity Pin Interrupts ACMP1 ACMP2 ADC channels DBG IIC1 IIC2 IRQ MCG MSCAN RTC SCI1 SCI2 SPI1 SPI2 TPM1 channels TPM2 channels TPM3 channels XOSC COP Watchdog
1 2
MC9S08DZ128 131,072 8192 2048 100 32 64 24 yes yes1 24 24 yes yes yes no yes yes yes yes yes yes yes yes no 6 2 4
2
MC9S08DZ96 98,304 6016 2048
MC9S08DV128 131,072 6016 — 48 24 100 32 64 24 yes yes1 16 24 24 yes yes no yes no yes yes yes yes yes yes yes no yes no 6 2 42 yes yes no no 16 24 48 24
MC9S08DV96 98,304 4096 — 100 32 64 24 yes yes1 24 yes yes yes no yes yes yes yes yes yes yes yes no 6 2 42 yes yes no no 16 48 24
48 24
100 32
64 24 yes yes1
16
24
24 yes yes
no
yes
no yes yes yes yes yes yes yes
no
yes
no 6 2 42 yes yes
yes yes
ACMP2O is not available in the 48-pin package. TPM3 pins are not available in the 64-pin and 48-pin packages.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 22 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 1 Device Overview
Table 1-2 provides the functional version of the on-chip modules.
Table 1-2. Module Versions
Module Central Processor Unit Analog Comparator (5V) Analog-to-Digital Converter Debug Module Inter-Integrated Circuit Multi-Purpose Clock Generator Freescale’s Controller Area Network Serial Peripheral Interface Serial Communications Interface Real-Time Counter Timer Pulse Width Modulator (CPU) (ACMP_5V) (ADC) (DBG) (IIC) (MCG) (MSCAN) (SPI) (SCI) (RTC) (TPM) Version 5 3 1 3 2 2 1 3 4 1 3
1.2
MCU Block Diagram
Figure 1-1 is the MC9S08DZ128 Series system-level block diagram.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 23
Chapter 1 Device Overview
HCS08 CORE CPU BKGD/MS BDC BKP DEBUG MODULE (DBG) ANALOG COMPARATOR (ACMP1) ACMP1O ACMP1ACMP1+ PORT A
RESET
HCS08 SYSTEM CONTROL RESETS AND INTERRUPTS MODES OF OPERATION POWER MANAGEMENT IRQ COP INT LVD IRQ VOLTAGE REGULATOR
PTA7/PIA7/ADP7/IRQ PTA6/PIA6/ADP6 PTA5/PIA5/ADP5 PTA4/PIA4/ADP4 PTA3/PIA3/ADP3/ACMP1O PTA2/PIA2/ADP2/ACMP1PTA1/PIA1/ADP1/ACMP1+ PTA0/PIA0/ADP0/MCLK PTB7/PIB7/ADP15 PTB6/PIB6/ADP14 PTB5/PIB5/ADP13 PTB4/PIB4/ADP12 PTB3/PIB3/ADP11 PTB2/PIB2/ADP10 PTB1/PIB1/ADP9 PTB0/PIB0/ADP8
● ● ● ● ● ● ● ●
REAL-TIME COUNTER (RTC)
VDD VSS VREFH VREFL VDDA VSSA
8 24-CHANNEL,12-BIT ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER (ADC) ADP7-ADP0 ADP15-ADP8 ADP23-ADP16
PORT B
USER MEMORY FLASH _EEPROM _RAM MC9S08DZ128 = 128K_2K_8K MC9S08DZ96 = 96K_2K_6K MC9S08DV128 = 128K_0K_6K MC9S08DV96 = 96K_0K_4K PTJ7/PIJ7/TPM3CLK PTJ6/PIJ6 PTJ5/PIJ5 PTJ4/PIJ4 PTJ3/PIJ3/TMP3CH3 PTJ2/PIJ2/TPM3CH2 PTJ1/PIJ1/TPM3CH1 PTJ0/PIJ0/TMP3CH0 PTK7 PTK6 PTK5 PTK4 PTK3 PTK2 PTK1 PTK0 PTL7 PTL6 PTL5 PTL4 PTL3 PTL2 PTL1 PTL0 PTH7 PTH6 PTH5 PTH4 PTH3/MISO2 PTH2/MOSI2 PTH1/SPSCK2 PTH0/SS2 TPM3CLK PORT J TPM3CH0 TPM3CH3 6-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM1) 2-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM2) 4-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM3) CONTROLLER AREA NETWORK (MSCAN) PORT K SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE (SPI1) SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE (SCI1) ANALOG COMPARATOR (ACMP2) IIC MODULE (IIC1) SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE (SCI2) IIC MODULE (IIC2) PORT H MISO2 MOSI2 SPSCK2 SS2 RxCAN TXCAN MISO1 MOSI1 SPSCK1 SS1 RxD1 TxD1 ACMP2O ACMP2ACMP2+ SDA1 SCL1 RxD2 TxD2 SDA2 SCL2 MULTI-PURPOSE CLOCK GENERATOR (MCG) OSCILLATOR (XOSC) XTAL EXTAL TPM1CH5 TPM1CH0 6 TPM1CLK TPM2CH1, TPM2CH0 TPM2CLK
PTC7/ADP23 PTC6/ADP22 PTC5/ADP21 PTC4/ADP20 PTC3/ADP19 PTC2/ADP18 PTC1/ADP17 PTC0/ADP16 PTD7/PID7/TPM1CH5 PTD6/PID6/TPM1CH4 PTD5/PID5/TPM1CH3 PTD4/PID4/TPM1CH2 PTD3/PID3/TPM1CH1 PTD2/PID2/TPM1CH0 PTD1/PID1/TPM2CH1 PTD0/PID0/TPM2CH0 PTE7/RxD2/RXCAN PTE6/TxD2/TXCAN PTE5/SDA1/MISO1 PTE4/SCL1/MOSI1 PTE3/SPSCK1 PTE2/SS1 PTE1/RxD1 PTE0/TxD1
4
PORT E
●
●
PORT D
PORT C
PTF7 PTF6/ACMP2O PTF5/ACMP2PTF4/ACMP2+ PTF3/TPM2CLK/SDA1 PTF2/TPM1CLK/SCL1 PTF1/RxD2 PTF0/TxD2 PTG7/SDA2 PTG6/SCL2 PTG5 PTG4 PTG3 PTG2 PTG1/XTAL PTG0/EXTAL
PORT L
PORT F PORT G
● ● ● ●
SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE (SPI2)
- Pin not connected in 64-pin and 48-pin packages ● - Pin not available in the 48-pin package - In 48-pin package, VDDA and VREFH are internally connected to each other and VSSA and VREFL are internally connected to each other.
Figure 1-1. MC9S08DZ128 Block Diagram
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 24 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 1 Device Overview
1.3
System Clock Distribution
Figure 1-2 shows a simplified clock connection diagram. Some modules in the MCU have selectable clock inputs as shown. The clock inputs to the modules indicate the clock(s) that are used to drive the module function. The following are the clocks used in this MCU: • BUSCLK — The frequency of the bus is always half of MCGOUT. • LPO — Independent 1-kHz clock that can be selected as the source for the COP and RTC modules. • MCGOUT — Primary output of the MCG and is twice the bus frequency. • MCGLCLK — Development tools can select this clock source to speed up BDC communications in systems where BUSCLK is configured to run at a very slow frequency. • MCGERCLK — External reference clock can be selected as the RTC clock source. It can also be used as the alternate clock for the ADC and MSCAN. • MCGIRCLK — Internal reference clock can be selected as the RTC clock source. • MCGFFCLK — Fixed frequency clock can be selected as clock source for the TPMx. • TPM1CLK — External input clock source for TPM1. • TPM2CLK — External input clock source for TPM2. • TPM3CLK — External input clock source for TPM3.
TPM1CLK TPM2CLK TPM3CLK 1 kHZ LPO MCGERCLK MCGIRCLK MCG TPM1 TPM2 TPM3 IIC1 IIC2 SCI1 SCI2 SPI1 SPI2
RTC
COP
MCGFFCLK
÷2 ÷2
BUSCLK
FFCLK*
MCGOUT MCGLCLK XOSC CPU
BDC
ADC
MSCAN
FLASH
EEPROM
EXTAL
XTAL
* The fixed frequency clock (FFCLK) is internally synchronized to the bus clock and must not exceed one half of the bus clock frequency.
ADC has min and max frequency requirements. See the ADC chapter and electricals appendix for details.
FLASH and EEPROM have frequency requirements for program and erase operation. See the electricals appendix for details.
Figure 1-2. System Clock Distribution Diagram
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 25
Chapter 1 Device Overview
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 26 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 2 Pins and Connections
This section describes signals that connect to package pins. It includes pinout diagrams, recommended system connections, and detailed discussions of signals.
2.1
Device Pin Assignment
This section shows the pin assignments for MC9S08DZ128 Series MCUs in the available packages.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 27
Chapter 2 Pins and Connections
100 99 98 97 96 95 94 93 92 91 90 89 88 87 86 85 84 83 82 81 80 79 78 77 76
PTA6/PIA6/ADP6 PTB5/PIB5/ADP13 PTA5/PIA5/ADP5 PTC4/ADP20 PTB4/PIB4/ADP12 PTA4/PIA4/ADP4 PTK7 PTK6 PTK5 PTK4 VDDA VREFH VREFL VSSA PTK3 PTK2 PTK1 PTK0 PTL4 PTA3/PIA3/ADP3/ACMP1O PTB3/PIB3/ADP11 PTC3/ADP19 PTA2/PIA2/ADP2/ACMP1PTB2/PIB2/ADP10 PTA1/PIA1/ADP1/ACMP1+ 75 74 73 72 71 70 69 68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51
Figure 2-1. MC9S08DZ128 Series in 100-Pin LQFP Package
28
PTE2/SS1 PTE3/SPSCK1 PTE4/SCL1/MOSI1 PTE5/SDA1/MISO1 PTG2 PTG3 PTL6 PTL7 PTF0/TxD2 PTF1/RxD2 PTF2/TPM1CLK/SCL1 PTF3/TPM2CLK/SDA1 VDD VSS PTG4 PTG5 PTG6/SCL2 PTG7/SDA2 PTE6/TxD2/TxCAN PTE7/RxD2/RxCAN PTL0 PTL1 PTL2 PTD0/PID0/TPM2CH0 PTD1/PID1/TPM2CH1
26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50
PTB6/PIB6/ADP14 PTC5/ADP21 PTA7/PIA7/ADP7/IRQ PTC6/ADP22 PTB7/PIB7/ADP15 PTC7/ADP23 PTJ0/PIJ0/TPM3CH0 PTJ1/PIJ1/TPM3CH1 VDD VSS PTG0/EXTAL PTG1/XTAL RESET PTJ2/PIJ2/TPM3CH2 PTJ3/PIJ3/TPM3CH3 PTL5 PTF4/ACMP2+ PTF5/ACMP2PTF6/ACMP2O PTJ4/PIJ4 PTJ5/PIJ5 PTJ6/PIJ6 PTJ7/PIJ7/TPM3CLK PTE0/TxD1 PTE1/RxD1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25
100-Pin LQFP
PTB1/PIB1/ADP9 PTC2/ADP18 PTA0/PIA0/ADP0/MCLK PTC1/ADP17 PTB0/PIB0/ADP8 PTC0/ADP16 PTH7 PTH6 PTH5 PTH4 BKGD/MS PTD7/PID7/TPM1CH5 PTD6/PID6/TPM1CH4 VDD VSS PTL3 PTF7 PTH3/MISO2 PTH2/MOSI2 PTH1/SPSCK2 PTH0/SS2 PTD5/PID5/TPM1CH3 PTD4/PID4/TPM1CH2 PTD3/PID3/TPM1CH1 PTD2/PID2/TPM1CH0
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 2 Pins and Connections
64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49
PTA6/PIA6/ADP6 PTB5/PIB5/ADP13 PTA5/PIA5/ADP5 PTC4/ADP20 PTB4/PIB4/ADP12 PTA4/PIA4/ADP4 VDDA VREFH VREFL VSSA PTA3/PIA3/ADP3/ACMP1O PTB3/PIB3/ADP11 PTC3/ADP19 PTA2/PIA2/ADP2/ACMP1PTB2/PIB2/ADP10 PTA1/PIA1/ADP1/ACMP1+ 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33
Figure 2-2. MC9S08DZ128 Series in 64-Pin LQFP Package
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 29
PTE2/SS1 PTE3/SPSCk1 PTE4/SCL1/MOSI1 PTE5/SDA1/MISO1 PTG2 PTG3 PTF0/TxD2 PTF1/RxD2 PTF2/TPM1CLK/SCL1 PTF3/TPM2CLK/SDA1 PTG4 PTG5 PTE6/TxD2TxCAN PTE7/RxD2/RxCAN PTD0/PID0/TPM2CH0 PTD1/PID1/TPM2CH1
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
PTB6/PIB6/ADP14 PTC5/ADP21 PTA7/PIA7/ADP7/IRQ PTC6/ADP22 PTB7/PIB7/ADP15 PTC7/ADP23 VDD VSS PTG0/EXTAL PTG1/XTAL RESET PTF4/ACMP2+ PTF5/ACMP2PTF6/ACMP2O PTE0/TxD1 PTE1/RxD1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
64-Pin LQFP
PTB1/PIB1/ADP9 PTC2/ADP18 PTA0/PIA0/ADP0/MCLK PTC1/ADP17 PTB0/PIB0/ADP8 PTC0/ADP16 BKGD/MS PTD7/PID7/TPM1CH5 PTD6/PID6/TPM1CH4 VDD VSS PTF7 PTD5/PID5/TPM1CH3 PTD4/PID4/TPM1CH2 PTD3/PID3/TPM1CH1 PTD2/PID2/TPM1CH0
Chapter 2 Pins and Connections
48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37
PTA6/PIA6/ADP6 PTB5/PIB5/ADP13 PTA5/PIA5/ADP5 PTB4/PIB4/ADP12 PTA4/PIA4/ADP4 VDDA/VREFH VSSA/VREFL PTA3/PIA3/ADP3/ACMP1O PTB3/PIB3/ADP11 PTA2/PIA2/ADP2/ACMP1PTB2/PIB2/ADP10 PTA1/PIA1/ADP1/ACMP1+ PTB6/PIB6/ADP14 PTA7/PIA7/ADP7/IRQ PTB7/PIB7/ADP15 VDD VSS PTG0/EXTAL PTG1/XTAL RESET PTF4/ACMP2+ PTF5/ACMP2PTE0/TxD1 PTE1/RxD1 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25
VREFH and VREFL are internally connected to VDDA and VSSA, respectively.
Figure 2-3. MC9S08DZ128 Series in 48-Pin LQFP
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 30 Freescale Semiconductor
PTE2/SS1 PTE3/SPSCK1 PTE4/SCL1/MOSI1 PTE5/SDA1/MISO1 PTF0/TxD2 PTF1/RxD2 PTF2/TPM1CLK/SCL1 PTF3/TPM2CLK/SDA1 PTE6/TxD2/TXCAN PTE7/RxD2/RXCAN PTD0/PID0/TPM2CH0 PTD1/PID1/TPM2CH1
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
48-Pin LQFP
PTB1/PIB1/ADP9 PTA0/PIA0/ADP0/MCLK PTB0/PIB0/ADP8 BKGD/MS PTD7/PID7/TPM1CH5 PTD6/PID6/TPM1CH4 VDD VSS PTD5/PID5/TPM1CH3 PTD4/PID4/TPM1CH2 PTD3/PID3/TPM1CH1 PTD2/PID2/TPM1CH0
Chapter 2 Pins and Connections
2.2
Recommended System Connections
VDD + 5V CBLK + 10 μF CBY 0.1 μF VSS SYSTEM POWER VDDA VREFH VREFL VSSA IRQ PORT A MC9S08DZ128
Figure 2-4 shows pin connections that are common to MC9S08DZ128 Series application systems.
CBY 0.1 μF
PTA0/PIA0/ADP0/MCLK PTA1/PIA1/ADP1/ACMP1+ PTA2/PIA2/ADP2/ACMP1PTA3/PIA3/ADP3/ACMP1O PTA4/PIA4/ADP4 PTA5/PIA5/ADP5 PTA6/PIA6/ADP6 PTA7/PIA7/ADP7/IRQ PTB0/PIB0/ADP8 PTB1/PIB1/ADP9 PTB2/PIB2/ADP10 PTB3/PIB3/ADP11 PTB4/PIB4/ADP12 PTB5/PIB5/ADP13 PTB6/PIB6/ADP14 PTB7/PIB7/ADP15 PTC0/ADP16 PTC1/ADP17 PTC2/ADP18 PTC3/ADP19 PTC4/ADP20 PTC5/ADP21 PTC6/ADP22 PTC7/ADP23 PTD0/PID0/TPM2CH0 PTD1/PID1/TPM2CH1 PTD2/PID2/TPM1CH0 PTD3/PID3/TPM1CH1 PTD4/PID4/TPM1CH2 PTD5/PID5/TPM1CH3 PTD6/PID6/TPM1CH4 PTD7/PID7/TPM1CH5 PTE0/TxD1 PTE1/RxD1 PTE2/SS1 PTE3/SPSCK1 PTE4/SCL1/MOSI1 PTE5/SDA1/MISO1 PTE6/TxD2/TXCAN PTE7/RxD2/RXCAN PTF0/TxD2 PTF1/RxD2 PTF2/TPM1CLK/SCL1 PTF3/TPM2CLK/SDA1 PTF4/ACMP2+ PTF5/ACMP2– PTF6/ACMP2O RS PTF7 PTG0/EXTAL PTG1/XTAL PTG2 PTG3 PTG4 PTG5 PTG6/SCL2 PTG7/SDA2 C1 X1
BACKGROUND HEADER VDD BKGD/MS VDD 4.7 kΩ–10 kΩ RESET
PORT B
PORT C
OPTIONAL MANUAL RESET
PTL0 PTL1 PTL2 PTL3 PTL4 PTL5 PTL6 PTL7 PTK0 PTK1 PTK2 PTK3 PTK4 PTK5 PTK6 PTK7 PTJ0/PIJ0/TPM3CH0 PTJ1/PIJ1/TPM3CH1 PTJ2/PIJ2/TPM3CH2 PTJ3/PIJ3/TPM3CH3 PTJ4/PIJ4 PTJ5/PIJ5 PTJ6/PIJ6 PTJ7/PIJ7/TPM3CLK PTH0/SS2 PTH1/SPSCK2 PTH2/MOSI2 PTH3/MISO2 PTH4 PTH5 PTH6 PTH7
0.1 μF
PORT L
PORT D
PORT K
PORT E
PORT J
PORT F
RF C2
PORT H
PORT G
Figure 2-4. Basic System Connections (Shown in 100Pin Package)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 31
Chapter 2 Pins and Connections
2.2.1
Power
VDD and VSS are the primary power supply pins for the MCU. This voltage source supplies power to all I/O buffer circuitry and to an internal voltage regulator. The internal voltage regulator provides regulated lower-voltage source to the CPU and other internal circuitry of the MCU. Typically, application systems have two separate capacitors across the power pins. In this case, there should be a bulk electrolytic capacitor, such as a 10-μF tantalum capacitor, to provide bulk charge storage for the overall system and a 0.1-μF ceramic bypass capacitor located as near to the MCU power pins as practical to suppress high-frequency noise. The MC9S08DZ128 Series has up to three VDD pins. Each pin must have a bypass capacitor for best noise suppression. VDDA and VSSA are the analog power supply pins for the MCU. This voltage source supplies power to the ADC module. A 0.1-μF ceramic bypass capacitor should be located as near to the MCU power pins as practical to suppress high-frequency noise.
2.2.2
Oscillator
Immediately after reset, the MCU uses an internally generated clock provided by the multi-purpose clock generator (MCG) module. For more information on the MCG, see Chapter 8, “Multi-Purpose Clock Generator (S08MCGV2).” The oscillator (XOSC) in this MCU is a Pierce oscillator that can accommodate a crystal or ceramic resonator. Rather than a crystal or ceramic resonator, an external oscillator can be connected to the EXTAL input pin. Refer to Figure 2-4 for the following discussion. RS (when used) and RF should be low-inductance resistors such as carbon composition resistors. Wire-wound resistors and some metal film resistors have too much inductance. C1 and C2 normally should be high-quality ceramic capacitors that are specifically designed for high-frequency applications. RF is used to provide a bias path to keep the EXTAL input in its linear range during crystal startup; its value is not generally critical. Typical systems use 1 MΩ to 10 MΩ. Higher values are sensitive to humidity, and lower values reduce gain and (in extreme cases) could prevent startup. C1 and C2 are typically in the 5-pF to 25-pF range and are chosen to match the requirements of a specific crystal or resonator. Be sure to take into account printed circuit board (PCB) capacitance and MCU pin capacitance when selecting C1 and C2. The crystal manufacturer typically specifies a load capacitance which is the series combination of C1 and C2 (which are usually the same size). As a first-order approximation, use 10 pF as an estimate of combined pin and PCB capacitance for each oscillator pin (EXTAL and XTAL).
2.2.3
RESET
RESET is a dedicated pin with a pull-up device built in. It has input hysteresis, a high current output driver, and no output slew rate control. Internal power-on reset and low-voltage reset circuitry typically make external reset circuitry unnecessary. This pin is normally connected to the standard 6-pin background debug connector so a development system can directly reset the MCU system. If desired, a manual external reset can be added by supplying a simple switch to ground (pull reset pin low to force a reset).
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 32 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 2 Pins and Connections
Whenever any reset is initiated (whether from an external signal or from an internal system), the RESET pin is driven low for about 34 bus cycles. The reset circuitry decodes the cause of reset and records it by setting a corresponding bit in the system reset status register (SRS).
2.2.4
Background / Mode Select (BKGD/MS)
While in reset, the BKGD/MS pin functions as a mode select pin. Immediately after reset rises, the pin functions as the background pin and can be used for background debug communication. While functioning as a background or mode select pin, the pin includes an internal pull-up device, input hysteresis, a standard output driver, and no output slew rate control. If nothing is connected to this pin, the MCU will enter normal operating mode at the rising edge of reset. If a debug system is connected to the 6-pin standard background debug header, it can hold BKGD low during the rising edge of reset which forces the MCU to active background mode. The BKGD/MS pin is used primarily for background debug controller (BDC) communications using a custom protocol that uses 16 clock cycles of the target MCU’s BDC clock per bit time. The target MCU’s BDC clock could be as fast as the bus clock rate, so there should never be any significant capacitance connected to the BKGD/MS pin that could interfere with background serial communications. Although the BKGD/MS pin is a pseudo open-drain pin, the background debug communication protocol provides brief, actively driven, high speedup pulses to ensure fast rise times. Small capacitances from cables and the absolute value of the internal pull-up device play almost no role in determining rise and fall times on the BKGD/MS pin.
2.2.5
ADC Reference (VREFH, VREFL) Pins
The VREFH and VREFL pins are the voltage reference high and voltage reference low inputs, respectively, for the ADC module.
2.2.6
General-Purpose I/O and Peripheral Ports
The MC9S08DZ128 Series series of MCUs support up to 87 general-purpose I/O pins and 1 input-only pin, which are shared with on-chip peripheral functions (timers, serial I/O, ADC, MSCAN, etc.). When a port pin is configured as a general-purpose output or a peripheral uses the port pin as an output, software can select one of two drive strengths and enable or disable slew rate control. When a port pin is configured as a general-purpose input or a peripheral uses the port pin as an input, software can enable a pull-up device. Immediately after reset, all of these pins are configured as high-impedance general-purpose inputs with internal pull-up devices disabled. When an on-chip peripheral system is controlling a pin, data direction control bits still determine what is read from port data registers even though the peripheral module controls the pin direction by controlling the enable for the pin’s output buffer. For information about controlling these pins as general-purpose I/O pins, see Chapter 6, “Parallel Input/Output Control.”
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 33
Chapter 2 Pins and Connections
NOTE To avoid extra current drain from floating input pins, the reset initialization routine in the application program should either enable on-chip pull-up devices or change the direction of unused or non-bonded pins to outputs so they do not float.
Table 2-1. Pin Availability by Package Pin-Count
Pin Number 100 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 64 1 2 3 4 5 6 — — — — 7 8 9 10 11 — 12 13 14 — — — — 15 16 48 1 — 2 — 3 — — — — — 4 5 6 7 8 — 9 10 — — — — — 11 12 PTL5 PTF4 PTF5 PTF6 PTJ4 PTJ5 PTJ6 PTJ7 PTE0 PTE1
1
Highest Alt 1 Alt 2
ADP14 ADP21 ADP7 ADP22 ADP15 ADP23 TPM3CH0 TPM3CH1 TPM3CH2 TPM3CH3 VDD VSS IRQ
PTG0 PTG1
EXTAL XTAL RESET ACMP2+ ACMP2ACMP2O PIJ4 PIJ5 PIJ6 PIJ7 TPM3CLK TxD1 RxD1
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 34 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 2 Pins and Connections
Table 2-1. Pin Availability by Package Pin-Count (continued)
Pin Number 100 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 64 17 18 19 20 21 22 — — 23 24 25 26 — — 27 28 — — 29 30 — — — 31 32 48 13 14 15 16 — — — — 17 18 19 20 — — — — — — 21 22 — — — 23 24 PTG4 PTG5 PTG6 PTG7 PTE6 PTE7 PTL0 PTL1 PTL2 PTD0 PTD1 PID0 PID1 TPM2CH0 TPM2CH1 TxD2
3
Highest Alt 1 Alt 2 SS1 SPSCK1
SCL12 SDA12
MOSI1 MISO1
TxD23 RxD23 TPM1CLK TPM2CLK SCL12 SDA12 VDD VSS
SCL2 SDA2 TXCAN RxCAN RxD23
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 35
Chapter 2 Pins and Connections
Table 2-1. Pin Availability by Package Pin-Count (continued)
Pin Number 100 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 64 33 34 35 36 — — — — 37 — 38 39 40 41 42 — — — — 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 — — — — — 55 56 48 25 26 27 28 — — — — — — 29 30 31 32 33 — — — — — 34 — 35 — 36 37 38 39 — 40 41 — — — — — 42 PTH4 PTH5 PTH6 PTH7 PTC0 PTB0 PTC1 PTA0 PTC2 PTB1 PTA1 PTB2 PTA2 PTC3 PTB3 PTA3 PTL4 PTK0 PTK1 PTK2 PTK3 VSSA VREFL PIB3 PIA3 PIB1 PIA1 PIB2 PIA2 PIA0 PIB0 ADP16 ADP8 ADP17 ADP0 ADP18 ADP9 ADP14 ADP10 ADP24 ADP19 ADP11 ADP3 ACMP1O ACMP1-4 ACMP1+4 MCLK PTD6 PTD7 PID6 PID7 BKGD PTD2 PTD3 PTD4 PTD5 PTH0 PTH1 PTH2 PTH3 PTF7 PTL3 VSS VDD TPM1CH4 TPM1CH5 MS Highest Alt 1 Alt 2 TPM1CH0 TPM1CH1 TPM1CH2 TPM1CH3 SS2 SPSCK2 MOSI2 MISO2
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 36 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 2 Pins and Connections
Table 2-1. Pin Availability by Package Pin-Count (continued)
Pin Number 100 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100
1
Highest Alt 1 Alt 2 VREFH VDDA
64 57 58 — — — — 59 60 61 62 63 64
ADP4 ADP12 ADP20 ADP5 ADP13 ADP6
Pin does not contain a clamp diode to VDD and should not be driven above VDD. The voltage measured on this pin when internal pull-up is enabled may be as low as VDD - 0.7V. The internal gates connected to this pin are pulled to VDD. 2 The IIC1 module pins can be repositioned using IIC1PS bit in the SOPT1 register. The default reset locations are on PTF2 and PTF3. 3 The SCI2 module pins can be repositioned using SCI2PS bit in the SOPT1 register. The default reset locations are on PTF0 and PTF1. 4 If both these analog modules are enabled they both will have access to the pin.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 37
Chapter 2 Pins and Connections
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 38 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 3 Modes of Operation
3.1 Introduction
The operating modes of the MC9S08DZ128 Series are described in this chapter. Entry into each mode, exit from each mode, and functionality while in each of the modes are described.
3.2
• • •
Features
Active background mode for code development Wait mode — CPU shuts down to conserve power; system clocks are running and full regulation is maintained Stop modes — System clocks are stopped and voltage regulator is in standby — Stop3 — All internal circuits are powered for fast recovery — Stop2 — Partial power down of internal circuits; RAM content is retained
3.3
Run Mode
This is the normal operating mode for the MC9S08DZ128 Series. This mode is selected when the BKGD/MS pin is high at the rising edge of reset. In this mode, the CPU executes code from internal memory with execution beginning at the address fetched from memory at 0xFFFE–0xFFFF after reset.
3.4
Active Background Mode
The active background mode functions are managed through the background debug controller (BDC) in the HCS08 core. The BDC, together with the on-chip debug module (DBG), provide the means for analyzing MCU operation during software development. Active background mode is entered in any of five ways: • When the BKGD/MS pin is low at the rising edge of reset • When a BACKGROUND command is received through the BKGD/MS pin • When a BGND instruction is executed • When encountering a BDC breakpoint • When encountering a DBG breakpoint After entering active background mode, the CPU is held in a suspended state waiting for serial background commands rather than executing instructions from the user application program.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 39
Chapter 3 Modes of Operation
Background commands are of two types: • Non-intrusive commands, defined as commands that can be issued while the user program is running. Non-intrusive commands can be issued through the BKGD/MS pin while the MCU is in run mode; non-intrusive commands can also be executed when the MCU is in the active background mode. Non-intrusive commands include: — Memory access commands — Memory-access-with-status commands — BDC register access commands — The BACKGROUND command • Active background commands, which can only be executed while the MCU is in active background mode. Active background commands include commands to: — Read or write CPU registers — Trace one user program instruction at a time — Leave active background mode to return to the user application program (GO) The active background mode is used to program a bootloader or user application program into the FLASH program memory before the MCU is operated in run mode for the first time. When the MC9S08DZ128 Series is shipped from the Freescale Semiconductor factory, the FLASH program memory is erased by default unless specifically noted so there is no program that could be executed in run mode until the FLASH memory is initially programmed. The active background mode can also be used to erase and reprogram the FLASH memory after it has been previously programmed. For additional information about the active background mode, refer to the Development Support chapter.
3.5
Wait Mode
Wait mode is entered by executing a WAIT instruction. Upon execution of the WAIT instruction, the CPU enters a low-power state in which it is not clocked. The I bit in CCR is cleared when the CPU enters the wait mode, enabling interrupts. When an interrupt request occurs, the CPU exits the wait mode and resumes processing, beginning with the stacking operations leading to the interrupt service routine. While the MCU is in wait mode, there are some restrictions on which background debug commands can be used. Only the BACKGROUND command and memory-access-with-status commands are available when the MCU is in wait mode. The memory-access-with-status commands do not allow memory access, but they report an error indicating that the MCU is in either stop or wait mode. The BACKGROUND command can be used to wake the MCU from wait mode and enter active background mode.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 40 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 3 Modes of Operation
3.6
Stop Modes
One of two stop modes is entered upon execution of a STOP instruction when the STOPE bit in SOPT1 register is set. In both stop modes, all internal clocks are halted. The MCG module can be configured to leave the reference clocks running. See Chapter 8, “Multi-Purpose Clock Generator (S08MCGV2),” for more information. Table 3-1 shows all of the control bits that affect stop mode selection and the mode selected under various conditions. The selected mode is entered following the execution of a STOP instruction.
Table 3-1. Stop Mode Selection
STOPE 0 1 1 1 1
1 2
ENBDM 1 x 1 0 0 0
LVDE x x
LVDSE
PPDC x x x3 0 1
Stop Mode Stop modes disabled; illegal opcode reset if STOP instruction executed Stop3 with BDM enabled 2 Stop3 with voltage regulator active Stop3 Stop2
Both bits must be 1 Either bit a 0 Either bit a 0
ENBDM is located in the BDCSCR, which is only accessible through BDC commands, see the Development Support chapter. When in Stop3 mode with BDM enabled, The SIDD will be near RIDD levels because internal clocks are enabled. 3 If LVD = 1 in stop, the MCU enters stop3, regardless of the configuration of PPDC.
3.6.1
Stop3 Mode
Stop3 mode is entered by executing a STOP instruction under the conditions as shown in Table 3-1. The states of all of the internal registers and logic, RAM contents, and I/O pin states are maintained. Exit from stop3 is done by asserting RESET or an asynchronous interrupt pin. The asynchronous interrupt pins are IRQ, PIA0–PIA7, PIB0–PIB7, PID0–PID7, and PIJ0–PIJ7. Exit from stop3 can also be done by the low voltage detection (LVD) reset, the low voltage warning (LVW) interrupt, the ADC conversion complete interrupt, the analog comparator interrupt, the real-time clock (RTC) interrupt, the MSCAN wake-up interrupt, or the SCI receiver interrupt. If stop3 is exited by means of the RESET pin, the MCU will be reset and operation will resume after fetching the reset vector. Exit by means of an interrupt will result in the MCU fetching the appropriate interrupt vector.
3.6.1.1
LVD Enabled in Stop3 Mode
The LVD system is capable of generating either an interrupt or a reset when the supply voltage drops below the LVD voltage. If the LVD is enabled in stop (LVDE and LVDSE bits in SPMSC1 both set) at the time the CPU executes a STOP instruction, then the voltage regulator remains active during stop mode. For the ADC to operate or for the ACMP to be used when comparing with an internal voltage, the LVD must be left enabled when entering stop3.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 41
Chapter 3 Modes of Operation
3.6.1.2
Active BDM Enabled in Stop3 Mode
Entry into the active background mode from run mode is enabled if ENBDM in BDCSCR is set. This register is described in Chapter 17, “Development Support.” If ENBDM is set when the CPU executes a STOP instruction, the system clocks to the background debug logic remain active when the MCU enters stop mode. Because of this, background debug communication remains possible. In addition, the voltage regulator does not enter its low-power standby state but maintains full internal regulation. Most background commands are not available in stop mode. The memory-access-with-status commands do not allow memory access, but they report an error indicating that the MCU is in either stop or wait mode. The BACKGROUND command can be used to wake the MCU from stop and enter active background mode if the ENBDM bit is set. After entering background debug mode, all background commands are available.
3.6.2
Stop2 Mode
Stop2 mode is entered by executing a STOP instruction under the conditions as shown in Table 3-1. Most of the internal circuitry of the MCU is powered off in stop2 with the exception of the RAM. Upon entering stop2, all I/O pin control signals are latched so that the pins retain their states during stop2. Exit from stop2 is performed by asserting RESET. In addition, the real-time counter (RTC) can wake the MCU from stop2, if enabled. Upon wake-up from stop2 mode, the MCU starts up as from a power-on reset (POR): • All module control and status registers are reset • The LVD reset function is enabled and the MCU remains in the reset state if VDD is below the LVD trip point (low trip point selected due to POR) • The CPU takes the reset vector In addition to the above, upon waking up from stop2, the PPDF bit in SPMSC2 is set. This flag is used to direct user code to go to a stop2 recovery routine. PPDF remains set and the I/O pin states remain latched until a 1 is written to PPDACK in SPMSC2. To maintain I/O states for pins that were configured as general-purpose I/O before entering stop2, the user must restore the contents of the I/O port registers, which have been saved in RAM, to the port registers before writing to the PPDACK bit. If the port registers are not restored from RAM before writing to PPDACK, then the pins will switch to their reset states when PPDACK is written. For pins that were configured as peripheral I/O, the user must reconfigure the peripheral module that interfaces to the pin before writing to the PPDACK bit. If the peripheral module is not enabled before writing to PPDACK, the pins will be controlled by their associated port control registers when the I/O latches are opened.
3.6.3
On-Chip Peripheral Modules in Stop Modes
When the MCU enters any stop mode, system clocks to the internal peripheral modules are stopped. Even in the exception case (ENBDM = 1), where clocks to the background debug logic continue to operate,
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 42 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 3 Modes of Operation
clocks to the peripheral systems are halted to reduce power consumption. Refer to Section 3.6.1, “Stop3 Mode” and Section 3.6.1, “Stop3 Mode” for specific information on system behavior in stop modes.
Table 3-2. Stop Mode Behavior
Mode Peripheral Stop2 CPU RAM FLASH/EEPROM Parallel Port Registers ACMP ADC IIC MCG MSCAN RTC SCI SPI TPM Voltage Regulator XOSC I/O Pins
1 2 3 4 5 6
Stop3 Standby Standby Standby Standby Optionally On1 Optionally On2 Standby Optionally On3 Standby On4 Optionally On4 Standby Standby Standby
5
Off Standby Off Off Off Off Off Off Off Optionally Off Off Off Optionally On Off States Held
Optionally On5 Optionally On6 States Held
Requires the LVD to be enabled, else in standby. Requires the asynchronous ADC clock and LVD to be enabled, else in standby. IRCLKEN and IREFSTEN set in MCGC1, else in standby. Requires the RTC to be enabled, else in standby. Requires the LVD or BDC to be enabled. ERCLKEN and EREFSTEN set in MCGC2 for, else in standby. For high frequency range (RANGE in MCGC2 set) requires the LVD to also be enabled in stop3.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 43
Chapter 3 Modes of Operation
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 44 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 4 Memory
4.1 MC9S08DZ128 Series Memory Map
On-chip memory in the MC9S08DZ128 Series consists of RAM, EEPROM, and FLASH program memory for nonvolatile data storage, and I/O and control/status registers. The registers are divided into three groups: • Direct-page registers (0x0000 through 0x007F) • High-page registers (0x1800 through 0x18FF) • Nonvolatile registers (0xFFB0 through 0xFFBF)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 45
Chapter 4 Memory
Extended Address 0x0_0000 0x0_007F 0x0_0080
CPU Address 0x0000 DIRECT PAGE REGISTERS 0x007F 128 BYTES 0x0080 RAM 6016 BYTES All 128K bytes of Flash can also be accessed through the linear address pointer. 0x17FF 0x1800 0x18FF 0x1900 0x217F 0x2180 0x3BFF 0x3C00 0x3FFF 0x4000 Extended Address 0x1_C000 - 0x1_FFFF 0x1_8000 - 0x1_BFFF 0x1_4000 - 0x1_7FFF 0x1_0000 - 0x1_3FFF 0x0_C000 - 0x0_FFFF 0x0_8000 - 0x0_BFFF 0x0_4000 - 0x0_7FFF 0x0_0000 - 0x0_3FFF FLASH 16384 BYTES 0xBFFF 0xC000 PPAGE=3 FLASH 16384 BYTES PPAGE=0 PPAGE=1 PPAGE=2 PPAGE=3 PPAGE=4 PPAGE=6 PPAGE=7
0x0_17FF 0x0_1800 0x0_18FF 0x0_1900 0x0_217F 0x0_2180 0x0_3BFF 0x0_3C00 0x0_3FFF 0x0_4000
HIGH PAGE REGISTERS 256 BYTES RAM 2176 BYTES PPAGE=0 FLASH 6784 BYTES EEPROM1 2 x 1024 BYTES PPAGE=1 FLASH 16384 BYTES
0x0_7FFF 0x0_8000 Paging Window Extended addresses formed with PPAGE and CPU addresses A13:A0 0x0_BFFF 0x0_C000
0x7FFF 0x8000
0x0_FFFF
1
0xFFFF
EEPROM address range shows half the total EEPROM. See Section 4.6.10, “EEPROM Mapping” for more
Figure 4-1. MC9S08DZ128 Series Memory Map
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 46 Freescale Semiconductor
PPAGE=5
Chapter 4 Memory
Extended Address 0x0_0000 0x0_007F 0x0_0080 DIRECT PAGE REGISTERS 128 BYTES RAM 6016 BYTES 0x0_17FF 0x0_1800 0x0_18FF 0x0_1900 HIGH PAGE REGISTERS 256 BYTES PPAGE=0 FLASH 8960 BYTES 0x0_3BFF 0x0_3C00 0x0_3FFF 0x0_4000 EEPROM1 2 x 1024 BYTES PPAGE=1 FLASH 16384 BYTES 0x0_7FFF 0x0_8000
CPU Address 0x0000 0x007F 0x0080 All 96K bytes of Flash can also be accessed through the linear address pointer.
0x1_C000 - 0x1_FFFF 0x1_8000 - 0x1_BFFF RESERVED 16384 BYTES PPAGE=6 PPAGE=7
0x17FF 0x1800 0x18FF 0x1900
0x3BFF 0x3C00 0x3FFF 0x4000 Extended Address 0x1_4000 - 0x1_7FFF 0x1_0000 - 0x1_3FFF 0x0_C000 - 0x0_FFFF 0x0_8000 - 0x0_BFFF 0x0_4000 - 0x0_7FFF 0x0_0000 - 0x0_3FFF FLASH 16384 BYTES 0xBFFF 0xC000 PPAGE=0 PPAGE=1 PPAGE=2 PPAGE=3 PPAGE=4
0x7FFF 0x8000 Paging Window Extended addresses formed with PPAGE and CPU addresses A13:A0
0x0_BFFF 0x0_C000 PPAGE=3 FLASH 16384 BYTES 0x0_FFFF
1
0xFFFF
EEPROM address range shows half the total EEPROM. See Section 4.6.10, “EEPROM Mapping” for more details.
Figure 4-2. MC9S08DZ96 Memory Map
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 47
PPAGE=5
Chapter 4 Memory
Extended Address 0x0_0000 0x0_0080 RAM 6016 BYTES 0x0_17FF 0x0_1800 0x0_18FF 0x0_1900 HIGH PAGE REGISTERS 256 BYTES DIRECT PAGE REGISTERS 128 BYTES
CPU Address 0x0000 0x007F 0x0080
All 128K bytes of Flash can also be accessed through the linear address pointer.
0x17FF 0x1800 0x18FF 0x1900
PPAGE=0 FLASH 9984 BYTES 0x0_3FFF 0x0_4000 PPAGE=1 FLASH 16384 BYTES 0x0_7FFF 0x0_8000 Paging Window Extended addresses formed with PPAGE and CPU addresses A13:A0 0x0_BFFF 0x0_C000 PPAGE=3 FLASH 16384 BYTES 0x0_FFFF 0xFFFF 0xBFFF 0xC000 0x7FFF 0x8000 0x3FFF 0x4000
Extended Address 0x1_C000 - 0x1_FFFF 0x1_8000 - 0x1_BFFF 0x1_4000 - 0x1_7FFF 0x1_0000 - 0x1_3FFF 0x0_C000 - 0x0_FFFF 0x0_8000 - 0x0_BFFF 0x0_4000 - 0x0_7FFF 0x0_0000 - 0x0_3FFF FLASH 16384 BYTES PPAGE=0 PPAGE=1 PPAGE=2 PPAGE=3 PPAGE=4 PPAGE=6 PPAGE=7
Figure 4-3. MC9S08DV128 Memory Map
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 48 Freescale Semiconductor
PPAGE=5
Chapter 4 Memory
Extended Address 0x0_0000 0x0_007F 0x0_0080 0x0_107F 0x0_1080 DIRECT PAGE REGISTERS 128 BYTES RAM 4096 BYTES PPAGE=0 FLASH 1920 BYTES 0x0_17FF 0x0_1800 0x0_18FF 0x0_1900 HIGH PAGE REGISTERS 256 BYTES PPAGE=0 FLASH 9984 BYTES 0x0_3FFF 0x0_4000 PPAGE=1 FLASH 16384 BYTES 0x0_7FFF 0x0_8000
CPU Address 0x0000 0x007F 0x0080 0x107F 0x1080 All 96K bytes of Flash can also be accessed through the linear address pointer.
0x1_C000 - 0x1_FFFF 0x1_8000 - 0x1_BFFF RESERVED 16384 BYTES PPAGE=6 PPAGE=7
0x17FF 0x1800 0x18FF 0x1900
0x3FFF 0x4000
FLASH 16384 BYTES 0xBFFF 0xC000
0x0_BFFF 0x0_C000 PPAGE=3 FLASH 16384 BYTES 0x0_FFFF
0xFFFF
Figure 4-4. MC9S08DV96 Memory Map
4.2
Reset and Interrupt Vector Assignments
Table 4-1 shows address assignments for reset and interrupt vectors. The vector names shown in this table are the labels used in the MC9S08DZ128 Series equate file provided by Freescale Semiconductor.
Table 4-1. Reset and Interrupt Vectors
Address (High:Low) 0xFF80:0xFF81 0xFF8E:0xFF8F 0xFF90:0xFF91 0xFF92:0xFF93 0xFF94:0xFF95 0xFF96:0xFF97 0xFF98:0xFF99 0xFF9A:0xFF9B Vector Reserved Port J IIC2 SPI2 TPM3 Overflow TPM3 Channel 3 TPM3 Channel 2 Vector Name Reserved Vportj Viic2 Vspi2 Vtpm3ovf Vtpm3ch3 Vtpm3ch2
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 49
PPAGE=0
Paging Window Extended addresses formed with PPAGE and CPU addresses A13:A0
PPAGE=1
PPAGE=2
0x7FFF 0x8000
PPAGE=3
PPAGE=4
Extended Address 0x1_4000 - 0x1_7FFF 0x1_0000 - 0x1_3FFF 0x0_C000 - 0x0_FFFF 0x0_8000 - 0x0_BFFF 0x0_4000 - 0x0_7FFF 0x0_0000 - 0x0_3FFF
PPAGE=5
Chapter 4 Memory
Table 4-1. Reset and Interrupt Vectors (continued)
Address (High:Low) 0xFF9C:0xFF9D 0xFF9E:0xFF9F 0xFFA0:0xFFBF 0xFFC0:0xFFC1 0xFFC2:0xFFC3 0xFFC4:0xFFC5 0xFFC6:0xFFC7 0xFFC8:0xFFC9 0xFFCA:0xFFCB 0xFFCC:0xFFCD 0xFFCE:0xFFCF 0xFFD0:0xFFD1 0xFFD2:0xFFD3 0xFFD4:0xFFD5 0xFFD6:0xFFD7 0xFFD8:0xFFD9 0xFFDA:0xFFDB 0xFFDC:0xFFDD 0xFFDE:0xFFDF 0xFFE0:0xFFE1 0xFFE2:0xFFE3 0xFFE4:0xFFE5 0xFFE6:0xFFE7 0xFFE8:0xFFE9 0xFFEA:0xFFEB 0xFFEC:0xFFED 0xFFEE:0xFFEF 0xFFF0:0xFFF1 0xFFF2:0xFFF3 0xFFF4:0xFFF5 0xFFF6:0xFFF7 0xFFF8:0xFFF9 0xFFFA:0xFFFB 0xFFFC:0xFFFD 0xFFFE:0xFFFF Vector TPM3 Channel 1 TPM3 Channel 0 Non-vector space ACMP2 ACMP1 MSCAN Transmit MSCAN Receive MSCAN errors MSCAN wake up RTC IIC1 ADC Conversion Port A, Port B, Port D SCI2 Transmit SCI2 Receive SCI2 Error SCI1 Transmit SCI1 Receive SCI1 Error SPI1 TPM2 Overflow TPM2 Channel 1 TPM2 Channel 0 TPM1 Overflow TPM1 Channel 5 TPM1 Channel 4 TPM1 Channel 3 TPM1 Channel 2 TPM1 Channel 1 TPM1 Channel 0 MCG Loss of lock Low-Voltage Detect IRQ SWI Reset Vector Name Vtpm3ch1 Vtpm3ch0 N/A Vacmp2 Vacmp1 Vcantx Vcanrx Vcanerr Vcanwu Vrtc Viic1 Vadc Vport Vsci2tx Vsci2rx Vsci2err Vsci1tx Vsci1rx Vsci1err Vspi1 Vtpm2ovf Vtpm2ch1 Vtpm2ch0 Vtpm1ovf Vtpm1ch5 Vtpm1ch4 Vtpm1ch3 Vtpm1ch2 Vtpm1ch1 Vtpm1ch0 Vlol Vlvd Virq Vswi Vreset
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 50 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 4 Memory
4.3
Register Addresses and Bit Assignments
The registers in the MC9S08DZ128 Series are divided into these groups: • Direct-page registers are located in the first 128 locations in the memory map; these are accessible with efficient direct addressing mode instructions. • High-page registers are used much less often, so they are located above 0x1800 in the memory map. This leaves more room in the direct page for more frequently used registers and RAM. • The nonvolatile register area consists of a block of 16 locations in FLASH memory at 0xFFB0–0xFFBF. Nonvolatile register locations include: — NVPROT and NVOPT are loaded into working registers at reset — An 8-byte backdoor comparison key that optionally allows a user to gain controlled access to secure memory Because the nonvolatile register locations are FLASH memory, they must be erased and programmed like other FLASH memory locations. Direct-page registers can be accessed with efficient direct addressing mode instructions. Bit manipulation instructions can be used to access any bit in any direct-page register. Table 4-2 is a summary of all user-accessible direct-page registers and control bits. The direct page registers in Table 4-2 can use the more efficient direct addressing mode, which requires only the lower byte of the address. Because of this, the lower byte of the address in column one is shown in bold text. In Table 4-3 and Table 4-5, the whole address in column one is shown in bold. In Table 4-2, Table 4-3, and Table 4-5, the register names in column two are shown in bold to set them apart from the bit names to the right. Cells that are not associated with named bits are shaded. A shaded cell with a 0 indicates this unused bit always reads as a 0. Shaded cells with dashes indicate unused or reserved bit locations that could read as 1s or 0s.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 51
Chapter 4 Memory
Table 4-2. Direct-Page Register Summary (Sheet 1 of 4)
Address Register Name Bit 7 PTAD7 PTADD7 PTBD7 PTBDD7 PTCD7 PTCDD7 PTDD7 PTDDD7 PTED7 PTEDD7 PTFD7 PTFDD7 PTGD7 PTGDD7 ACME ACME COCO ADACT 0 ADR7 0 ADCV7 ADLPC ADPC7 ADPC15 ADPC23 — — 0 — — TOF Bit 15 Bit 7 Bit 15 Bit 7 CH0F Bit 15 Bit 7 6 PTAD6 PTADD6 PTBD6 PTBDD6 PTCD6 PTCDD6 PTDD6 PTDDD6 PTED6 PTEDD6 PTFD6 PTFDD6 PTGD6 PTGDD6 ACBGS ACBGS AIEN ADTRG 0 ADR6 0 ADCV6 ADPC6 ADPC14 ADPC22 — — IRQPDD — — TOIE 14 6 14 6 CH0IE 14 6 ADIV ADPC5 ADPC13 ADPC21 — — IRQEDG — — CPWMS 13 5 13 5 MS0B 13 5 5 PTAD5 PTADD5 PTBD5 PTBDD5 PTCD5 PTCDD5 PTDD5 PTDDD5 PTED5 PTEDD5 PTFD5 PTFDD5 PTGD5 PTGDD5 ACF ACF ADCO ACFE 0 ADR5 0 ADCV5 ACFGT 0 ADR4 0 ADCV4 ADLSMP ADPC4 ADPC12 ADPC20 — — IRQPE — — CLKSB 12 4 12 4 MS0A 12 4 0 ADR11 ADR3 ADC11 ADCV3 ADPC3 ADPC11 ADPC19 — — IRQF — — CLKSA 11 3 11 3 ELS0B 11 3 4 PTAD4 PTADD4 PTBD4 PTBDD4 PTCD4 PTCDD4 PTDD4 PTDDD4 PTED4 PTEDD4 PTFD4 PTFDD4 PTGD4 PTGDD4 ACIE ACIE 3 PTAD3 PTADD3 PTBD3 PTBDD3 PTCD3 PTCDD3 PTDD3 PTDDD3 PTED3 PTEDD3 PTFD3 PTFDD3 PTGD3 PTGDD3 ACO ACO 2 PTAD2 PTADD2 PTBD2 PTBDD2 PTCD2 PTCDD2 PTDD2 PTDDD2 PTED2 PTEDD2 PTFD2 PTFDD2 PTGD2 PTGDD2 ACOPE ACOPE ADCH 0 ADR10 ADR2 ADC10 ADCV2 ADPC2 ADPC10 ADPC18 — — IRQACK — — PS2 10 2 10 2 ELS0A 10 2 Reserved ADR9 ADR1 ADCV9 ADCV1 ADPC1 ADPC9 ADPC17 — — IRQIE — — PS1 9 1 9 1 0 9 1 Reserved ADR8 ADR0 ADCV8 ADCV0 ADPC0 ADPC8 ADPC16 — — IRQMOD — — PS0 Bit 8 Bit 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 1 PTAD1 PTADD1 PTBD1 PTBDD1 PTCD1 PTCDD1 PTDD1 PTDDD1 PTED1 PTEDD1 PTFD1 PTFDD1 PTGD1 PTGDD1 ACMOD1 ACMOD1 Bit 0 PTAD0 PTADD0 PTBD0 PTBDD0 PTCD0 PTCDD0 PTDD0 PTDDD0 PTED0 PTEDD0 PTFD0 PTFDD0 PTGD0 PTGDD0 ACMOD0 ACMOD0
0x0000 0x0001 0x0002 0x0003 0x0004 0x0005 0x0006 0x0007 0x0008 0x0009 0x000A 0x000B 0x000C 0x000D 0x000E 0x000F 0x0010 0x0011 0x0012 0x0013 0x0014 0x0015 0x0016 0x0017 0x0018 0x0019 0x001A– 0x001B 0x001C 0x001D– 0x001F 0x0020 0x0021 0x0022 0x0023 0x0024 0x0025 0x0026 0x0027
PTAD PTADD PTBD PTBDD PTCD PTCDD PTDD PTDDD PTED PTEDD PTFD PTFDD PTGD PTGDD ACMP1SC ACMP2SC ADCSC1 ADCSC2 ADCRH ADCRL ADCCVH ADCCVL ADCCFG APCTL1 APCTL2 APCTL3 Reserved IRQSC Reserved TPM1SC TPM1CNTH TPM1CNTL TPM1MODH TPM1MODL TPM1C0SC TPM1C0VH TPM1C0VL
MODE
ADICLK
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 52 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 4 Memory
Table 4-2. Direct-Page Register Summary (Sheet 2 of 4)
Address Register Name Bit 7 CH1F Bit 15 Bit 7 CH2F Bit 15 Bit 7 CH3F Bit 15 Bit 7 CH4F Bit 15 Bit 7 CH5F Bit 15 Bit 7 — LBKDIE SBR7 LOOPS TIE TDRE LBKDIF R8 Bit 7 LBKDIE SBR7 LOOPS TIE TDRE LBKDIF R8 Bit 7 CLKS BDIV LOLS LOLIE 0 LOCK PLLS 0 RANGE PLLST CME DMX32 6 CH1IE 14 6 CH2IE 14 6 CH3IE 14 6 CH4IE 14 6 CH5IE 14 6 — RXEDGIE SBR6 SCISWAI TCIE TC RXEDGIF T8 6 RXEDGIE SBR6 SCISWAI TCIE TC RXEDGIF T8 6 5 MS1B 13 5 MS2B 13 5 MS3B 13 5 MS4B 13 5 MS5B 13 5 — 0 SBR5 RSRC RIE RDRF 0 TXDIR 5 0 SBR5 RSRC RIE RDRF 0 TXDIR 5 4 MS1A 12 4 MS2A 12 4 MS3A 12 4 MS4A 12 4 MS5A 12 4 — SBR12 SBR4 M ILIE IDLE RXINV TXINV 4 SBR12 SBR4 M ILIE IDLE RXINV TXINV 4 RDIV HGO TRIM IREFST DIV32 0 0 0 CLKST OSCINIT VDIV 0 DRS FTRIM LP 3 ELS1B 11 3 ELS2B 11 3 ELS3B 11 3 ELS4B 11 3 ELS5B 11 3 — SBR11 SBR3 WAKE TE OR RWUID ORIE 3 SBR11 SBR3 WAKE TE OR RWUID ORIE 3 2 ELS1A 10 2 ELS2A 10 2 ELS3A 10 2 ELS4A 10 2 ELS5A 10 2 — SBR10 SBR2 ILT RE NF BRK13 NEIE 2 SBR10 SBR2 ILT RE NF BRK13 NEIE 2 IREFS EREFS 1 0 9 1 0 9 1 0 9 1 0 9 1 0 9 1 — SBR9 SBR1 PE RWU FE LBKDE FEIE 1 SBR9 SBR1 PE RWU FE LBKDE FEIE 1 IRCLKEN Bit 0 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 — SBR8 SBR0 PT SBK PF RAF PEIE Bit 0 SBR8 SBR0 PT SBK PF RAF PEIE Bit 0 IREFSTEN
0x0028 0x0029 0x002A 0x002B 0x002C 0x002D 0x002E 0x002F 0x0030 0x0031 0x0032 0x0033 0x0034 0x0035 0x0036 0x0037 0x0038 0x0039 0x003A 0x003B 0x003C 0x003D 0x003E 0x003F 0x0040 0x0041 0x0042 0x0043 0x0044 0x0045 0x0046 0x0047 0x0048 0x0049 0x004A 0x004B 0x004C 0x004D
TPM1C1SC TPM1C1VH TPM1C1VL TPM1C2SC TPM1C2VH TPM1C2VL TPM1C3SC TPM1C3VH TPM1C3VL TPM1C4SC TPM1C4VH TPM1C4VL TPM1C5SC TPM1C5VH TPM1C5VL Reserved SCI1BDH SCI1BDL SCI1C1 SCI1C2 SCI1S1 SCI1S2 SCI1C3 SCI1D SCI2BDH SCI2BDL SCI2C1 SCI2C2 SCI2S1 SCI2S2 SCI2C3 SCI2D MCGC1 MCGC2 MCGTRM MCGSC MCGC3 MCGT
ERCLKEN EREFSTEN
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 53
Chapter 4 Memory
Table 4-2. Direct-Page Register Summary (Sheet 3 of 4)
Address Register Name Bit 7 — — SPIE 0 0 SPRF 0 Bit 7 — — AD7 MULT IICEN TCF GCAEN — — TOF Bit 15 Bit 7 Bit 15 Bit 7 CH0F Bit 15 Bit 7 CH1F Bit 15 Bit 7 — RTIF IICIE IAAS ADEXT — — TOIE 14 6 14 6 CH0IE 14 6 CH1IE 14 6 — RTCLKS MST BUSY 0 — — CPWMS 13 5 13 5 MS0B 13 5 MS1B 13 5 — TX ARBL DATA 0 — — CLKSB 12 4 12 4 MS0A 12 4 MS1A 12 4 — RTIE RTCCNT RTCMOD — PTHD7 PTHDD7 PTJD7 PTJDD7 PTKD7 — PTHD6 PTHDD6 PTJD6 PTJDD6 PTKD6 — PTHD5 PTHDD5 PTJD5 PTJDD5 PTKD5 — PTHD4 PTHDD4 PTJD4 PTJDD4 PTKD4 — PTHD3 PTHDD3 PTJD3 PTJDD3 PTKD3 — PTHD2 PTHDD2 PTJD2 PTJDD2 PTKD2 — PTHD1 PTHDD1 PTJD1 PTJDD1 PTKD1 — PTHD0 PTHDD0 PTJD0 PTJDD0 PTKD0 0 — — CLKSA 11 3 11 3 ELS0B 11 3 ELS1B 11 3 — AD10 — — PS2 10 2 10 2 ELS0A 10 2 ELS1A 10 2 — RTCPS AD9 — — PS1 9 1 9 1 0 9 1 0 9 1 — AD8 — — PS0 Bit 8 Bit 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 — TXAK 0 6 — — SPE 0 SPPR2 0 0 6 — — AD6 5 — — SPTIE 0 SPPR1 SPTEF 0 5 — — AD5 4 — — MSTR MODFEN SPPR0 MODF 0 4 — — AD4 3 — — CPOL BIDIROE 0 0 0 3 — — AD3 ICR RSTA SRW 0 IICIF 0 RXAK 2 — — CPHA 0 SPR2 0 0 2 — — AD2 1 — — SSOE SPISWAI SPR1 0 0 1 — — AD1 Bit 0 — — LSBFE SPC0 SPR0 0 0 Bit 0 — — 0
0x004E– 0x004F 0x0050 0x0051 0x0052 0x0053 0x0054 0x0055 0x0056– 0x0057 0x0058 0x0059 0x005A 0x005B 0x005C 0x005D 0x005E– 0x005F 0x0060 0x0061 0x0062 0x0063 0x0064 0x0065 0x0066 0x0067 0x0068 0x0069 0x006A 0x006B 0x006C 0x006D 0x006E 0x006F 0x0070 0x0071 0x0072 0x0073 0x0074
Reserved SPI1C1 SPI1C2 SPI1BR SPI1S Reserved SPI1D Reserved IIC1A IIC1F IIC1C1 IIC1S IIC1D IIC1C2 Reserved TPM2SC TPM2CNTH TPM2CNTL TPM2MODH TPM2MODL TPM2C0SC TPM2C0VH TPM2C0VL TPM2C1SC TPM2C1VH TPM2C1VL Reserved RTCSC RTCCNT RTCMOD Reserved PTHD PTHDD PTJD PTJDD PTKD
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 54 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 4 Memory
Table 4-2. Direct-Page Register Summary (Sheet 4 of 4)
Address Register Name Bit 7 PTKDD7 PTLD7 PTLDD7 0 0 LA15 LA7 D7 D7 D7 D7 6 PTKDD6 PTLD6 PTLDD6 0 0 LA14 LA6 D6 D6 D6 D6 5 PTKDD5 PTLD5 PTLDD5 0 0 LA13 LA5 D5 D5 D5 D5 4 PTKDD4 PTLD4 PTLDD4 0 0 LA12 LA4 D4 D4 D4 D4 3 PTKDD3 PTLD3 PTLDD3 0 0 LA11 LA3 D3 D3 D3 D3 2 PTKDD2 PTLD2 PTLDD2 XA16 0 LA10 LA2 D2 D2 D2 D2 1 PTKDD1 PTLD1 PTLDD1 XA15 0 LA9 LA1 D1 D1 D1 D1 Bit 0 PTKDD0 PTLD0 PTLDD0 XA14 LA16 LA8 LA0 D0 D0 D0 D0
0x0075 0x0076 0x0077 0x0078 0x0079 0x007A 0x007B 0x007C 0x007D 0x007E 0x007F
PTKDD PTLD PTLDD PPAGE LAP2 LAP1 LAP0 LWP LBP LB LAPAB
High-page registers, shown in Table 4-3, are accessed much less often than other I/O and control registers so they have been located outside the direct addressable memory space, starting at 0x1800.
Table 4-3. High-Page Register Summary (Sheet 1 of 5)
Address Register Name Bit 7 POR 0 COPT COPCLKS — — — ID7 — LVWF 0 — — Bit 15 Bit 7 Bit 15 Bit 7 Bit 15 Bit 7 Bit 15 Bit 7 RWAEN RWBEN COPW — — — ID6 — LVWACK 0 — — 14 6 14 6 14 6 14 6 RWA RWB 6 PIN 0 5 COP 0 STOPE 0 — — — ID5 — LVWIE LVDV — — 13 5 13 5 13 5 13 5 PAGSEL PAGSEL 4 ILOP 0 SCI2PS ADHTS — — — ID4 — LVDRE LVWV — — 12 4 12 4 12 4 12 4 0 0 3 ILAD 0 IIC1PS 0 — — ID11 ID3 — LVDSE PPDF — — 11 3 11 3 11 3 11 3 0 0 — — ID10 ID2 — LVDE PPDACK — — 10 2 10 2 10 2 10 2 0 0 2 LOC 0 0 1 LVD 0 0 MCSEL — — ID9 ID1 — 0 — — — 9 1 9 1 9 1 9 1 0 0 — — ID8 ID0 — BGBE PPDC — — Bit 8 Bit 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 Bit 16 Bit 16 Bit 0 0 BDFR 0
0x1800 0x1801 0x1802 0x1803 0x1804 – 0x1805 0x1806 0x1807 0x1808 0x1809 0x180A 0x180B– 0x180F 0x1810 0x1811 0x1812 0x1813 0x1814 0x1815 0x1816 0x1817 0x1818 0x1819
SRS SBDFR SOPT1 SOPT2 Reserved SDIDH SDIDL Reserved SPMSC1 SPMSC2 Reserved DBGCAH DBGCAL DBGCBH DBGCBL DBGCCH DBGCCL DBGFH DBGFL DBGCAX DBGCBX
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 55
Chapter 4 Memory
Table 4-3. High-Page Register Summary (Sheet 2 of 5)
Address Register Name Bit 7 RWCEN PPACC DBGEN TRGSEL AF 0 DIVLD KEYEN — 0 FCBEF — — SPIE 0 0 SPRF 0 Bit 7 — — PTKPE7 PTKSE7 PTKDS7 — PTLPE7 PTLSE7 PTLDS7 — PTAPE7 PTASE7 PTADS7 — 0 PTAPS7 PTAES7 — PTBPE7 EPS FCCF — — SPE 0 SPPR2 0 0 6 — — PTKPE6 PTKSE6 PTKDS6 — PTLPE6 PTLSE6 PTLDS6 — PTAPE6 PTASE6 PTADS6 — 0 PTAPS6 PTAES6 — PTBPE6 FPVIOL — — SPTIE 0 SPPR1 SPTEF 0 5 — — PTKPE5 PTKSE5 PTKDS5 — PTLPE5 PTLSE5 PTLDS5 — PTAPE5 PTASE5 PTADS5 — 0 PTAPS5 PTAES5 — PTBPE5 FACCERR FCMD — — MSTR MODFEN SPPR0 MODF 0 4 — — PTKPE4 PTKSE4 PTKDS4 — PTLPE4 PTLSE4 PTLDS4 — PTAPE4 PTASE4 PTADS4 — 0 PTAPS4 PTAES4 — PTBPE4 — — CPOL BIDIROE 0 0 0 3 — — PTKPE3 PTKSE3 PTKDS3 — PTLPE3 PTLSE3 PTLDS3 — PTAPE3 PTASE3 PTADS3 — PTAIF PTAPS3 PTAES3 — PTBPE3 — — CPHA 0 SPR2 0 0 2 — — PTKPE2 PTKSE2 PTKDS2 — PTLPE2 PTLSE2 PTLDS2 — PTAPE2 PTASE2 PTADS2 — PTAACK PTAPS2 PTAES2 — PTBPE2 — — SSOE SPISWAI SPR1 0 0 1 — — PTKPE1 PTKSE1 PTKDS1 — PTLPE1 PTLSE1 PTLDS1 — PTAPE1 PTASE1 PTADS1 — PTAIE PTAPS1 PTAES1 — PTBPE1 — — LSBFE SPC0 SPR0 0 0 Bit 0 — — PTKPE0 PTKSE0 PTKDS0 — PTLPE0 PTLSE0 PTLDS0 — PTAPE0 PTASE0 PTADS0 — PTAMOD PTAPS0 PTAES0 — PTBPE0 6 RWC 0 ARM BEGIN BF 0 PRDIV8 FNORED — EPGSEL EPGMOD — KEYACC 0 — 1 0 — 0 FPS 0 FBLANK 0 5 PAGSEL 0 TAG 0 CF 0 4 0 0 BRKEN 0 0 0 DIV 0 — 0 — 0 SEC — 1 FPOP 0 0 0 CNT 3 0 0 0 2 0 0 0 TRG 0 ARMF 1 0 0 0 Bit 0 Bit 16 Bit 16 LOOP1
0x181A 0x181B 0x181C 0x181D 0x181E 0x181F 0x1820 0x1821 0x1822 0x1823 0x1824 0x1825 0x1826 0x1827– 0x182F 0x1830 0x1831 0x1832 0x1833 0x1834 0x1835 0x1836– 0x1837 0x1838 0x1839 0x183A 0x183B 0x183C 0x183D 0x183E 0x183F 0x1840 0x1841 0x1842 0x1843 0x1844 0x1845 0x1846 0x1847 0x1848
DBGCCX DBGFX DBGC DBGT DBGS DBGCNT FCDIV FOPT Reserved FCNFG FPROT FSTAT FCMD Reserved SPI2C1 SPI2C2 SPI2BR SPI2S Reserved SPI2D Reserved PTKPE PTKSE PTKDS Reserved PTLPE PTLSE PTLDS Reserved PTAPE PTASE PTADS Reserved PTASC PTAPS PTAES Reserved PTBPE
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 56 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 4 Memory
Table 4-3. High-Page Register Summary (Sheet 3 of 5)
Address Register Name Bit 7 PTBSE7 PTBDS7 — 0 PTBPS7 PTBES7 — PTCPE7 PTCSE7 PTCDS7 — — PTDPE7 PTDSE7 PTDDS7 — 0 PTDPS7 PTDES7 — PTEPE7 PTESE7 PTEDS7 — — PTFPE7 PTFSE7 PTFDS7 — — PTGPE7 PTGSE7 PTGDS7 — PTHPE7 PTHSE7 PTHDS7 — PTJPE7 PTJSE7 6 PTBSE6 PTBDS6 — 0 PTBPS6 PTBES6 — PTCPE6 PTCSE6 PTCDS6 — — PTDPE6 PTDSE6 PTDDS6 — 0 PTDPS6 PTDES6 — PTEPE6 PTESE6 PTEDS6 — — PTFPE6 PTFSE6 PTFDS6 — — PTGPE6 PTGSE6 PTGDS6 — PTHPE6 PTHSE6 PTHDS6 — PTJPE6 PTJSE6 5 PTBSE5 PTBDS5 — 0 PTBPS5 PTBES5 — PTCPE5 PTCSE5 PTCDS5 — — PTDPE5 PTDSE5 PTDDS5 — 0 PTDPS5 PTDES5 — PTEPE5 PTESE5 PTEDS5 — — PTFPE5 PTFSE5 PTFDS5 — — PTGPE5 PTGSE5 PTGDS5 — PTHPE5 PTHSE5 PTHDS5 — PTJPE5 PTJSE5 4 PTBSE4 PTBDS4 — 0 PTBPS4 PTBES4 — PTCPE4 PTCSE4 PTCDS4 — — PTDPE4 PTDSE4 PTDDS4 — 0 PTDPS4 PTDES4 — PTEPE4 PTESE4 PTEDS4 — — PTFPE4 PTFSE4 PTFDS4 — — PTGPE4 PTGSE4 PTGDS4 — PTHPE4 PTHSE4 PTHDS4 — PTJPE4 PTJSE4 3 PTBSE3 PTBDS3 — PTBIF PTBPS3 PTBES3 — PTCPE3 PTCSE3 PTCDS3 — — PTDPE3 PTDSE3 PTDDS3 — PTDIF PTDPS3 PTDES3 — PTEPE3 PTESE3 PTEDS3 — — PTFPE3 PTFSE3 PTFDS3 — — PTGPE3 PTGSE3 PTGDS3 — PTHPE3 PTHSE3 PTHDS3 — PTJPE3 PTJSE3 2 PTBSE2 PTBDS2 — PTBACK PTBPS2 PTBES2 — PTCPE2 PTCSE2 PTCDS2 — — PTDPE2 PTDSE2 PTDDS2 — PTDACK PTDPS2 PTDES2 — PTEPE2 PTESE2 PTEDS2 — — PTFPE2 PTFSE2 PTFDS2 — — PTGPE2 PTGSE2 PTGDS2 — PTHPE2 PTHSE2 PTHDS2 — PTJPE2 PTJSE2 1 PTBSE1 PTBDS1 — PTBIE PTBPS1 PTBES1 — PTCPE1 PTCSE1 PTCDS1 — — PTDPE1 PTDSE1 PTDDS1 — PTDIE PTDPS1 PTDES1 — PTEPE1 PTESE1 PTEDS1 — — PTFPE1 PTFSE1 PTFDS1 — — PTGPE1 PTGSE1 PTGDS1 — PTHPE1 PTHSE1 PTHDS1 — PTJPE1 PTJSE1 Bit 0 PTBSE0 PTBDS0 — PTBMOD PTBPS0 PTBES0 — PTCPE0 PTCSE0 PTCDS0 — — PTDPE0 PTDSE0 PTDDS0 — PTDMOD PTDPS0 PTDES0 — PTEPE0 PTESE0 PTEDS0 — — PTFPE0 PTFSE0 PTFDS0 — — PTGPE0 PTGSE0 PTGDS0 — PTHPE0 PTHSE0 PTHDS0 — PTJPE0 PTJSE0
0x1849 0x184A 0x184B 0x184C 0x184D 0x184E 0x184F 0x1850 0x1851 0x1852 0x1853– 0x1857 0x1858 0x1859 0x185A 0x185B 0x185C 0x185D 0x185E 0x185F 0x1860 0x1861 0x1862 0x1863– 0x1867 0x1868 0x1869 0x186A 0x186B– 0x186F 0x1870 0x1871 0x1872 0x1873 0x1874 0x1875 0x1876 0x1877 0x1878 0x1879
PTBSE PTBDS Reserved PTBSC PTBPS PTBES Reserved PTCPE PTCSE PTCDS Reserved PTDPE PTDSE PTDDS Reserved PTDSC PTDPS PTDES Reserved PTEPE PTESE PTEDS Reserved PTFPE PTFSE PTFDS Reserved PTGPE PTGSE PTGDS Reserved PTHPE PTHSE PTHDS Reserved PTJPE PTJSE
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 57
Chapter 4 Memory
Table 4-3. High-Page Register Summary (Sheet 4 of 5)
Address Register Name Bit 7 PTJDS7 — 0 PTJPS7 PTJES7 — RXFRM CANE SJW1 SAMP WUPIF WUPIE 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 RXERR7 TXERR7 AC7 AM7 AC7 AM7 6 PTJDS6 — 0 PTJPS6 PTJES6 — RXACT CLKSRC SJW0 TSEG22 CSCIF CSCIE 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 RXERR6 TXERR6 AC6 AM6 AC6 AM6 5 PTJDS5 — 0 PTJPS5 PTJES5 — CSWAI LOOPB BRP5 TSEG21 RSTAT1 RSTATE1 0 0 0 0 0 IDAM1 0 0 RXERR5 TXERR5 AC5 AM5 AC5 AM5 4 PTJDS4 — 0 PTJPS4 PTJES4 — SYNCH LISTEN BRP4 TSEG20 RSTAT0 RSTATE0 0 0 0 0 0 IDAM0 0 0 RXERR4 TXERR4 AC4 AM4 AC4 AM4 3 PTJDS3 — PTJIF PTJPS3 PTJES3 — TIME BORM BRP3 TSEG13 TSTAT1 TSTATE1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 RXERR3 TXERR3 AC3 AM3 AC3 AM3 2 PTJDS2 — PTJACK PTJPS2 PTJES2 — WUPE WUPM BRP2 TSEG12 TSTAT0 TSTATE0 TXE2 TXEIE2 ABTRQ2 ABTAK2 TX2 IDHIT2 0 0 RXERR2 TXERR2 AC2 AM2 AC2 AM2 1 PTJDS1 — PTJIE PTJPS1 PTJES1 — SLPRQ SLPAK BRP1 TSEG11 OVRIF OVRIE TXE1 TXEIE1 ABTRQ1 ABTAK1 TX1 IDHIT1 0 0 RXERR1 TXERR1 AC1 AM1 AC1 AM1 Bit 0 PTJDS0 — PTJMOD PTJPS0 PTJES0 — INITRQ INITAK BRP0 TSEG10 RXF RXFIE TXE0 TXEIE0 ABTRQ0 ABTAK0 TX0 IDHIT0 0 BOHOLD RXERR0 TXERR0 AC0 AM0 AC0 AM0
0x187A 0x187B 0x187C 0x187D 0x187E 0x187F 0x1880 0x1881 0x1882 0x1883 0x1884 0x1885 0x1886 0x1887 0x1888 0x1889 0x188A 0x188B 0x188C 0x188D 0x188E 0x188F 0x1890 – 0x1893 0x1894 – 0x1897 0x1898 – 0x189B 0x189C – 0x189F 0x18A0 – 0x18AF 0x18B0 – 0x18BF 0x18C0 0x18C1 0x18C2 0x18C3 0x18C4 0x18C5 0x18C6
PTJDS Reserved PTJSC PTJPS PTJES Reserved CANCTL0 CANCTL1 CANBTR0 CANBTR1 CANRFLG CANRIER CANTFLG CANTIER CANTARQ CANTAAK CANTBSEL CANIDAC Reserved CANMISC CANRXERR CANTXERR CANIDAR0 – CANIDAR3 CANIDMR0 – CANIDMR3 CANIDAR4 – CANIDAR7 CANIDMR4 – CANIDMR7 MSCAN Rx Buffer MSCAN Tx Buffer TPM3SC TPM3CNTH TPM3CNTL TPM3MODH TPM3MODL TPM3C0SC TPM3C0VH
See Table 4-4 for an example extended mapping buffer layout. For complete details, see the MSCAN chapter. See Table 4-4 for an example extended mapping buffer layout. For complete details, see the MSCAN chapter. TOF Bit 15 Bit 7 Bit 15 Bit 7 CH0F Bit 15 TOIE 14 6 14 6 CH0IE 14 CPWMS 13 5 13 5 MS0B 13 CLKSB 12 4 12 4 MS0A 12 CLKSA 11 3 11 3 ELS0B 11 PS2 10 2 10 2 ELS0A 10 PS1 9 1 9 1 0 9 PS0 Bit 8 Bit 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 0 Bit 8
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 58 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 4 Memory
Table 4-3. High-Page Register Summary (Sheet 5 of 5)
Address Register Name Bit 7 Bit 7 CH1F Bit 15 Bit 7 CH2F Bit 15 Bit 7 CH3F Bit 15 Bit 7 — — AD7 MULT IICEN TCF GCAEN — — IICIE IAAS ADEXT — — MST BUSY 0 — — TX ARBL DATA 0 — — 0 — — AD10 — — AD9 — — AD8 — — TXAK 0 6 6 CH1IE 14 6 CH2IE 14 6 CH3IE 14 6 — — AD6 5 5 MS1B 13 5 MS2B 13 5 MS3B 13 5 — — AD5 4 4 MS1A 12 4 MS2A 12 4 MS3A 12 4 — — AD4 3 3 ELS1B 11 3 ELS2B 11 3 ELS3B 11 3 — — AD3 ICR RSTA SRW 0 IICIF 0 RXAK 2 2 ELS1A 10 2 ELS2A 10 2 ELS3A 10 2 — — AD2 1 1 0 9 1 0 9 1 0 9 1 — — AD1 Bit 0 Bit 0 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 — — 0
0x18C7 0x18C8 0x18C9 0x18CA 0x18CB 0x18CC 0x18CD 0x18CE 0x18CF 0x18D0 0x18D1– 0x18D7 0x18D8 0x18D9 0x18DA 0x18DB 0x18DC 0x18DD 0x18DE– 0x18FF
TPM3C0VL TPM3C1SC TPM3C1VH TPM3C1VL TPM3C2SC TPM3C2VH TPM3C2VL TPM3C3SC TPM3C3VH TPM3C3VL Reserved IIC2A IIC2F IIC2C1 IIC2S IIC2D IIC2C2 Reserved
Figure 4-4 shows the structure of receive and transmit buffers for extended identifier mapping. These registers vary depending on whether standard or extended mapping is selected. See Chapter 12, “Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1),” for details on extended and standard identifier mapping.
Table 4-4. MSCAN Foreground Receive and Transmit Buffer Layouts — Extended Mapping Shown (Sheet 1 of 2) 0x18A0 0x18A1 0x18A2 0x18A3 0x18A4 – 0x18AB 0x18AC 0x18AD 0x18AE 0x18AF 0x18B0 0x18B1 0x18B2 CANRIDR0 CANRIDR1 CANRIDR2 CANRIDR3 CANRDSR0 – CANRDSR7 CANRDLR Reserved CANRTSRH CANRTSRL CANTIDR0 CANTIDR1 CANTIDR2
ID28 ID20 ID14 ID6 DB7 — — TSR15 TSR7 ID28 ID20 ID14 ID27 ID19 ID13 ID5 DB6 — — TSR14 TSR6 ID27 ID19 ID13 ID26 ID18 ID12 ID4 DB5 — — TSR13 TSR5 ID26 ID18 ID12 ID25 SRR(1) ID11 ID3 DB4 — — TSR12 TSR4 ID25 SRR(3) ID11 ID24 IDE(1) ID10 ID2 DB3 DLC3 — TSR11 TSR3 ID24 IDE(1) ID10 ID23 ID17 ID9 ID1 DB2 DLC2 — TSR10 TSR2 ID23 ID17 ID9 ID22 ID16 ID8 ID0 DB1 DLC1 — TSR9 TSR1 ID22 ID16 ID8 ID21 ID15 ID7 RTR2 DB0 DLC0 — TSR8 TSR0 ID21 ID15 ID7
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 59
Chapter 4 Memory
Table 4-4. MSCAN Foreground Receive and Transmit Buffer Layouts — Extended Mapping Shown (Sheet 2 of 2) 0x18B3 0x18B4 – 0x18BB 0x18BC 0x18BD 0x18BE 0x18BF
1 2
CANTIDR3 CANTDSR0 – CANTDSR7 CANTDLR CANTTBPR CANTTSRH CANTTSRL
ID6 DB7 — PRIO7 TSR15 TSR7
ID5 DB6 — PRIO6 TSR14 TSR6
ID4 DB5 — PRIO5 TSR13 TSR5
ID3 DB4 — PRIO4 TSR12 TSR4
ID2 DB3 DLC3 PRIO3 TSR11 TSR3
ID1 DB2 DLC2 PRIO2 TSR10 TSR2
ID0 DB1 DLC1 PRIO1 TSR9 TSR1
RTR4 DB0 DLC0 PRIO0 TSR8 TSR0
SRR and IDE are both 1s. The position of RTR differs between extended and standard identifier mapping. 3 SRR and IDE are both 1s. 4 The position of RTR differs between extended and standard identifier mapping.
Nonvolatile FLASH registers, shown in Table 4-5, are located in the FLASH memory. These registers include an 8-byte backdoor key, NVBACKKEY, which can be used to gain access to secure memory resources. During reset events, the contents of NVPROT and NVOPT in the nonvolatile register area of the FLASH memory are transferred into corresponding FPROT and FOPT working registers in the high-page registers to control security and block protection options. The factory MCG trim value is stored in a nonvolatile location and will be loaded into the MCGTRM and MCGSC registers after any reset if not in a BDM mode. If in a BDM mode, a default value of 0x80 is loaded. The internal reference trim values stored in Flash (0xFFAE, 0xFFAF), TRIM and FTRIM, can be programmed by third party programmers and must be copied into the corresponding MCG registers by user code to override the factory trim.
Table 4-5. Nonvolatile Register Summary
Address 0xFFAE 0xFFAF Register Name Reserved for storage of FTRIM Reserved for storage of MCGTRM Bit 7 0 6 0 5 0 4 0 TRIM 8-Byte Comparison Key — — EPS — KEYEN — FNORED — EPGMOD — 0 — — — — — — — — FPS — 0 — 0 — SEC — — — — — — FPOP — 3 0 2 0 1 0 Bit 0 FTRIM
0xFFB0– NVBACKKEY 0xFFB7 0xFFB8– Reserved 0xFFBC 0xFFBD 0xFFBE 0xFFBF NVPROT Reserved NVOPT
Provided the key enable (KEYEN) bit is 1, the 8-byte comparison key can be used to temporarily disengage memory security. This key mechanism can be accessed only through user code running in secure memory. (A security key cannot be entered directly through background debug commands.) This security key can be disabled completely by programming the KEYEN bit to 0. If the security key is disabled, the only way to disengage security is by mass erasing the FLASH if needed (normally through the background
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 60 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 4 Memory
debug interface) and verifying that FLASH is blank. To avoid returning to secure mode after the next reset, program the security bits (SEC) to the unsecured state (1:0).
4.4
Memory Management Unit
The memory management unit (MMU) allows the program and data space for the HCS08 Family of Microcontrollers to be extended beyond the 64K CPU addressable memory map. The extended memory when used for data can also be accessed linearly using a linear address pointer and data access registers.
4.4.1
Features
Key features of the MMU module are: • Memory Management Unit extends the HCS08 memory space — up to 128K for program and data space • Extended program space using paging scheme — PPAGE register used for page selection — fixed 16K byte memory window — architecture supports eight 16K pages • Extended data space using linear address pointer — 17-bit linear address pointer — linear address pointer and data register provided in direct page allows access of complete FLASH memory map using direct page instructions — optional auto increment of pointer when data accessed — supports a 2s complement addition/subtraction to address pointer without using any math instructions or memory resources — supports word accesses to any address specified by the linear address pointer when using LDHX, STHX instructions
4.4.2
Memory Expansion
The HCS08 Core architecture limits the CPU addressable space available to 64K bytes. The Program Page (PPAGE) allows for integrating up to 128K of FLASH into the system by selecting one of the 16K byte blocks to be accessed through the Paging Window located at 0x8000-0xBFFF. The MMU module also provides a linear address pointer that allows extension of data access up to 128K.
4.4.2.1
Program Space
The PPAGE register holds the page select value for the Paging Window. The value in PPAGE can be manipulated by using normal read and write instructions as well as the CALL and RTC instructions. The user should not change PPAGE directly when running from paged memory, only CALL and RTC should be used.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 61
Chapter 4 Memory
When the MMU detects that the CPU is addressing the Paging Window, the value currently in PPAGE will be used to create an extended address that the MCU’s decode logic will use to select the desired FLASH location. For example, the Flash from location 0x4000-0x7FFF can be accessed directly or using the paging window, PPAGE = 1, address 0x8000-0xBFFF.
4.4.2.2
CALL and RTC (Return from Call) Instructions
CALL and RTC are instructions that perform automated page switching when executed in the user program. CALL is similar to a JSR instruction, but the subroutine that is called can be located anywhere in the normal 64K address space or on any page of program memory. During the execution of a CALL instruction, the CPU: • • • • Stacks the return address. Pushes the current PPAGE value onto the stack. Writes the new instruction-supplied PPAGE value into the PPAGE register. Transfers control to the subroutine of the new instruction-supplied address.
This sequence is not interruptible; there is no need to inhibit interrupts during CALL execution. A CALL can be executed from any address in memory to any other address. The new PPAGE value is provided by an immediate operand in the instruction along with the address within the paging window, 0x8000-0xBFFF. RTC is similar to an RTS instruction. The RTC instruction terminates subroutines invoked by a CALL instruction. During the execution of an RTC instruction, the CPU: • • • Pulls the old PPAGE value from the stack and loads it into the PPAGE register Pulls the 16-bit return address from the stack and loads it into the PC Resumes execution at the return address
This sequence is not interruptible; there is no need to inhibit interrupts during RTC execution. An RTC can be executed from any address in memory.
4.4.2.3
Data Space
The linear address pointer registers, LAP2:LAP0 along with the linear data register allow the CPU to read or write any address in the extended FLASH memory space. This linear address pointer may be used to access data from any memory location while executing code from any location in extended memory, including accessing data from a different PPAGE than the currently executing program. To access data using the linear address pointer, the user would first setup the extended address in the 17-bit address pointer, LAP2:LAP0. Accessing one of the three linear data registers LB, LBP and LWP will access the extended memory location specified by LAP2:LAP0. The three linear data registers access the memory locations in the same way, however the LBP and LWP will also increment LAP2:LAP0.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 62 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 4 Memory
Accessing either the LBP or LWP registers allows a user program to read successive memory locations without re-writing the linear address pointer. Accessing LBP or LWP does the exact same function. However, because of the address mapping of the registers with LBP following LWP, a user can do word accesses in the extended address space using the LDHX or STHX instructions to access location LWP. The MMU supports the addition of a 2s complement value to the linear address pointer without using any math instructions or memory resources. Writes to LAPAB with a 2s complement value will cause the MMU to add that value to the existing value in LAP2:LAP0.
4.4.3
4.4.3.1
MMU Registers and Control Bits
Program Page Register (PPAGE)
The HCS08 Core architecture limits the CPU addressable space available to 64K bytes. The address space can be extended to 128K bytes using a paging window scheme. The Program Page (PPAGE) allows for selecting one of the 16K byte blocks to be accessed through the Program Page Window located at 0x8000-0xBFFF. The CALL and RTC instructions can load or store the value of PPAGE onto or from the stack during program execution. After any reset, PPAGE is set to PAGE 2.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset:
0
0
0
0
0 XA16 XA15 1 XA14 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 4-5. Program Page Register (PPAGE) Table 4-6. Program Page Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
2:0 When the CPU addresses the paging window, 0x8000-0xBFFF, the value in the PPAGE register along with the XA16:XA14 CPU addresses A13:A0 are used to create a 17-bit extended address.
4.4.3.2
Linear Address Pointer Registers 2:0 (LAP2:LAP0)
The three registers, LAP2:LAP0 contain the 17-bit linear address that allows the user to access any FLASH location in the extended address map. This register is used in conjunction with the data registers, linear byte (LB), linear byte post increment (LBP) and linear word post increment (LWP). The contents of LAP2:LAP0 will auto-increment when accessing data using the LBP and LWP registers. The contents of LAP2:LAP0 can be increased by writing an 8-bit value to LAPAB.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 63
Chapter 4 Memory
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R W R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0 LA16
LA15 W R LA7 W Reset: 0
LA14
LA13
LA12
LA11
LA10
LA9
LA8
LA6 0
LA5 0
LA4 0
LA3 0
LA2 0
LA1 0
LA0 0
Figure 4-6. Linear Address Pointer Registers 2:0 (LAP2:LAP0) Table 4-7. Linear Address Pointer Registers 2:0 Field Descriptions
Field 16:0 LA16:LA0 Description The values in LAP2:LAP0 are used to create a 17-bit linear address pointer. The value in these registers are used as the extended address when accessing any of the data registers LB, LBP and LWP.
4.4.3.3
Linear Word Post Increment Register (LWP)
This register is one of three data registers that the user can use to access any FLASH memory location in the extended address map. When LWP is accessed the contents of LAP2:LAP0 make up the extended address of the FLASH memory location to be addressed. When accessing data using LWP, the contents of LAP2:LAP0 will increment after the read or write is complete. Accessing LWP does the same thing as accessing LBP. The MMU register ordering of LWP followed by LBP, allow the user to access data by words using the LDHX or STHX instructions of the LWP register.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R D7 W Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Figure 4-7. Linear Word Post Increment Register (LWP) Table 4-8. Linear Word Post Increment Register Field Descriptions
Field 7:0 D7:D0 Description Reads of this register will first return the data value pointed to by the linear address pointer, LAP2:LAP0 and then will increment LAP2:LAP0. Writes to this register will first write the data value to the memory location specified by the linear address pointer and then will increment LAP2:LAP0. Writes to this register are most commonly used when writing to the FLASH block(s) during programming.
4.4.3.4
Linear Byte Post Increment Register (LBP)
This register is one of three data registers that the user can use to access any FLASH memory location in the extended address map. When LBP is accessed the contents of LAP2:LAP0 make up the extended
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 64 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 4 Memory
address of the FLASH memory location to be addressed. When accessing data using LBP, the contents of LAP2:LAP0 will increment after the read or write is complete. Accessing LBP does the same thing as accessing LWP. The MMU register ordering of LWP followed by LBP, allow the user to access data by words using the LDHX or STHX instructions with the address of the LWP register.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R D7 W Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Figure 4-8. Linear Byte Post Increment Register (LBP) Table 4-9. Linear Byte Post Increment Register Field Descriptions
Field 7:0 D7:D0 Description Reads of this register will first return the data value pointed to by the linear address pointer, LAP2:LAP0 and then will increment LAP2:LAP0. Writes to this register will first write the data value to the memory location specified by the linear address pointer and then will increment LAP2:LAP0. Writes to this register are most commonly used when writing to the FLASH block(s) during programming.
4.4.3.5
Linear Byte Register (LB)
This register is one of three data registers that the user can use to access any FLASH memory location in the extended address map. When LB is accessed the contents of LAP2:LAP0 make up the extended address of the FLASH memory location to be addressed.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R D7 W Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Figure 4-9. Linear Byte Register (LB) Table 4-10. Linear Data Register Field Descriptions
Field 7:0 D7:D0 Description Reads of this register returns the data value pointed to by the linear address pointer, LAP2:LAP0. Writes to this register will write the data value to the memory location specified by the linear address pointer. Writes to this register are most commonly used when writing to the FLASH block(s) during programming.
4.4.3.6
Linear Address Pointer Add Byte Register (LAPAB)
The user can increase or decrease the contents of LAP2:LAP0 by writing a 2s complement value to LAPAB. The value written will be added to the current contents of LAP2:LAP0.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 65
Chapter 4 Memory
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R W Reset:
0 D7 0
0 D6 0
0 D5 0
0 D4 0
0 D3 0
0 D2 0
0 D1 0
0 D0 0
Figure 4-10. Linear Address Pointer Add Byte Register (LAPAB) Table 4-11. Linear Address Pointer Add Byte Register Field Descriptions
Field 7:0 D7:D0 Description The 2s complement value written to LAPAB will be added to contents of the linear address pointer register, LAP2:LAP0. Writing a value of 0x7f to LAPAB will increase LAP by 127, a value of 0x80 will decrease LAP by 128, and a value of 0xff will decrease LAP by 1.
4.5
RAM
The MC9S08DZ128 Series includes static RAM. The locations in RAM below 0x0100 can be accessed using the more efficient direct addressing mode, and any single bit in this area can be accessed with the bit manipulation instructions (BCLR, BSET, BRCLR, and BRSET). Locating the most frequently accessed program variables in this area of RAM is preferred. The RAM retains data while the MCU is in low-power wait, stop2, or stop3 mode. At power-on the contents of RAM are uninitialized. RAM data is unaffected by any reset if the supply voltage does not drop below the minimum value for RAM retention (VRAM). For compatibility with M68HC05 MCUs, the HCS08 resets the stack pointer to 0x00FF. In the MC9S08DZ128 Series, it is usually best to reinitialize the stack pointer to the top of the RAM so the direct page RAM can be used for frequently accessed RAM variables and bit-addressable program variables. Include the following 2-instruction sequence in your reset initialization routine (where RamLast is equated to the highest address of the RAM in the Freescale Semiconductor equate file).
LDHX TXS #RamLast+1 ;point one past RAM ;SP EXPECTED = 500 (RUNNING TOO FAST) TRMVAL = TRMVAL - 256/ (2**n) (DECREASING TRMVAL INCREASES THE FREQUENCY) TRMVAL = TRMVAL + 256/ (2**n) (INCREASING TRMVAL DECREASES THE FREQUENCY) STORE MCGTRM AND FTRIM VALUES IN NON-VOLATILE MEMORY
CONTINUE n = n+1
YES IS n > 9?
NO
Figure 8-13. Trim Procedure
In this particular case, the MCU has been attached to a PCB and the entire assembly is undergoing final test with automated test equipment. A separate signal or message is provided to the MCU operating under user provided software control. The MCU initiates a trim procedure as outlined in Figure 8-13 while the tester supplies a precision reference signal. If the intended bus frequency is near the maximum allowed for the device, it is recommended to trim using a reference divider value (RDIV setting) of twice the final value. After the trim procedure is complete, the reference divider can be restored. This will prevent accidental overshoot of the maximum clock frequency.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 197
Chapter 8 Multi-Purpose Clock Generator (S08MCGV2)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 198 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 9 5-V Analog Comparator (S08ACMPV3)
9.1 Introduction
The analog comparator module (ACMP) provides a circuit for comparing two analog input voltages or for comparing one analog input voltage to an internal reference voltage. The comparator circuit is designed to operate across the full range of the supply voltage (rail-to-rail operation). All MC9S08DZ128 Series MCUs have two full function ACMPs. MCUs in the 48-pin package have two ACMPs, but the output of ACMP2 is not accessible. NOTE MC9S08DZ128 Series devices operate at a higher voltage range (2.7 V to 5.5 V) and do not include stop1 mode. Please ignore references to stop1. ACMP2O is not available in the 48-pin package.
9.1.1
ACMP Configuration Information
When using the bandgap reference voltage for input to ACMP+, the user must enable the bandgap buffer by setting BGBE =1 in SPMSC1 see Section 5.8.7, “System Power Management Status and Control 1 Register (SPMSC1).” For value of bandgap voltage reference see Appendix A, “Electrical Characteristics”
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 199
Chapter 9 5-V Analog Comparator (S08ACMPV3)
HCS08 CORE CPU BKGD/MS BDC BKP DEBUG MODULE (DBG) ANALOG COMPARATOR (ACMP1) ACMP1O ACMP1ACMP1+ PORT A
RESET
HCS08 SYSTEM CONTROL RESETS AND INTERRUPTS MODES OF OPERATION POWER MANAGEMENT IRQ COP INT LVD IRQ VOLTAGE REGULATOR
PTA7/PIA7/ADP7/IRQ PTA6/PIA6/ADP6 PTA5/PIA5/ADP5 PTA4/PIA4/ADP4 PTA3/PIA3/ADP3/ACMP1O PTA2/PIA2/ADP2/ACMP1PTA1/PIA1/ADP1/ACMP1+ PTA0/PIA0/ADP0/MCLK PTB7/PIB7/ADP15 PTB6/PIB6/ADP14 PTB5/PIB5/ADP13 PTB4/PIB4/ADP12 PTB3/PIB3/ADP11 PTB2/PIB2/ADP10 PTB1/PIB1/ADP9 PTB0/PIB0/ADP8
● ● ● ● ● ● ● ●
REAL-TIME COUNTER (RTC)
VDD VSS VREFH VREFL VDDA VSSA
8 24-CHANNEL,12-BIT ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER (ADC) ADP7-ADP0 ADP15-ADP8 ADP23-ADP16
PORT B
USER MEMORY FLASH _EEPROM _RAM MC9S08DZ128 = 128K_2K_8K MC9S08DZ96 = 96K_2K_6K MC9S08DV128 = 128K_0K_6K MC9S08DV96 = 96K_0K_4K PTJ7/PIJ7/TPM3CLK PTJ6/PIJ6 PTJ5/PIJ5 PTJ4/PIJ4 PTJ3/PIJ3/TMP3CH3 PTJ2/PIJ2/TPM3CH2 PTJ1/PIJ1/TPM3CH1 PTJ0/PIJ0/TMP3CH0 PTK7 PTK6 PTK5 PTK4 PTK3 PTK2 PTK1 PTK0 PTL7 PTL6 PTL5 PTL4 PTL3 PTL2 PTL1 PTL0 PTH7 PTH6 PTH5 PTH4 PTH3/MISO2 PTH2/MOSI2 PTH1/SPSCK2 PTH0/SS2 TPM3CLK PORT J TPM3CH0 TPM3CH3 6-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM1) 2-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM2) 4-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM3) CONTROLLER AREA NETWORK (MSCAN) PORT K SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE (SPI1) SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE (SCI1) ANALOG COMPARATOR (ACMP2) IIC MODULE (IIC1) SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE (SCI2) IIC MODULE (IIC2) PORT H MISO2 MOSI2 SPSCK2 SS2 RxCAN TXCAN MISO1 MOSI1 SPSCK1 SS1 RxD1 TxD1 ACMP2O ACMP2ACMP2+ SDA1 SCL1 RxD2 TxD2 SDA2 SCL2 MULTI-PURPOSE CLOCK GENERATOR (MCG) OSCILLATOR (XOSC) XTAL EXTAL TPM1CH5 TPM1CH0 6 TPM1CLK TPM2CH1, TPM2CH0 TPM2CLK
PTC7/ADP23 PTC6/ADP22 PTC5/ADP21 PTC4/ADP20 PTC3/ADP19 PTC2/ADP18 PTC1/ADP17 PTC0/ADP16 PTD7/PID7/TPM1CH5 PTD6/PID6/TPM1CH4 PTD5/PID5/TPM1CH3 PTD4/PID4/TPM1CH2 PTD3/PID3/TPM1CH1 PTD2/PID2/TPM1CH0 PTD1/PID1/TPM2CH1 PTD0/PID0/TPM2CH0 PTE7/RxD2/RXCAN PTE6/TxD2/TXCAN PTE5/SDA1/MISO1 PTE4/SCL1/MOSI1 PTE3/SPSCK1 PTE2/SS1 PTE1/RxD1 PTE0/TxD1
4
PORT E
●
●
PORT D
PORT C
PTF7 PTF6/ACMP2O PTF5/ACMP2PTF4/ACMP2+ PTF3/TPM2CLK/SDA1 PTF2/TPM1CLK/SCL1 PTF1/RxD2 PTF0/TxD2 PTG7/SDA2 PTG6/SCL2 PTG5 PTG4 PTG3 PTG2 PTG1/XTAL PTG0/EXTAL
PORT L
PORT F PORT G
● ● ● ●
SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE (SPI2)
- Pin not connected in 64-pin and 48-pin packages ● - Pin not available in the 48-pin package - In 48-pin package, VDDA and VREFH are internally connected to each other and VSSA and VREFL are internally connected to each other.
Figure 9-1. MC9S08DZ128 Block Diagram with ACMP Highlighted
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 200 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 9 Analog Comparator (S08ACMPV3)
9.1.2
Features
The ACMP has the following features: • Full rail to rail supply operation. • Selectable interrupt on rising edge, falling edge, or either rising or falling edges of comparator output. • Option to compare to fixed internal bandgap reference voltage. • Option to allow comparator output to be visible on a pin, ACMPxO. • Can operate in stop3 mode
9.1.3
Modes of Operation
This section defines the ACMP operation in wait, stop and background debug modes.
9.1.3.1
ACMP in Wait Mode
The ACMP continues to run in wait mode if enabled before executing the WAIT instruction. Therefore, the ACMP can be used to bring the MCU out of wait mode if the ACMP interrupt, ACIE is enabled. For lowest possible current consumption, the ACMP should be disabled by software if not required as an interrupt source during wait mode.
9.1.3.2
9.1.3.2.1
ACMP in Stop Modes
Stop3 Mode Operation
The ACMP continues to operate in Stop3 mode if enabled and compare operation remains active. If ACOPE is enabled, comparator output operates as in the normal operating mode and comparator output is placed onto the external pin. The MCU is brought out of stop when a compare event occurs and ACIE is enabled; ACF flag sets accordingly. If stop is exited with a reset, the ACMP will be put into its reset state. 9.1.3.2.2 Stop2 and Stop1 Mode Operation
During either Stop2 and Stop1 mode, the ACMP module will be fully powered down. Upon wake-up from Stop2 or Stop1 mode, the ACMP module will be in the reset state.
9.1.3.3
ACMP in Active Background Mode
When the microcontroller is in active background mode, the ACMP will continue to operate normally.
9.1.4
Block Diagram
The block diagram for the Analog Comparator module is shown Figure 9-2.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 201
Chapter 9 Analog Comparator (S08ACMPV3)
Internal Bus Internal Reference ACBGS ACME Status & Control Register ACMOD ACIE ACF ACOPE set ACF ACMPx INTERRUPT REQUEST
ACMPx+ + Comparator
Interrupt Control
ACMPx-
ACMPxO
Figure 9-2. Analog Comparator 5V (ACMP5) Block Diagram
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 202 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 9 Analog Comparator (S08ACMPV3)
9.2
External Signal Description
The ACMP has two analog input pins, ACMPx+ and ACMPx- and one digital output pin ACMPxO. Each of these pins can accept an input voltage that varies across the full operating voltage range of the MCU. As shown in Figure 9-2, the ACMPx- pin is connected to the inverting input of the comparator, and the ACMPx+ pin is connected to the comparator non-inverting input if ACBGS is a 0. As shown in Figure 9-2, the ACMPxO pin can be enabled to drive an external pin. The signal properties of ACMP are shown in Table 9-1.
Table 9-1. Signal Properties
Signal ACMPxACMPx+ ACMPxO Function Inverting analog input to the ACMP. (Minus input) Non-inverting analog input to the ACMP. (Positive input) Digital output of the ACMP. I/O I I O
9.3
9.3.1
Memory Map
Register Descriptions
The ACMP includes one register: • An 8-bit status and control register Refer to the direct-page register summary in the memory section of this data sheet for the absolute address assignments for all ACMP registers.This section refers to registers and control bits only by their names . Some MCUs may have more than one ACMP, so register names include placeholder characters to identify which ACMP is being referenced.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 203
Chapter 9 Analog Comparator (S08ACMPV3)
9.3.1.1
ACMPx Status and Control Register (ACMPxSC)
ACMPxSC contains the status flag and control bits which are used to enable and configure the ACMP.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R ACME W Reset: 0 0 = Unimplemented 0 0 ACBGS ACF ACIE
ACO ACOPE 0 0 0 ACMOD 0
Figure 9-3. ACMPx Status and Control Register Table 9-2. ACMPx Status and Control Register Field Descriptions
Field 7 ACME 6 ACBGS Description Analog Comparator Module Enable — ACME enables the ACMP module. 0 ACMP not enabled 1 ACMP is enabled Analog Comparator Bandgap Select — ACBGS is used to select between the bandgap reference voltage or the ACMPx+ pin as the input to the non-inverting input of the analog comparatorr. 0 External pin ACMPx+ selected as non-inverting input to comparator 1 Internal reference select as non-inverting input to comparator Note: refer to this chapter introduction to verify if any other config bits are necessary to enable the bandgap reference in the chip level. Analog Comparator Flag — ACF is set when a compare event occurs. Compare events are defined by ACMOD. ACF is cleared by writing a one to ACF. 0 Compare event has not occured 1 Compare event has occured Analog Comparator Interrupt Enable — ACIE enables the interrupt from the ACMP. When ACIE is set, an interupt will be asserted when ACF is set. 0 Interrupt disabled 1 Interrupt enabled Analog Comparator Output — Reading ACO will return the current value of the analog comparator output. ACO is reset to a 0 and will read as a 0 when the ACMP is disabled (ACME = 0). Analog Comparator Output Pin Enable — ACOPE is used to enable the comparator output to be placed onto the external pin, ACMPxO. 0 Analog comparator output not available on ACMPxO 1 Analog comparator output is driven out on ACMPxO Analog Comparator Mode — ACMOD selects the type of compare event which sets ACF. 00 Encoding 0 — Comparator output falling edge 01 Encoding 1 — Comparator output rising edge 10 Encoding 2 — Comparator output falling edge 11 Encoding 3 — Comparator output rising or falling edge
5 ACF
4 ACIE
3 ACO 2 ACOPE
1:0 ACMOD
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 204 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 9 Analog Comparator (S08ACMPV3)
9.4
Functional Description
The analog comparator can be used to compare two analog input voltages applied to ACMPx+ and ACMPx-; or it can be used to compare an analog input voltage applied to ACMPx- with an internal bandgap reference voltage. ACBGS is used to select between the bandgap reference voltage or the ACMPx+ pin as the input to the non-inverting input of the analog comparator. The comparator output is high when the non-inverting input is greater than the inverting input, and is low when the non-inverting input is less than the inverting input. ACMOD is used to select the condition which will cause ACF to be set. ACF can be set on a rising edge of the comparator output, a falling edge of the comparator output, or either a rising or a falling edge (toggle). The comparator output can be read directly through ACO. The comparator output can be driven onto the ACMPxO pin using ACOPE.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 205
Chapter 9 Analog Comparator (S08ACMPV3)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 206 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
10.1 Introduction
The 12-bit analog-to-digital converter (ADC) is a successive approximation ADC designed for operation within an integrated microcontroller system-on-chip. NOTE MC9S08DZ128 Series devices operate at a higher voltage range (2.7 V to 5.5 V) and do not include stop1 mode. Please ignore references to stop1. The ADC channel assignments, alternate clock function, and hardware trigger function are configured as described in Section 10.1.1, “Channel Assignments.”
10.1.1
Channel Assignments
NOTE The ADC channel assignments for the MC9S08DZ128 Series devices are shown in Table 10-1. Reserved channels convert to an unknown value. This chapter shows bits for all S08ADC12V1 channels. MC9S08DZ128 Series MCUs do not use all of these channels. All bits corresponding to channels that are not available on a device are reserved.
10.1.2
Analog Power and Ground Signal Names
References to VDDAD and VSSAD in this chapter correspond to signals VDDA and VSSA, respectively.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 207
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
Table 10-1. ADC Channel Assignment
ADCH 00000 00001 00010 00011 00100 00101 00110 00111 01000 01001 01010 01011 01100 01101 01110 01111 Channel AD0 AD1 AD2 AD3 AD4 AD5 AD6 AD7 AD8 AD9 AD10 AD11 AD12 AD13 AD14 AD15 Input PTA0/ADP0/MCLK PTA1/ADP1/ACMP1+ PTA2/ADP2/ACMP1PPTA3/ADP3/ACMP1O PTA4/ADP4 PTA5/ADP5 PTA6/ADP6 PTA7/ADP7 PTB0/ADP8 PTB1/ADP9 PTB2/ADP10 PTB3/ADP11 PTB4/ADP12 PTB5/ADP13 PTB6/ADP14 PTB7/ADP15 ADCH 10000 10001 10010 10011 10100 10101 10110 10111 11000– 11001 11010 11011 11100 11101 11110 11111 AD26 AD27 VREFH VREFH VREFL Module Disabled Temperature Sensor1 Internal Bandgap2 VREFH VREFH VREFL None Channel AD16 AD17 AD18 AD19 AD20 AD21 AD22 AD23 AD24 through AD25 Input PTC0/ADP16 PTC1/ADP17 PTC2/ADP18 PTC3/ADP19 PTC4/ADP20 PTC5/ADP21 PTC6/ADP22 PTC7/ADP23 Reserved
Notes: 1 For information, see Section 10.1.5, “Temperature Sensor”. 2 Requires BGBE =1 in SPMSC1 see Section 5.8.7, “System Power Management Status and Control 1 Register (SPMSC1)”. For value of bandgap voltage reference see Section A.6, “DC Characteristics”.
10.1.3
Alternate Clock
The ADC module is capable of performing conversions using the MCU bus clock, the bus clock divided by two, the local asynchronous clock (ADACK) within the module, or the alternate clock, ALTCLK. The alternate clock for the MC9S08DZ128 Series MCU devices is the external reference clock (MCGERCLK). The selected clock source must run at a frequency such that the ADC conversion clock (ADCK) runs at a frequency within its specified range (fADCK) after being divided down from the ALTCLK input as determined by the ADIV bits. ALTCLK is active while the MCU is in wait mode provided the conditions described above are met. This allows ALTCLK to be used as the conversion clock source for the ADC while the MCU is in wait mode. ALTCLK cannot be used as the ADC conversion clock source while the MCU is in either stop2 or stop3.
10.1.4
Hardware Trigger
The ADC hardware trigger, ADHWT, is the output from the real time counter (RTC) overflow or the external interrupt request (IRQ) pin. The source is selected by the ADC hardware trigger select bit,
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 208 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
ADHTS, in the SOPT2 register. The RTC or IRQ can be configured to cause a hardware trigger in run, wait, and stop3 modes.
10.1.5
Temperature Sensor
To use the on-chip temperature sensor, the user must perform the following: • Configure ADC for long sample with a maximum of 1 MHz clock • Convert the bandgap voltage reference channel (AD27) — By converting the digital value of the bandgap voltage reference channel using the value of VBG the user can determine VDD. For value of bandgap voltage, see Section A.6, “DC Characteristics”. • Convert the temperature sensor channel (AD26) — By using the calculated value of VDD, convert the digital value of AD26 into a voltage, VTEMP Equation 10-1 provides an approximate transfer function of the temperature sensor.
Temp = 25 - ((VTEMP -VTEMP25) ÷ m) Eqn. 10-1
where: — VTEMP is the voltage of the temperature sensor channel at the ambient temperature. — VTEMP25 is the voltage of the temperature sensor channel at 25°C. — m is the hot or cold voltage versus temperature slope in V/°C. For temperature calculations, use the VTEMP25 and m values from the ADC Electricals table. In application code, the user reads the temperature sensor channel, calculates VTEMP, and compares to VTEMP25. If VTEMP is greater than VTEMP25 the cold slope value is applied in Equation 10-1. If VTEMP is less than VTEMP25 the hot slope value is applied in Equation 10-1. To improve accuracy the user should calibrate the bandgap voltage reference and temperature sensor. Calibrating at 25°C will improve accuracy to ± 4.5°C. Calibration at three points, -40°C, 25°C, and 125°C will improve accuracy to ± 2.5°C. Once calibration has been completed, the user will need to calculate the slope for both hot and cold. In application code, the user would then calculate the temperature using Equation 10-1 as detailed above and then determine if the temperature is above or below 25°C. Once determined if the temperature is above or below 25°C, the user can recalculate the temperature using the hot or cold slope value obtained during calibration.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 209
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
HCS08 CORE CPU BKGD/MS BDC BKP DEBUG MODULE (DBG) ANALOG COMPARATOR (ACMP1) ACMP1O ACMP1ACMP1+ PORT A
RESET
HCS08 SYSTEM CONTROL RESETS AND INTERRUPTS MODES OF OPERATION POWER MANAGEMENT IRQ COP INT LVD IRQ VOLTAGE REGULATOR
PTA7/PIA7/ADP7/IRQ PTA6/PIA6/ADP6 PTA5/PIA5/ADP5 PTA4/PIA4/ADP4 PTA3/PIA3/ADP3/ACMP1O PTA2/PIA2/ADP2/ACMP1PTA1/PIA1/ADP1/ACMP1+ PTA0/PIA0/ADP0/MCLK PTB7/PIB7/ADP15 PTB6/PIB6/ADP14 PTB5/PIB5/ADP13 PTB4/PIB4/ADP12 PTB3/PIB3/ADP11 PTB2/PIB2/ADP10 PTB1/PIB1/ADP9 PTB0/PIB0/ADP8
● ● ● ● ● ● ● ●
REAL-TIME COUNTER (RTC)
VDD VSS VREFH VREFL VDDA VSSA
8 24-CHANNEL,12-BIT ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER (ADC) ADP7-ADP0 ADP15-ADP8 ADP23-ADP16
PORT B
USER MEMORY FLASH _EEPROM _RAM MC9S08DZ128 = 128K_2K_8K MC9S08DZ96 = 96K_2K_6K MC9S08DV128 = 128K_0K_6K MC9S08DV96 = 96K_0K_4K PTJ7/PIJ7/TPM3CLK PTJ6/PIJ6 PTJ5/PIJ5 PTJ4/PIJ4 PTJ3/PIJ3/TMP3CH3 PTJ2/PIJ2/TPM3CH2 PTJ1/PIJ1/TPM3CH1 PTJ0/PIJ0/TMP3CH0 PTK7 PTK6 PTK5 PTK4 PTK3 PTK2 PTK1 PTK0 PTL7 PTL6 PTL5 PTL4 PTL3 PTL2 PTL1 PTL0 PTH7 PTH6 PTH5 PTH4 PTH3/MISO2 PTH2/MOSI2 PTH1/SPSCK2 PTH0/SS2 TPM3CLK PORT J TPM3CH0 TPM3CH3 6-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM1) 2-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM2) 4-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM3) CONTROLLER AREA NETWORK (MSCAN) PORT K SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE (SPI1) SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE (SCI1) ANALOG COMPARATOR (ACMP2) IIC MODULE (IIC1) SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE (SCI2) IIC MODULE (IIC2) PORT H MISO2 MOSI2 SPSCK2 SS2 RxCAN TXCAN MISO1 MOSI1 SPSCK1 SS1 RxD1 TxD1 ACMP2O ACMP2ACMP2+ SDA1 SCL1 RxD2 TxD2 SDA2 SCL2 MULTI-PURPOSE CLOCK GENERATOR (MCG) OSCILLATOR (XOSC) XTAL EXTAL TPM1CH5 TPM1CH0 6 TPM1CLK TPM2CH1, TPM2CH0 TPM2CLK
PTC7/ADP23 PTC6/ADP22 PTC5/ADP21 PTC4/ADP20 PTC3/ADP19 PTC2/ADP18 PTC1/ADP17 PTC0/ADP16 PTD7/PID7/TPM1CH5 PTD6/PID6/TPM1CH4 PTD5/PID5/TPM1CH3 PTD4/PID4/TPM1CH2 PTD3/PID3/TPM1CH1 PTD2/PID2/TPM1CH0 PTD1/PID1/TPM2CH1 PTD0/PID0/TPM2CH0 PTE7/RxD2/RXCAN PTE6/TxD2/TXCAN PTE5/SDA1/MISO1 PTE4/SCL1/MOSI1 PTE3/SPSCK1 PTE2/SS1 PTE1/RxD1 PTE0/TxD1
4
PORT E
●
●
PORT D
PORT C
PTF7 PTF6/ACMP2O PTF5/ACMP2PTF4/ACMP2+ PTF3/TPM2CLK/SDA1 PTF2/TPM1CLK/SCL1 PTF1/RxD2 PTF0/TxD2 PTG7/SDA2 PTG6/SCL2 PTG5 PTG4 PTG3 PTG2 PTG1/XTAL PTG0/EXTAL
PORT L
PORT F PORT G
● ● ● ●
SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE (SPI2)
- Pin not connected in 64-pin and 48-pin packages ● - Pin not available in the 48-pin package - In 48-pin package, VDDA and VREFH are internally connected to each other and VSSA and VREFL are internally connected to each other.
Figure 10-1. MC9S08DZ128 Block Diagram with ADC Highlighted
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 210 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
10.1.6
Features
Features of the ADC module include: • Linear successive approximation algorithm with 12-bit resolution • Up to 28 analog inputs • Output formatted in 12-, 10-, or 8-bit right-justified unsigned format • Single or continuous conversion (automatic return to idle after single conversion) • Configurable sample time and conversion speed/power • Conversion complete flag and interrupt • Input clock selectable from up to four sources • Operation in wait or stop3 modes for lower noise operation • Asynchronous clock source for lower noise operation • Selectable asynchronous hardware conversion trigger • Automatic compare with interrupt for less-than, or greater-than or equal-to, programmable value • Temperature sensor
10.1.7
ADC Module Block Diagram
Figure 10-2 provides a block diagram of the ADC module.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 211
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
3
Compare true
ADCSC1
COCO AIEN
ADCCFG
ADLSMP
complete
ADTRG
ADICLK
ADLPC
ADCH
MODE
ADCO
ADIV
1
2
Async Clock Gen
ADACK MCU STOP ADHWT ADCK Clock Divide
Bus Clock
÷2 ALTCLK
Control Sequencer
initialize transfer convert sample abort
AD0
•••
AIEN 1
Interrupt
ADVIN
SAR Converter
COCO 2
AD27
VREFH VREFL
Data Registers Sum
Compare true Compare Logic Value ACFGT
3
Compare Value Registers
ADCSC2
Figure 10-2. ADC Block Diagram
10.2
External Signal Description
The ADC module supports up to 28 separate analog inputs. It also requires four supply/reference/ground connections.
Table 10-2. Signal Properties
Name AD27–AD0 VREFH VREFL VDDAD VSSAD Function Analog Channel inputs High reference voltage Low reference voltage Analog power supply Analog ground
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 212 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
10.2.1
Analog Power (VDDAD)
The ADC analog portion uses VDDAD as its power connection. In some packages, VDDAD is connected internally to VDD. If externally available, connect the VDDAD pin to the same voltage potential as VDD. External filtering may be necessary to ensure clean VDDAD for good results.
10.2.2
Analog Ground (VSSAD)
The ADC analog portion uses VSSAD as its ground connection. In some packages, VSSAD is connected internally to VSS. If externally available, connect the VSSAD pin to the same voltage potential as VSS.
10.2.3
Voltage Reference High (VREFH)
VREFH is the high reference voltage for the converter. In some packages, VREFH is connected internally to VDDAD. If externally available, VREFH may be connected to the same potential as VDDAD or may be driven by an external source between the minimum VDDAD spec and the VDDAD potential (VREFH must never exceed VDDAD).
10.2.4
Voltage Reference Low (VREFL)
VREFL is the low-reference voltage for the converter. In some packages, VREFL is connected internally to VSSAD. If externally available, connect the VREFL pin to the same voltage potential as VSSAD.
10.2.5
Analog Channel Inputs (ADx)
The ADC module supports up to 28 separate analog inputs. An input is selected for conversion through the ADCH channel select bits.
10.3
• • • • • •
Register Definition
Status and control register, ADCSC1 Status and control register, ADCSC2 Data result registers, ADCRH and ADCRL Compare value registers, ADCCVH and ADCCVL Configuration register, ADCCFG Pin control registers, APCTL1, APCTL2, APCTL3
These memory-mapped registers control and monitor operation of the ADC:
10.3.1
Status and Control Register 1 (ADCSC1)
This section describes the function of the ADC status and control register (ADCSC1). Writing ADCSC1 aborts the current conversion and initiates a new conversion (if the ADCH bits are equal to a value other than all 1s).
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 213
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R W Reset:
COCO AIEN 0 0 ADCO 0 1 1 ADCH 1 1 1
Figure 10-3. Status and Control Register (ADCSC1) Table 10-3. ADCSC1 Field Descriptions
Field 7 COCO Description Conversion Complete Flag. The COCO flag is a read-only bit set each time a conversion is completed when the compare function is disabled (ACFE = 0). When the compare function is enabled (ACFE = 1), the COCO flag is set upon completion of a conversion only if the compare result is true. This bit is cleared when ADCSC1 is written or when ADCRL is read. 0 Conversion not completed 1 Conversion completed Interrupt Enable AIEN enables conversion complete interrupts. When COCO becomes set while AIEN is high, an interrupt is asserted. 0 Conversion complete interrupt disabled 1 Conversion complete interrupt enabled Continuous Conversion Enable. ADCO enables continuous conversions. 0 One conversion following a write to the ADCSC1 when software triggered operation is selected, or one conversion following assertion of ADHWT when hardware triggered operation is selected. 1 Continuous conversions initiated following a write to ADCSC1 when software triggered operation is selected. Continuous conversions are initiated by an ADHWT event when hardware triggered operation is selected. Input Channel Select. The ADCH bits form a 5-bit field that selects one of the input channels. The input channels are detailed in Table 10-4. The successive approximation converter subsystem is turned off when the channel select bits are all set. This feature allows for explicit disabling of the ADC and isolation of the input channel from all sources. Terminating continuous conversions this way prevents an additional, single conversion from being performed. It is not necessary to set the channel select bits to all ones to place the ADC in a low-power state when continuous conversions are not enabled because the module automatically enters a low-power state when a conversion completes.
6 AIEN
5 ADCO
4:0 ADCH
Table 10-4. Input Channel Select
ADCH 00000–01111 10000–11011 11100 11101 11110 11111 Input Select AD0–15 AD16–27 Reserved VREFH VREFL Module disabled
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 214 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
10.3.2
Status and Control Register 2 (ADCSC2)
The ADCSC2 register controls the compare function, conversion trigger, and conversion active of the ADC module.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset:
ADACT ADTRG 0 0 ACFE 0 ACFGT 0
0
0
R1 0
R1 0
0
0
Figure 10-4. Status and Control Register 2 (ADCSC2)
1
Bits 1 and 0 are reserved bits that must always be written to 0.
Table 10-5. ADCSC2 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7 ADACT Description Conversion Active. Indicates that a conversion is in progress. ADACT is set when a conversion is initiated and cleared when a conversion is completed or aborted. 0 Conversion not in progress 1 Conversion in progress Conversion Trigger Select. Selects the type of trigger used for initiating a conversion. Two types of triggers are selectable: software trigger and hardware trigger. When software trigger is selected, a conversion is initiated following a write to ADCSC1. When hardware trigger is selected, a conversion is initiated following the assertion of the ADHWT input. 0 Software trigger selected 1 Hardware trigger selected Compare Function Enable. Enables the compare function. 0 Compare function disabled 1 Compare function enabled Compare Function Greater Than Enable. Configures the compare function to trigger when the result of the conversion of the input being monitored is greater than or equal to the compare value. The compare function defaults to triggering when the result of the compare of the input being monitored is less than the compare value. 0 Compare triggers when input is less than compare value 1 Compare triggers when input is greater than or equal to compare value
6 ADTRG
5 ACFE 4 ACFGT
10.3.3
Data Result High Register (ADCRH)
In 12-bit operation, ADCRH contains the upper four bits of the result of a 12-bit conversion. In 10-bit mode, ADCRH contains the upper two bits of the result of a 10-bit conversion. When configured for 10-bit mode, ADR[11:10] are cleared. When configured for 8-bit mode, ADR[11:8] are cleared. In 12-bit and 10-bit mode, ADCRH is updated each time a conversion completes except when automatic compare is enabled and the compare condition is not met. When a compare event does occur, the value is the addition of the conversion result and the two’s complement of the compare value. In 12-bit and 10-bit mode, reading ADCRH prevents the ADC from transferring subsequent conversion results into the result registers until ADCRL is read. If ADCRL is not read until after the next conversion is completed, the intermediate conversion result is lost. In 8-bit mode, there is no interlocking with ADCRL.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 215
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
If the MODE bits are changed, any data in ADCRH becomes invalid.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset:
0
0
0
0
ADR11
ADR10
ADR9
ADR8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 10-5. Data Result High Register (ADCRH)
10.3.4
Data Result Low Register (ADCRL)
ADCRL contains the lower eight bits of the result of a 12-bit or 10-bit conversion, and all eight bits of an 8-bit conversion. This register is updated each time a conversion completes except when automatic compare is enabled and the compare condition is not met. In 12-bit and 10-bit mode, reading ADCRH prevents the ADC from transferring subsequent conversion results into the result registers until ADCRL is read. If ADCRL is not read until the after next conversion is completed, the intermediate conversion results are lost. In 8-bit mode, there is no interlocking with ADCRH. If the MODE bits are changed, any data in ADCRL becomes invalid.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset:
ADR7
ADR6
ADR5
ADR4
ADR3
ADR2
ADR1
ADR0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 10-6. Data Result Low Register (ADCRL)
10.3.5
Compare Value High Register (ADCCVH)
In 12-bit mode, the ADCCVH register holds the upper four bits of the 12-bit compare value. When the compare function is enabled, these bits are compared to the upper four bits of the result following a conversion in 12-bit mode.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset:
0
0
0
0 ADCV11 ADCV10 0 ADCV9 0 ADCV8 0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 10-7. Compare Value High Register (ADCCVH)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 216 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
In 10-bit mode, the ADCCVH register holds the upper two bits of the 10-bit compare value (ADCV[9:8]). These bits are compared to the upper two bits of the result following a conversion in 10-bit mode when the compare function is enabled. In 8-bit mode, ADCCVH is not used during compare.
10.3.6
Compare Value Low Register (ADCCVL)
This register holds the lower 8 bits of the 12-bit or 10-bit compare value or all 8 bits of the 8-bit compare value. When the compare function is enabled, bits ADCV[7:0] are compared to the lower 8 bits of the result following a conversion in 12-bit, 10-bit or 8-bit mode.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R ADCV7 W Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 ADCV6 ADCV5 ADCV4 ADCV3 ADCV2 ADCV1 ADCV0
Figure 10-8. Compare Value Low Register(ADCCVL)
10.3.7
Configuration Register (ADCCFG)
ADCCFG selects the mode of operation, clock source, clock divide, and configures for low power and long sample time.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R ADLPC W Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 ADIV ADLSMP MODE ADICLK
Figure 10-9. Configuration Register (ADCCFG) Table 10-6. ADCCFG Register Field Descriptions
Field 7 ADLPC Description Low-Power Configuration. ADLPC controls the speed and power configuration of the successive approximation converter. This optimizes power consumption when higher sample rates are not required. 0 High speed configuration 1 Low power configuration:The power is reduced at the expense of maximum clock speed. Clock Divide Select. ADIV selects the divide ratio used by the ADC to generate the internal clock ADCK. Table 10-7 shows the available clock configurations. Long Sample Time Configuration. ADLSMP selects between long and short sample time. This adjusts the sample period to allow higher impedance inputs to be accurately sampled or to maximize conversion speed for lower impedance inputs. Longer sample times can also be used to lower overall power consumption when continuous conversions are enabled if high conversion rates are not required. 0 Short sample time 1 Long sample time
6:5 ADIV 4 ADLSMP
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 217
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
Table 10-6. ADCCFG Register Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 3:2 MODE 1:0 ADICLK Description Conversion Mode Selection. MODE bits are used to select between 12-, 10-, or 8-bit operation. See Table 10-8. Input Clock Select. ADICLK bits select the input clock source to generate the internal clock ADCK. See Table 10-9.
Table 10-7. Clock Divide Select
ADIV 00 01 10 11 Divide Ratio 1 2 4 8 Clock Rate Input clock Input clock ÷ 2 Input clock ÷ 4 Input clock ÷ 8
Table 10-8. Conversion Modes
MODE 00 01 10 11 Mode Description 8-bit conversion (N=8) 12-bit conversion (N=12) 10-bit conversion (N=10) Reserved
Table 10-9. Input Clock Select
ADICLK 00 01 10 11 Bus clock Bus clock divided by 2 Alternate clock (ALTCLK) Asynchronous clock (ADACK) Selected Clock Source
10.3.8
Pin Control 1 Register (APCTL1)
The pin control registers disable the I/O port control of MCU pins used as analog inputs. APCTL1 is
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 218 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
used to control the pins associated with channels 0–7 of the ADC module.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R ADPC7 W Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 ADPC6 ADPC5 ADPC4 ADPC3 ADPC2 ADPC1 ADPC0
Figure 10-10. Pin Control 1 Register (APCTL1) Table 10-10. APCTL1 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7 ADPC7 6 ADPC6 5 ADPC5 4 ADPC4 3 ADPC3 2 ADPC2 1 ADPC1 0 ADPC0 Description ADC Pin Control 7. ADPC7 controls the pin associated with channel AD7. 0 AD7 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD7 pin I/O control disabled ADC Pin Control 6. ADPC6 controls the pin associated with channel AD6. 0 AD6 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD6 pin I/O control disabled ADC Pin Control 5. ADPC5 controls the pin associated with channel AD5. 0 AD5 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD5 pin I/O control disabled ADC Pin Control 4. ADPC4 controls the pin associated with channel AD4. 0 AD4 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD4 pin I/O control disabled ADC Pin Control 3. ADPC3 controls the pin associated with channel AD3. 0 AD3 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD3 pin I/O control disabled ADC Pin Control 2. ADPC2 controls the pin associated with channel AD2. 0 AD2 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD2 pin I/O control disabled ADC Pin Control 1. ADPC1 controls the pin associated with channel AD1. 0 AD1 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD1 pin I/O control disabled ADC Pin Control 0. ADPC0 controls the pin associated with channel AD0. 0 AD0 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD0 pin I/O control disabled
10.3.9
Pin Control 2 Register (APCTL2)
APCTL2 controls channels 8–15 of the ADC module.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R ADPC15 W Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 ADPC14 ADPC13 ADPC12 ADPC11 ADPC10 ADPC9 ADPC8
Figure 10-11. Pin Control 2 Register (APCTL2)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 219
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
Table 10-11. APCTL2 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7 ADPC15 6 ADPC14 5 ADPC13 4 ADPC12 3 ADPC11 2 ADPC10 1 ADPC9 0 ADPC8 Description ADC Pin Control 15. ADPC15 controls the pin associated with channel AD15. 0 AD15 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD15 pin I/O control disabled ADC Pin Control 14. ADPC14 controls the pin associated with channel AD14. 0 AD14 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD14 pin I/O control disabled ADC Pin Control 13. ADPC13 controls the pin associated with channel AD13. 0 AD13 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD13 pin I/O control disabled ADC Pin Control 12. ADPC12 controls the pin associated with channel AD12. 0 AD12 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD12 pin I/O control disabled ADC Pin Control 11. ADPC11 controls the pin associated with channel AD11. 0 AD11 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD11 pin I/O control disabled ADC Pin Control 10. ADPC10 controls the pin associated with channel AD10. 0 AD10 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD10 pin I/O control disabled ADC Pin Control 9. ADPC9 controls the pin associated with channel AD9. 0 AD9 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD9 pin I/O control disabled ADC Pin Control 8. ADPC8 controls the pin associated with channel AD8. 0 AD8 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD8 pin I/O control disabled
10.3.10 Pin Control 3 Register (APCTL3)
APCTL3 controls channels 16–23 of the ADC module.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R ADPC23 W Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 ADPC22 ADPC21 ADPC20 ADPC19 ADPC18 ADPC17 ADPC16
Figure 10-12. Pin Control 3 Register (APCTL3)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 220 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
Table 10-12. APCTL3 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7 ADPC23 6 ADPC22 5 ADPC21 4 ADPC20 3 ADPC19 2 ADPC18 1 ADPC17 0 ADPC16 Description ADC Pin Control 23. ADPC23 controls the pin associated with channel AD23. 0 AD23 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD23 pin I/O control disabled ADC Pin Control 22. ADPC22 controls the pin associated with channel AD22. 0 AD22 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD22 pin I/O control disabled ADC Pin Control 21. ADPC21 controls the pin associated with channel AD21. 0 AD21 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD21 pin I/O control disabled ADC Pin Control 20. ADPC20 controls the pin associated with channel AD20. 0 AD20 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD20 pin I/O control disabled ADC Pin Control 19. ADPC19 controls the pin associated with channel AD19. 0 AD19 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD19 pin I/O control disabled ADC Pin Control 18. ADPC18 controls the pin associated with channel AD18. 0 AD18 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD18 pin I/O control disabled ADC Pin Control 17. ADPC17 controls the pin associated with channel AD17. 0 AD17 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD17 pin I/O control disabled ADC Pin Control 16. ADPC16 controls the pin associated with channel AD16. 0 AD16 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD16 pin I/O control disabled
10.4
Functional Description
The ADC module is disabled during reset or when the ADCH bits are all high. The module is idle when a conversion has completed and another conversion has not been initiated. When idle, the module is in its lowest power state. The ADC can perform an analog-to-digital conversion on any of the software selectable channels. In 12-bit and 10-bit mode, the selected channel voltage is converted by a successive approximation algorithm into a 12-bit digital result. In 8-bit mode, the selected channel voltage is converted by a successive approximation algorithm into a 9-bit digital result. When the conversion is completed, the result is placed in the data registers (ADCRH and ADCRL). In 10-bit mode, the result is rounded to 10 bits and placed in the data registers (ADCRH and ADCRL). In 8-bit mode, the result is rounded to 8 bits and placed in ADCRL. The conversion complete flag (COCO) is then set and an interrupt is generated if the conversion complete interrupt has been enabled (AIEN = 1). The ADC module has the capability of automatically comparing the result of a conversion with the contents of its compare registers. The compare function is enabled by setting the ACFE bit and operates with any of the conversion modes and configurations.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 221
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
10.4.1
Clock Select and Divide Control
One of four clock sources can be selected as the clock source for the ADC module. This clock source is then divided by a configurable value to generate the input clock to the converter (ADCK). The clock is selected from one of the following sources by means of the ADICLK bits. • The bus clock, which is equal to the frequency at which software is executed. This is the default selection following reset. • The bus clock divided by two. For higher bus clock rates, this allows a maximum divide by 16 of the bus clock. • ALTCLK, as defined for this MCU (See module section introduction). • The asynchronous clock (ADACK). This clock is generated from a clock source within the ADC module. When selected as the clock source, this clock remains active while the MCU is in wait or stop3 mode and allows conversions in these modes for lower noise operation. Whichever clock is selected, its frequency must fall within the specified frequency range for ADCK. If the available clocks are too slow, the ADC do not perform according to specifications. If the available clocks are too fast, the clock must be divided to the appropriate frequency. This divider is specified by the ADIV bits and can be divide-by 1, 2, 4, or 8.
10.4.2
Input Select and Pin Control
The pin control registers (APCTL3, APCTL2, and APCTL1) disable the I/O port control of the pins used as analog inputs.When a pin control register bit is set, the following conditions are forced for the associated MCU pin: • The output buffer is forced to its high impedance state. • The input buffer is disabled. A read of the I/O port returns a zero for any pin with its input buffer disabled. • The pullup is disabled.
10.4.3
Hardware Trigger
The ADC module has a selectable asynchronous hardware conversion trigger, ADHWT, that is enabled when the ADTRG bit is set. This source is not available on all MCUs. Consult the module introduction for information on the ADHWT source specific to this MCU. When ADHWT source is available and hardware trigger is enabled (ADTRG=1), a conversion is initiated on the rising edge of ADHWT. If a conversion is in progress when a rising edge occurs, the rising edge is ignored. In continuous convert configuration, only the initial rising edge to launch continuous conversions is observed. The hardware trigger function operates in conjunction with any of the conversion modes and configurations.
10.4.4
Conversion Control
Conversions can be performed in 12-bit mode, 10-bit mode, or 8-bit mode as determined by the MODE bits. Conversions can be initiated by a software or hardware trigger. In addition, the ADC module can be
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 222 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
configured for low power operation, long sample time, continuous conversion, and automatic compare of the conversion result to a software determined compare value.
10.4.4.1
Initiating Conversions
A conversion is initiated: • Following a write to ADCSC1 (with ADCH bits not all 1s) if software triggered operation is selected. • Following a hardware trigger (ADHWT) event if hardware triggered operation is selected. • Following the transfer of the result to the data registers when continuous conversion is enabled. If continuous conversions are enabled, a new conversion is automatically initiated after the completion of the current conversion. In software triggered operation, continuous conversions begin after ADCSC1 is written and continue until aborted. In hardware triggered operation, continuous conversions begin after a hardware trigger event and continue until aborted.
10.4.4.2
Completing Conversions
A conversion is completed when the result of the conversion is transferred into the data result registers, ADCRH and ADCRL. This is indicated by the setting of COCO. An interrupt is generated if AIEN is high at the time that COCO is set. A blocking mechanism prevents a new result from overwriting previous data in ADCRH and ADCRL if the previous data is in the process of being read while in 12-bit or 10-bit MODE (the ADCRH register has been read but the ADCRL register has not). When blocking is active, the data transfer is blocked, COCO is not set, and the new result is lost. In the case of single conversions with the compare function enabled and the compare condition false, blocking has no effect and ADC operation is terminated. In all other cases of operation, when a data transfer is blocked, another conversion is initiated regardless of the state of ADCO (single or continuous conversions enabled). If single conversions are enabled, the blocking mechanism could result in several discarded conversions and excess power consumption. To avoid this issue, the data registers must not be read after initiating a single conversion until the conversion completes.
10.4.4.3
• • • •
Aborting Conversions
Any conversion in progress is aborted when: A write to ADCSC1 occurs (the current conversion will be aborted and a new conversion will be initiated, if ADCH are not all 1s). A write to ADCSC2, ADCCFG, ADCCVH, or ADCCVL occurs. This indicates a mode of operation change has occurred and the current conversion is therefore invalid. The MCU is reset. The MCU enters stop mode with ADACK not enabled.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 223
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
When a conversion is aborted, the contents of the data registers, ADCRH and ADCRL, are not altered. However, they continue to be the values transferred after the completion of the last successful conversion. If the conversion was aborted by a reset, ADCRH and ADCRL return to their reset states.
10.4.4.4
Power Control
The ADC module remains in its idle state until a conversion is initiated. If ADACK is selected as the conversion clock source, the ADACK clock generator is also enabled. Power consumption when active can be reduced by setting ADLPC. This results in a lower maximum value for fADCK (see the electrical specifications).
10.4.4.5
Sample Time and Total Conversion Time
The total conversion time depends on the sample time (as determined by ADLSMP), the MCU bus frequency, the conversion mode (8-bit, 10-bit or 12-bit), and the frequency of the conversion clock (fADCK). After the module becomes active, sampling of the input begins. ADLSMP selects between short (3.5 ADCK cycles) and long (23.5 ADCK cycles) sample times.When sampling is complete, the converter is isolated from the input channel and a successive approximation algorithm is performed to determine the digital value of the analog signal. The result of the conversion is transferred to ADCRH and ADCRL upon completion of the conversion algorithm. If the bus frequency is less than the fADCK frequency, precise sample time for continuous conversions cannot be guaranteed when short sample is enabled (ADLSMP=0). If the bus frequency is less than 1/11th of the fADCK frequency, precise sample time for continuous conversions cannot be guaranteed when long sample is enabled (ADLSMP=1). The maximum total conversion time for different conditions is summarized in Table 10-13.
Table 10-13. Total Conversion Time vs. Control Conditions
Conversion Type Single or first continuous 8-bit Single or first continuous 10-bit or 12-bit Single or first continuous 8-bit Single or first continuous 10-bit or 12-bit Single or first continuous 8-bit Single or first continuous 10-bit or 12-bit Single or first continuous 8-bit Single or first continuous 10-bit or 12-bit Subsequent continuous 8-bit; fBUS > fADCK Subsequent continuous 10-bit or 12-bit; fBUS > fADCK Subsequent continuous 8-bit; fBUS > fADCK/11 ADICLK 0x, 10 0x, 10 0x, 10 0x, 10 11 11 11 11 xx xx xx ADLSMP 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 Max Total Conversion Time 20 ADCK cycles + 5 bus clock cycles 23 ADCK cycles + 5 bus clock cycles 40 ADCK cycles + 5 bus clock cycles 43 ADCK cycles + 5 bus clock cycles 5 μs + 20 ADCK + 5 bus clock cycles 5 μs + 23 ADCK + 5 bus clock cycles 5 μs + 40 ADCK + 5 bus clock cycles 5 μs + 43 ADCK + 5 bus clock cycles 17 ADCK cycles 20 ADCK cycles 37 ADCK cycles
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 224 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
Table 10-13. Total Conversion Time vs. Control Conditions
Conversion Type Subsequent continuous 10-bit or 12-bit; fBUS > fADCK/11 ADICLK xx ADLSMP 1 Max Total Conversion Time 40 ADCK cycles
The maximum total conversion time is determined by the clock source chosen and the divide ratio selected. The clock source is selectable by the ADICLK bits, and the divide ratio is specified by the ADIV bits. For example, in 10-bit mode, with the bus clock selected as the input clock source, the input clock divide-by-1 ratio selected, and a bus frequency of 8 MHz, then the conversion time for a single conversion is:
Conversion time = 23 ADCK Cyc 8 MHz/1 + 5 bus Cyc 8 MHz = 3.5 ms
Number of bus cycles = 3.5 ms x 8 MHz = 28 cycles
NOTE The ADCK frequency must be between fADCK minimum and fADCK maximum to meet ADC specifications.
10.4.5
Automatic Compare Function
The compare function can be configured to check for an upper or lower limit. After the input is sampled and converted, the result is added to the two’s complement of the compare value (ADCCVH and ADCCVL). When comparing to an upper limit (ACFGT = 1), if the result is greater-than or equal-to the compare value, COCO is set. When comparing to a lower limit (ACFGT = 0), if the result is less than the compare value, COCO is set. The value generated by the addition of the conversion result and the two’s complement of the compare value is transferred to ADCRH and ADCRL. Upon completion of a conversion while the compare function is enabled, if the compare condition is not true, COCO is not set and no data is transferred to the result registers. An ADC interrupt is generated upon the setting of COCO if the ADC interrupt is enabled (AIEN = 1). NOTE The compare function can monitor the voltage on a channel while the MCU is in wait or stop3 mode. The ADC interrupt wakes the MCU when the compare condition is met.
10.4.6
MCU Wait Mode Operation
Wait mode is a lower power-consumption standby mode from which recovery is fast because the clock sources remain active. If a conversion is in progress when the MCU enters wait mode, it continues until completion. Conversions can be initiated while the MCU is in wait mode by means of the hardware trigger or if continuous conversions are enabled. The bus clock, bus clock divided by two, and ADACK are available as conversion clock sources while in wait mode. The use of ALTCLK as the conversion clock source in wait is dependent on the definition of
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 225
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
ALTCLK for this MCU. Consult the module introduction for information on ALTCLK specific to this MCU. A conversion complete event sets the COCO and generates an ADC interrupt to wake the MCU from wait mode if the ADC interrupt is enabled (AIEN = 1).
10.4.7
MCU Stop3 Mode Operation
Stop mode is a low power-consumption standby mode during which most or all clock sources on the MCU are disabled.
10.4.7.1
Stop3 Mode With ADACK Disabled
If the asynchronous clock, ADACK, is not selected as the conversion clock, executing a stop instruction aborts the current conversion and places the ADC in its idle state. The contents of ADCRH and ADCRL are unaffected by stop3 mode. After exiting from stop3 mode, a software or hardware trigger is required to resume conversions.
10.4.7.2
Stop3 Mode With ADACK Enabled
If ADACK is selected as the conversion clock, the ADC continues operation during stop3 mode. For guaranteed ADC operation, the MCU’s voltage regulator must remain active during stop3 mode. Consult the module introduction for configuration information for this MCU. If a conversion is in progress when the MCU enters stop3 mode, it continues until completion. Conversions can be initiated while the MCU is in stop3 mode by means of the hardware trigger or if continuous conversions are enabled. A conversion complete event sets the COCO and generates an ADC interrupt to wake the MCU from stop3 mode if the ADC interrupt is enabled (AIEN = 1). NOTE The ADC module can wake the system from low-power stop and cause the MCU to begin consuming run-level currents without generating a system level interrupt. To prevent this scenario, software should ensure the data transfer blocking mechanism (discussed in Section 10.4.4.2, “Completing Conversions) is cleared when entering stop3 and continuing ADC conversions.
10.4.8
MCU Stop2 Mode Operation
The ADC module is automatically disabled when the MCU enters stop2 mode. All module registers contain their reset values following exit from stop2. Therefore, the module must be re-enabled and re-configured following exit from stop2.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 226 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
10.5
Initialization Information
This section gives an example that provides some basic direction on how to initialize and configure the ADC module. You can configure the module for 8-, 10-, or 12-bit resolution, single or continuous conversion, and a polled or interrupt approach, among many other options. Refer to Table 10-7, Table 10-8, and Table 10-9 for information used in this example. NOTE Hexadecimal values designated by a preceding 0x, binary values designated by a preceding %, and decimal values have no preceding character.
10.5.1
10.5.1.1
ADC Module Initialization Example
Initialization Sequence
Before the ADC module can be used to complete conversions, an initialization procedure must be performed. A typical sequence is as follows: 1. Update the configuration register (ADCCFG) to select the input clock source and the divide ratio used to generate the internal clock, ADCK. This register is also used for selecting sample time and low-power configuration. 2. Update status and control register 2 (ADCSC2) to select the conversion trigger (hardware or software) and compare function options, if enabled. 3. Update status and control register 1 (ADCSC1) to select whether conversions will be continuous or completed only once, and to enable or disable conversion complete interrupts. The input channel on which conversions will be performed is also selected here.
10.5.1.2
Pseudo-Code Example
In this example, the ADC module is set up with interrupts enabled to perform a single 10-bit conversion at low power with a long sample time on input channel 1, where the internal ADCK clock is derived from the bus clock divided by 1. ADCCFG = 0x98 (%10011000)
Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit 7 6:5 4 3:2 1:0 ADLPC ADIV ADLSMP MODE ADICLK 1 00 1 10 00 Configures for low power (lowers maximum clock speed) Sets the ADCK to the input clock ÷ 1 Configures for long sample time Sets mode at 10-bit conversions Selects bus clock as input clock source
ADCSC2 = 0x00 (%00000000)
Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit 7 6 5 4 3:2 1:0 ADACT ADTRG ACFE ACFGT 0 0 0 0 00 00 Flag indicates if a conversion is in progress Software trigger selected Compare function disabled Not used in this example Reserved, always reads zero Reserved for Freescale’s internal use; always write zero
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 227
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
ADCSC1 = 0x41 (%01000001)
Bit Bit Bit Bit 7 6 5 4:0 COCO AIEN ADCO ADCH 0 1 0 00001 Read-only flag which is set when a conversion completes Conversion complete interrupt enabled One conversion only (continuous conversions disabled) Input channel 1 selected as ADC input channel
ADCRH/L = 0xxx
Holds results of conversion. Read high byte (ADCRH) before low byte (ADCRL) so that conversion data cannot be overwritten with data from the next conversion.
ADCCVH/L = 0xxx
Holds compare value when compare function enabled
APCTL1=0x02
AD1 pin I/O control disabled. All other AD pins remain general purpose I/O pins
APCTL2=0x00
All other AD pins remain general purpose I/O pins
Reset
Initialize ADC ADCCFG = 0x98 ADCSC2 = 0x00 ADCSC1 = 0x41
Check COCO=1? Yes Read ADCRH Then ADCRL To Clear COCO Bit
No
Continue
Figure 10-13. Initialization Flowchart for Example
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 228 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
10.6
Application Information
This section contains information for using the ADC module in applications. The ADC has been designed to be integrated into a microcontroller for use in embedded control applications requiring an A/D converter.
10.6.1
External Pins and Routing
The following sections discuss the external pins associated with the ADC module and how they should be used for best results.
10.6.1.1
Analog Supply Pins
The ADC module has analog power and ground supplies (VDDAD and VSSAD) available as separate pins on some devices. VSSAD is shared on the same pin as the MCU digital VSS on some devices. On other devices, VSSAD and VDDAD are shared with the MCU digital supply pins. In these cases, there are separate pads for the analog supplies bonded to the same pin as the corresponding digital supply so that some degree of isolation between the supplies is maintained. When available on a separate pin, both VDDAD and VSSAD must be connected to the same voltage potential as their corresponding MCU digital supply (VDD and VSS) and must be routed carefully for maximum noise immunity and bypass capacitors placed as near as possible to the package. If separate power supplies are used for analog and digital power, the ground connection between these supplies must be at the VSSAD pin. This should be the only ground connection between these supplies if possible. The VSSAD pin makes a good single point ground location.
10.6.1.2
Analog Reference Pins
In addition to the analog supplies, the ADC module has connections for two reference voltage inputs. The high reference is VREFH, which may be shared on the same pin as VDDAD on some devices. The low reference is VREFL, which may be shared on the same pin as VSSAD on some devices. When available on a separate pin, VREFH may be connected to the same potential as VDDAD, or may be driven by an external source between the minimum VDDAD spec and the VDDAD potential (VREFH must never exceed VDDAD). When available on a separate pin, VREFL must be connected to the same voltage potential as VSSAD. VREFH and VREFL must be routed carefully for maximum noise immunity and bypass capacitors placed as near as possible to the package. AC current in the form of current spikes required to supply charge to the capacitor array at each successive approximation step is drawn through the VREFH and VREFL loop. The best external component to meet this current demand is a 0.1 μF capacitor with good high frequency characteristics. This capacitor is connected between VREFH and VREFL and must be placed as near as possible to the package pins. Resistance in the path is not recommended because the current causes a voltage drop that could result in conversion errors. Inductance in this path must be minimum (parasitic only).
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 229
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
10.6.1.3
Analog Input Pins
The external analog inputs are typically shared with digital I/O pins on MCU devices. The pin I/O control is disabled by setting the appropriate control bit in one of the pin control registers. Conversions can be performed on inputs without the associated pin control register bit set. It is recommended that the pin control register bit always be set when using a pin as an analog input. This avoids problems with contention because the output buffer is in its high impedance state and the pullup is disabled. Also, the input buffer draws DC current when its input is not at VDD or VSS. Setting the pin control register bits for all pins used as analog inputs should be done to achieve lowest operating current. Empirical data shows that capacitors on the analog inputs improve performance in the presence of noise or when the source impedance is high. Use of 0.01 μF capacitors with good high-frequency characteristics is sufficient. These capacitors are not necessary in all cases, but when used they must be placed as near as possible to the package pins and be referenced to VSSA. For proper conversion, the input voltage must fall between VREFH and VREFL. If the input is equal to or exceeds VREFH, the converter circuit converts the signal to 0xFFF (full scale 12-bit representation), 0x3FF (full scale 10-bit representation) or 0xFF (full scale 8-bit representation). If the input is equal to or less than VREFL, the converter circuit converts it to 0x000. Input voltages between VREFH and VREFL are straight-line linear conversions. There is a brief current associated with VREFL when the sampling capacitor is charging. The input is sampled for 3.5 cycles of the ADCK source when ADLSMP is low, or 23.5 cycles when ADLSMP is high. For minimal loss of accuracy due to current injection, pins adjacent to the analog input pins should not be transitioning during conversions.
10.6.2
Sources of Error
Several sources of error exist for A/D conversions. These are discussed in the following sections.
10.6.2.1
Sampling Error
For proper conversions, the input must be sampled long enough to achieve the proper accuracy. Given the maximum input resistance of approximately 7kΩ and input capacitance of approximately 5.5 pF, sampling to within 1/4LSB (at 12-bit resolution) can be achieved within the minimum sample window (3.5 cycles @ 8 MHz maximum ADCK frequency) provided the resistance of the external analog source (RAS) is kept below 2 kΩ. Higher source resistances or higher-accuracy sampling is possible by setting ADLSMP (to increase the sample window to 23.5 cycles) or decreasing ADCK frequency to increase sample time.
10.6.2.2
Pin Leakage Error
Leakage on the I/O pins can cause conversion error if the external analog source resistance (RAS) is high. If this error cannot be tolerated by the application, keep RAS lower than VDDAD / (2N*ILEAK) for less than 1/4LSB leakage error (N = 8 in 8-bit, 10 in 10-bit or 12 in 12-bit mode).
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 230 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
10.6.2.3
Noise-Induced Errors
System noise that occurs during the sample or conversion process can affect the accuracy of the conversion. The ADC accuracy numbers are guaranteed as specified only if the following conditions are met: • There is a 0.1 μF low-ESR capacitor from VREFH to VREFL. • There is a 0.1 μF low-ESR capacitor from VDDAD to VSSAD. • If inductive isolation is used from the primary supply, an additional 1 μF capacitor is placed from VDDAD to VSSAD. • VSSAD (and VREFL, if connected) is connected to VSS at a quiet point in the ground plane. • Operate the MCU in wait or stop3 mode before initiating (hardware triggered conversions) or immediately after initiating (hardware or software triggered conversions) the ADC conversion. — For software triggered conversions, immediately follow the write to ADCSC1 with a wait instruction or stop instruction. — For stop3 mode operation, select ADACK as the clock source. Operation in stop3 reduces VDD noise but increases effective conversion time due to stop recovery. • There is no I/O switching, input or output, on the MCU during the conversion. There are some situations where external system activity causes radiated or conducted noise emissions or excessive VDD noise is coupled into the ADC. In these situations, or when the MCU cannot be placed in wait or stop3 or I/O activity cannot be halted, these recommended actions may reduce the effect of noise on the accuracy: • Place a 0.01 μF capacitor (CAS) on the selected input channel to VREFL or VSSAD (this improves noise issues, but affects the sample rate based on the external analog source resistance). • Average the result by converting the analog input many times in succession and dividing the sum of the results. Four samples are required to eliminate the effect of a 1LSB, one-time error. • Reduce the effect of synchronous noise by operating off the asynchronous clock (ADACK) and averaging. Noise that is synchronous to ADCK cannot be averaged out.
10.6.2.4
Code Width and Quantization Error
The ADC quantizes the ideal straight-line transfer function into 4096 steps (in 12-bit mode). Each step ideally has the same height (1 code) and width. The width is defined as the delta between the transition points to one code and the next. The ideal code width for an N bit converter (in this case N can be 8, 10 or 12), defined as 1LSB, is:
1 lsb = (VREFH - VREFL) / 2N Eqn. 10-2
There is an inherent quantization error due to the digitization of the result. For 8-bit or 10-bit conversions the code transitions when the voltage is at the midpoint between the points where the straight line transfer function is exactly represented by the actual transfer function. Therefore, the quantization error will be ± 1/2 lsb in 8- or 10-bit mode. As a consequence, however, the code width of the first (0x000) conversion is only 1/2 lsb and the code width of the last (0xFF or 0x3FF) is 1.5 lsb.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 231
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC12V1)
For 12-bit conversions the code transitions only after the full code width is present, so the quantization error is −1 lsb to 0 lsb and the code width of each step is 1 lsb.
10.6.2.5
Linearity Errors
The ADC may also exhibit non-linearity of several forms. Every effort has been made to reduce these errors but the system should be aware of them because they affect overall accuracy. These errors are: • Zero-scale error (EZS) (sometimes called offset) — This error is defined as the difference between the actual code width of the first conversion and the ideal code width (1/2 lsb in 8-bit or 10-bit modes and 1 lsb in 12-bit mode). If the first conversion is 0x001, the difference between the actual 0x001 code width and its ideal (1 lsb) is used. • Full-scale error (EFS) — This error is defined as the difference between the actual code width of the last conversion and the ideal code width (1.5 lsb in 8-bit or 10-bit modes and 1LSB in 12-bit mode). If the last conversion is 0x3FE, the difference between the actual 0x3FE code width and its ideal (1LSB) is used. • Differential non-linearity (DNL) — This error is defined as the worst-case difference between the actual code width and the ideal code width for all conversions. • Integral non-linearity (INL) — This error is defined as the highest-value the (absolute value of the) running sum of DNL achieves. More simply, this is the worst-case difference of the actual transition voltage to a given code and its corresponding ideal transition voltage, for all codes. • Total unadjusted error (TUE) — This error is defined as the difference between the actual transfer function and the ideal straight-line transfer function and includes all forms of error.
10.6.2.6
Code Jitter, Non-Monotonicity, and Missing Codes
Analog-to-digital converters are susceptible to three special forms of error. These are code jitter, non-monotonicity, and missing codes. Code jitter is when, at certain points, a given input voltage converts to one of two values when sampled repeatedly. Ideally, when the input voltage is infinitesimally smaller than the transition voltage, the converter yields the lower code (and vice-versa). However, even small amounts of system noise can cause the converter to be indeterminate (between two codes) for a range of input voltages around the transition voltage. This range is normally around 1/2lsb in 8-bit or 10-bit mode, or around 2 lsb in 12-bit mode, and increases with noise. This error may be reduced by repeatedly sampling the input and averaging the result. Additionally the techniques discussed in Section 10.6.2.3 reduces this error. Non-monotonicity is defined as when, except for code jitter, the converter converts to a lower code for a higher input voltage. Missing codes are those values never converted for any input value. In 8-bit or 10-bit mode, the ADC is guaranteed to be monotonic and have no missing codes.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 232 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 11 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV2)
11.1 Introduction
The inter-integrated circuit (IIC) provides a method of communication between a number of devices. The interface is designed to operate up to 100 kbps with maximum bus loading and timing. The device is capable of operating at higher baud rates, up to a maximum of clock/20, with reduced bus loading. The maximum communication length and the number of devices that can be connected are limited by a maximum bus capacitance of 400 pF. All MC9S08DZ128 Series MCUs in the 100-pin package have two IICs; devices in the 64-pin and 48-pin packages have one IIC. NOTE MC9S08DZ128 Series devices operate at a higher voltage range (2.7 V to 5.5 V) and do not include stop1 mode. Please ignore references to stop1.
11.1.1
IIC1 Configuration Information
The IIC1 module pins, SDA1 and SCL1 can be repositioned under software control using IIC1PS in SOPT1 as shown in Table 11-1. IIC1PS in SOPT1 selects which general-purpose I/O ports are associated with the IIC1 operation.
Table 11-1. IIC1 Position Options
IIC1PS in SOPT1 0 (default) 1 Port Pin for SCL1 PTF2 PTE4 Port Pin for SDA1 PTF3 PTE5
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 233
Chapter 11 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV2) PTA7/PIA7/ADP7/IRQ PTA6/PIA6/ADP6 PTA5/PIA5/ADP5 PTA4/PIA4/ADP4 PTA3/PIA3/ADP3/ACMP1O PTA2/PIA2/ADP2/ACMP1PTA1/PIA1/ADP1/ACMP1+ PTA0/PIA0/ADP0/MCLK PTB7/PIB7/ADP15 PTB6/PIB6/ADP14 PTB5/PIB5/ADP13 PTB4/PIB4/ADP12 PTB3/PIB3/ADP11 PTB2/PIB2/ADP10 PTB1/PIB1/ADP9 PTB0/PIB0/ADP8
● ● ● ● ● ● ● ●
HCS08 CORE CPU BKGD/MS BDC BKP DEBUG MODULE (DBG) ANALOG COMPARATOR (ACMP1) ACMP1O ACMP1ACMP1+ PORT A 8 24-CHANNEL,12-BIT ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER (ADC) USER MEMORY FLASH _EEPROM _RAM MC9S08DZ128 = 128K_2K_8K MC9S08DZ96 = 96K_2K_6K MC9S08DV128 = 128K_0K_6K MC9S08DV96 = 96K_0K_4K PTJ7/PIJ7/TPM3CLK PTJ6/PIJ6 PTJ5/PIJ5 PTJ4/PIJ4 PTJ3/PIJ3/TMP3CH3 PTJ2/PIJ2/TPM3CH2 PTJ1/PIJ1/TPM3CH1 PTJ0/PIJ0/TMP3CH0 PTK7 PTK6 PTK5 PTK4 PTK3 PTK2 PTK1 PTK0 PTL7 PTL6 PTL5 PTL4 PTL3 PTL2 PTL1 PTL0 PTH7 PTH6 PTH5 PTH4 PTH3/MISO2 PTH2/MOSI2 PTH1/SPSCK2 PTH0/SS2 TPM3CLK PORT J TPM3CH0 TPM3CH3 6-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM1) 2-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM2) 4-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM3) CONTROLLER AREA NETWORK (MSCAN) PORT K SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE (SPI1) SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE (SCI1) ANALOG COMPARATOR (ACMP2) IIC MODULE (IIC1) SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE (SCI2) IIC MODULE (IIC2) PORT H MISO2 MOSI2 SPSCK2 SS2 RxCAN TXCAN MISO1 MOSI1 SPSCK1 SS1 RxD1 TxD1 ACMP2O ACMP2ACMP2+ SDA1 TPM1CH5 TPM1CH0 6 TPM1CLK TPM2CH1, TPM2CH0 TPM2CLK ADP7-ADP0 ADP15-ADP8 ADP23-ADP16 PORT C PORT B
RESET
HCS08 SYSTEM CONTROL RESETS AND INTERRUPTS MODES OF OPERATION POWER MANAGEMENT IRQ COP INT LVD IRQ VOLTAGE REGULATOR
REAL-TIME COUNTER (RTC)
VDD VSS VREFH VREFL VDDA VSSA
PTC7/ADP23 PTC6/ADP22 PTC5/ADP21 PTC4/ADP20 PTC3/ADP19 PTC2/ADP18 PTC1/ADP17 PTC0/ADP16 PTD7/PID7/TPM1CH5 PTD6/PID6/TPM1CH4 PTD5/PID5/TPM1CH3 PTD4/PID4/TPM1CH2 PTD3/PID3/TPM1CH1 PTD2/PID2/TPM1CH0 PTD1/PID1/TPM2CH1 PTD0/PID0/TPM2CH0 PTE7/RxD2/RXCAN PTE6/TxD2/TXCAN PTE5/SDA1/MISO1 PTE4/SCL1/MOSI1 PTE3/SPSCK1 PTE2/SS1 PTE1/RxD1 PTE0/TxD1
4
PORT E
●
●
PORT D
SCL1
RxD2 TxD2
PTF7 PTF6/ACMP2O PTF5/ACMP2PTF4/ACMP2+ PTF3/TPM2CLK/SDA1 PTF2/TPM1CLK/SCL1 PTF1/RxD2 PTF0/TxD2 PTG7/SDA2 PTG6/SCL2 PTG5 PTG4 PTG3 PTG2 PTG1/XTAL PTG0/EXTAL
PORT L
SDA2 SCL2
MULTI-PURPOSE CLOCK GENERATOR (MCG) OSCILLATOR (XOSC) XTAL EXTAL PORT G
● ● ● ●
SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE (SPI2)
- Pin not connected in 64-pin and 48-pin packages ● - Pin not available in the 48-pin package - In 48-pin package, VDDA and VREFH are internally connected to each other and VSSA and VREFL are internally connected to each other.
Figure 11-1. MC9S08DZ128 Block Diagram with IIC Highlighted
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 234 Freescale Semiconductor
PORT F
Chapter 11 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV2)
11.1.2
Features
The IIC includes these distinctive features: • Compatible with IIC bus standard • Multi-master operation • Software programmable for one of 64 different serial clock frequencies • Software selectable acknowledge bit • Interrupt driven byte-by-byte data transfer • Arbitration lost interrupt with automatic mode switching from master to slave • Calling address identification interrupt • Start and stop signal generation/detection • Repeated start signal generation • Acknowledge bit generation/detection • Bus busy detection • General call recognition • 10-bit address extension
11.1.3
Modes of Operation
A brief description of the IIC in the various MCU modes is given here. • Run mode — This is the basic mode of operation. To conserve power in this mode, disable the module. • Wait mode — The module continues to operate while the MCU is in wait mode and can provide a wake-up interrupt. • Stop mode — The IIC is inactive in stop3 mode for reduced power consumption. The stop instruction does not affect IIC register states. Stop2 resets the register contents.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 235
Chapter 11 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV2)
11.1.4
Block Diagram
Address Interrupt ADDR_DECODE DATA_MUX Data Bus
Figure 11-2 is a block diagram of the IIC.
CTRL_REG
FREQ_REG
ADDR_REG
STATUS_REG
DATA_REG
Input Sync Start Stop Arbitration Control Clock Control In/Out Data Shift Register
Address Compare
SCL
SDA
Figure 11-2. IIC Functional Block Diagram
11.2
External Signal Description
This section describes each user-accessible pin signal.
11.2.1
SCL — Serial Clock Line
The bidirectional SCL is the serial clock line of the IIC system.
11.2.2
SDA — Serial Data Line
The bidirectional SDA is the serial data line of the IIC system.
11.3
Register Definition
This section consists of the IIC register descriptions in address order.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 236 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 11 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV2)
Refer to the direct-page register summary in the memory chapter of this document for the absolute address assignments for all IIC registers. This section refers to registers and control bits only by their names. A Freescale-provided equate or header file is used to translate these names into the appropriate absolute addresses.
11.3.1
IIC Address Register (IICxA)
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R AD7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 AD1
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 11-3. IIC Address Register (IICxA) Table 11-2. IICxA Field Descriptions
Field 7–1 AD[7:1] Description Slave Address. The AD[7:1] field contains the slave address to be used by the IIC module. This field is used on the 7-bit address scheme and the lower seven bits of the 10-bit address scheme.
11.3.2
IIC Frequency Divider Register (IICxF)
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R MULT W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 ICR
Figure 11-4. IIC Frequency Divider Register (IICxF)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 237
Chapter 11 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV2)
Table 11-3. IICxF Field Descriptions
Field 7–6 MULT Description IIC Multiplier Factor. The MULT bits define the multiplier factor, mul. This factor, along with the SCL divider, generates the IIC baud rate. The multiplier factor mul as defined by the MULT bits is provided below. 00 mul = 01 01 mul = 02 10 mul = 04 11 Reserved IIC Clock Rate. The ICR bits are used to prescale the bus clock for bit rate selection. These bits and the MULT bits determine the IIC baud rate, the SDA hold time, the SCL Start hold time, and the SCL Stop hold time. Table 11-5 provides the SCL divider and hold values for corresponding values of the ICR. The SCL divider multiplied by multiplier factor mul generates IIC baud rate. bus speed (Hz) IIC baud rate = -------------------------------------------mul × SCLdivider
5–0 ICR
Eqn. 11-1
SDA hold time is the delay from the falling edge of SCL (IIC clock) to the changing of SDA (IIC data). SDA hold time = bus period (s) × mul × SDA hold value
Eqn. 11-2
SCL start hold time is the delay from the falling edge of SDA (IIC data) while SCL is high (Start condition) to the falling edge of SCL (IIC clock). SCL Start hold time = bus period (s) × mul × SCL Start hold value SCL stop hold time is the delay from the rising edge of SCL (IIC clock) to the rising edge of SDA SDA (IIC data) while SCL is high (Stop condition). SCL Stop hold time = bus period (s) × mul × SCL Stop hold value
Eqn. 11-3
Eqn. 11-4
For example, if the bus speed is 8 MHz, the table below shows the possible hold time values with different ICR and MULT selections to achieve an IIC baud rate of 100kbps.
Table 11-4. Hold Time Values for 8 MHz Bus Speed
Hold Times (μs) MULT ICR SDA 0x2 0x1 0x1 0x0 0x0 0x00 0x07 0x0B 0x14 0x18 3.500 2.500 2.250 2.125 1.125 SCL Start 3.000 4.000 4.000 4.250 4.750 SCL Stop 5.500 5.250 5.250 5.125 5.125
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 238 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 11 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV2)
Table 11-5. IIC Divider and Hold Values
ICR (hex) 00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 0A 0B 0C 0D 0E 0F 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 1A 1B 1C 1D 1E 1F SCL Divider 20 22 24 26 28 30 34 40 28 32 36 40 44 48 56 68 48 56 64 72 80 88 104 128 80 96 112 128 144 160 192 240 SDA Hold Value 7 7 8 8 9 9 10 10 7 7 9 9 11 11 13 13 9 9 13 13 17 17 21 21 9 9 17 17 25 25 33 33 SCL Hold (Start) Value 6 7 8 9 10 11 13 16 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30 18 22 26 30 34 38 46 58 38 46 54 62 70 78 94 118 SDA Hold (Stop) Value 11 12 13 14 15 16 18 21 15 17 19 21 23 25 29 35 25 29 33 37 41 45 53 65 41 49 57 65 73 81 97 121 ICR (hex) 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 2A 2B 2C 2D 2E 2F 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 3A 3B 3C 3D 3E 3F SCL Divider 160 192 224 256 288 320 384 480 320 384 448 512 576 640 768 960 640 768 896 1024 1152 1280 1536 1920 1280 1536 1792 2048 2304 2560 3072 3840 SDA Hold Value 17 17 33 33 49 49 65 65 33 33 65 65 97 97 129 129 65 65 129 129 193 193 257 257 129 129 257 257 385 385 513 513 SCL Hold (Start) Value 78 94 110 126 142 158 190 238 158 190 222 254 286 318 382 478 318 382 446 510 574 638 766 958 638 766 894 1022 1150 1278 1534 1918 SCL Hold (Stop) Value 81 97 113 129 145 161 193 241 161 193 225 257 289 321 385 481 321 385 449 513 577 641 769 961 641 769 897 1025 1153 1281 1537 1921
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 239
Chapter 11 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV2)
11.3.3
IIC Control Register (IICxC1)
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R IICEN W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 IICIE MST TX TXAK
0 RSTA 0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 11-5. IIC Control Register (IICxC1) Table 11-6. IICxC1 Field Descriptions
Field 7 IICEN 6 IICIE 5 MST Description IIC Enable. The IICEN bit determines whether the IIC module is enabled. 0 IIC is not enabled 1 IIC is enabled IIC Interrupt Enable. The IICIE bit determines whether an IIC interrupt is requested. 0 IIC interrupt request not enabled 1 IIC interrupt request enabled Master Mode Select. The MST bit changes from a 0 to a 1 when a start signal is generated on the bus and master mode is selected. When this bit changes from a 1 to a 0 a stop signal is generated and the mode of operation changes from master to slave. 0 Slave mode 1 Master mode Transmit Mode Select. The TX bit selects the direction of master and slave transfers. In master mode, this bit should be set according to the type of transfer required. Therefore, for address cycles, this bit is always high. When addressed as a slave, this bit should be set by software according to the SRW bit in the status register. 0 Receive 1 Transmit Transmit Acknowledge Enable. This bit specifies the value driven onto the SDA during data acknowledge cycles for master and slave receivers. 0 An acknowledge signal is sent out to the bus after receiving one data byte 1 No acknowledge signal response is sent Repeat start. Writing a 1 to this bit generates a repeated start condition provided it is the current master. This bit is always read as cleared. Attempting a repeat at the wrong time results in loss of arbitration.
4 TX
3 TXAK
2 RSTA
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 240 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 11 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV2)
11.3.4
IIC Status Register (IICxS)
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
TCF IAAS 1 0
BUSY ARBL 0 0
0
SRW IICIF
RXAK
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 11-6. IIC Status Register (IICxS) Table 11-7. IICxS Field Descriptions
Field 7 TCF Description Transfer Complete Flag. This bit is set on the completion of a byte transfer. This bit is only valid during or immediately following a transfer to the IIC module or from the IIC module.The TCF bit is cleared by reading the IICxD register in receive mode or writing to the IICxD in transmit mode. 0 Transfer in progress 1 Transfer complete Addressed as a Slave. The IAAS bit is set when the calling address matches the programmed slave address or when the GCAEN bit is set and a general call is received. Writing the IICxC register clears this bit. 0 Not addressed 1 Addressed as a slave Bus Busy. The BUSY bit indicates the status of the bus regardless of slave or master mode. The BUSY bit is set when a start signal is detected and cleared when a stop signal is detected. 0 Bus is idle 1 Bus is busy Arbitration Lost. This bit is set by hardware when the arbitration procedure is lost. The ARBL bit must be cleared by software by writing a 1 to it. 0 Standard bus operation 1 Loss of arbitration Slave Read/Write. When addressed as a slave, the SRW bit indicates the value of the R/W command bit of the calling address sent to the master. 0 Slave receive, master writing to slave 1 Slave transmit, master reading from slave IIC Interrupt Flag. The IICIF bit is set when an interrupt is pending. This bit must be cleared by software, by writing a 1 to it in the interrupt routine. One of the following events can set the IICIF bit: • One byte transfer completes • Match of slave address to calling address • Arbitration lost 0 No interrupt pending 1 Interrupt pending Receive Acknowledge. When the RXAK bit is low, it indicates an acknowledge signal has been received after the completion of one byte of data transmission on the bus. If the RXAK bit is high it means that no acknowledge signal is detected. 0 Acknowledge received 1 No acknowledge received
6 IAAS
5 BUSY
4 ARBL
2 SRW
1 IICIF
0 RXAK
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 241
Chapter 11 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV2)
11.3.5
IIC Data I/O Register (IICxD)
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R DATA W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Figure 11-7. IIC Data I/O Register (IICxD) Table 11-8. IICxD Field Descriptions
Field 7–0 DATA Description Data — In master transmit mode, when data is written to the IICxD, a data transfer is initiated. The most significant bit is sent first. In master receive mode, reading this register initiates receiving of the next byte of data.
NOTE When transitioning out of master receive mode, the IIC mode should be switched before reading the IICxD register to prevent an inadvertent initiation of a master receive data transfer. In slave mode, the same functions are available after an address match has occurred. The TX bit in IICxC must correctly reflect the desired direction of transfer in master and slave modes for the transmission to begin. For instance, if the IIC is configured for master transmit but a master receive is desired, reading the IICxD does not initiate the receive. Reading the IICxD returns the last byte received while the IIC is configured in master receive or slave receive modes. The IICxD does not reflect every byte transmitted on the IIC bus, nor can software verify that a byte has been written to the IICxD correctly by reading it back. In master transmit mode, the first byte of data written to IICxD following assertion of MST is used for the address transfer and should comprise of the calling address (in bit 7 to bit 1) concatenated with the required R/W bit (in position bit 0).
11.3.6
IIC Control Register 2 (IICxC2)
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R GCAEN W Reset 0 0 ADEXT
0
0
0 AD10 AD9 0 AD8 0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved Figure 11-8. IIC Control Register (IICxC2)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 242 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 11 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV2)
Table 11-9. IICxC2 Field Descriptions
Field 7 GCAEN 6 ADEXT 2–0 AD[10:8] Description General Call Address Enable. The GCAEN bit enables or disables general call address. 0 General call address is disabled 1 General call address is enabled Address Extension. The ADEXT bit controls the number of bits used for the slave address. 0 7-bit address scheme 1 10-bit address scheme Slave Address. The AD[10:8] field contains the upper three bits of the slave address in the 10-bit address scheme. This field is only valid when the ADEXT bit is set.
11.4
Functional Description
This section provides a complete functional description of the IIC module.
11.4.1
IIC Protocol
The IIC bus system uses a serial data line (SDA) and a serial clock line (SCL) for data transfer. All devices connected to it must have open drain or open collector outputs. A logic AND function is exercised on both lines with external pull-up resistors. The value of these resistors is system dependent. Normally, a standard communication is composed of four parts: • Start signal • Slave address transmission • Data transfer • Stop signal The stop signal should not be confused with the CPU stop instruction. The IIC bus system communication is described briefly in the following sections and illustrated in Figure 11-9.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 243
Chapter 11 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV2)
msb SCL 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
lsb 8 9
msb 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
lsb 8 9
SDA
AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 AD1 R/W
XXX
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
Start Signal
Calling Address
Read/ Ack Write Bit
Data Byte
No Ack Bit lsb
Stop Signal
msb SCL 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
lsb 8 9
msb 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
8
9
SDA
AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 AD1 R/W
XX
AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 AD1 R/W
Start Signal
Calling Address
Read/ Ack Write Bit
Repeated Start Signal
New Calling Address
Read/ Write
No Ack Bit
Stop Signal
Figure 11-9. IIC Bus Transmission Signals
11.4.1.1
Start Signal
When the bus is free, no master device is engaging the bus (SCL and SDA lines are at logical high), a master may initiate communication by sending a start signal. As shown in Figure 11-9, a start signal is defined as a high-to-low transition of SDA while SCL is high. This signal denotes the beginning of a new data transfer (each data transfer may contain several bytes of data) and brings all slaves out of their idle states.
11.4.1.2
Slave Address Transmission
The first byte of data transferred immediately after the start signal is the slave address transmitted by the master. This is a seven-bit calling address followed by a R/W bit. The R/W bit tells the slave the desired direction of data transfer. 1 = Read transfer, the slave transmits data to the master. 0 = Write transfer, the master transmits data to the slave. Only the slave with a calling address that matches the one transmitted by the master responds by sending back an acknowledge bit. This is done by pulling the SDA low at the ninth clock (see Figure 11-9). No two slaves in the system may have the same address. If the IIC module is the master, it must not transmit an address equal to its own slave address. The IIC cannot be master and slave at the same time. However, if arbitration is lost during an address cycle, the IIC reverts to slave mode and operates correctly even if it is being addressed by another master.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 244 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 11 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV2)
11.4.1.3
Data Transfer
Before successful slave addressing is achieved, the data transfer can proceed byte-by-byte in a direction specified by the R/W bit sent by the calling master. All transfers that come after an address cycle are referred to as data transfers, even if they carry sub-address information for the slave device Each data byte is 8 bits long. Data may be changed only while SCL is low and must be held stable while SCL is high as shown in Figure 11-9. There is one clock pulse on SCL for each data bit, the msb being transferred first. Each data byte is followed by a 9th (acknowledge) bit, which is signalled from the receiving device. An acknowledge is signalled by pulling the SDA low at the ninth clock. In summary, one complete data transfer needs nine clock pulses. If the slave receiver does not acknowledge the master in the ninth bit time, the SDA line must be left high by the slave. The master interprets the failed acknowledge as an unsuccessful data transfer. If the master receiver does not acknowledge the slave transmitter after a data byte transmission, the slave interprets this as an end of data transfer and releases the SDA line. In either case, the data transfer is aborted and the master does one of two things: • Relinquishes the bus by generating a stop signal. • Commences a new calling by generating a repeated start signal.
11.4.1.4
Stop Signal
The master can terminate the communication by generating a stop signal to free the bus. However, the master may generate a start signal followed by a calling command without generating a stop signal first. This is called repeated start. A stop signal is defined as a low-to-high transition of SDA while SCL at logical 1 (see Figure 11-9). The master can generate a stop even if the slave has generated an acknowledge at which point the slave must release the bus.
11.4.1.5
Repeated Start Signal
As shown in Figure 11-9, a repeated start signal is a start signal generated without first generating a stop signal to terminate the communication. This is used by the master to communicate with another slave or with the same slave in different mode (transmit/receive mode) without releasing the bus.
11.4.1.6
Arbitration Procedure
The IIC bus is a true multi-master bus that allows more than one master to be connected on it. If two or more masters try to control the bus at the same time, a clock synchronization procedure determines the bus clock, for which the low period is equal to the longest clock low period and the high is equal to the shortest one among the masters. The relative priority of the contending masters is determined by a data arbitration procedure, a bus master loses arbitration if it transmits logic 1 while another master transmits logic 0. The losing masters immediately switch over to slave receive mode and stop driving SDA output. In this case,
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 245
Chapter 11 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV2)
the transition from master to slave mode does not generate a stop condition. Meanwhile, a status bit is set by hardware to indicate loss of arbitration.
11.4.1.7
Clock Synchronization
Because wire-AND logic is performed on the SCL line, a high-to-low transition on the SCL line affects all the devices connected on the bus. The devices start counting their low period and after a device’s clock has gone low, it holds the SCL line low until the clock high state is reached. However, the change of low to high in this device clock may not change the state of the SCL line if another device clock is still within its low period. Therefore, synchronized clock SCL is held low by the device with the longest low period. Devices with shorter low periods enter a high wait state during this time (see Figure 11-10). When all devices concerned have counted off their low period, the synchronized clock SCL line is released and pulled high. There is then no difference between the device clocks and the state of the SCL line and all the devices start counting their high periods. The first device to complete its high period pulls the SCL line low again.
Delay SCL1 Start Counting High Period
SCL2
SCL
Internal Counter Reset
Figure 11-10. IIC Clock Synchronization
11.4.1.8
Handshaking
The clock synchronization mechanism can be used as a handshake in data transfer. Slave devices may hold the SCL low after completion of one byte transfer (9 bits). In such a case, it halts the bus clock and forces the master clock into wait states until the slave releases the SCL line.
11.4.1.9
Clock Stretching
The clock synchronization mechanism can be used by slaves to slow down the bit rate of a transfer. After the master has driven SCL low the slave can drive SCL low for the required period and then release it. If the slave SCL low period is greater than the master SCL low period then the resulting SCL bus signal low period is stretched.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 246 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 11 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV2)
11.4.2
10-bit Address
For 10-bit addressing, 0x11110 is used for the first 5 bits of the first address byte. Various combinations of read/write formats are possible within a transfer that includes 10-bit addressing.
11.4.2.1
Master-Transmitter Addresses a Slave-Receiver
The transfer direction is not changed (see Table 11-10). When a 10-bit address follows a start condition, each slave compares the first seven bits of the first byte of the slave address (11110XX) with its own address and tests whether the eighth bit (R/W direction bit) is 0. More than one device can find a match and generate an acknowledge (A1). Then, each slave that finds a match compares the eight bits of the second byte of the slave address with its own address. Only one slave finds a match and generates an acknowledge (A2). The matching slave remains addressed by the master until it receives a stop condition (P) or a repeated start condition (Sr) followed by a different slave address.
S Slave Address 1st 7 bits 11110 + AD10 + AD9 R/W 0 A1 Slave Address 2nd byte AD[8:1] A2 Data A ... Data A/A P
Table 11-10. Master-Transmitter Addresses Slave-Receiver with a 10-bit Address
After the master-transmitter has sent the first byte of the 10-bit address, the slave-receiver sees an IIC interrupt. Software must ensure the contents of IICD are ignored and not treated as valid data for this interrupt.
11.4.2.2
Master-Receiver Addresses a Slave-Transmitter
The transfer direction is changed after the second R/W bit (see Table 11-11). Up to and including acknowledge bit A2, the procedure is the same as that described for a master-transmitter addressing a slave-receiver. After the repeated start condition (Sr), a matching slave remembers that it was addressed before. This slave then checks whether the first seven bits of the first byte of the slave address following Sr are the same as they were after the start condition (S) and tests whether the eighth (R/W) bit is 1. If there is a match, the slave considers that it has been addressed as a transmitter and generates acknowledge A3. The slave-transmitter remains addressed until it receives a stop condition (P) or a repeated start condition (Sr) followed by a different slave address. After a repeated start condition (Sr), all other slave devices also compare the first seven bits of the first byte of the slave address with their own addresses and test the eighth (R/W) bit. However, none of them are addressed because R/W = 1 (for 10-bit devices) or the 11110XX slave address (for 7-bit devices) does not match.
S Slave Address 1st 7 bits 11110 + AD10 + AD9 R/W 0 A1 Slave Address 2nd byte AD[8:1] A2 Sr Slave Address 1st 7 bits 11110 + AD10 + AD9 R/W 1 A3 Data A ... Data A P
Table 11-11. Master-Receiver Addresses a Slave-Transmitter with a 10-bit Address
After the master-receiver has sent the first byte of the 10-bit address, the slave-transmitter sees an IIC interrupt. Software must ensure the contents of IICD are ignored and not treated as valid data for this interrupt.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 247
Chapter 11 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV2)
11.4.3
General Call Address
General calls can be requested in 7-bit address or 10-bit address. If the GCAEN bit is set, the IIC matches the general call address as well as its own slave address. When the IIC responds to a general call, it acts as a slave-receiver and the IAAS bit is set after the address cycle. Software must read the IICD register after the first byte transfer to determine whether the address matches is its own slave address or a general call. If the value is 00, the match is a general call. If the GCAEN bit is clear, the IIC ignores any data supplied from a general call address by not issuing an acknowledgement.
11.5
Resets
The IIC is disabled after reset. The IIC cannot cause an MCU reset.
11.6
Interrupts
The IIC generates a single interrupt. An interrupt from the IIC is generated when any of the events in Table 11-12 occur, provided the IICIE bit is set. The interrupt is driven by bit IICIF (of the IIC status register) and masked with bit IICIE (of the IIC control register). The IICIF bit must be cleared by software by writing a 1 to it in the interrupt routine. You can determine the interrupt type by reading the status register.
Table 11-12. Interrupt Summary
Interrupt Source Complete 1-byte transfer Match of received calling address Arbitration Lost Status TCF IAAS ARBL Flag IICIF IICIF IICIF Local Enable IICIE IICIE IICIE
11.6.1
Byte Transfer Interrupt
The TCF (transfer complete flag) bit is set at the falling edge of the ninth clock to indicate the completion of byte transfer.
11.6.2
Address Detect Interrupt
When the calling address matches the programmed slave address (IIC address register) or when the GCAEN bit is set and a general call is received, the IAAS bit in the status register is set. The CPU is interrupted, provided the IICIE is set. The CPU must check the SRW bit and set its Tx mode accordingly.
11.6.3
Arbitration Lost Interrupt
The IIC is a true multi-master bus that allows more than one master to be connected on it. If two or more masters try to control the bus at the same time, the relative priority of the contending masters is determined by a data arbitration procedure. The IIC module asserts this interrupt when it loses the data arbitration process and the ARBL bit in the status register is set.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 248 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 11 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV2)
Arbitration is lost in the following circumstances: • SDA sampled as a low when the master drives a high during an address or data transmit cycle. • SDA sampled as a low when the master drives a high during the acknowledge bit of a data receive cycle. • A start cycle is attempted when the bus is busy. • A repeated start cycle is requested in slave mode. • A stop condition is detected when the master did not request it. This bit must be cleared by software writing a 1 to it.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 249
Chapter 11 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV2)
11.7
1.
Initialization/Application Information
Module Initialization (Slave) Write: IICC2 — to enable or disable general call — to select 10-bit or 7-bit addressing mode Write: IICA — to set the slave address Write: IICC1 — to enable IIC and interrupts Initialize RAM variables (IICEN = 1 and IICIE = 1) for transmit data Initialize RAM variables used to achieve the routine shown in Figure 11-12
2. 3. 4. 5.
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.
Module Initialization (Master) Write: IICF — to set the IIC baud rate (example provided in this chapter) Write: IICC1 — to enable IIC and interrupts Initialize RAM variables (IICEN = 1 and IICIE = 1) for transmit data Initialize RAM variables used to achieve the routine shown in Figure 11-12 Write: IICC1 — to enable TX Write: IICC1 — to enable MST (master mode) Write: IICD — with the address of the target slave. (The lsb of this byte determines whether the communication is master receive or transmit.) Module Use The routine shown in Figure 11-12 can handle both master and slave IIC operations. For slave operation, an incoming IIC message that contains the proper address begins IIC communication. For master operation, communication must be initiated by writing to the IICD register.
Register Model IICA MULT AD[7:1] 0
When addressed as a slave (in slave mode), the module responds to this address IICF ICR Baud rate = BUSCLK / (2 x MULT x (SCL DIVIDER)) IICC1 IICS IICD IICEN TCF IICIE IAAS MST BUSY TX ARBL DATA Data register; Write to transmit IIC data read to read IIC data IICC2 GCAEN ADEXT Address configuration 0 0 0 AD10 AD9 AD8 TXAK 0 RSTA SRW 0 IICIF 0 RXAK
Module configuration Module status flags
Figure 11-11. IIC Module Quick Start
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 250 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 11 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV2)
Clear IICIF
Y
Master Mode ?
N
TX
Tx/Rx ?
RX
Y
Arbitration Lost ? N
Last Byte Transmitted ? N
Y
Clear ARBL
RXAK=0 ? Y
N
Last Byte to Be Read ? N
N Y
IAAS=1 ? Y
Y
IAAS=1 ? N Data Transfer See Note 2 TX/RX ? TX RX
Address Transfer See Note 1 Y End of Addr Cycle (Master Rx) ? N Y 2nd Last Byte to Be Read ? N Y (Read) SRW=1 ? N (Write)
Write Next Byte to IICD
Set TXACK =1
Generate Stop Signal (MST = 0)
Set TX Mode
Y
ACK from Receiver ? N Read Data from IICD and Store
Write Data to IICD
Tx Next Byte
Switch to Rx Mode
Set RX Mode
Switch to Rx Mode
Dummy Read from IICD
Generate Stop Signal (MST = 0)
Read Data from IICD and Store
Dummy Read from IICD
Dummy Read from IICD
RTI NOTES: 1. If general call is enabled, a check must be done to determine whether the received address was a general call address (0x00). If the received address was a general call address, then the general call must be handled by user software. 2. When 10-bit addressing is used to address a slave, the slave sees an interrupt following the first byte of the extended address. User software must ensure that for this interrupt, the contents of IICD are ignored and not treated as a valid data transfer
Figure 11-12. Typical IIC Interrupt Routine
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 251
Chapter 11 Inter-Integrated Circuit (S08IICV2)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 252 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
12.1 Introduction
Freescale’s controller area network (MSCAN) is a communication controller implementing the CAN 2.0A/B protocol as defined in the Bosch specification dated September 1991. To fully understand the MSCAN specification, it is recommended that the Bosch specification be read first to gain familiarity with the terms and concepts contained within this document. Though not exclusively intended for automotive applications, CAN protocol is designed to meet the specific requirements of a vehicle serial data bus: real-time processing, reliable operation in the EMI environment of a vehicle, cost-effectiveness, and required bandwidth. MSCAN uses an advanced buffer arrangement resulting in predictable real-time behavior and simplified application software. The MSCAN module is available in all devices in the MC9S08DZ128 Series.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 253
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
HCS08 CORE CPU BKGD/MS BDC BKP DEBUG MODULE (DBG) ANALOG COMPARATOR (ACMP1) ACMP1O ACMP1ACMP1+ PORT A
RESET
HCS08 SYSTEM CONTROL RESETS AND INTERRUPTS MODES OF OPERATION POWER MANAGEMENT IRQ COP INT LVD IRQ VOLTAGE REGULATOR
PTA7/PIA7/ADP7/IRQ PTA6/PIA6/ADP6 PTA5/PIA5/ADP5 PTA4/PIA4/ADP4 PTA3/PIA3/ADP3/ACMP1O PTA2/PIA2/ADP2/ACMP1PTA1/PIA1/ADP1/ACMP1+ PTA0/PIA0/ADP0/MCLK PTB7/PIB7/ADP15 PTB6/PIB6/ADP14 PTB5/PIB5/ADP13 PTB4/PIB4/ADP12 PTB3/PIB3/ADP11 PTB2/PIB2/ADP10 PTB1/PIB1/ADP9 PTB0/PIB0/ADP8
● ● ● ● ● ● ● ●
REAL-TIME COUNTER (RTC)
VDD VSS VREFH VREFL VDDA VSSA
8 24-CHANNEL,12-BIT ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER (ADC) ADP7-ADP0 ADP15-ADP8 ADP23-ADP16
PORT B
USER MEMORY FLASH _EEPROM _RAM MC9S08DZ128 = 128K_2K_8K MC9S08DZ96 = 96K_2K_6K MC9S08DV128 = 128K_0K_6K MC9S08DV96 = 96K_0K_4K PTJ7/PIJ7/TPM3CLK PTJ6/PIJ6 PTJ5/PIJ5 PTJ4/PIJ4 PTJ3/PIJ3/TMP3CH3 PTJ2/PIJ2/TPM3CH2 PTJ1/PIJ1/TPM3CH1 PTJ0/PIJ0/TMP3CH0 PTK7 PTK6 PTK5 PTK4 PTK3 PTK2 PTK1 PTK0 PTL7 PTL6 PTL5 PTL4 PTL3 PTL2 PTL1 PTL0 PTH7 PTH6 PTH5 PTH4 PTH3/MISO2 PTH2/MOSI2 PTH1/SPSCK2 PTH0/SS2 TPM3CLK PORT J TPM3CH0 TPM3CH3 6-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM1) 2-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM2) 4-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM3) CONTROLLER AREA NETWORK (MSCAN) PORT K SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE (SPI1) SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE (SCI1) ANALOG COMPARATOR (ACMP2) IIC MODULE (IIC1) SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE (SCI2) IIC MODULE (IIC2) PORT H MISO2 MOSI2 SPSCK2 SS2 RxCAN TXCAN MISO1 MOSI1 SPSCK1 SS1 RxD1 TxD1 ACMP2O ACMP2ACMP2+ SDA1 SCL1 RxD2 TxD2 SDA2 SCL2 MULTI-PURPOSE CLOCK GENERATOR (MCG) OSCILLATOR (XOSC) XTAL EXTAL TPM1CH5 TPM1CH0 6 TPM1CLK TPM2CH1, TPM2CH0 TPM2CLK
PTC7/ADP23 PTC6/ADP22 PTC5/ADP21 PTC4/ADP20 PTC3/ADP19 PTC2/ADP18 PTC1/ADP17 PTC0/ADP16 PTD7/PID7/TPM1CH5 PTD6/PID6/TPM1CH4 PTD5/PID5/TPM1CH3 PTD4/PID4/TPM1CH2 PTD3/PID3/TPM1CH1 PTD2/PID2/TPM1CH0 PTD1/PID1/TPM2CH1 PTD0/PID0/TPM2CH0 PTE7/RxD2/RXCAN PTE6/TxD2/TXCAN PTE5/SDA1/MISO1 PTE4/SCL1/MOSI1 PTE3/SPSCK1 PTE2/SS1 PTE1/RxD1 PTE0/TxD1
4
PORT E
●
●
PORT D
PORT C
PTF7 PTF6/ACMP2O PTF5/ACMP2PTF4/ACMP2+ PTF3/TPM2CLK/SDA1 PTF2/TPM1CLK/SCL1 PTF1/RxD2 PTF0/TxD2 PTG7/SDA2 PTG6/SCL2 PTG5 PTG4 PTG3 PTG2 PTG1/XTAL PTG0/EXTAL
PORT L
PORT F PORT G
● ● ● ●
SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE (SPI2)
- Pin not connected in 64-pin and 48-pin packages ● - Pin not available in the 48-pin package - In 48-pin package, VDDA and VREFH are internally connected to each other and VSSA and VREFL are internally connected to each other.
Figure 12-1. MC9S08DZ128 Block Diagram with MSCAN Highlighted
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 254 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
12.1.1
Features
The basic features of the MSCAN are as follows: • Implementation of the CAN protocol — Version 2.0A/B — Standard and extended data frames — Zero to eight bytes data length — Programmable bit rate up to 1 Mbps1 — Support for remote frames • Five receive buffers with FIFO storage scheme • Three transmit buffers with internal prioritization using a “local priority” concept • Flexible maskable identifier filter supports two full-size (32-bit) extended identifier filters, or four 16-bit filters, or eight 8-bit filters • Programmable wakeup functionality with integrated low-pass filter • Programmable loopback mode supports self-test operation • Programmable listen-only mode for monitoring of CAN bus • Programmable bus-off recovery functionality • Separate signalling and interrupt capabilities for all CAN receiver and transmitter error states (warning, error passive, bus-off) • Programmable MSCAN clock source either bus clock or oscillator clock • Internal timer for time-stamping of received and transmitted messages • Three low-power modes: sleep, power down, and MSCAN enable • Global initialization of configuration registers
12.1.2
Modes of Operation
The following modes of operation are specific to the MSCAN. See Section 12.5, “Functional Description,” for details. • Listen-Only Mode • MSCAN Sleep Mode • MSCAN Initialization Mode • MSCAN Power Down Mode • Loopback Self Test Mode
1. Depending on the actual bit timing and the clock jitter of the PLL. MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 255
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
12.1.3
Block Diagram MSCAN
Oscillator Clock Bus Clock
CANCLK
MUX
Presc.
Tq Clk
Receive/ Transmit Engine
RXCAN TXCAN
Transmit Interrupt Req. Receive Interrupt Req. Errors Interrupt Req. Wake-Up Interrupt Req.
Control and Status
Message Filtering and Buffering
Configuration Registers
Wake-Up
Low Pass Filter
Figure 12-2. MSCAN Block Diagram
12.2
External Signal Description
The MSCAN uses two external pins:
12.2.1
RXCAN — CAN Receiver Input Pin
RXCAN is the MSCAN receiver input pin.
12.2.2
TXCAN — CAN Transmitter Output Pin
TXCAN is the MSCAN transmitter output pin. The TXCAN output pin represents the logic level on the CAN bus: 0 = Dominant state 1 = Recessive state
12.2.3
CAN System
A typical CAN system with MSCAN is shown in Figure 12-3. Each CAN node is connected physically to the CAN bus lines through a transceiver device. The transceiver is capable of driving the large current needed for the CAN bus and has current protection against defective CAN or defective nodes.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 256 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1) CAN node 1 MCU CAN Controller (MSCAN) CAN node 2 CAN node n
TXCAN
RXCAN
Transceiver CAN_H CAN_L CAN Bus
Figure 12-3. CAN System
12.3
Register Definition
This section describes in detail all the registers and register bits in the MSCAN module. Each description includes a standard register diagram with an associated figure number. Details of register bit and field function follow the register diagrams, in bit order. All bits of all registers in this module are completely synchronous to internal clocks during a register read.
12.3.1
MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0)
The CANCTL0 register provides various control bits of the MSCAN module as described below.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset:
RXFRM
RXACT CSWAI
SYNCH TIME 0 0 WUPE 0 SLPRQ 0 INITRQ 1
0
0 = Unimplemented
0
Figure 12-4. MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0)
NOTE The CANCTL0 register, except WUPE, INITRQ, and SLPRQ, is held in the reset state when the initialization mode is active (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1). This register is writable again as soon as the initialization mode is exited (INITRQ = 0 and INITAK = 0). Read: Anytime Write: Anytime when out of initialization mode; exceptions are read-only RXACT and SYNCH, RXFRM (which is set by the module only), and INITRQ (which is also writable in initialization mode).
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 257
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
Table 12-1. CANCTL0 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7 RXFRM1 Description Received Frame Flag — This bit is read and clear only. It is set when a receiver has received a valid message correctly, independently of the filter configuration. After it is set, it remains set until cleared by software or reset. Clearing is done by writing a 1. Writing a 0 is ignored. This bit is not valid in loopback mode. 0 No valid message was received since last clearing this flag 1 A valid message was received since last clearing of this flag Receiver Active Status — This read-only flag indicates the MSCAN is receiving a message. The flag is controlled by the receiver front end. This bit is not valid in loopback mode. 0 MSCAN is transmitting or idle2 1 MSCAN is receiving a message (including when arbitration is lost)2 CAN Stops in Wait Mode — Enabling this bit allows for lower power consumption in wait mode by disabling all the clocks at the CPU bus interface to the MSCAN module. 0 The module is not affected during wait mode 1 The module ceases to be clocked during wait mode Synchronized Status — This read-only flag indicates whether the MSCAN is synchronized to the CAN bus and able to participate in the communication process. It is set and cleared by the MSCAN. 0 MSCAN is not synchronized to the CAN bus 1 MSCAN is synchronized to the CAN bus Timer Enable — This bit activates an internal 16-bit wide free running timer which is clocked by the bit clock rate. If the timer is enabled, a 16-bit time stamp will be assigned to each transmitted/received message within the active TX/RX buffer. As soon as a message is acknowledged on the CAN bus, the time stamp will be written to the highest bytes (0x000E, 0x000F) in the appropriate buffer (see Section 12.4, “Programmer’s Model of Message Storage”). The internal timer is reset (all bits set to 0) when disabled. This bit is held low in initialization mode. 0 Disable internal MSCAN timer 1 Enable internal MSCAN timer Wake-Up Enable — This configuration bit allows the MSCAN to restart from sleep mode when traffic on CAN is detected (see Section 12.5.5.4, “MSCAN Sleep Mode”). This bit must be configured before sleep mode entry for the selected function to take effect. 0 Wake-up disabled — The MSCAN ignores traffic on CAN 1 Wake-up enabled — The MSCAN is able to restart
6 RXACT
5 CSWAI3
4 SYNCH
3 TIME
2 WUPE4
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 258 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
Table 12-1. CANCTL0 Register Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 1 SLPRQ5 Description Sleep Mode Request — This bit requests the MSCAN to enter sleep mode, which is an internal power saving mode (see Section 12.5.5.4, “MSCAN Sleep Mode”). The sleep mode request is serviced when the CAN bus is idle, i.e., the module is not receiving a message and all transmit buffers are empty. The module indicates entry to sleep mode by setting SLPAK = 1 (see Section 12.3.2, “MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1)”). SLPRQ cannot be set while the WUPIF flag is set (see Section 12.3.4.1, “MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG)”). Sleep mode will be active until SLPRQ is cleared by the CPU or, depending on the setting of WUPE, the MSCAN detects activity on the CAN bus and clears SLPRQ itself. 0 Running — The MSCAN functions normally 1 Sleep mode request — The MSCAN enters sleep mode when CAN bus idle Initialization Mode Request — When this bit is set by the CPU, the MSCAN skips to initialization mode (see Section 12.5.5.5, “MSCAN Initialization Mode”). Any ongoing transmission or reception is aborted and synchronization to the CAN bus is lost. The module indicates entry to initialization mode by setting INITAK = 1 (Section 12.3.2, “MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1)”). The following registers enter their hard reset state and restore their default values: CANCTL08, CANRFLG9, CANRIER10, CANTFLG, CANTIER, CANTARQ, CANTAAK, and CANTBSEL. The registers CANCTL1, CANBTR0, CANBTR1, CANIDAC, CANIDAR0-7, and CANIDMR0-7 can only be written by the CPU when the MSCAN is in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1). The values of the error counters are not affected by initialization mode. When this bit is cleared by the CPU, the MSCAN restarts and then tries to synchronize to the CAN bus. If the MSCAN is not in bus-off state, it synchronizes after 11 consecutive recessive bits on the CAN bus; if the MSCAN is in bus-off state, it continues to wait for 128 occurrences of 11 consecutive recessive bits. Writing to other bits in CANCTL0, CANRFLG, CANRIER, CANTFLG, or CANTIER must be done only after initialization mode is exited, which is INITRQ = 0 and INITAK = 0. 0 Normal operation 1 MSCAN in initialization mode
0 INITRQ6,7
1 2
The MSCAN must be in normal mode for this bit to become set. See the Bosch CAN 2.0A/B specification for a detailed definition of transmitter and receiver states. 3 In order to protect from accidentally violating the CAN protocol, the TXCAN pin is immediately forced to a recessive state when the CPU enters wait (CSWAI = 1) or stop mode (see Section 12.5.5.2, “Operation in Wait Mode” and Section 12.5.5.3, “Operation in Stop Mode”). 4 The CPU has to make sure that the WUPE bit and the WUPIE wake-up interrupt enable bit (see Section 12.3.5, “MSCAN Receiver Interrupt Enable Register (CANRIER)) is enabled, if the recovery mechanism from stop or wait is required. 5 The CPU cannot clear SLPRQ before the MSCAN has entered sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1). 6 The CPU cannot clear INITRQ before the MSCAN has entered initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1). 7 In order to protect from accidentally violating the CAN protocol, the TXCAN pin is immediately forced to a recessive state when the initialization mode is requested by the CPU. Thus, the recommended procedure is to bring the MSCAN into sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1) before requesting initialization mode. 8 Not including WUPE, INITRQ, and SLPRQ. 9 TSTAT1 and TSTAT0 are not affected by initialization mode. 10 RSTAT1 and RSTAT0 are not affected by initialization mode.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 259
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
12.3.2
MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1)
The CANCTL1 register provides various control bits and handshake status information of the MSCAN module as described below.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R CANE W Reset: 0 0 = Unimplemented 0 1 0 0 CLKSRC LOOPB LISTEN BORM WUPM
SLPAK
INITAK
0
1
Figure 12-5. MSCAN Control Register 1(CANCTL1)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime when INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1, except CANE which is write once in normal and anytime in special system operation modes when the MSCAN is in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1).
Table 12-2. CANCTL1 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7 CANE 6 CLKSRC MSCAN Enable 0 MSCAN module is disabled 1 MSCAN module is enabled MSCAN Clock Source — This bit defines the clock source for the MSCAN module (only for systems with a clock generation module; Section 12.5.3.3, “Clock System,” and Section Figure 12-42., “MSCAN Clocking Scheme,”). 0 MSCAN clock source is the oscillator clock 1 MSCAN clock source is the bus clock Loopback Self Test Mode — When this bit is set, the MSCAN performs an internal loopback which can be used for self test operation. The bit stream output of the transmitter is fed back to the receiver internally.Section 12.5.4.6, “Loopback Self Test Mode. 0 Loopback self test disabled 1 Loopback self test enabled Listen Only Mode — This bit configures the MSCAN as a CAN bus monitor. When LISTEN is set, all valid CAN messages with matching ID are received, but no acknowledgement or error frames are sent out (see Section 12.5.4.4, “Listen-Only Mode”). In addition, the error counters are frozen. Listen only mode supports applications which require “hot plugging” or throughput analysis. The MSCAN is unable to transmit any messages when listen only mode is active. 0 Normal operation 1 Listen only mode activated Bus-Off Recovery Mode — This bits configures the bus-off state recovery mode of the MSCAN. Refer to Section 12.6.2, “Bus-Off Recovery,” for details. 0 Automatic bus-off recovery (see Bosch CAN 2.0A/B protocol specification) 1 Bus-off recovery upon user request Wake-Up Mode — If WUPE in CANCTL0 is enabled, this bit defines whether the integrated low-pass filter is applied to protect the MSCAN from spurious wake-up (see Section 12.5.5.4, “MSCAN Sleep Mode”). 0 MSCAN wakes up on any dominant level on the CAN bus 1 MSCAN wakes up only in case of a dominant pulse on the CAN bus that has a length of Twup Description
5 LOOPB
4 LISTEN
3 BORM
2 WUPM
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 260 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
Table 12-2. CANCTL1 Register Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 1 SLPAK Description Sleep Mode Acknowledge — This flag indicates whether the MSCAN module has entered sleep mode (see Section 12.5.5.4, “MSCAN Sleep Mode”). It is used as a handshake flag for the SLPRQ sleep mode request. Sleep mode is active when SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1. Depending on the setting of WUPE, the MSCAN will clear the flag if it detects activity on the CAN bus while in sleep mode.CPU clearing the SLPRQ bit will also reset the SLPAK bit. 0 Running — The MSCAN operates normally 1 Sleep mode active — The MSCAN has entered sleep mode Initialization Mode Acknowledge — This flag indicates whether the MSCAN module is in initialization mode (see Section 12.5.5.5, “MSCAN Initialization Mode”). It is used as a handshake flag for the INITRQ initialization mode request. Initialization mode is active when INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1. The registers CANCTL1, CANBTR0, CANBTR1, CANIDAC, CANIDAR0–CANIDAR7, and CANIDMR0–CANIDMR7 can be written only by the CPU when the MSCAN is in initialization mode. 0 Running — The MSCAN operates normally 1 Initialization mode active — The MSCAN is in initialization mode
0 INITAK
12.3.3
MSCAN Bus Timing Register 0 (CANBTR0)
The CANBTR0 register configures various CAN bus timing parameters of the MSCAN module.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R SJW1 W Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 SJW0 BRP5 BRP4 BRP3 BRP2 BRP1 BRP0
Figure 12-6. MSCAN Bus Timing Register 0 (CANBTR0)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1)
Table 12-3. CANBTR0 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7:6 SJW[1:0] 5:0 BRP[5:0] Description Synchronization Jump Width — The synchronization jump width defines the maximum number of time quanta (Tq) clock cycles a bit can be shortened or lengthened to achieve resynchronization to data transitions on the CAN bus (see Table 12-4). Baud Rate Prescaler — These bits determine the time quanta (Tq) clock which is used to build up the bit timing (see Table 12-5).
Table 12-4. Synchronization Jump Width
SJW1 0 0 1 1 SJW0 0 1 0 1 Synchronization Jump Width 1 Tq clock cycle 2 Tq clock cycles 3 Tq clock cycles 4 Tq clock cycles
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 261
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
Table 12-5. Baud Rate Prescaler
BRP5 0 0 0 0 : 1 BRP4 0 0 0 0 : 1 BRP3 0 0 0 0 : 1 BRP2 0 0 0 0 : 1 BRP1 0 0 1 1 : 1 BRP0 0 1 0 1 : 1 Prescaler value (P) 1 2 3 4 : 64
12.3.4
MSCAN Bus Timing Register 1 (CANBTR1)
The CANBTR1 register configures various CAN bus timing parameters of the MSCAN module.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R SAMP W Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 TSEG22 TSEG21 TSEG20 TSEG13 TSEG12 TSEG11 TSEG10
Figure 12-7. MSCAN Bus Timing Register 1 (CANBTR1)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1)
Table 12-6. CANBTR1 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7 SAMP Description Sampling — This bit determines the number of CAN bus samples taken per bit time. 0 One sample per bit. 1 Three samples per bit1. If SAMP = 0, the resulting bit value is equal to the value of the single bit positioned at the sample point. If SAMP = 1, the resulting bit value is determined by using majority rule on the three total samples. For higher bit rates, it is recommended that only one sample is taken per bit time (SAMP = 0).
6:4 Time Segment 2 — Time segments within the bit time fix the number of clock cycles per bit time and the location TSEG2[2:0] of the sample point (see Figure 12-43). Time segment 2 (TSEG2) values are programmable as shown in Table 12-7. 3:0 Time Segment 1 — Time segments within the bit time fix the number of clock cycles per bit time and the location TSEG1[3:0] of the sample point (see Figure 12-43). Time segment 1 (TSEG1) values are programmable as shown in Table 12-8.
1
In this case, PHASE_SEG1 must be at least 2 time quanta (Tq).
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 262 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
Table 12-7. Time Segment 2 Values
TSEG22 0 0 : 1 1
1
TSEG21 0 0 : 1 1
TSEG20 0 1 : 0 1
Time Segment 2 1 Tq clock cycle1 2 Tq clock cycles : 7 Tq clock cycles 8 Tq clock cycles
This setting is not valid. Please refer to Table 12-35 for valid settings.
Table 12-8. Time Segment 1 Values
TSEG13 0 0 0 0 : 1 1
1
TSEG12 0 0 0 0 : 1 1
TSEG11 0 0 1 1 : 1 1
TSEG10 0 1 0 1 : 0 1
Time segment 1 1 Tq clock cycle1 2 Tq clock cycles1 3 Tq clock cycles1 4 Tq clock cycles : 15 Tq clock cycles 16 Tq clock cycles
This setting is not valid. Please refer to Table 12-35 for valid settings.
The bit time is determined by the oscillator frequency, the baud rate prescaler, and the number of time quanta (Tq) clock cycles per bit (as shown in Table 12-7 and Table 12-8).
Eqn. 12-1
( Prescaler value ) Bit Time = ----------------------------------------------------- • ( 1 + TimeSegment1 + TimeSegment2 ) f CANCLK
12.3.4.1
MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG)
A flag can be cleared only by software (writing a 1 to the corresponding bit position) when the condition which caused the setting is no longer valid. Every flag has an associated interrupt enable bit in the CANRIER register.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R WUPIF W Reset: 0 0 CSCIF
RSTAT1
RSTAT0
TSTAT1
TSTAT0 OVRIF RXF 0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 12-8. MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 263
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
NOTE The CANRFLG register is held in the reset state1 when the initialization mode is active (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1). This register is writable again as soon as the initialization mode is exited (INITRQ = 0 and INITAK = 0). Read: Anytime Write: Anytime when out of initialization mode, except RSTAT[1:0] and TSTAT[1:0] flags which are read-only; write of 1 clears flag; write of 0 is ignored.
Table 12-9. CANRFLG Register Field Descriptions
Field 7 WUPIF Description Wake-Up Interrupt Flag — If the MSCAN detects CAN bus activity while in sleep mode (see Section 12.5.5.4, “MSCAN Sleep Mode,”) and WUPE = 1 in CANTCTL0 (see Section 12.3.1, “MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0)”), the module will set WUPIF. If not masked, a wake-up interrupt is pending while this flag is set. 0 No wake-up activity observed while in sleep mode 1 MSCAN detected activity on the CAN bus and requested wake-up CAN Status Change Interrupt Flag — This flag is set when the MSCAN changes its current CAN bus status due to the actual value of the transmit error counter (TEC) and the receive error counter (REC). An additional 4-bit (RSTAT[1:0], TSTAT[1:0]) status register, which is split into separate sections for TEC/REC, informs the system on the actual CAN bus status (see Section 12.3.5, “MSCAN Receiver Interrupt Enable Register (CANRIER)”). If not masked, an error interrupt is pending while this flag is set. CSCIF provides a blocking interrupt. That guarantees that the receiver/transmitter status bits (RSTAT/TSTAT) are only updated when no CAN status change interrupt is pending. If the TECs/RECs change their current value after the CSCIF is asserted, which would cause an additional state change in the RSTAT/TSTAT bits, these bits keep their status until the current CSCIF interrupt is cleared again. 0 No change in CAN bus status occurred since last interrupt 1 MSCAN changed current CAN bus status
6 CSCIF
5:4 Receiver Status Bits — The values of the error counters control the actual CAN bus status of the MSCAN. As RSTAT[1:0] soon as the status change interrupt flag (CSCIF) is set, these bits indicate the appropriate receiver related CAN bus status of the MSCAN. The coding for the bits RSTAT1, RSTAT0 is: 00 RxOK: 0 ≤ receive error counter ≤ 96 01 RxWRN: 96 < receive error counter ≤ 127 10 RxERR: 127 < receive error counter 11 Bus-off1: transmit error counter > 255 3:2 Transmitter Status Bits — The values of the error counters control the actual CAN bus status of the MSCAN. TSTAT[1:0] As soon as the status change interrupt flag (CSCIF) is set, these bits indicate the appropriate transmitter related CAN bus status of the MSCAN. The coding for the bits TSTAT1, TSTAT0 is: 00 TxOK: 0 ≤ transmit error counter ≤ 96 01 TxWRN: 96 < transmit error counter ≤ 127 10 TxERR: 127 < transmit error counter ≤ 255 11 Bus-Off: transmit error counter > 255
1. The RSTAT[1:0], TSTAT[1:0] bits are not affected by initialization mode. MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 264 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
Table 12-9. CANRFLG Register Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 1 OVRIF Description Overrun Interrupt Flag — This flag is set when a data overrun condition occurs. If not masked, an error interrupt is pending while this flag is set. 0 No data overrun condition 1 A data overrun detected Receive Buffer Full Flag — RXF is set by the MSCAN when a new message is shifted in the receiver FIFO. This flag indicates whether the shifted buffer is loaded with a correctly received message (matching identifier, matching cyclic redundancy code (CRC) and no other errors detected). After the CPU has read that message from the RxFG buffer in the receiver FIFO, the RXF flag must be cleared to release the buffer. A set RXF flag prohibits the shifting of the next FIFO entry into the foreground buffer (RxFG). If not masked, a receive interrupt is pending while this flag is set. 0 No new message available within the RxFG 1 The receiver FIFO is not empty. A new message is available in the RxFG
0 RXF2
1
Redundant Information for the most critical CAN bus status which is “bus-off”. This only occurs if the Tx error counter exceeds a number of 255 errors. Bus-off affects the receiver state. As soon as the transmitter leaves its bus-off state the receiver state skips to RxOK too. Refer also to TSTAT[1:0] coding in this register. 2 To ensure data integrity, do not read the receive buffer registers while the RXF flag is cleared. For MCUs with dual CPUs, reading the receive buffer registers while the RXF flag is cleared may result in a CPU fault condition.
12.3.5
MSCAN Receiver Interrupt Enable Register (CANRIER)
This register contains the interrupt enable bits for the interrupt flags described in the CANRFLG register.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R WUPIE W Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 CSCIE RSTATE1 RSTATE0 TSTATE1 TSTATE0 OVRIE RXFIE
Figure 12-9. MSCAN Receiver Interrupt Enable Register (CANRIER)
NOTE The CANRIER register is held in the reset state when the initialization mode is active (INITRQ=1 and INITAK=1). This register is writable when not in initialization mode (INITRQ=0 and INITAK=0). The RSTATE[1:0], TSTATE[1:0] bits are not affected by initialization mode. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime when not in initialization mode
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 265
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
Table 12-10. CANRIER Register Field Descriptions
Field 7 WUPIE1 6 CSCIE Description Wake-Up Interrupt Enable 0 No interrupt request is generated from this event. 1 A wake-up event causes a Wake-Up interrupt request. CAN Status Change Interrupt Enable 0 No interrupt request is generated from this event. 1 A CAN Status Change event causes an error interrupt request.
5:4 Receiver Status Change Enable — These RSTAT enable bits control the sensitivity level in which receiver state RSTATE[1:0] changes are causing CSCIF interrupts. Independent of the chosen sensitivity level the RSTAT flags continue to indicate the actual receiver state and are only updated if no CSCIF interrupt is pending. 00 Do not generate any CSCIF interrupt caused by receiver state changes. 01 Generate CSCIF interrupt only if the receiver enters or leaves “bus-off” state. Discard other receiver state changes for generating CSCIF interrupt. 10 Generate CSCIF interrupt only if the receiver enters or leaves “RxErr” or “bus-off”2 state. Discard other receiver state changes for generating CSCIF interrupt. 11 Generate CSCIF interrupt on all state changes. 3:2 Transmitter Status Change Enable — These TSTAT enable bits control the sensitivity level in which transmitter TSTATE[1:0] state changes are causing CSCIF interrupts. Independent of the chosen sensitivity level, the TSTAT flags continue to indicate the actual transmitter state and are only updated if no CSCIF interrupt is pending. 00 Do not generate any CSCIF interrupt caused by transmitter state changes. 01 Generate CSCIF interrupt only if the transmitter enters or leaves “bus-off” state. Discard other transmitter state changes for generating CSCIF interrupt. 10 Generate CSCIF interrupt only if the transmitter enters or leaves “TxErr” or “bus-off” state. Discard other transmitter state changes for generating CSCIF interrupt. 11 Generate CSCIF interrupt on all state changes. 1 OVRIE 0 RXFIE
1
Overrun Interrupt Enable 0 No interrupt request is generated from this event. 1 An overrun event causes an error interrupt request. Receiver Full Interrupt Enable 0 No interrupt request is generated from this event. 1 A receive buffer full (successful message reception) event causes a receiver interrupt request.
WUPIE and WUPE (see Section 12.3.1, “MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0)”) must both be enabled if the recovery mechanism from stop or wait is required. 2 Bus-off state is defined by the CAN standard (see Bosch CAN 2.0A/B protocol specification: for only transmitters. Because the only possible state change for the transmitter from bus-off to TxOK also forces the receiver to skip its current state to RxOK, the coding of the RXSTAT[1:0] flags define an additional bus-off state for the receiver (see Section 12.3.4.1, “MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG)”).
12.3.6
MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)
The transmit buffer empty flags each have an associated interrupt enable bit in the CANTIER register.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 266 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R W Reset:
0
0
0
0
0 TXE2 TXE1 1 TXE0 1
0
0
0
0
0
1
= Unimplemented
Figure 12-10. MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)
NOTE The CANTFLG register is held in the reset state when the initialization mode is active (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1). This register is writable when not in initialization mode (INITRQ = 0 and INITAK = 0). Read: Anytime Write: Anytime for TXEx flags when not in initialization mode; write of 1 clears flag, write of 0 is ignored
Table 12-11. CANTFLG Register Field Descriptions
Field 2:0 TXE[2:0] Description Transmitter Buffer Empty — This flag indicates that the associated transmit message buffer is empty, and thus not scheduled for transmission. The CPU must clear the flag after a message is set up in the transmit buffer and is due for transmission. The MSCAN sets the flag after the message is sent successfully. The flag is also set by the MSCAN when the transmission request is successfully aborted due to a pending abort request (see Section 12.3.8, “MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Request Register (CANTARQ)”). If not masked, a transmit interrupt is pending while this flag is set. Clearing a TXEx flag also clears the corresponding ABTAKx (see Section 12.3.9, “MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Acknowledge Register (CANTAAK)”). When a TXEx flag is set, the corresponding ABTRQx bit is cleared (see Section 12.3.8, “MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Request Register (CANTARQ)”). When listen-mode is active (see Section 12.3.2, “MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1)”) the TXEx flags cannot be cleared and no transmission is started. Read and write accesses to the transmit buffer are blocked, if the corresponding TXEx bit is cleared (TXEx = 0) and the buffer is scheduled for transmission. 0 The associated message buffer is full (loaded with a message due for transmission) 1 The associated message buffer is empty (not scheduled)
12.3.7
MSCAN Transmitter Interrupt Enable Register (CANTIER)
This register contains the interrupt enable bits for the transmit buffer empty interrupt flags.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset:
0
0
0
0
0 TXEIE2 TXEIE1 0 TXEIE0 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 12-11. MSCAN Transmitter Interrupt Enable Register (CANTIER)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 267
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
NOTE The CANTIER register is held in the reset state when the initialization mode is active (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1). This register is writable when not in initialization mode (INITRQ = 0 and INITAK = 0). Read: Anytime Write: Anytime when not in initialization mode
Table 12-12. CANTIER Register Field Descriptions
Field 2:0 TXEIE[2:0] Description Transmitter Empty Interrupt Enable 0 No interrupt request is generated from this event. 1 A transmitter empty (transmit buffer available for transmission) event causes a transmitter empty interrupt request. See Section 12.5.2.2, “Transmit Structures” for details.
12.3.8
MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Request Register (CANTARQ)
The CANTARQ register allows abort request of messages queued for transmission.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset:
0
0
0
0
0 ABTRQ2 ABTRQ1 0 ABTRQ0 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 12-12. MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Request Register (CANTARQ)
NOTE The CANTARQ register is held in the reset state when the initialization mode is active (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1). This register is writable when not in initialization mode (INITRQ = 0 and INITAK = 0). Read: Anytime Write: Anytime when not in initialization mode
Table 12-13. CANTARQ Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
2:0 Abort Request — The CPU sets the ABTRQx bit to request that a scheduled message buffer (TXEx = 0) be ABTRQ[2:0] aborted. The MSCAN grants the request if the message has not already started transmission, or if the transmission is not successful (lost arbitration or error). When a message is aborted, the associated TXE (see Section 12.3.6, “MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)”) and abort acknowledge flags (ABTAK, see Section 12.3.9, “MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Acknowledge Register (CANTAAK)”) are set and a transmit interrupt occurs if enabled. The CPU cannot reset ABTRQx. ABTRQx is reset whenever the associated TXE flag is set. 0 No abort request 1 Abort request pending
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 268 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
12.3.9
MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Acknowledge Register (CANTAAK)
The CANTAAK register indicates the successful abort of messages queued for transmission, if requested by the appropriate bits in the CANTARQ register.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
ABTAK2
ABTAK1
ABTAK0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 12-13. MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Acknowledge Register (CANTAAK)
NOTE The CANTAAK register is held in the reset state when the initialization mode is active (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1). Read: Anytime Write: Unimplemented for ABTAKx flags
Table 12-14. CANTAAK Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
2:0 Abort Acknowledge — This flag acknowledges that a message was aborted due to a pending transmission ABTAK[2:0] abort request from the CPU. After a particular message buffer is flagged empty, this flag can be used by the application software to identify whether the message was aborted successfully or was sent anyway. The ABTAKx flag is cleared whenever the corresponding TXE flag is cleared. 0 The message was not aborted. 1 The message was aborted.
12.3.10 MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL)
The CANTBSEL selections of the actual transmit message buffer, which is accessible in the CANTXFG register space.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset:
0
0
0
0
0 TX2 TX1 0 TX0 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 12-14. MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 269
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
NOTE The CANTBSEL register is held in the reset state when the initialization mode is active (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK=1). This register is writable when not in initialization mode (INITRQ = 0 and INITAK = 0). Read: Find the lowest ordered bit set to 1, all other bits will be read as 0 Write: Anytime when not in initialization mode
Table 12-15. CANTBSEL Register Field Descriptions
Field 2:0 TX[2:0] Description Transmit Buffer Select — The lowest numbered bit places the respective transmit buffer in the CANTXFG register space (e.g., TX1 = 1 and TX0 = 1 selects transmit buffer TX0; TX1 = 1 and TX0 = 0 selects transmit buffer TX1). Read and write accesses to the selected transmit buffer will be blocked, if the corresponding TXEx bit is cleared and the buffer is scheduled for transmission (see Section 12.3.6, “MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)”). 0 The associated message buffer is deselected 1 The associated message buffer is selected, if lowest numbered bit
The following gives a short programming example of the usage of the CANTBSEL register: To get the next available transmit buffer, application software must read the CANTFLG register and write this value back into the CANTBSEL register. In this example Tx buffers TX1 and TX2 are available. The value read from CANTFLG is therefore 0b0000_0110. When writing this value back to CANTBSEL, the Tx buffer TX1 is selected in the CANTXFG because the lowest numbered bit set to 1 is at bit position 1. Reading back this value out of CANTBSEL results in 0b0000_0010, because only the lowest numbered bit position set to 1 is presented. This mechanism eases the application software the selection of the next available Tx buffer. • LDD CANTFLG; value read is 0b0000_0110 • STD CANTBSEL; value written is 0b0000_0110 • LDD CANTBSEL; value read is 0b0000_0010 If all transmit message buffers are deselected, no accesses are allowed to the CANTXFG buffer register.
12.3.11 MSCAN Identifier Acceptance Control Register (CANIDAC)
The CANIDAC register is used for identifier filter acceptance control as described below.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset:
0
0 IDAM1 IDAM0 0
0
IDHIT2
IDHIT1
IDHIT0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 12-15. MSCAN Identifier Acceptance Control Register (CANIDAC)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 270 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1), except bits IDHITx, which are read-only
Table 12-16. CANIDAC Register Field Descriptions
Field 5:4 IDAM[1:0] 2:0 IDHIT[2:0] Description Identifier Acceptance Mode — The CPU sets these flags to define the identifier acceptance filter organization (see Section 12.5.3, “Identifier Acceptance Filter”). Table 12-17 summarizes the different settings. In filter closed mode, no message is accepted such that the foreground buffer is never reloaded. Identifier Acceptance Hit Indicator — The MSCAN sets these flags to indicate an identifier acceptance hit (see Section 12.5.3, “Identifier Acceptance Filter”). Table 12-18 summarizes the different settings.
Table 12-17. Identifier Acceptance Mode Settings
IDAM1 0 0 1 1 IDAM0 0 1 0 1 Identifier Acceptance Mode Two 32-bit acceptance filters Four 16-bit acceptance filters Eight 8-bit acceptance filters Filter closed
Table 12-18. Identifier Acceptance Hit Indication
IDHIT2 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 IDHIT1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 IDHIT0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Identifier Acceptance Hit Filter 0 hit Filter 1 hit Filter 2 hit Filter 3 hit Filter 4 hit Filter 5 hit Filter 6 hit Filter 7 hit
The IDHITx indicators are always related to the message in the foreground buffer (RxFG). When a message gets shifted into the foreground buffer of the receiver FIFO the indicators are updated as well.
12.3.12 MSCAN Miscellaneous Register (CANMISC)
This register provides additional features.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 271
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R W Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0 BOHOLD
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 12-16. MSCAN Miscellaneous Register (CANMISC)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime; write of ‘1’ clears flag; write of ‘0’ ignored
Table 12-19. CANMISC Register Field Descriptions
Field 0 BOHOLD Description Bus-off State Hold Until User Request — If BORM is set in Section 12.3.2, “MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1), this bit indicates whether the module has entered the bus-off state. Clearing this bit requests the recovery from bus-off. Refer to Section 12.6.2, “Bus-Off Recovery,” for details. 0 Module is not bus-off or recovery has been requested by user in bus-off state 1 Module is bus-off and holds this state until user request
12.3.13 MSCAN Receive Error Counter (CANRXERR)
This register reflects the status of the MSCAN receive error counter.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset:
RXERR7
RXERR6
RXERR5
RXERR4
RXERR3
RXERR2
RXERR1
RXERR0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 12-17. MSCAN Receive Error Counter (CANRXERR)
Read: Only when in sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1) or initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1) Write: Unimplemented NOTE Reading this register when in any other mode other than sleep or initialization mode may return an incorrect value. For MCUs with dual CPUs, this may result in a CPU fault condition. Writing to this register when in special modes can alter the MSCAN functionality.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 272 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
12.3.14 MSCAN Transmit Error Counter (CANTXERR)
This register reflects the status of the MSCAN transmit error counter.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset:
TXERR7
TXERR6
TXERR5
TXERR4
TXERR3
TXERR2
TXERR1
TXERR0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 12-18. MSCAN Transmit Error Counter (CANTXERR)
Read: Only when in sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1) or initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1) Write: Unimplemented NOTE Reading this register when in any other mode other than sleep or initialization mode, may return an incorrect value. For MCUs with dual CPUs, this may result in a CPU fault condition. Writing to this register when in special modes can alter the MSCAN functionality.
12.3.15 MSCAN Identifier Acceptance Registers (CANIDAR0-7)
On reception, each message is written into the background receive buffer. The CPU is only signalled to read the message if it passes the criteria in the identifier acceptance and identifier mask registers (accepted); otherwise, the message is overwritten by the next message (dropped). The acceptance registers of the MSCAN are applied on the IDR0–IDR3 registers (see Section 12.4.1, “Identifier Registers (IDR0–IDR3)”) of incoming messages in a bit by bit manner (see Section 12.5.3, “Identifier Acceptance Filter”). For extended identifiers, all four acceptance and mask registers are applied. For standard identifiers, only the first two (CANIDAR0/1, CANIDMR0/1) are applied.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
AC7 0
AC6 0
AC5 0
AC4 0
AC3 0
AC2 0
AC1 0
AC0 0
Figure 12-19. MSCAN Identifier Acceptance Registers (First Bank) — CANIDAR0–CANIDAR3
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 273
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
Table 12-20. CANIDAR0–CANIDAR3 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7:0 AC[7:0] Description Acceptance Code Bits — AC[7:0] comprise a user-defined sequence of bits with which the corresponding bits of the related identifier register (IDRn) of the receive message buffer are compared. The result of this comparison is then masked with the corresponding identifier mask register.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R W Reset
AC7 0
AC6 0
AC5 0
AC4 0
AC3 0
AC2 0
AC1 0
AC0 0
Figure 12-20. MSCAN Identifier Acceptance Registers (Second Bank) — CANIDAR4–CANIDAR7
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1)
Table 12-21. CANIDAR4–CANIDAR7 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7:0 AC[7:0] Description Acceptance Code Bits — AC[7:0] comprise a user-defined sequence of bits with which the corresponding bits of the related identifier register (IDRn) of the receive message buffer are compared. The result of this comparison is then masked with the corresponding identifier mask register.
12.3.16 MSCAN Identifier Mask Registers (CANIDMR0–CANIDMR7)
The identifier mask register specifies which of the corresponding bits in the identifier acceptance register are relevant for acceptance filtering. To receive standard identifiers in 32 bit filter mode, it is required to program the last three bits (AM[2:0]) in the mask registers CANIDMR1 and CANIDMR5 to “don’t care.” To receive standard identifiers in 16 bit filter mode, it is required to program the last three bits (AM[2:0]) in the mask registers CANIDMR1, CANIDMR3, CANIDMR5, and CANIDMR7 to “don’t care.”
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
AM7 0
AM6 0
AM5 0
AM4 0
AM3 0
AM2 0
AM1 0
AM0 0
Figure 12-21. MSCAN Identifier Mask Registers (First Bank) — CANIDMR0–CANIDMR3
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 274 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
Table 12-22. CANIDMR0–CANIDMR3 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7:0 AM[7:0] Description Acceptance Mask Bits — If a particular bit in this register is cleared, this indicates that the corresponding bit in the identifier acceptance register must be the same as its identifier bit before a match is detected. The message is accepted if all such bits match. If a bit is set, it indicates that the state of the corresponding bit in the identifier acceptance register does not affect whether or not the message is accepted. 0 Match corresponding acceptance code register and identifier bits 1 Ignore corresponding acceptance code register bit (don’t care)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R W Reset
AM7 0
AM6 0
AM5 0
AM4 0
AM3 0
AM2 0
AM1 0
AM0 0
Figure 12-22. MSCAN Identifier Mask Registers (Second Bank) — CANIDMR4–CANIDMR7
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1)
Table 12-23. CANIDMR4–CANIDMR7 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7:0 AM[7:0] Description Acceptance Mask Bits — If a particular bit in this register is cleared, this indicates that the corresponding bit in the identifier acceptance register must be the same as its identifier bit before a match is detected. The message is accepted if all such bits match. If a bit is set, it indicates that the state of the corresponding bit in the identifier acceptance register does not affect whether or not the message is accepted. 0 Match corresponding acceptance code register and identifier bits 1 Ignore corresponding acceptance code register bit (don’t care)
12.4
Programmer’s Model of Message Storage
The following section details the organization of the receive and transmit message buffers and the associated control registers. To simplify the programmer interface, the receive and transmit message buffers have the same outline. Each message buffer allocates 16 bytes in the memory map containing a 13 byte data structure. An additional transmit buffer priority register (TBPR) is defined for the transmit buffers. Within the last two bytes of this memory map, the MSCAN stores a special 16-bit time stamp, which is sampled from an internal timer after successful transmission or reception of a message. This feature is only available for transmit and receiver buffers if the TIME bit is set (see Section 12.3.1, “MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0)”). The time stamp register is written by the MSCAN. The CPU can only read these registers.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 275
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
Table 12-24. Message Buffer Organization
Offset Address 0x00X0 0x00X1 0x00X2 0x00X3 0x00X4 0x00X5 0x00X6 0x00X7 0x00X8 0x00X9 0x00XA 0x00XB 0x00XC 0x00XD 0x00XE 0x00XF
1 2
Register Identifier Register 0 Identifier Register 1 Identifier Register 2 Identifier Register 3 Data Segment Register 0 Data Segment Register 1 Data Segment Register 2 Data Segment Register 3 Data Segment Register 4 Data Segment Register 5 Data Segment Register 6 Data Segment Register 7 Data Length Register Transmit Buffer Priority Register1 Time Stamp Register (High Byte)2 Time Stamp Register (Low Byte)3
Access
Not applicable for receive buffers Read-only for CPU 3 Read-only for CPU
Figure 12-23 shows the common 13-byte data structure of receive and transmit buffers for extended identifiers. The mapping of standard identifiers into the IDR registers is shown in Figure 12-24. All bits of the receive and transmit buffers are ‘x’ out of reset because of RAM-based implementation1. All reserved or unused bits of the receive and transmit buffers always read ‘x’.
1. Exception: The transmit priority registers are 0 out of reset. MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 276 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
Register Name IDR0 R W R W R IDR2 W R IDR3 W R DSR0 W R DSR1 W R DSR2 W R DSR3 W R DSR4 W R DSR5 W R DSR6 W R DSR7 W R DLR W
Bit 7 ID28
6 ID27
5 ID26
4 ID25
3 ID24
2 ID23
1 ID22
Bit0 ID21
IDR1
ID20
ID19
ID18
SRR(1)
IDE(1)
ID17
ID16
ID15
ID14
ID13
ID12
ID11
ID10
ID9
ID8
ID7
ID6
ID5
ID4
ID3
ID2
ID1
ID0
RTR2
DB7
DB6
DB5
DB4
DB3
DB2
DB1
DB0
DB7
DB6
DB5
DB4
DB3
DB2
DB1
DB0
DB7
DB6
DB5
DB4
DB3
DB2
DB1
DB0
DB7
DB6
DB5
DB4
DB3
DB2
DB1
DB0
DB7
DB6
DB5
DB4
DB3
DB2
DB1
DB0
DB7
DB6
DB5
DB4
DB3
DB2
DB1
DB0
DB7
DB6
DB5
DB4
DB3
DB2
DB1
DB0
DB7
DB6
DB5
DB4
DB3
DB2
DB1
DB0
DLC3
DLC2
DLC1
DLC0
= Unused, always read ‘x’
Figure 12-23. Receive/Transmit Message Buffer — Extended Identifier Mapping
1 2
SRR and IDE are both 1s. The position of RTR differs between extended and standard indentifier mapping.
Read: For transmit buffers, anytime when TXEx flag is set (see Section 12.3.6, “MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)”) and the corresponding transmit buffer is selected in CANTBSEL (see
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 277
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
Section 12.3.10, “MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL)”). For receive buffers, only when RXF flag is set (see Section 12.3.4.1, “MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG)”). Write: For transmit buffers, anytime when TXEx flag is set (see Section 12.3.6, “MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)”) and the corresponding transmit buffer is selected in CANTBSEL (see Section 12.3.10, “MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL)”). Unimplemented for receive buffers. Reset: Undefined (0x00XX) because of RAM-based implementation
Register Name IDR0 R W R W R W R W Bit 7 ID10 6 ID9 5 ID8 4 ID7 3 ID6 2 ID5 1 ID4 Bit 0 ID3
IDR1
ID2
ID1
ID0
RTR1
IDE2
IDR2
IDR3
= Unused, always read ‘x’
Figure 12-24. Receive/Transmit Message Buffer — Standard Identifier Mapping
1 2
The position of RTR differs between extended and standard indentifier mapping. IDE is 0.
12.4.1
Identifier Registers (IDR0–IDR3)
The identifier registers for an extended format identifier consist of a total of 32 bits; ID[28:0], SRR, IDE, and RTR bits. The identifier registers for a standard format identifier consist of a total of 13 bits; ID[10:0], RTR, and IDE bits.
12.4.1.1
IDR0–IDR3 for Extended Identifier Mapping
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R ID28 W Reset: x x x x x x x x ID27 ID26 ID25 ID24 ID23 ID22 ID21
Figure 12-25. Identifier Register 0 (IDR0) — Extended Identifier Mapping
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 278 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
Table 12-25. IDR0 Register Field Descriptions — Extended
Field 7:0 ID[28:21] Description Extended Format Identifier — The identifiers consist of 29 bits (ID[28:0]) for the extended format. ID28 is the most significant bit and is transmitted first on the CAN bus during the arbitration procedure. The priority of an identifier is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R ID20 W Reset: x x x ID19 ID18
SRR(1) x
IDE(1) x
ID17 x
ID16 x
ID15 x
Figure 12-26. Identifier Register 1 (IDR1) — Extended Identifier Mapping
1
SRR and IDE are both 1s.
Table 12-26. IDR1 Register Field Descriptions — Extended
Field 7:5 ID[20:18] 4 SRR 3 IDE Description Extended Format Identifier — The identifiers consist of 29 bits (ID[28:0]) for the extended format. ID28 is the most significant bit and is transmitted first on the CAN bus during the arbitration procedure. The priority of an identifier is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number. Substitute Remote Request — This fixed recessive bit is used only in extended format. It must be set to 1 by the user for transmission buffers and is stored as received on the CAN bus for receive buffers. ID Extended — This flag indicates whether the extended or standard identifier format is applied in this buffer. In the case of a receive buffer, the flag is set as received and indicates to the CPU how to process the buffer identifier registers. In the case of a transmit buffer, the flag indicates to the MSCAN what type of identifier to send. 0 Standard format (11 bit) 1 Extended format (29 bit) Extended Format Identifier — The identifiers consist of 29 bits (ID[28:0]) for the extended format. ID28 is the most significant bit and is transmitted first on the CAN bus during the arbitration procedure. The priority of an identifier is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number.
2:0 ID[17:15]
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R ID14 W Reset: x x x x x x x x ID13 ID12 ID11 ID10 ID9 ID8 ID7
Figure 12-27. Identifier Register 2 (IDR2) — Extended Identifier Mapping Table 12-27. IDR2 Register Field Descriptions — Extended
Field 7:0 ID[14:7] Description Extended Format Identifier — The identifiers consist of 29 bits (ID[28:0]) for the extended format. ID28 is the most significant bit and is transmitted first on the CAN bus during the arbitration procedure. The priority of an identifier is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 279
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R ID6 W Reset: x x x x x x x x ID5 ID4 ID3 ID2 ID1 ID0 RTR
Figure 12-28. Identifier Register 3 (IDR3) — Extended Identifier Mapping Table 12-28. IDR3 Register Field Descriptions — Extended
Field 7:1 ID[6:0] 0 RTR Description Extended Format Identifier — The identifiers consist of 29 bits (ID[28:0]) for the extended format. ID28 is the most significant bit and is transmitted first on the CAN bus during the arbithation procedure. The priority of an identifier is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number. Remote Transmission Request — This flag reflects the status of the remote transmission request bit in the CAN frame. In the case of a receive buffer, it indicates the status of the received frame and supports the transmission of an answering frame in software. In the case of a transmit buffer, this flag defines the setting of the RTR bit to be sent. 0 Data frame 1 Remote frame
12.4.2
IDR0–IDR3 for Standard Identifier Mapping
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R ID10 W Reset: x x x x x x x x ID9 ID8 ID7 ID6 ID5 ID4 ID3
Figure 12-29. Identifier Register 0 — Standard Mapping Table 12-29. IDR0 Register Field Descriptions — Standard
Field 7:0 ID[10:3] Description Standard Format Identifier — The identifiers consist of 11 bits (ID[10:0]) for the standard format. ID10 is the most significant bit and is transmitted first on the CAN bus during the arbitration procedure. The priority of an identifier is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number. See also ID bits in Table 12-30.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R ID2 W Reset: x x x x ID1 ID0 RTR
IDE(1) x x x x
= Unused; always read ‘x’
Figure 12-30. Identifier Register 1 — Standard Mapping
1
IDE is 0.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 280 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
Table 12-30. IDR1 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7:5 ID[2:0] 4 RTR Description Standard Format Identifier — The identifiers consist of 11 bits (ID[10:0]) for the standard format. ID10 is the most significant bit and is transmitted first on the CAN bus during the arbitration procedure. The priority of an identifier is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number. See also ID bits in Table 12-29. Remote Transmission Request — This flag reflects the status of the Remote Transmission Request bit in the CAN frame. In the case of a receive buffer, it indicates the status of the received frame and supports the transmission of an answering frame in software. In the case of a transmit buffer, this flag defines the setting of the RTR bit to be sent. 0 Data frame 1 Remote frame ID Extended — This flag indicates whether the extended or standard identifier format is applied in this buffer. In the case of a receive buffer, the flag is set as received and indicates to the CPU how to process the buffer identifier registers. In the case of a transmit buffer, the flag indicates to the MSCAN what type of identifier to send. 0 Standard format (11 bit) 1 Extended format (29 bit)
3 IDE
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R W Reset: x x x x x x x x
= Unused; always read ‘x’
Figure 12-31. Identifier Register 2 — Standard Mapping
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset: x x x x x x x x
= Unused; always read ‘x’
Figure 12-32. Identifier Register 3 — Standard Mapping
12.4.3
Data Segment Registers (DSR0-7)
The eight data segment registers, each with bits DB[7:0], contain the data to be transmitted or received. The number of bytes to be transmitted or received is determined by the data length code in the corresponding DLR register.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 281
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R DB7 W Reset: x x x x x x x x DB6 DB5 DB4 DB3 DB2 DB1 DB0
Figure 12-33. Data Segment Registers (DSR0–DSR7) — Extended Identifier Mapping
Table 12-31. DSR0–DSR7 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7:0 DB[7:0] Data bits 7:0 Description
12.4.4
Data Length Register (DLR)
This register keeps the data length field of the CAN frame.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R DLC3 W Reset: x x x x x x x x DLC2 DLC1 DLC0
= Unused; always read “x”
Figure 12-34. Data Length Register (DLR) — Extended Identifier Mapping
Table 12-32. DLR Register Field Descriptions
Field 3:0 DLC[3:0] Description Data Length Code Bits — The data length code contains the number of bytes (data byte count) of the respective message. During the transmission of a remote frame, the data length code is transmitted as programmed while the number of transmitted data bytes is always 0. The data byte count ranges from 0 to 8 for a data frame. Table 12-33 shows the effect of setting the DLC bits.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 282 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
Table 12-33. Data Length Codes
Data Length Code DLC3 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 DLC2 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 DLC1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 DLC0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 Data Byte Count 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
12.4.5
Transmit Buffer Priority Register (TBPR)
This register defines the local priority of the associated message transmit buffer. The local priority is used for the internal prioritization process of the MSCAN and is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number. The MSCAN implements the following internal prioritization mechanisms: • All transmission buffers with a cleared TXEx flag participate in the prioritization immediately before the SOF (start of frame) is sent. • The transmission buffer with the lowest local priority field wins the prioritization. In cases of more than one buffer having the same lowest priority, the message buffer with the lower index number wins.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R PRIO7 W Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 PRIO6 PRIO5 PRIO4 PRIO3 PRIO2 PRIO1 PRIO0
Figure 12-35. Transmit Buffer Priority Register (TBPR)
Read: Anytime when TXEx flag is set (see Section 12.3.6, “MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)”) and the corresponding transmit buffer is selected in CANTBSEL (see Section 12.3.10, “MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL)”). Write: Anytime when TXEx flag is set (see Section 12.3.6, “MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)”) and the corresponding transmit buffer is selected in CANTBSEL (see Section 12.3.10, “MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL)”).
12.4.6
Time Stamp Register (TSRH–TSRL)
If the TIME bit is enabled, the MSCAN will write a time stamp to the respective registers in the active transmit or receive buffer as soon as a message has been acknowledged on the CAN bus (see
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 283
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
Section 12.3.1, “MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0)”). In case of a transmission, the CPU can only read the time stamp after the respective transmit buffer has been flagged empty. The timer value, which is used for stamping, is taken from a free running internal CAN bit clock. A timer overrun is not indicated by the MSCAN. The timer is reset (all bits set to 0) during initialization mode. The CPU can only read the time stamp registers.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset:
TSR15
TSR14
TSR13
TSR12
TSR11
TSR10
TSR9
TSR8
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Figure 12-36. Time Stamp Register — High Byte (TSRH)
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset:
TSR7
TSR6
TSR5
TSR4
TSR3
TSR2
TSR1
TSR0
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Figure 12-37. Time Stamp Register — Low Byte (TSRL)
Read: Anytime when TXEx flag is set (see Section 12.3.6, “MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)”) and the corresponding transmit buffer is selected in CANTBSEL (see Section 12.3.10, “MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL)”). Write: Unimplemented
12.5
12.5.1
Functional Description
General
This section provides a complete functional description of the MSCAN. It describes each of the features and modes listed in the introduction.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 284 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
12.5.2
Message Storage
CAN Receive / Transmit Engine CPU12 Memory Mapped I/O
Rx0
Rx1 Rx2 Rx3 Rx4
RXF
RxBG
MSCAN
Receiver
Tx0
RxFG
CPU bus
TXE0
TxBG
Tx1
PRIO
TXE1
TxFG
MSCAN
CPU bus
PRIO
Tx2
TXE2
Transmitter
TxBG
PRIO
Figure 12-38. User Model for Message Buffer Organization
MSCAN facilitates a sophisticated message storage system which addresses the requirements of a broad range of network applications.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 285
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
12.5.2.1
Message Transmit Background
Modern application layer software is built upon two fundamental assumptions: • Any CAN node is able to send out a stream of scheduled messages without releasing the CAN bus between the two messages. Such nodes arbitrate for the CAN bus immediately after sending the previous message and only release the CAN bus in case of lost arbitration. • The internal message queue within any CAN node is organized such that the highest priority message is sent out first, if more than one message is ready to be sent. The behavior described in the bullets above cannot be achieved with a single transmit buffer. That buffer must be reloaded immediately after the previous message is sent. This loading process lasts a finite amount of time and must be completed within the inter-frame sequence (IFS) to be able to send an uninterrupted stream of messages. Even if this is feasible for limited CAN bus speeds, it requires that the CPU reacts with short latencies to the transmit interrupt. A double buffer scheme de-couples the reloading of the transmit buffer from the actual message sending and, therefore, reduces the reactiveness requirements of the CPU. Problems can arise if the sending of a message is finished while the CPU re-loads the second buffer. No buffer would then be ready for transmission, and the CAN bus would be released. At least three transmit buffers are required to meet the first of the above requirements under all circumstances. The MSCAN has three transmit buffers. The second requirement calls for some sort of internal prioritization which the MSCAN implements with the “local priority” concept described in Section 12.5.2.2, “Transmit Structures.”
12.5.2.2
Transmit Structures
The MSCAN triple transmit buffer scheme optimizes real-time performance by allowing multiple messages to be set up in advance. The three buffers are arranged as shown in Figure 12-38. All three buffers have a 13-byte data structure similar to the outline of the receive buffers (see Section 12.4, “Programmer’s Model of Message Storage”). An additional Section 12.4.5, “Transmit Buffer Priority Register (TBPR) contains an 8-bit local priority field (PRIO) (see Section 12.4.5, “Transmit Buffer Priority Register (TBPR)”). The remaining two bytes are used for time stamping of a message, if required (see Section 12.4.6, “Time Stamp Register (TSRH–TSRL)”). To transmit a message, the CPU must identify an available transmit buffer, which is indicated by a set transmitter buffer empty (TXEx) flag (see Section 12.3.6, “MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)”). If a transmit buffer is available, the CPU must set a pointer to this buffer by writing to the CANTBSEL register (see Section 12.3.10, “MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL)”). This makes the respective buffer accessible within the CANTXFG address space (see Section 12.4, “Programmer’s Model of Message Storage”). The algorithmic feature associated with the CANTBSEL register simplifies the transmit buffer selection. In addition, this scheme makes the handler software simpler because only one address area is applicable for the transmit process, and the required address space is minimized. The CPU then stores the identifier, the control bits, and the data content into one of the transmit buffers. Finally, the buffer is flagged as ready for transmission by clearing the associated TXE flag.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 286 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
The MSCAN then schedules the message for transmission and signals the successful transmission of the buffer by setting the associated TXE flag. A transmit interrupt (see Section 12.5.7.2, “Transmit Interrupt”) is generated1 when TXEx is set and can be used to drive the application software to re-load the buffer. If more than one buffer is scheduled for transmission when the CAN bus becomes available for arbitration, the MSCAN uses the local priority setting of the three buffers to determine the prioritization. For this purpose, every transmit buffer has an 8-bit local priority field (PRIO). The application software programs this field when the message is set up. The local priority reflects the priority of this particular message relative to the set of messages being transmitted from this node. The lowest binary value of the PRIO field is defined to be the highest priority. The internal scheduling process takes place whenever the MSCAN arbitrates for the CAN bus. This is also the case after the occurrence of a transmission error. When a high priority message is scheduled by the application software, it may become necessary to abort a lower priority message in one of the three transmit buffers. Because messages that are already in transmission cannot be aborted, the user must request the abort by setting the corresponding abort request bit (ABTRQ) (see Section 12.3.8, “MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Request Register (CANTARQ)”.) The MSCAN then grants the request, if possible, by: 1. Setting the corresponding abort acknowledge flag (ABTAK) in the CANTAAK register. 2. Setting the associated TXE flag to release the buffer. 3. Generating a transmit interrupt. The transmit interrupt handler software can determine from the setting of the ABTAK flag whether the message was aborted (ABTAK = 1) or sent (ABTAK = 0).
12.5.2.3
Receive Structures
The received messages are stored in a five stage input FIFO. The five message buffers are alternately mapped into a single memory area (see Figure 12-38). The background receive buffer (RxBG) is exclusively associated with the MSCAN, but the foreground receive buffer (RxFG) is addressable by the CPU (see Figure 12-38). This scheme simplifies the handler software because only one address area is applicable for the receive process. All receive buffers have a size of 15 bytes to store the CAN control bits, the identifier (standard or extended), the data contents, and a time stamp, if enabled (see Section 12.4, “Programmer’s Model of Message Storage”). The receiver full flag (RXF) (see Section 12.3.4.1, “MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG)”) signals the status of the foreground receive buffer. When the buffer contains a correctly received message with a matching identifier, this flag is set. On reception, each message is checked to see whether it passes the filter (see Section 12.5.3, “Identifier Acceptance Filter”) and simultaneously is written into the active RxBG. After successful reception of a valid message, the MSCAN shifts the content of RxBG into the receiver FIFO2, sets the RXF flag, and generates a receive interrupt (see Section 12.5.7.3, “Receive Interrupt”) to the CPU3. The user’s receive handler must read the received message from the RxFG and then reset the RXF flag to acknowledge the interrupt and to release the foreground buffer. A new message, which can follow immediately after the IFS
1. The transmit interrupt occurs only if not masked. A polling scheme can be applied on TXEx also. 2. Only if the RXF flag is not set. 3. The receive interrupt occurs only if not masked. A polling scheme can be applied on RXF also. MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 287
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
field of the CAN frame, is received into the next available RxBG. If the MSCAN receives an invalid message in its RxBG (wrong identifier, transmission errors, etc.) the actual contents of the buffer will be over-written by the next message. The buffer will then not be shifted into the FIFO. When the MSCAN module is transmitting, the MSCAN receives its own transmitted messages into the background receive buffer, RxBG, but does not shift it into the receiver FIFO, generate a receive interrupt, or acknowledge its own messages on the CAN bus. The exception to this rule is in loopback mode (see Section 12.3.2, “MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1)”) where the MSCAN treats its own messages exactly like all other incoming messages. The MSCAN receives its own transmitted messages in the event that it loses arbitration. If arbitration is lost, the MSCAN must be prepared to become a receiver. An overrun condition occurs when all receive message buffers in the FIFO are filled with correctly received messages with accepted identifiers and another message is correctly received from the CAN bus with an accepted identifier. The latter message is discarded and an error interrupt with overrun indication is generated if enabled (see Section 12.5.7.5, “Error Interrupt”). The MSCAN remains able to transmit messages while the receiver FIFO is full, but all incoming messages are discarded. As soon as a receive buffer in the FIFO is available again, new valid messages will be accepted.
12.5.3
Identifier Acceptance Filter
The MSCAN identifier acceptance registers (see Section 12.3.11, “MSCAN Identifier Acceptance Control Register (CANIDAC)”) define the acceptable patterns of the standard or extended identifier (ID[10:0] or ID[28:0]). Any of these bits can be marked ‘don’t care’ in the MSCAN identifier mask registers (see Section 12.3.16, “MSCAN Identifier Mask Registers (CANIDMR0–CANIDMR7)”). A filter hit is indicated to the application software by a set receive buffer full flag (RXF = 1) and three bits in the CANIDAC register (see Section 12.3.11, “MSCAN Identifier Acceptance Control Register (CANIDAC)”). These identifier hit flags (IDHIT[2:0]) clearly identify the filter section that caused the acceptance. They simplify the application software’s task to identify the cause of the receiver interrupt. If more than one hit occurs (two or more filters match), the lower hit has priority. A very flexible programmable generic identifier acceptance filter has been introduced to reduce the CPU interrupt loading. The filter is programmable to operate in four different modes (see Bosch CAN 2.0A/B protocol specification): • Two identifier acceptance filters, each to be applied to: — The full 29 bits of the extended identifier and to the following bits of the CAN 2.0B frame: – Remote transmission request (RTR) – Identifier extension (IDE) – Substitute remote request (SRR) — The 11 bits of the standard identifier plus the RTR and IDE bits of the CAN 2.0A/B messages1. This mode implements two filters for a full length CAN 2.0B compliant extended identifier. Figure 12-39 shows how the first 32-bit filter bank (CANIDAR0–CANIDAR3, CANIDMR0–CANIDMR3) produces a filter 0 hit. Similarly, the second filter bank (CANIDAR4–CANIDAR7, CANIDMR4–CANIDMR7) produces a filter 1 hit.
1.Although this mode can be used for standard identifiers, it is recommended to use the four or eight identifier acceptance filters for standard identifiers MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 288 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
•
•
•
Four identifier acceptance filters, each to be applied to — a) the 14 most significant bits of the extended identifier plus the SRR and IDE bits of CAN 2.0B messages or — b) the 11 bits of the standard identifier, the RTR and IDE bits of CAN 2.0A/B messages. Figure 12-40 shows how the first 32-bit filter bank (CANIDAR0–CANIDA3, CANIDMR0–3CANIDMR) produces filter 0 and 1 hits. Similarly, the second filter bank (CANIDAR4–CANIDAR7, CANIDMR4–CANIDMR7) produces filter 2 and 3 hits. Eight identifier acceptance filters, each to be applied to the first 8 bits of the identifier. This mode implements eight independent filters for the first 8 bits of a CAN 2.0A/B compliant standard identifier or a CAN 2.0B compliant extended identifier. Figure 12-41 shows how the first 32-bit filter bank (CANIDAR0–CANIDAR3, CANIDMR0–CANIDMR3) produces filter 0 to 3 hits. Similarly, the second filter bank (CANIDAR4–CANIDAR7, CANIDMR4–CANIDMR7) produces filter 4 to 7 hits. Closed filter. No CAN message is copied into the foreground buffer RxFG, and the RXF flag is never set.
IDR0 IDR0 ID21 ID3 ID20 ID2 IDR1 IDR1 ID15 IDE ID14 ID10 IDR2 IDR2 ID7 ID3 ID6 ID10 IDR3 IDR3 RTR ID3
CAN 2.0B Extended Identifier ID28 CAN 2.0A/B Standard Identifier ID10
AM7
CANIDMR0
AM0
AM7
CANIDMR1
AM0
AM7
CANIDMR2
AM0
AM7
CANIDMR3
AM0
AC7
CANIDAR0
AC0
AC7
CANIDAR1
AC0
AC7
CANIDAR2
AC0
AC7
CANIDAR3
AC0
ID Accepted (Filter 0 Hit)
Figure 12-39. 32-bit Maskable Identifier Acceptance Filter
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 289
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
CAN 2.0B Extended Identifier CAN 2.0A/B Standard Identifier
ID28 ID10
IDR0 IDR0
ID21 ID3
ID20 ID2
IDR1 IDR1
ID15 IDE
ID14 ID10
IDR2 IDR2
ID7 ID3
ID6 ID10
IDR3 IDR3
RTR ID3
AM7
CANIDMR0
AM0
AM7
CANIDMR1
AM0
AC7
CANIDAR0
AC0
AC7
CANIDAR1
AC0
ID Accepted (Filter 0 Hit)
AM7
CANIDMR2
AM0
AM7
CANIDMR3
AM0
AC7
CANIDAR2
AC0
AC7
CANIDAR3
AC0
ID Accepted (Filter 1 Hit)
Figure 12-40. 16-bit Maskable Identifier Acceptance Filters
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 290 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
CAN 2.0B Extended Identifier ID28 CAN 2.0A/B Standard Identifier ID10
IDR0 IDR0
ID21 ID3
ID20 ID2
IDR1 IDR1
ID15 IDE
ID14 ID10
IDR2 IDR2
ID7 ID3
ID6 ID10
IDR3 IDR3
RTR ID3
AM7
CIDMR0
AM0
AC7
CIDAR0
AC0
ID Accepted (Filter 0 Hit)
AM7
CIDMR1
AM0
AC7
CIDAR1
AC0
ID Accepted (Filter 1 Hit)
AM7
CIDMR2
AM0
AC7
CIDAR2
AC0
ID Accepted (Filter 2 Hit)
AM7
CIDMR3
AM0
AC7
CIDAR3
AC0
ID Accepted (Filter 3 Hit)
Figure 12-41. 8-bit Maskable Identifier Acceptance Filters
MSCAN filter uses three sets of registers to provide the filter configuration. Firstly, the CANIDAC register determines the configuration of the banks into filter sizes and number of filters. Secondly, registers CANIDMR0/1/2/3 determine those bits on which the filter will operate by placing a ‘0’ at the appropriate
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 291
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
bit position in the filter register. Finally, registers CANIDAR0/1/2/3 determine the value of those bits determined by CANIDMR0/1/2/3. For instance in the case of the filter value of: 0001x1001x0 The CANIDMR0/1/2/3 register would be configured as: 00001000010 and so all message identifier bits except bit 1 and bit 6 would be compared against the CANIDAR0/1/2/3 registers. These would be configured as: 00010100100 In this case bits 1 and 6 are set to ‘0’, but since they are ignored it is equally valid to set them to ‘1’.
12.5.3.1
Identifier Acceptance Filters example
As described above, filters work by comparisons to individual bits in the CAN message identifier field. The filter will check each one of the eleven bits of a standard CAN message identifier. Suppose a filter value of 0001x1001x0. In this simple example, there are only three possible CAN messages. Filter value: 0001x1001x0 Message 1: 00011100110 Message 2: 00110100110 Message 3: 00010100100 Message 2 will be rejected since its third most significant bit is not ‘0’ - 001. The filter is simply a convenient way of defining the set of messages that the CPU must receive. For full 29-bits of an extended CAN message identifier, the filter identifies two sets of messages: one set that it receives and one set that it rejects. Alternatively, the filter may be split into two. This allows the MSCAN to examine only the first 16 bits of a message identifier, but allows two separate filters to perform the checking. See the example below: Filter value A: 0001x1001x0 Filter value B: 00x101x01x0 Message 1: 00011100110 Message 2: 00110100110 Message 3: 00010100100 MSCAN will accept all three messages. Filter A will accept messages 1 and 3 as before and filter B will accept message 2. In practice, it is unimportant which filter accepts the message - messages accepted by either will be placed in the input buffer. A message may be accepted by more than one filter.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 292 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
12.5.3.2
Protocol Violation Protection
The MSCAN protects the user from accidentally violating the CAN protocol through programming errors. The protection logic implements the following features: • The receive and transmit error counters cannot be written or otherwise manipulated. • All registers which control the configuration of the MSCAN cannot be modified while the MSCAN is on-line. The MSCAN has to be in Initialization Mode. The corresponding INITRQ/INITAK handshake bits in the CANCTL0/CANCTL1 registers (see Section 12.3.1, “MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0)”) serve as a lock to protect the following registers: — MSCAN control 1 register (CANCTL1) — MSCAN bus timing registers 0 and 1 (CANBTR0, CANBTR1) — MSCAN identifier acceptance control register (CANIDAC) — MSCAN identifier acceptance registers (CANIDAR0–CANIDAR7) — MSCAN identifier mask registers (CANIDMR0–CANIDMR7) • The TXCAN pin is immediately forced to a recessive state when the MSCAN goes into the power down mode or initialization mode (see Section 12.5.5.6, “MSCAN Power Down Mode,” and Section 12.5.5.5, “MSCAN Initialization Mode”). • The MSCAN enable bit (CANE) is writable only once in normal system operation modes, which provides further protection against inadvertently disabling the MSCAN.
12.5.3.3
Clock System
Figure 12-42 shows the structure of the MSCAN clock generation circuitry.
MSCAN
Bus Clock
CANCLK CLKSRC
Prescaler (1 .. 64)
Time quanta clock (Tq)
CLKSRC Oscillator Clock
Figure 12-42. MSCAN Clocking Scheme
The clock source bit (CLKSRC) in the CANCTL1 register (12.3.2/-260) defines whether the internal CANCLK is connected to the output of a crystal oscillator (oscillator clock) or to the bus clock. The clock source has to be chosen such that the tight oscillator tolerance requirements (up to 0.4%) of the CAN protocol are met. Additionally, for high CAN bus rates (1 Mbps), a 45% to 55% duty cycle of the clock is required.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 293
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
If the bus clock is generated from a PLL, it is recommended to select the oscillator clock rather than the bus clock due to jitter considerations, especially at the faster CAN bus rates. PLL lock may also be too wide to ensure adequate clock tolerance. For microcontrollers without a clock and reset generator (CRG), CANCLK is driven from the crystal oscillator (oscillator clock). A programmable prescaler generates the time quanta (Tq) clock from CANCLK. A time quantum is the atomic unit of time handled by the MSCAN.
Eqn. 12-2
f CANCLK = ----------------------------------------------------Tq ( Prescaler value ) A bit time is subdivided into three segments as described in the Bosch CAN specification. (see Figure 12-43): • SYNC_SEG: This segment has a fixed length of one time quantum. Signal edges are expected to happen within this section. • Time Segment 1: This segment includes the PROP_SEG and the PHASE_SEG1 of the CAN standard. It can be programmed by setting the parameter TSEG1 to consist of 4 to 16 time quanta. • Time Segment 2: This segment represents the PHASE_SEG2 of the CAN standard. It can be programmed by setting the TSEG2 parameter to be 2 to 8 time quanta long.
Eqn. 12-3
f Tq Bit Rate = -------------------------------------------------------------------------------( number of Time Quanta )
NRZ Signal
SYNC_SEG
Time Segment 1 (PROP_SEG + PHASE_SEG1) 4 ... 16 8 ... 25 Time Quanta = 1 Bit Time
Time Segment 2 (PHASE_SEG2) 2 ... 8
1
Transmit Point
Sample Point (single or triple sampling)
Figure 12-43. Segments within the Bit Time
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 294 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
Table 12-34. Time Segment Syntax
Syntax SYNC_SEG Transmit Point Description System expects transitions to occur on the CAN bus during this period. A node in transmit mode transfers a new value to the CAN bus at this point. A node in receive mode samples the CAN bus at this point. If the three samples per bit option is selected, then this point marks the position of the third sample.
Sample Point
The synchronization jump width (see the Bosch CAN specification for details) can be programmed in a range of 1 to 4 time quanta by setting the SJW parameter. The SYNC_SEG, TSEG1, TSEG2, and SJW parameters are set by programming the MSCAN bus timing registers (CANBTR0, CANBTR1) (see Section 12.3.3, “MSCAN Bus Timing Register 0 (CANBTR0)” and Section 12.3.4, “MSCAN Bus Timing Register 1 (CANBTR1)”). Table 12-35 gives an overview of the CAN compliant segment settings and the related parameter values. NOTE It is the user’s responsibility to ensure the bit time settings are in compliance with the CAN standard.
Table 12-35. CAN Standard Compliant Bit Time Segment Settings
Time Segment 1 5 .. 10 4 .. 11 5 .. 12 6 .. 13 7 .. 14 8 .. 15 9 .. 16 TSEG1 4 .. 9 3 .. 10 4 .. 11 5 .. 12 6 .. 13 7 .. 14 8 .. 15 Time Segment 2 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 TSEG2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Synchronization Jump Width 1 .. 2 1 .. 3 1 .. 4 1 .. 4 1 .. 4 1 .. 4 1 .. 4 SJW 0 .. 1 0 .. 2 0 .. 3 0 .. 3 0 .. 3 0 .. 3 0 .. 3
12.5.4
12.5.4.1
Modes of Operation
Normal Modes
The MSCAN module behaves as described within this specification in all normal system operation modes.
12.5.4.2
Special Modes
The MSCAN module behaves as described within this specification in all special system operation modes.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 295
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
12.5.4.3
Emulation Modes
In all emulation modes, the MSCAN module behaves just like normal system operation modes as described within this specification.
12.5.4.4
Listen-Only Mode
In an optional CAN bus monitoring mode (listen-only), the CAN node is able to receive valid data frames and valid remote frames, but it sends only “recessive” bits on the CAN bus. In addition, it cannot start a transmision. If the MAC sub-layer is required to send a “dominant” bit (ACK bit, overload flag, or active error flag), the bit is rerouted internally so that the MAC sub-layer monitors this “dominant” bit, although the CAN bus may remain in recessive state externally.
12.5.4.5
Security Modes
The MSCAN module has no security features.
12.5.4.6
Loopback Self Test Mode
Loopback self test mode is sometimes used to check software, independent of connections in the external system, to help isolate system problems. In this mode, the transmitter output is internally connected to the receiver input. The RXCAN input pin is ignored and the TXCAN output goes to the recessive state (logic 1). The MSCAN behaves as it does normally when transmitting and treats its own transmitted message as a message received from a remote node. In this state, the MSCAN ignores the bit sent during the ACK slot in the CAN frame acknowledge field to ensure proper reception of its own message. Both transmit and receive interrupts are generated.
12.5.5
Low-Power Options
If the MSCAN is disabled (CANE = 0), the MSCAN clocks are stopped for power saving. If the MSCAN is enabled (CANE = 1), the MSCAN has two additional modes with reduced power consumption, compared to normal mode: sleep and power down mode. In sleep mode, power consumption is reduced by stopping all clocks except those to access the registers from the CPU side. In power down mode, all clocks are stopped and no power is consumed. Table 12-36 summarizes the combinations of MSCAN and CPU modes. A particular combination of modes is entered by the given settings on the CSWAI and SLPRQ/SLPAK bits. For all modes, an MSCAN wake-up interrupt can occur only if the MSCAN is in sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1), wake-up functionality is enabled (WUPE = 1), and the wake-up interrupt is enabled (WUPIE = 1).
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 296 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
Table 12-36. CPU vs. MSCAN Operating Modes
MSCAN Mode CPU Mode Normal Sleep CSWAI = X1 SLPRQ = 0 SLPAK = 0 CSWAI = 0 SLPRQ = 0 SLPAK = 0 CSWAI = X SLPRQ = 1 SLPAK = 1 CSWAI = 0 SLPRQ = 1 SLPAK = 1 CSWAI = X2 SLPRQ = 1 SLPAK = 1 CSWAI = 1 SLPRQ = X SLPAK = X CSWAI = X SLPRQ = 0 SLPAK = 0 CSWAI = X SLPRQ = X SLPAK = X Power Down Reduced Power Consumption Disabled (CANE=0) CSWAI = X SLPRQ = X SLPAK = X CSWAI = X SLPRQ = X SLPAK = X CSWAI = X SLPRQ = X SLPAK = X CSWAI = X SLPRQ = X SLPAK = X
Run
Wait
Stop3
Stop1 or 2
1 2
‘X’ means don’t care. For a safe wake up from Sleep mode, SLPRQ and SLPAK must be set to 1 before going into Stop3 mode.
12.5.5.1
Operation in Run Mode
As shown in Table 12-36, only MSCAN sleep mode is available as low power option when the CPU is in run mode.
12.5.5.2
Operation in Wait Mode
The WAIT instruction puts the MCU in a low power consumption stand-by mode. If the CSWAI bit is set, additional power can be saved in power down mode because the CPU clocks are stopped. After leaving this power down mode, the MSCAN restarts its internal controllers and enters normal mode again. While the CPU is in wait mode, the MSCAN can be operated in normal mode and generate interrupts (registers can be accessed via background debug mode). The MSCAN can also operate in any of the low-power modes depending on the values of the SLPRQ/SLPAK and CSWAI bits as seen in Table 12-36.
12.5.5.3
Operation in Stop Mode
The STOP instruction puts the MCU in a low power consumption stand-by mode. In stop1 or stop2 modes, the MSCAN is set in power down mode regardless of the value of the SLPRQ/SLPAK. In stop3 mode, power down or sleep modes are determined by the SLPRQ/SLPAK values set prior to entering stop3. CSWAI bit has no function in any of the stop modes.Table 12-36.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 297
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
12.5.5.4
MSCAN Sleep Mode
The CPU can request the MSCAN to enter this low power mode by asserting the SLPRQ bit in the CANCTL0 register. The time when the MSCAN enters sleep mode depends on a fixed synchronization delay and its current activity: • If there are one or more message buffers scheduled for transmission (TXEx = 0), the MSCAN will continue to transmit until all transmit message buffers are empty (TXEx = 1, transmitted successfully or aborted) and then goes into sleep mode. • If the MSCAN is receiving, it continues to receive and goes into sleep mode as soon as the CAN bus next becomes idle. • If the MSCAN is neither transmitting nor receiving, it immediately goes into sleep mode.
Bus Clock Domain
CAN Clock Domain SLPRQ Flag
SLPRQ CPU Sleep Request
SYNC
sync. SLPRQ
SLPAK Flag
sync.
SLPAK
SYNC
SLPAK MSCAN in Sleep Mode
Figure 12-44. Sleep Request / Acknowledge Cycle
NOTE The application software must avoid setting up a transmission (by clearing one or more TXEx flag(s)) and immediately request sleep mode (by setting SLPRQ). Whether the MSCAN starts transmitting or goes into sleep mode directly depends on the exact sequence of operations. If sleep mode is active, the SLPRQ and SLPAK bits are set (Figure 12-44). The application software must use SLPAK as a handshake indication for the request (SLPRQ) to go into sleep mode. When in sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1), the MSCAN stops its internal clocks. However, clocks that allow register accesses from the CPU side continue to run. If the MSCAN is in bus-off state, it stops counting the 128 occurrences of 11 consecutive recessive bits due to the stopped clocks. The TXCAN pin remains in a recessive state. If RXF = 1, the message can be read and RXF can be cleared. Shifting a new message into the foreground buffer of the receiver FIFO (RxFG) does not take place while in sleep mode. It is possible to access the transmit buffers and to clear the associated TXE flags. No message abort takes place while in sleep mode.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 298 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
If the WUPE bit in CANCLT0 is not asserted, the MSCAN will mask any activity it detects on CAN. The RXCAN pin is therefore held internally in a recessive state. This locks the MSCAN in sleep mode (Figure 12-45). WUPE must be set before entering sleep mode to take effect.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 299
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
The MSCAN is able to leave sleep mode (wake up) only when: • CAN bus activity occurs and WUPE = 1 or • the CPU clears the SLPRQ bit NOTE The CPU cannot clear the SLPRQ bit before sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1) is active. After wake-up, the MSCAN waits for 11 consecutive recessive bits to synchronize to the CAN bus. As a consequence, if the MSCAN is woken-up by a CAN frame, this frame is not received. The receive message buffers (RxFG and RxBG) contain messages if they were received before sleep mode was entered. All pending actions will be executed upon wake-up; copying of RxBG into RxFG, message aborts and message transmissions. If the MSCAN remains in bus-off state after sleep mode was exited, it continues counting the 128 occurrences of 11 consecutive recessive bits.
CAN Activity
StartUp
Wait for Idle
CAN Activity SLPRQ
(CAN Activity & WUPE) | SLPRQ
CAN Activity & SLPRQ
Idle
Sleep
(CAN Activity & WUPE) |
CAN Activity & SLPRQ
CAN Activity CAN Activity
Tx/Rx Message Active
CAN Activity
Figure 12-45. Simplified State Transitions for Entering/Leaving Sleep Mode
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 300 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
12.5.5.5
MSCAN Initialization Mode
In initialization mode, any on-going transmission or reception is immediately aborted and synchronization to the CAN bus is lost, potentially causing CAN protocol violations. To protect the CAN bus system from fatal consequences of violations, the MSCAN immediately drives the TXCAN pin into a recessive state. NOTE The user is responsible for ensuring that the MSCAN is not active when initialization mode is entered. The recommended procedure is to bring the MSCAN into sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1) before setting the INITRQ bit in the CANCTL0 register. Otherwise, the abort of an on-going message can cause an error condition and can impact other CAN bus devices. In initialization mode, the MSCAN is stopped. However, interface registers remain accessible. This mode is used to reset the CANCTL0, CANRFLG, CANRIER, CANTFLG, CANTIER, CANTARQ, CANTAAK, and CANTBSEL registers to their default values. In addition, the MSCAN enables the configuration of the CANBTR0, CANBTR1 bit timing registers; CANIDAC; and the CANIDAR, CANIDMR message filters. See Section 12.3.1, “MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0),” for a detailed description of the initialization mode.
Bus Clock Domain
CAN Clock Domain INIT Flag
INITRQ CPU Init Request
SYNC
sync. INITRQ
INITAK Flag
sync.
INITAK
SYNC
INITAK
Figure 12-46. Initialization Request/Acknowledge Cycle
Due to independent clock domains within the MSCAN, INITRQ must be synchronized to all domains by using a special handshake mechanism. This handshake causes additional synchronization delay (see Section Figure 12-46., “Initialization Request/Acknowledge Cycle”). If there is no message transfer ongoing on the CAN bus, the minimum delay will be two additional bus clocks and three additional CAN clocks. When all parts of the MSCAN are in initialization mode, the INITAK flag is set. The application software must use INITAK as a handshake indication for the request (INITRQ) to go into initialization mode. NOTE The CPU cannot clear INITRQ before initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1) is active.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 301
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
12.5.5.6
MSCAN Power Down Mode
The MSCAN is in power down mode (Table 12-36) when • CPU is in stop mode or • CPU is in wait mode and the CSWAI bit is set When entering the power down mode, the MSCAN immediately stops all ongoing transmissions and receptions, potentially causing CAN protocol violations. To protect the CAN bus system from fatal consequences of violations to the above rule, the MSCAN immediately drives the TXCAN pin into a recessive state. NOTE The user is responsible for ensuring that the MSCAN is not active when power down mode is entered. The recommended procedure is to bring the MSCAN into Sleep mode before the STOP or WAIT instruction (if CSWAI is set) is executed. Otherwise, the abort of an ongoing message can cause an error condition and impact other CAN bus devices. In power down mode, all clocks are stopped and no registers can be accessed. If the MSCAN was not in sleep mode before power down mode became active, the module performs an internal recovery cycle after powering up. This causes some fixed delay before the module enters normal mode again.
12.5.5.7
Programmable Wake-Up Function
The MSCAN can be programmed to wake up the MSCAN as soon as CAN bus activity is detected (see control bit WUPE in Section 12.3.1, “MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0)”). The sensitivity to existing CAN bus action can be modified by applying a low-pass filter function to the RXCAN input line while in sleep mode (see control bit WUPM in Section 12.3.2, “MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1)”). This feature can be used to protect the MSCAN from wake-up due to short glitches on the CAN bus lines. Such glitches can result from—for example—electromagnetic interference within noisy environments.
12.5.6
Reset Initialization
The reset state of each individual bit is listed in Section 12.3, “Register Definition,” which details all the registers and their bit-fields.
12.5.7
Interrupts
This section describes all interrupts originated by the MSCAN. It documents the enable bits and generated flags. Each interrupt is listed and described separately.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 302 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
12.5.7.1
Description of Interrupt Operation
The MSCAN supports four interrupt vectors (see Table 12-37), any of which can be individually masked (for details see sections from Section 12.3.5, “MSCAN Receiver Interrupt Enable Register (CANRIER),” to Section 12.3.7, “MSCAN Transmitter Interrupt Enable Register (CANTIER)”). NOTE The dedicated interrupt vector addresses are defined in the Resets and Interrupts chapter.
Table 12-37. Interrupt Vectors
Interrupt Source Wake-Up Interrupt (WUPIF) Error Interrupts Interrupt (CSCIF, OVRIF) Receive Interrupt (RXF) Transmit Interrupts (TXE[2:0]) CCR Mask I bit I bit I bit I bit Local Enable CANRIER (WUPIE) CANRIER (CSCIE, OVRIE) CANRIER (RXFIE) CANTIER (TXEIE[2:0])
12.5.7.2
Transmit Interrupt
At least one of the three transmit buffers is empty (not scheduled) and can be loaded to schedule a message for transmission. The TXEx flag of the empty message buffer is set.
12.5.7.3
Receive Interrupt
A message is successfully received and shifted into the foreground buffer (RxFG) of the receiver FIFO. This interrupt is generated immediately after receiving the EOF symbol. The RXF flag is set. If there are multiple messages in the receiver FIFO, the RXF flag is set as soon as the next message is shifted to the foreground buffer.
12.5.7.4
Wake-Up Interrupt
A wake-up interrupt is generated if activity on the CAN bus occurs during MSCAN internal sleep mode. WUPE (see Section 12.3.1, “MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0)”) must be enabled.
12.5.7.5
Error Interrupt
An error interrupt is generated if an overrun of the receiver FIFO, error, warning, or bus-off condition occurrs. Section 12.3.4.1, “MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG) indicates one of the following conditions: • Overrun — An overrun condition of the receiver FIFO as described in Section 12.5.2.3, “Receive Structures,” occurred. • CAN Status Change — The actual value of the transmit and receive error counters control the CAN bus state of the MSCAN. As soon as the error counters skip into a critical range (Tx/Rx-warning, Tx/Rx-error, bus-off) the MSCAN flags an error condition. The status change, which caused the error condition, is indicated by the TSTAT and RSTAT flags (see
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 303
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
Section 12.3.4.1, “MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG)” and Section 12.3.5, “MSCAN Receiver Interrupt Enable Register (CANRIER)”).
12.5.7.6
Interrupt Acknowledge
Interrupts are directly associated with one or more status flags in either the Section 12.3.4.1, “MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG)” or the Section 12.3.6, “MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG).” Interrupts are pending as long as one of the corresponding flags is set. The flags in CANRFLG and CANTFLG must be reset within the interrupt handler to handshake the interrupt. The flags are reset by writing a 1 to the corresponding bit position. A flag cannot be cleared if the respective condition prevails. NOTE It must be guaranteed that the CPU clears only the bit causing the current interrupt. For this reason, bit manipulation instructions (BSET) must not be used to clear interrupt flags. These instructions may cause accidental clearing of interrupt flags which are set after entering the current interrupt service routine.
12.5.7.7
Recovery from Stop or Wait
The MSCAN can recover from stop or wait via the wake-up interrupt. This interrupt can only occur if the MSCAN was in sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1) before entering power down mode, the wake-up option is enabled (WUPE = 1), and the wake-up interrupt is enabled (WUPIE = 1).
12.6
12.6.1
Initialization/Application Information
MSCAN initialization
The procedure to initially start up the MSCAN module out of reset is as follows: 1. Assert CANE 2. Write to the configuration registers in initialization mode 3. Clear INITRQ to leave initialization mode and enter normal mode If the configuration of registers which are writable in initialization mode needs to be changed only when the MSCAN module is in normal mode: 1. Bring the module into sleep mode by setting SLPRQ and awaiting SLPAK to assert after the CAN bus becomes idle. 2. Enter initialization mode: assert INITRQ and await INITAK 3. Write to the configuration registers in initialization mode 4. Clear INITRQ to leave initialization mode and continue in normal mode
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 304 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
12.6.2
Bus-Off Recovery
The bus-off recovery is user configurable. The bus-off state can either be exited automatically or on user request. For reasons of backwards compatibility, the MSCAN defaults to automatic recovery after reset. In this case, the MSCAN will become error active again after counting 128 occurrences of 11 consecutive recessive bits on the CAN bus (See the Bosch CAN specification for details). If the MSCAN is configured for user request (BORM set in Section 12.3.2, “MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1)”), the recovery from bus-off starts after both independent events have become true: • 128 occurrences of 11 consecutive recessive bits on the CAN bus have been monitored • BOHOLD in Section 12.3.12, “MSCAN Miscellaneous Register (CANMISC) has been cleared by the user These two events may occur in any order.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 305
Chapter 12 Freescale’s Controller Area Network (S08MSCANV1)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 306 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 13 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)
13.1 Introduction
The serial peripheral interface (SPI) module provides for full-duplex, synchronous, serial communication between the MCU and peripheral devices. These peripheral devices can include other microcontrollers, analog-to-digital converters, shift registers, sensors, memories, etc. The SPI runs at a baud rate up to the bus clock divided by two in master mode and up to the bus clock divided by four in slave mode. Software can poll the status flags, or SPI operation can be interrupt driven. All MC9S08DZ128 Series MCUs in the 100-pin package have two SPIs; devices in the 64-pin and 48-pin packages have one SPI.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 307
Chapter 13 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)
HCS08 CORE CPU BKGD/MS BDC BKP DEBUG MODULE (DBG) ANALOG COMPARATOR (ACMP1) ACMP1O ACMP1ACMP1+ PORT A
RESET
HCS08 SYSTEM CONTROL RESETS AND INTERRUPTS MODES OF OPERATION POWER MANAGEMENT IRQ COP INT LVD IRQ VOLTAGE REGULATOR
PTA7/PIA7/ADP7/IRQ PTA6/PIA6/ADP6 PTA5/PIA5/ADP5 PTA4/PIA4/ADP4 PTA3/PIA3/ADP3/ACMP1O PTA2/PIA2/ADP2/ACMP1PTA1/PIA1/ADP1/ACMP1+ PTA0/PIA0/ADP0/MCLK PTB7/PIB7/ADP15 PTB6/PIB6/ADP14 PTB5/PIB5/ADP13 PTB4/PIB4/ADP12 PTB3/PIB3/ADP11 PTB2/PIB2/ADP10 PTB1/PIB1/ADP9 PTB0/PIB0/ADP8
● ● ● ● ● ● ● ●
REAL-TIME COUNTER (RTC)
VDD VSS VREFH VREFL VDDA VSSA
8 24-CHANNEL,12-BIT ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER (ADC) ADP7-ADP0 ADP15-ADP8 ADP23-ADP16
PORT B
USER MEMORY FLASH _EEPROM _RAM MC9S08DZ128 = 128K_2K_8K MC9S08DZ96 = 96K_2K_6K MC9S08DV128 = 128K_0K_6K MC9S08DV96 = 96K_0K_4K PTJ7/PIJ7/TPM3CLK PTJ6/PIJ6 PTJ5/PIJ5 PTJ4/PIJ4 PTJ3/PIJ3/TMP3CH3 PTJ2/PIJ2/TPM3CH2 PTJ1/PIJ1/TPM3CH1 PTJ0/PIJ0/TMP3CH0 PTK7 PTK6 PTK5 PTK4 PTK3 PTK2 PTK1 PTK0 PTL7 PTL6 PTL5 PTL4 PTL3 PTL2 PTL1 PTL0 PTH7 PTH6 PTH5 PTH4 PTH3/MISO2 PTH2/MOSI2 PTH1/SPSCK2 PTH0/SS2 TPM3CLK PORT J TPM3CH0 TPM3CH3 6-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM1) 2-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM2) 4-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM3) CONTROLLER AREA NETWORK (MSCAN) PORT K SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE (SPI1) SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE (SCI1) ANALOG COMPARATOR (ACMP2) IIC MODULE (IIC1) SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE (SCI2) IIC MODULE (IIC2) PORT H MISO2 MOSI2 SPSCK2 SS2 RxCAN TXCAN MISO1 MOSI1 SPSCK1 SS1 RxD1 TxD1 ACMP2O ACMP2ACMP2+ SDA1 SCL1 RxD2 TxD2 SDA2 SCL2 MULTI-PURPOSE CLOCK GENERATOR (MCG) OSCILLATOR (XOSC) XTAL EXTAL TPM1CH5 TPM1CH0 6 TPM1CLK TPM2CH1, TPM2CH0 TPM2CLK
PTC7/ADP23 PTC6/ADP22 PTC5/ADP21 PTC4/ADP20 PTC3/ADP19 PTC2/ADP18 PTC1/ADP17 PTC0/ADP16 PTD7/PID7/TPM1CH5 PTD6/PID6/TPM1CH4 PTD5/PID5/TPM1CH3 PTD4/PID4/TPM1CH2 PTD3/PID3/TPM1CH1 PTD2/PID2/TPM1CH0 PTD1/PID1/TPM2CH1 PTD0/PID0/TPM2CH0 PTE7/RxD2/RXCAN PTE6/TxD2/TXCAN PTE5/SDA1/MISO1 PTE4/SCL1/MOSI1 PTE3/SPSCK1 PTE2/SS1 PTE1/RxD1 PTE0/TxD1
4
PORT E
●
●
PORT D
PORT C
PTF7 PTF6/ACMP2O PTF5/ACMP2PTF4/ACMP2+ PTF3/TPM2CLK/SDA1 PTF2/TPM1CLK/SCL1 PTF1/RxD2 PTF0/TxD2 PTG7/SDA2 PTG6/SCL2 PTG5 PTG4 PTG3 PTG2 PTG1/XTAL PTG0/EXTAL
PORT L
PORT F PORT G
● ● ● ●
SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE (SPI2)
- Pin not connected in 64-pin and 48-pin packages ● - Pin not available in the 48-pin package - In 48-pin package, VDDA and VREFH are internally connected to each other and VSSA and VREFL are internally connected to each other.
Figure 13-1. MC9S08DZ128 Block Diagram with SPI Highlighted
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 308 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 13 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)
13.1.1
Features
Features of the SPI module include: • Master or slave mode operation • Full-duplex or single-wire bidirectional option • Programmable transmit bit rate • Double-buffered transmit and receive • Serial clock phase and polarity options • Slave select output • Selectable MSB-first or LSB-first shifting
13.1.2
Block Diagrams
This section includes block diagrams showing SPI system connections, the internal organization of the SPI module, and the SPI clock dividers that control the master mode bit rate.
13.1.2.1
SPI System Block Diagram
Figure 13-2 shows the SPI modules of two MCUs connected in a master-slave arrangement. The master device initiates all SPI data transfers. During a transfer, the master shifts data out (on the MOSI pin) to the slave while simultaneously shifting data in (on the MISO pin) from the slave. The transfer effectively exchanges the data that was in the SPI shift registers of the two SPI systems. The SPSCK signal is a clock output from the master and an input to the slave. The slave device must be selected by a low level on the slave select input (SS pin). In this system, the master device has configured its SS pin as an optional slave select output.
MASTER MOSI SPI SHIFTER 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MISO MISO 7 MOSI
SLAVE
SPI SHIFTER 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
SPSCK
SPSCK
CLOCK GENERATOR
SS
SS
Figure 13-2. SPI System Connections
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 309
Chapter 13 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)
The most common uses of the SPI system include connecting simple shift registers for adding input or output ports or connecting small peripheral devices such as serial A/D or D/A converters. Although Figure 13-2 shows a system where data is exchanged between two MCUs, many practical systems involve simpler connections where data is unidirectionally transferred from the master MCU to a slave or from a slave to the master MCU.
13.1.2.2
SPI Module Block Diagram
Figure 13-3 is a block diagram of the SPI module. The central element of the SPI is the SPI shift register. Data is written to the double-buffered transmitter (write to SPIxD) and gets transferred to the SPI shift register at the start of a data transfer. After shifting in a byte of data, the data is transferred into the double-buffered receiver where it can be read (read from SPIxD). Pin multiplexing logic controls connections between MCU pins and the SPI module. When the SPI is configured as a master, the clock output is routed to the SPSCK pin, the shifter output is routed to MOSI, and the shifter input is routed from the MISO pin. When the SPI is configured as a slave, the SPSCK pin is routed to the clock input of the SPI, the shifter output is routed to MISO, and the shifter input is routed from the MOSI pin. In the external SPI system, simply connect all SPSCK pins to each other, all MISO pins together, and all MOSI pins together. Peripheral devices often use slightly different names for these pins.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 310 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 13 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3) PIN CONTROL M SPE Tx BUFFER (WRITE SPIxD) ENABLE SPI SYSTEM SHIFT OUT SPI SHIFT REGISTER SHIFT IN SPC0 BIDIROE LSBFE SHIFT DIRECTION SHIFT CLOCK Rx BUFFER FULL Tx BUFFER EMPTY M S MISO (SISO) S MOSI (MOMI)
Rx BUFFER (READ SPIxD)
MASTER CLOCK BUS RATE CLOCK MSTR SPIBR CLOCK GENERATOR MASTER/SLAVE MODE SELECT MODFEN MODE FAULT DETECTION SSOE CLOCK LOGIC SLAVE CLOCK
M SPSCK S MASTER/ SLAVE
SS
SPRF
SPTEF SPTIE SPI INTERRUPT REQUEST
MODF SPIE
Figure 13-3. SPI Module Block Diagram
13.1.3
SPI Baud Rate Generation
As shown in Figure 13-4, the clock source for the SPI baud rate generator is the bus clock. The three prescale bits (SPPR2:SPPR1:SPPR0) choose a prescale divisor of 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, or 8. The three rate select bits (SPR2:SPR1:SPR0) divide the output of the prescaler stage by 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128, or 256 to get the internal SPI master mode bit-rate clock.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 311
Chapter 13 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3) PRESCALER BUS CLOCK DIVIDE BY 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, or 8 CLOCK RATE DIVIDER DIVIDE BY 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128, or 256 MASTER SPI BIT RATE
SPPR2:SPPR1:SPPR0
SPR2:SPR1:SPR0
Figure 13-4. SPI Baud Rate Generation
13.2
External Signal Description
The SPI optionally shares four port pins. The function of these pins depends on the settings of SPI control bits. When the SPI is disabled (SPE = 0), these four pins revert to being general-purpose port I/O pins that are not controlled by the SPI.
13.2.1
SPSCK — SPI Serial Clock
When the SPI is enabled as a slave, this pin is the serial clock input. When the SPI is enabled as a master, this pin is the serial clock output.
13.2.2
MOSI — Master Data Out, Slave Data In
When the SPI is enabled as a master and SPI pin control zero (SPC0) is 0 (not bidirectional mode), this pin is the serial data output. When the SPI is enabled as a slave and SPC0 = 0, this pin is the serial data input. If SPC0 = 1 to select single-wire bidirectional mode, and master mode is selected, this pin becomes the bidirectional data I/O pin (MOMI). Also, the bidirectional mode output enable bit determines whether the pin acts as an input (BIDIROE = 0) or an output (BIDIROE = 1). If SPC0 = 1 and slave mode is selected, this pin is not used by the SPI and reverts to being a general-purpose port I/O pin.
13.2.3
MISO — Master Data In, Slave Data Out
When the SPI is enabled as a master and SPI pin control zero (SPC0) is 0 (not bidirectional mode), this pin is the serial data input. When the SPI is enabled as a slave and SPC0 = 0, this pin is the serial data output. If SPC0 = 1 to select single-wire bidirectional mode, and slave mode is selected, this pin becomes the bidirectional data I/O pin (SISO) and the bidirectional mode output enable bit determines whether the pin acts as an input (BIDIROE = 0) or an output (BIDIROE = 1). If SPC0 = 1 and master mode is selected, this pin is not used by the SPI and reverts to being a general-purpose port I/O pin.
13.2.4
SS — Slave Select
When the SPI is enabled as a slave, this pin is the low-true slave select input. When the SPI is enabled as a master and mode fault enable is off (MODFEN = 0), this pin is not used by the SPI and reverts to being a general-purpose port I/O pin. When the SPI is enabled as a master and MODFEN = 1, the slave select output enable bit determines whether this pin acts as the mode fault input (SSOE = 0) or as the slave select output (SSOE = 1).
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 312 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 13 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)
13.3
13.3.1
Modes of Operation
SPI in Stop Modes
The SPI is disabled in all stop modes, regardless of the settings before executing the STOP instruction. During either stop1 or stop2 mode, the SPI module will be fully powered down. Upon wake-up from stop1 or stop2 mode, the SPI module will be in the reset state. During stop3 mode, clocks to the SPI module are halted. No registers are affected. If stop3 is exited with a reset, the SPI will be put into its reset state. If stop3 is exited with an interrupt, the SPI continues from the state it was in when stop3 was entered.
13.4
Register Definition
The SPI has five 8-bit registers to select SPI options, control baud rate, report SPI status, and for transmit/receive data. Refer to the direct-page register summary in the Memory chapter of this data sheet for the absolute address assignments for all SPI registers. This section refers to registers and control bits only by their names, and a Freescale-provided equate or header file is used to translate these names into the appropriate absolute addresses.
13.4.1
SPI Control Register 1 (SPIxC1)
This read/write register includes the SPI enable control, interrupt enables, and configuration options.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R SPIE W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 SPE SPTIE MSTR CPOL CPHA SSOE LSBFE
Figure 13-5. SPI Control Register 1 (SPIxC1) Table 13-1. SPIxC1 Field Descriptions
Field 7 SPIE Description SPI Interrupt Enable (for SPRF and MODF) — This is the interrupt enable for SPI receive buffer full (SPRF) and mode fault (MODF) events. 0 Interrupts from SPRF and MODF inhibited (use polling) 1 When SPRF or MODF is 1, request a hardware interrupt SPI System Enable — Disabling the SPI halts any transfer that is in progress, clears data buffers, and initializes internal state machines. SPRF is cleared and SPTEF is set to indicate the SPI transmit data buffer is empty. 0 SPI system inactive 1 SPI system enabled SPI Transmit Interrupt Enable — This is the interrupt enable bit for SPI transmit buffer empty (SPTEF). 0 Interrupts from SPTEF inhibited (use polling) 1 When SPTEF is 1, hardware interrupt requested
6 SPE
5 SPTIE
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 313
Chapter 13 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)
Table 13-1. SPIxC1 Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 4 MSTR 3 CPOL Description Master/Slave Mode Select 0 SPI module configured as a slave SPI device 1 SPI module configured as a master SPI device Clock Polarity — This bit effectively places an inverter in series with the clock signal from a master SPI or to a slave SPI device. Refer to Section 13.5.1, “SPI Clock Formats” for more details. 0 Active-high SPI clock (idles low) 1 Active-low SPI clock (idles high) Clock Phase — This bit selects one of two clock formats for different kinds of synchronous serial peripheral devices. Refer to Section 13.5.1, “SPI Clock Formats” for more details. 0 First edge on SPSCK occurs at the middle of the first cycle of an 8-cycle data transfer 1 First edge on SPSCK occurs at the start of the first cycle of an 8-cycle data transfer Slave Select Output Enable — This bit is used in combination with the mode fault enable (MODFEN) bit in SPCR2 and the master/slave (MSTR) control bit to determine the function of the SS pin as shown in Table 13-2. LSB First (Shifter Direction) 0 SPI serial data transfers start with most significant bit 1 SPI serial data transfers start with least significant bit
2 CPHA
1 SSOE 0 LSBFE
Table 13-2. SS Pin Function
MODFEN 0 0 1 1 SSOE 0 1 0 1 Master Mode General-purpose I/O (not SPI) General-purpose I/O (not SPI) SS input for mode fault Automatic SS output Slave Mode Slave select input Slave select input Slave select input Slave select input
NOTE Ensure that the SPI should not be disabled (SPE=0) at the same time as a bit change to the CPHA bit. These changes should be performed as separate operations or unexpected behavior may occur.
13.4.2
SPI Control Register 2 (SPIxC2)
This read/write register is used to control optional features of the SPI system. Bits 7, 6, 5, and 2 are not implemented and always read 0.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0
0 MODFEN BIDIROE 0
0 SPISWAI 0 0 SPC0 0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-6. SPI Control Register 2 (SPIxC2)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 314 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 13 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)
Table 13-3. SPIxC2 Register Field Descriptions
Field 4 MODFEN Description Master Mode-Fault Function Enable — When the SPI is configured for slave mode, this bit has no meaning or effect. (The SS pin is the slave select input.) In master mode, this bit determines how the SS pin is used (refer to Table 13-2 for more details). 0 Mode fault function disabled, master SS pin reverts to general-purpose I/O not controlled by SPI 1 Mode fault function enabled, master SS pin acts as the mode fault input or the slave select output Bidirectional Mode Output Enable — When bidirectional mode is enabled by SPI pin control 0 (SPC0) = 1, BIDIROE determines whether the SPI data output driver is enabled to the single bidirectional SPI I/O pin. Depending on whether the SPI is configured as a master or a slave, it uses either the MOSI (MOMI) or MISO (SISO) pin, respectively, as the single SPI data I/O pin. When SPC0 = 0, BIDIROE has no meaning or effect. 0 Output driver disabled so SPI data I/O pin acts as an input 1 SPI I/O pin enabled as an output SPI Stop in Wait Mode 0 SPI clocks continue to operate in wait mode 1 SPI clocks stop when the MCU enters wait mode SPI Pin Control 0 — The SPC0 bit chooses single-wire bidirectional mode. If MSTR = 0 (slave mode), the SPI uses the MISO (SISO) pin for bidirectional SPI data transfers. If MSTR = 1 (master mode), the SPI uses the MOSI (MOMI) pin for bidirectional SPI data transfers. When SPC0 = 1, BIDIROE is used to enable or disable the output driver for the single bidirectional SPI I/O pin. 0 SPI uses separate pins for data input and data output 1 SPI configured for single-wire bidirectional operation
3 BIDIROE
1 SPISWAI 0 SPC0
13.4.3
SPI Baud Rate Register (SPIxBR)
This register is used to set the prescaler and bit rate divisor for an SPI master. This register may be read or written at any time.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0 SPPR2 0 0 SPPR1 0 SPPR0 0
0 SPR2 0 0 SPR1 0 SPR0 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-7. SPI Baud Rate Register (SPIxBR) Table 13-4. SPIxBR Register Field Descriptions
Field 6:4 SPPR[2:0] 2:0 SPR[2:0] Description SPI Baud Rate Prescale Divisor — This 3-bit field selects one of eight divisors for the SPI baud rate prescaler as shown in Table 13-5. The input to this prescaler is the bus rate clock (BUSCLK). The output of this prescaler drives the input of the SPI baud rate divider (see Figure 13-4). SPI Baud Rate Divisor — This 3-bit field selects one of eight divisors for the SPI baud rate divider as shown in Table 13-6. The input to this divider comes from the SPI baud rate prescaler (see Figure 13-4). The output of this divider is the SPI bit rate clock for master mode.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 315
Chapter 13 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)
Table 13-5. SPI Baud Rate Prescaler Divisor
SPPR2:SPPR1:SPPR0 0:0:0 0:0:1 0:1:0 0:1:1 1:0:0 1:0:1 1:1:0 1:1:1 Prescaler Divisor 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Table 13-6. SPI Baud Rate Divisor
SPR2:SPR1:SPR0 0:0:0 0:0:1 0:1:0 0:1:1 1:0:0 1:0:1 1:1:0 1:1:1 Rate Divisor 2 4 8 16 32 64 128 256
13.4.4
SPI Status Register (SPIxS)
This register has three read-only status bits. Bits 6, 3, 2, 1, and 0 are not implemented and always read 0. Writes have no meaning or effect.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
SPRF
0
SPTEF
MODF
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-8. SPI Status Register (SPIxS)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 316 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 13 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)
Table 13-7. SPIxS Register Field Descriptions
Field 7 SPRF Description SPI Read Buffer Full Flag — SPRF is set at the completion of an SPI transfer to indicate that received data may be read from the SPI data register (SPIxD). SPRF is cleared by reading SPRF while it is set, then reading the SPI data register. 0 No data available in the receive data buffer 1 Data available in the receive data buffer SPI Transmit Buffer Empty Flag — This bit is set when there is room in the transmit data buffer. It is cleared by reading SPIxS with SPTEF set, followed by writing a data value to the transmit buffer at SPIxD. SPIxS must be read with SPTEF = 1 before writing data to SPIxD or the SPIxD write will be ignored. SPTEF generates an SPTEF CPU interrupt request if the SPTIE bit in the SPIxC1 is also set. SPTEF is automatically set when a data byte transfers from the transmit buffer into the transmit shift register. For an idle SPI (no data in the transmit buffer or the shift register and no transfer in progress), data written to SPIxD is transferred to the shifter almost immediately so SPTEF is set within two bus cycles allowing a second 8-bit data value to be queued into the transmit buffer. After completion of the transfer of the value in the shift register, the queued value from the transmit buffer will automatically move to the shifter and SPTEF will be set to indicate there is room for new data in the transmit buffer. If no new data is waiting in the transmit buffer, SPTEF simply remains set and no data moves from the buffer to the shifter. 0 SPI transmit buffer not empty 1 SPI transmit buffer empty Master Mode Fault Flag — MODF is set if the SPI is configured as a master and the slave select input goes low, indicating some other SPI device is also configured as a master. The SS pin acts as a mode fault error input only when MSTR = 1, MODFEN = 1, and SSOE = 0; otherwise, MODF will never be set. MODF is cleared by reading MODF while it is 1, then writing to SPI control register 1 (SPIxC1). 0 No mode fault error 1 Mode fault error detected
5 SPTEF
4 MODF
13.4.5
R
SPI Data Register (SPIxD)
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Bit 7 W Reset 0
6 0
5 0
4 0
3 0
2 0
1 0
Bit 0 0
Figure 13-9. SPI Data Register (SPIxD)
Reads of this register return the data read from the receive data buffer. Writes to this register write data to the transmit data buffer. When the SPI is configured as a master, writing data to the transmit data buffer initiates an SPI transfer. Data should not be written to the transmit data buffer unless the SPI transmit buffer empty flag (SPTEF) is set, indicating there is room in the transmit buffer to queue a new transmit byte. Data may be read from SPIxD any time after SPRF is set and before another transfer is finished. Failure to read the data out of the receive data buffer before a new transfer ends causes a receive overrun condition and the data from the new transfer is lost.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 317
Chapter 13 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)
13.5
Functional Description
An SPI transfer is initiated by checking for the SPI transmit buffer empty flag (SPTEF = 1) and then writing a byte of data to the SPI data register (SPIxD) in the master SPI device. When the SPI shift register is available, this byte of data is moved from the transmit data buffer to the shifter, SPTEF is set to indicate there is room in the buffer to queue another transmit character if desired, and the SPI serial transfer starts. During the SPI transfer, data is sampled (read) on the MISO pin at one SPSCK edge and shifted, changing the bit value on the MOSI pin, one-half SPSCK cycle later. After eight SPSCK cycles, the data that was in the shift register of the master has been shifted out the MOSI pin to the slave while eight bits of data were shifted in the MISO pin into the master’s shift register. At the end of this transfer, the received data byte is moved from the shifter into the receive data buffer and SPRF is set to indicate the data can be read by reading SPIxD. If another byte of data is waiting in the transmit buffer at the end of a transfer, it is moved into the shifter, SPTEF is set, and a new transfer is started. Normally, SPI data is transferred most significant bit (MSB) first. If the least significant bit first enable (LSBFE) bit is set, SPI data is shifted LSB first. When the SPI is configured as a slave, its SS pin must be driven low before a transfer starts and SS must stay low throughout the transfer. If a clock format where CPHA = 0 is selected, SS must be driven to a logic 1 between successive transfers. If CPHA = 1, SS may remain low between successive transfers. See Section 13.5.1, “SPI Clock Formats” for more details. Because the transmitter and receiver are double buffered, a second byte, in addition to the byte currently being shifted out, can be queued into the transmit data buffer, and a previously received character can be in the receive data buffer while a new character is being shifted in. The SPTEF flag indicates when the transmit buffer has room for a new character. The SPRF flag indicates when a received character is available in the receive data buffer. The received character must be read out of the receive buffer (read SPIxD) before the next transfer is finished or a receive overrun error results. In the case of a receive overrun, the new data is lost because the receive buffer still held the previous character and was not ready to accept the new data. There is no indication for such an overrun condition so the application system designer must ensure that previous data has been read from the receive buffer before a new transfer is initiated.
13.5.1
SPI Clock Formats
To accommodate a wide variety of synchronous serial peripherals from different manufacturers, the SPI system has a clock polarity (CPOL) bit and a clock phase (CPHA) control bit to select one of four clock formats for data transfers. CPOL selectively inserts an inverter in series with the clock. CPHA chooses between two different clock phase relationships between the clock and data. Figure 13-10 shows the clock formats when CPHA = 1. At the top of the figure, the eight bit times are shown for reference with bit 1 starting at the first SPSCK edge and bit 8 ending one-half SPSCK cycle after the sixteenth SPSCK edge. The MSB first and LSB first lines show the order of SPI data bits depending on the setting in LSBFE. Both variations of SPSCK polarity are shown, but only one of these waveforms applies for a specific transfer, depending on the value in CPOL. The SAMPLE IN waveform applies to the MOSI input of a slave or the MISO input of a master. The MOSI waveform applies to the MOSI output
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 318 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 13 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)
pin from a master and the MISO waveform applies to the MISO output from a slave. The SS OUT waveform applies to the slave select output from a master (provided MODFEN and SSOE = 1). The master SS output goes to active low one-half SPSCK cycle before the start of the transfer and goes back high at the end of the eighth bit time of the transfer. The SS IN waveform applies to the slave select input of a slave.
BIT TIME # (REFERENCE) 1 2 ... 6 7 8
SPSCK (CPOL = 0)
SPSCK (CPOL = 1)
SAMPLE IN (MISO OR MOSI)
MOSI (MASTER OUT) MSB FIRST LSB FIRST MISO (SLAVE OUT) BIT 7 BIT 0 BIT 6 BIT 1 ... ... BIT 2 BIT 5 BIT 1 BIT 6 BIT 0 BIT 7
SS OUT (MASTER)
SS IN (SLAVE)
Figure 13-10. SPI Clock Formats (CPHA = 1)
When CPHA = 1, the slave begins to drive its MISO output when SS goes to active low, but the data is not defined until the first SPSCK edge. The first SPSCK edge shifts the first bit of data from the shifter onto the MOSI output of the master and the MISO output of the slave. The next SPSCK edge causes both the master and the slave to sample the data bit values on their MISO and MOSI inputs, respectively. At the third SPSCK edge, the SPI shifter shifts one bit position which shifts in the bit value that was just sampled, and shifts the second data bit value out the other end of the shifter to the MOSI and MISO outputs of the master and slave, respectively. When CHPA = 1, the slave’s SS input is not required to go to its inactive high level between transfers. Figure 13-11 shows the clock formats when CPHA = 0. At the top of the figure, the eight bit times are shown for reference with bit 1 starting as the slave is selected (SS IN goes low), and bit 8 ends at the last SPSCK edge. The MSB first and LSB first lines show the order of SPI data bits depending on the setting
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 319
Chapter 13 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)
in LSBFE. Both variations of SPSCK polarity are shown, but only one of these waveforms applies for a specific transfer, depending on the value in CPOL. The SAMPLE IN waveform applies to the MOSI input of a slave or the MISO input of a master. The MOSI waveform applies to the MOSI output pin from a master and the MISO waveform applies to the MISO output from a slave. The SS OUT waveform applies to the slave select output from a master (provided MODFEN and SSOE = 1). The master SS output goes to active low at the start of the first bit time of the transfer and goes back high one-half SPSCK cycle after the end of the eighth bit time of the transfer. The SS IN waveform applies to the slave select input of a slave.
BIT TIME # (REFERENCE) SPSCK (CPOL = 0) 1 2 ... 6 7 8
SPSCK (CPOL = 1)
SAMPLE IN (MISO OR MOSI)
MOSI (MASTER OUT) MSB FIRST LSB FIRST MISO (SLAVE OUT) BIT 7 BIT 0 BIT 6 BIT 1 ... ... BIT 2 BIT 5 BIT 1 BIT 6 BIT 0 BIT 7
SS OUT (MASTER)
SS IN (SLAVE)
Figure 13-11. SPI Clock Formats (CPHA = 0)
When CPHA = 0, the slave begins to drive its MISO output with the first data bit value (MSB or LSB depending on LSBFE) when SS goes to active low. The first SPSCK edge causes both the master and the slave to sample the data bit values on their MISO and MOSI inputs, respectively. At the second SPSCK edge, the SPI shifter shifts one bit position which shifts in the bit value that was just sampled and shifts the second data bit value out the other end of the shifter to the MOSI and MISO outputs of the master and slave, respectively. When CPHA = 0, the slave’s SS input must go to its inactive high level between transfers.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 320 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 13 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)
13.5.2
SPI Interrupts
There are three flag bits, two interrupt mask bits, and one interrupt vector associated with the SPI system. The SPI interrupt enable mask (SPIE) enables interrupts from the SPI receiver full flag (SPRF) and mode fault flag (MODF). The SPI transmit interrupt enable mask (SPTIE) enables interrupts from the SPI transmit buffer empty flag (SPTEF). When one of the flag bits is set, and the associated interrupt mask bit is set, a hardware interrupt request is sent to the CPU. If the interrupt mask bits are cleared, software can poll the associated flag bits instead of using interrupts. The SPI interrupt service routine (ISR) should check the flag bits to determine what event caused the interrupt. The service routine should also clear the flag bit(s) before returning from the ISR (usually near the beginning of the ISR).
13.5.3
Mode Fault Detection
A mode fault occurs and the mode fault flag (MODF) becomes set when a master SPI device detects an error on the SS pin (provided the SS pin is configured as the mode fault input signal). The SS pin is configured to be the mode fault input signal when MSTR = 1, mode fault enable is set (MODFEN = 1), and slave select output enable is clear (SSOE = 0). The mode fault detection feature can be used in a system where more than one SPI device might become a master at the same time. The error is detected when a master’s SS pin is low, indicating that some other SPI device is trying to address this master as if it were a slave. This could indicate a harmful output driver conflict, so the mode fault logic is designed to disable all SPI output drivers when such an error is detected. When a mode fault is detected, MODF is set and MSTR is cleared to change the SPI configuration back to slave mode. The output drivers on the SPSCK, MOSI, and MISO (if not bidirectional mode) are disabled. MODF is cleared by reading it while it is set, then writing to the SPI control register 1 (SPIxC1). User software should verify the error condition has been corrected before changing the SPI back to master mode.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 321
Chapter 13 Serial Peripheral Interface (S08SPIV3)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 322 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 14 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV4)
14.1 Introduction
NOTE MC9S08DZ128 Series devices operate at a higher voltage range (2.7 V to 5.5 V) and do not include stop1 mode. Please ignore references to stop1. All MCUs in the MC9S08DZ128 Series include SCI1 and SCI2.
14.1.1
SCI2 Configuration Information
The SCI2 module pins, TxD2 and RxD2 can be repositioned under software control using SCI2PS in SOPT1 as shown in Table 14-1. SCI2PS in SOPT1 selects which general-purpose I/O ports are associated with the SCI2 operation.
Table 14-1. SCI2 Position Options
SCI2PS in SOPT1 0 (default) 1 Port Pin for TXD2 PTF0 PTE6 Port Pin for RxD2 PTF1 PTE7
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 323
Chapter 14 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV4)
HCS08 CORE CPU BKGD/MS BDC BKP DEBUG MODULE (DBG) ANALOG COMPARATOR (ACMP1) ACMP1O ACMP1ACMP1+ PORT A
RESET
HCS08 SYSTEM CONTROL RESETS AND INTERRUPTS MODES OF OPERATION POWER MANAGEMENT IRQ COP INT LVD IRQ VOLTAGE REGULATOR
PTA7/PIA7/ADP7/IRQ PTA6/PIA6/ADP6 PTA5/PIA5/ADP5 PTA4/PIA4/ADP4 PTA3/PIA3/ADP3/ACMP1O PTA2/PIA2/ADP2/ACMP1PTA1/PIA1/ADP1/ACMP1+ PTA0/PIA0/ADP0/MCLK PTB7/PIB7/ADP15 PTB6/PIB6/ADP14 PTB5/PIB5/ADP13 PTB4/PIB4/ADP12 PTB3/PIB3/ADP11 PTB2/PIB2/ADP10 PTB1/PIB1/ADP9 PTB0/PIB0/ADP8
● ● ● ● ● ● ● ●
REAL-TIME COUNTER (RTC)
VDD VSS VREFH VREFL VDDA VSSA
8 24-CHANNEL,12-BIT ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER (ADC) ADP7-ADP0 ADP15-ADP8 ADP23-ADP16
PORT B
USER MEMORY FLASH _EEPROM _RAM MC9S08DZ128 = 128K_2K_8K MC9S08DZ96 = 96K_2K_6K MC9S08DV128 = 128K_0K_6K MC9S08DV96 = 96K_0K_4K PTJ7/PIJ7/TPM3CLK PTJ6/PIJ6 PTJ5/PIJ5 PTJ4/PIJ4 PTJ3/PIJ3/TMP3CH3 PTJ2/PIJ2/TPM3CH2 PTJ1/PIJ1/TPM3CH1 PTJ0/PIJ0/TMP3CH0 PTK7 PTK6 PTK5 PTK4 PTK3 PTK2 PTK1 PTK0 PTL7 PTL6 PTL5 PTL4 PTL3 PTL2 PTL1 PTL0 PTH7 PTH6 PTH5 PTH4 PTH3/MISO2 PTH2/MOSI2 PTH1/SPSCK2 PTH0/SS2 TPM3CLK PORT J TPM3CH0 TPM3CH3 6-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM1) 2-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM2) 4-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM3) CONTROLLER AREA NETWORK (MSCAN) PORT K SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE (SPI1) SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE (SCI1) ANALOG COMPARATOR (ACMP2) IIC MODULE (IIC1) SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE (SCI2) IIC MODULE (IIC2) PORT H MISO2 MOSI2 SPSCK2 SS2 RxCAN TXCAN MISO1 MOSI1 SPSCK1 SS1 RxD1 TxD1 ACMP2O ACMP2ACMP2+ SDA1 SCL1
RxD2
PTC7/ADP23 PTC6/ADP22 PTC5/ADP21 PTC4/ADP20 PTC3/ADP19 PTC2/ADP18 PTC1/ADP17 PTC0/ADP16 PTD7/PID7/TPM1CH5 PTD6/PID6/TPM1CH4 PTD5/PID5/TPM1CH3 PTD4/PID4/TPM1CH2 PTD3/PID3/TPM1CH1 PTD2/PID2/TPM1CH0 PTD1/PID1/TPM2CH1 PTD0/PID0/TPM2CH0 PTE7/RxD2/RXCAN PTE6/TxD2/TXCAN PTE5/SDA1/MISO1 PTE4/SCL1/MOSI1 PTE3/SPSCK1 PTE2/SS1 PTE1/RxD1 PTE0/TxD1
4
PORT E
●
●
PORT D
TPM1CH5 TPM1CH0 6 TPM1CLK TPM2CH1, TPM2CH0 TPM2CLK
PORT C
TxD2 SDA2 SCL2 MULTI-PURPOSE CLOCK GENERATOR (MCG) OSCILLATOR (XOSC) XTAL EXTAL PORT G
● ● ● ●
PTF7 PTF6/ACMP2O PTF5/ACMP2PTF4/ACMP2+ PTF3/TPM2CLK/SDA1 PTF2/TPM1CLK/SCL1 PTF1/RxD2 PTF0/TxD2 PTG7/SDA2 PTG6/SCL2 PTG5 PTG4 PTG3 PTG2 PTG1/XTAL PTG0/EXTAL
PORT L
SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE (SPI2)
- Pin not connected in 64-pin and 48-pin packages ● - Pin not available in the 48-pin package - In 48-pin package, VDDA and VREFH are internally connected to each other and VSSA and VREFL are internally connected to each other.
Figure 14-1. MC9S08DZ128 Block Diagram with SCI Highlighted
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 324 Freescale Semiconductor
PORT F
Chapter 14 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV4)
14.1.2
Features
Features of SCI module include: • Full-duplex, standard non-return-to-zero (NRZ) format • Double-buffered transmitter and receiver with separate enables • Programmable baud rates (13-bit modulo divider) • Interrupt-driven or polled operation: — Transmit data register empty and transmission complete — Receive data register full — Receive overrun, parity error, framing error, and noise error — Idle receiver detect — Active edge on receive pin — Break detect supporting LIN • Hardware parity generation and checking • Programmable 8-bit or 9-bit character length • Receiver wakeup by idle-line or address-mark • Optional 13-bit break character generation / 11-bit break character detection • Selectable transmitter output polarity
14.1.3
Modes of Operation
See Section 14.3, “Functional Description,” For details concerning SCI operation in these modes: • 8- and 9-bit data modes • Stop mode operation • Loop mode • Single-wire mode
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 325
Chapter 14 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV4)
14.1.4
Block Diagram
INTERNAL BUS (WRITE-ONLY) LOOPS SCID – Tx BUFFER RSRC LOOP CONTROL
Figure 14-2 shows the transmitter portion of the SCI.
11-BIT TRANSMIT SHIFT REGISTER START STOP M
TO RECEIVE DATA IN
SHIFT DIRECTION
LSB
1 × BAUD RATE CLOCK
H
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
L
TO TxD PIN
TXINV PREAMBLE (ALL 1s)
LOAD FROM SCIxD
T8
PE PT
PARITY GENERATION
BREAK (ALL 0s) SCI CONTROLS TxD
TE SBK TXDIR BRK13 TRANSMIT CONTROL
SHIFT ENABLE
TxD DIRECTION
TO TxD PIN LOGIC
TDRE TIE TC TCIE Tx INTERRUPT REQUEST
Figure 14-2. SCI Transmitter Block Diagram
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 326 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 14 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV4)
Figure 14-3 shows the receiver portion of the SCI.
INTERNAL BUS (READ-ONLY) 16 × BAUD RATE CLOCK FROM TRANSMITTER SINGLE-WIRE LOOP CONTROL STOP M LBKDE ALL 1s DATA RECOVERY MSB LSB 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 SHIFT DIRECTION RWU RWUID RDRF RIE IDLE ILIE LBKDIF LBKDIE RXEDGIF RXEDGIE OR ORIE FE FEIE NF NEIE PE PT PARITY CHECKING PF PEIE ERROR INTERRUPT REQUEST Rx INTERRUPT REQUEST LOOPS RSRC FROM RxD PIN RXINV START L 11-BIT RECEIVE SHIFT REGISTER DIVIDE BY 16 SCID – Rx BUFFER
H
WAKE ILT ACTIVE EDGE DETECT
WAKEUP LOGIC
Figure 14-3. SCI Receiver Block Diagram
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 327
Chapter 14 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV4)
14.2
Register Definition
The SCI has eight 8-bit registers to control baud rate, select SCI options, report SCI status, and for transmit/receive data. Refer to the direct-page register summary in the Memory chapter of this data sheet for the absolute address assignments for all SCI registers. This section refers to registers and control bits only by their names. A Freescale-provided equate or header file is used to translate these names into the appropriate absolute addresses.
14.2.1
SCI Baud Rate Registers (SCIxBDH, SCIxBDL)
This pair of registers controls the prescale divisor for SCI baud rate generation. To update the 13-bit baud rate setting [SBR12:SBR0], first write to SCIxBDH to buffer the high half of the new value and then write to SCIxBDL. The working value in SCIxBDH does not change until SCIxBDL is written. SCIxBDL is reset to a non-zero value, so after reset the baud rate generator remains disabled until the first time the receiver or transmitter is enabled (RE or TE bits in SCIxC2 are written to 1).
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R LBKDIE W Reset 0 0 RXEDGIE
0 SBR12 0 0 SBR11 0 SBR10 0 SBR9 0 SBR8 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 14-4. SCI Baud Rate Register (SCIxBDH) Table 14-2. SCIxBDH Field Descriptions
Field 7 LBKDIE 6 RXEDGIE 4:0 SBR[12:8] Description LIN Break Detect Interrupt Enable (for LBKDIF) 0 Hardware interrupts from LBKDIF disabled (use polling). 1 Hardware interrupt requested when LBKDIF flag is 1. RxD Input Active Edge Interrupt Enable (for RXEDGIF) 0 Hardware interrupts from RXEDGIF disabled (use polling). 1 Hardware interrupt requested when RXEDGIF flag is 1. Baud Rate Modulo Divisor — The 13 bits in SBR[12:0] are referred to collectively as BR, and they set the modulo divide rate for the SCI baud rate generator. When BR = 0, the SCI baud rate generator is disabled to reduce supply current. When BR = 1 to 8191, the SCI baud rate = BUSCLK/(16×BR). See also BR bits in Table 14-3.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 328 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 14 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV4)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R SBR7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 SBR6 SBR5 SBR4 SBR3 SBR2 SBR1 SBR0
Figure 14-5. SCI Baud Rate Register (SCIxBDL) Table 14-3. SCIxBDL Field Descriptions
Field 7:0 SBR[7:0] Description Baud Rate Modulo Divisor — These 13 bits in SBR[12:0] are referred to collectively as BR, and they set the modulo divide rate for the SCI baud rate generator. When BR = 0, the SCI baud rate generator is disabled to reduce supply current. When BR = 1 to 8191, the SCI baud rate = BUSCLK/(16×BR). See also BR bits in Table 14-2.
14.2.2
SCI Control Register 1 (SCIxC1)
This read/write register is used to control various optional features of the SCI system.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R LOOPS W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 SCISWAI RSRC M WAKE ILT PE PT
Figure 14-6. SCI Control Register 1 (SCIxC1) Table 14-4. SCIxC1 Field Descriptions
Field 7 LOOPS Description Loop Mode Select — Selects between loop back modes and normal 2-pin full-duplex modes. When LOOPS = 1, the transmitter output is internally connected to the receiver input. 0 Normal operation — RxD and TxD use separate pins. 1 Loop mode or single-wire mode where transmitter outputs are internally connected to receiver input. (See RSRC bit.) RxD pin is not used by SCI. SCI Stops in Wait Mode 0 SCI clocks continue to run in wait mode so the SCI can be the source of an interrupt that wakes up the CPU. 1 SCI clocks freeze while CPU is in wait mode. Receiver Source Select — This bit has no meaning or effect unless the LOOPS bit is set to 1. When LOOPS = 1, the receiver input is internally connected to the TxD pin and RSRC determines whether this connection is also connected to the transmitter output. 0 Provided LOOPS = 1, RSRC = 0 selects internal loop back mode and the SCI does not use the RxD pins. 1 Single-wire SCI mode where the TxD pin is connected to the transmitter output and receiver input. 9-Bit or 8-Bit Mode Select 0 Normal — start + 8 data bits (LSB first) + stop. 1 Receiver and transmitter use 9-bit data characters start + 8 data bits (LSB first) + 9th data bit + stop.
6 SCISWAI 5 RSRC
4 M
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 329
Chapter 14 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV4)
Table 14-4. SCIxC1 Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 3 WAKE Description Receiver Wakeup Method Select — Refer to Section 14.3.3.2, “Receiver Wakeup Operation” for more information. 0 Idle-line wakeup. 1 Address-mark wakeup. Idle Line Type Select — Setting this bit to 1 ensures that the stop bit and logic 1 bits at the end of a character do not count toward the 10 or 11 bit times of logic high level needed by the idle line detection logic. Refer to Section 14.3.3.2.1, “Idle-Line Wakeup” for more information. 0 Idle character bit count starts after start bit. 1 Idle character bit count starts after stop bit. Parity Enable — Enables hardware parity generation and checking. When parity is enabled, the most significant bit (MSB) of the data character (eighth or ninth data bit) is treated as the parity bit. 0 No hardware parity generation or checking. 1 Parity enabled. Parity Type — Provided parity is enabled (PE = 1), this bit selects even or odd parity. Odd parity means the total number of 1s in the data character, including the parity bit, is odd. Even parity means the total number of 1s in the data character, including the parity bit, is even. 0 Even parity. 1 Odd parity.
2 ILT
1 PE
0 PT
14.2.3
SCI Control Register 2 (SCIxC2)
This register can be read or written at any time.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R TIE W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 TCIE RIE ILIE TE RE RWU SBK
Figure 14-7. SCI Control Register 2 (SCIxC2) Table 14-5. SCIxC2 Field Descriptions
Field 7 TIE 6 TCIE 5 RIE 4 ILIE Description Transmit Interrupt Enable (for TDRE) 0 Hardware interrupts from TDRE disabled (use polling). 1 Hardware interrupt requested when TDRE flag is 1. Transmission Complete Interrupt Enable (for TC) 0 Hardware interrupts from TC disabled (use polling). 1 Hardware interrupt requested when TC flag is 1. Receiver Interrupt Enable (for RDRF) 0 Hardware interrupts from RDRF disabled (use polling). 1 Hardware interrupt requested when RDRF flag is 1. Idle Line Interrupt Enable (for IDLE) 0 Hardware interrupts from IDLE disabled (use polling). 1 Hardware interrupt requested when IDLE flag is 1.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 330 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 14 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV4)
Table 14-5. SCIxC2 Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 3 TE Description Transmitter Enable 0 Transmitter off. 1 Transmitter on. TE must be 1 in order to use the SCI transmitter. When TE = 1, the SCI forces the TxD pin to act as an output for the SCI system. When the SCI is configured for single-wire operation (LOOPS = RSRC = 1), TXDIR controls the direction of traffic on the single SCI communication line (TxD pin). TE also can be used to queue an idle character by writing TE = 0 then TE = 1 while a transmission is in progress. Refer to Section 14.3.2.1, “Send Break and Queued Idle” for more details. When TE is written to 0, the transmitter keeps control of the port TxD pin until any data, queued idle, or queued break character finishes transmitting before allowing the pin to revert to a general-purpose I/O pin. Receiver Enable — When the SCI receiver is off, the RxD pin reverts to being a general-purpose port I/O pin. If LOOPS = 1 the RxD pin reverts to being a general-purpose I/O pin even if RE = 1. 0 Receiver off. 1 Receiver on. Receiver Wakeup Control — This bit can be written to 1 to place the SCI receiver in a standby state where it waits for automatic hardware detection of a selected wakeup condition. The wakeup condition is either an idle line between messages (WAKE = 0, idle-line wakeup), or a logic 1 in the most significant data bit in a character (WAKE = 1, address-mark wakeup). Application software sets RWU and (normally) a selected hardware condition automatically clears RWU. Refer to Section 14.3.3.2, “Receiver Wakeup Operation” for more details. 0 Normal SCI receiver operation. 1 SCI receiver in standby waiting for wakeup condition. Send Break — Writing a 1 and then a 0 to SBK queues a break character in the transmit data stream. Additional break characters of 10 or 11 (13 or 14 if BRK13 = 1) bit times of logic 0 are queued as long as SBK = 1. Depending on the timing of the set and clear of SBK relative to the information currently being transmitted, a second break character may be queued before software clears SBK. Refer to Section 14.3.2.1, “Send Break and Queued Idle” for more details. 0 Normal transmitter operation. 1 Queue break character(s) to be sent.
2 RE
1 RWU
0 SBK
14.2.4
SCI Status Register 1 (SCIxS1)
This register has eight read-only status flags. Writes have no effect. Special software sequences (which do not involve writing to this register) are used to clear these status flags.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R W Reset
TDRE
TC
RDRF
IDLE
OR
NF
FE
PF
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 14-8. SCI Status Register 1 (SCIxS1)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 331
Chapter 14 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV4)
Table 14-6. SCIxS1 Field Descriptions
Field 7 TDRE Description Transmit Data Register Empty Flag — TDRE is set out of reset and when a transmit data value transfers from the transmit data buffer to the transmit shifter, leaving room for a new character in the buffer. To clear TDRE, read SCIxS1 with TDRE = 1 and then write to the SCI data register (SCIxD). 0 Transmit data register (buffer) full. 1 Transmit data register (buffer) empty. Transmission Complete Flag — TC is set out of reset and when TDRE = 1 and no data, preamble, or break character is being transmitted. 0 Transmitter active (sending data, a preamble, or a break). 1 Transmitter idle (transmission activity complete). TC is cleared automatically by reading SCIxS1 with TC = 1 and then doing one of the following three things: • Write to the SCI data register (SCIxD) to transmit new data • Queue a preamble by changing TE from 0 to 1 • Queue a break character by writing 1 to SBK in SCIxC2 Receive Data Register Full Flag — RDRF becomes set when a character transfers from the receive shifter into the receive data register (SCIxD). To clear RDRF, read SCIxS1 with RDRF = 1 and then read the SCI data register (SCIxD). 0 Receive data register empty. 1 Receive data register full. Idle Line Flag — IDLE is set when the SCI receive line becomes idle for a full character time after a period of activity. When ILT = 0, the receiver starts counting idle bit times after the start bit. So if the receive character is all 1s, these bit times and the stop bit time count toward the full character time of logic high (10 or 11 bit times depending on the M control bit) needed for the receiver to detect an idle line. When ILT = 1, the receiver doesn’t start counting idle bit times until after the stop bit. So the stop bit and any logic high bit times at the end of the previous character do not count toward the full character time of logic high needed for the receiver to detect an idle line. To clear IDLE, read SCIxS1 with IDLE = 1 and then read the SCI data register (SCIxD). After IDLE has been cleared, it cannot become set again until after a new character has been received and RDRF has been set. IDLE will get set only once even if the receive line remains idle for an extended period. 0 No idle line detected. 1 Idle line was detected. Receiver Overrun Flag — OR is set when a new serial character is ready to be transferred to the receive data register (buffer), but the previously received character has not been read from SCIxD yet. In this case, the new character (and all associated error information) is lost because there is no room to move it into SCIxD. To clear OR, read SCIxS1 with OR = 1 and then read the SCI data register (SCIxD). 0 No overrun. 1 Receive overrun (new SCI data lost). Noise Flag — The advanced sampling technique used in the receiver takes seven samples during the start bit and three samples in each data bit and the stop bit. If any of these samples disagrees with the rest of the samples within any bit time in the frame, the flag NF will be set at the same time as the flag RDRF gets set for the character. To clear NF, read SCIxS1 and then read the SCI data register (SCIxD). 0 No noise detected. 1 Noise detected in the received character in SCIxD.
6 TC
5 RDRF
4 IDLE
3 OR
2 NF
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 332 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 14 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV4)
Table 14-6. SCIxS1 Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 1 FE Description Framing Error Flag — FE is set at the same time as RDRF when the receiver detects a logic 0 where the stop bit was expected. This suggests the receiver was not properly aligned to a character frame. To clear FE, read SCIxS1 with FE = 1 and then read the SCI data register (SCIxD). 0 No framing error detected. This does not guarantee the framing is correct. 1 Framing error. Parity Error Flag — PF is set at the same time as RDRF when parity is enabled (PE = 1) and the parity bit in the received character does not agree with the expected parity value. To clear PF, read SCIxS1 and then read the SCI data register (SCIxD). 0 No parity error. 1 Parity error.
0 PF
14.2.5
SCI Status Register 2 (SCIxS2)
This register has one read-only status flag.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R LBKDIF W Reset 0 0 RXEDGIF
0 RXINV 0 0 RWUID 0 BRK13 0 LBKDE 0
RAF
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 14-9. SCI Status Register 2 (SCIxS2) Table 14-7. SCIxS2 Field Descriptions
Field 7 LBKDIF Description LIN Break Detect Interrupt Flag — LBKDIF is set when the LIN break detect circuitry is enabled and a LIN break character is detected. LBKDIF is cleared by writing a “1” to it. 0 No LIN break character has been detected. 1 LIN break character has been detected. RxD Pin Active Edge Interrupt Flag — RXEDGIF is set when an active edge (falling if RXINV = 0, rising if RXINV=1) on the RxD pin occurs. RXEDGIF is cleared by writing a “1” to it. 0 No active edge on the receive pin has occurred. 1 An active edge on the receive pin has occurred. Receive Data Inversion — Setting this bit reverses the polarity of the received data input. 0 Receive data not inverted 1 Receive data inverted Receive Wake Up Idle Detect— RWUID controls whether the idle character that wakes up the receiver sets the IDLE bit. 0 During receive standby state (RWU = 1), the IDLE bit does not get set upon detection of an idle character. 1 During receive standby state (RWU = 1), the IDLE bit gets set upon detection of an idle character. Break Character Generation Length — BRK13 is used to select a longer transmitted break character length. Detection of a framing error is not affected by the state of this bit. 0 Break character is transmitted with length of 10 bit times (11 if M = 1) 1 Break character is transmitted with length of 13 bit times (14 if M = 1)
6 RXEDGIF
4 RXINV1 3 RWUID
2 BRK13
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 333
Chapter 14 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV4)
Table 14-7. SCIxS2 Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 1 LBKDE Description LIN Break Detection Enable— LBKDE is used to select a longer break character detection length. While LBKDE is set, framing error (FE) and receive data register full (RDRF) flags are prevented from setting. 0 Break character is detected at length of 10 bit times (11 if M = 1). 1 Break character is detected at length of 11 bit times (12 if M = 1). Receiver Active Flag — RAF is set when the SCI receiver detects the beginning of a valid start bit, and RAF is cleared automatically when the receiver detects an idle line. This status flag can be used to check whether an SCI character is being received before instructing the MCU to go to stop mode. 0 SCI receiver idle waiting for a start bit. 1 SCI receiver active (RxD input not idle).
0 RAF
1
Setting RXINV inverts the RxD input for all cases: data bits, start and stop bits, break, and idle.
When using an internal oscillator in a LIN system, it is necessary to raise the break detection threshold by one bit time. Under the worst case timing conditions allowed in LIN, it is possible that a 0x00 data character can appear to be 10.26 bit times long at a slave which is running 14% faster than the master. This would trigger normal break detection circuitry which is designed to detect a 10 bit break symbol. When the LBKDE bit is set, framing errors are inhibited and the break detection threshold changes from 10 bits to 11 bits, preventing false detection of a 0x00 data character as a LIN break symbol.
14.2.6
SCI Control Register 3 (SCIxC3)
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
R8 T8 0 0 TXDIR 0 TXINV 0 ORIE 0 NEIE 0 FEIE 0 PEIE 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 14-10. SCI Control Register 3 (SCIxC3) Table 14-8. SCIxC3 Field Descriptions
Field 7 R8 Description Ninth Data Bit for Receiver — When the SCI is configured for 9-bit data (M = 1), R8 can be thought of as a ninth receive data bit to the left of the MSB of the buffered data in the SCIxD register. When reading 9-bit data, read R8 before reading SCIxD because reading SCIxD completes automatic flag clearing sequences which could allow R8 and SCIxD to be overwritten with new data. Ninth Data Bit for Transmitter — When the SCI is configured for 9-bit data (M = 1), T8 may be thought of as a ninth transmit data bit to the left of the MSB of the data in the SCIxD register. When writing 9-bit data, the entire 9-bit value is transferred to the SCI shift register after SCIxD is written so T8 should be written (if it needs to change from its previous value) before SCIxD is written. If T8 does not need to change in the new value (such as when it is used to generate mark or space parity), it need not be written each time SCIxD is written. TxD Pin Direction in Single-Wire Mode — When the SCI is configured for single-wire half-duplex operation (LOOPS = RSRC = 1), this bit determines the direction of data at the TxD pin. 0 TxD pin is an input in single-wire mode. 1 TxD pin is an output in single-wire mode.
6 T8
5 TXDIR
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 334 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 14 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV4)
Table 14-8. SCIxC3 Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 4 TXINV1 3 ORIE 2 NEIE 1 FEIE Description Transmit Data Inversion — Setting this bit reverses the polarity of the transmitted data output. 0 Transmit data not inverted 1 Transmit data inverted Overrun Interrupt Enable — This bit enables the overrun flag (OR) to generate hardware interrupt requests. 0 OR interrupts disabled (use polling). 1 Hardware interrupt requested when OR = 1. Noise Error Interrupt Enable — This bit enables the noise flag (NF) to generate hardware interrupt requests. 0 NF interrupts disabled (use polling). 1 Hardware interrupt requested when NF = 1. Framing Error Interrupt Enable — This bit enables the framing error flag (FE) to generate hardware interrupt requests. 0 FE interrupts disabled (use polling). 1 Hardware interrupt requested when FE = 1. Parity Error Interrupt Enable — This bit enables the parity error flag (PF) to generate hardware interrupt requests. 0 PF interrupts disabled (use polling). 1 Hardware interrupt requested when PF = 1.
0 PEIE
1
Setting TXINV inverts the TxD output for all cases: data bits, start and stop bits, break, and idle.
14.2.7
SCI Data Register (SCIxD)
This register is actually two separate registers. Reads return the contents of the read-only receive data buffer and writes go to the write-only transmit data buffer. Reads and writes of this register are also involved in the automatic flag clearing mechanisms for the SCI status flags.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
R7 T7 0
R6 T6 0
R5 T5 0
R4 T4 0
R3 T3 0
R2 T2 0
R1 T1 0
R0 T0 0
Figure 14-11. SCI Data Register (SCIxD)
14.3
Functional Description
The SCI allows full-duplex, asynchronous, NRZ serial communication among the MCU and remote devices, including other MCUs. The SCI comprises a baud rate generator, transmitter, and receiver block. The transmitter and receiver operate independently, although they use the same baud rate generator. During normal operation, the MCU monitors the status of the SCI, writes the data to be transmitted, and processes received data. The following describes each of the blocks of the SCI.
14.3.1
Baud Rate Generation
As shown in Figure 14-12, the clock source for the SCI baud rate generator is the bus-rate clock.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 335
Chapter 14 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV4)
MODULO DIVIDE BY (1 THROUGH 8191) DIVIDE BY 16 Tx BAUD RATE
BUSCLK
SBR12:SBR0 BAUD RATE GENERATOR OFF IF [SBR12:SBR0] = 0
Rx SAMPLING CLOCK (16 × BAUD RATE) BAUD RATE = BUSCLK [SBR12:SBR0] × 16
Figure 14-12. SCI Baud Rate Generation
SCI communications require the transmitter and receiver (which typically derive baud rates from independent clock sources) to use the same baud rate. Allowed tolerance on this baud frequency depends on the details of how the receiver synchronizes to the leading edge of the start bit and how bit sampling is performed. The MCU resynchronizes to bit boundaries on every high-to-low transition, but in the worst case, there are no such transitions in the full 10- or 11-bit time character frame so any mismatch in baud rate is accumulated for the whole character time. For a Freescale Semiconductor SCI system whose bus frequency is driven by a crystal, the allowed baud rate mismatch is about 4.5percent for 8-bit data format and about 4 percent for 9-bit data format. Although baud rate modulo di ider settings do not always v produce baud rates that exactly match standard rates, it is normally possible to get within a few percent, which is acceptable for reliable communications.
14.3.2
Transmitter Functional Description
This section describes the overall block diagram for the SCI transmitter, as well as specialized functions for sending break and idle characters. The transmitter block diagram is shown in Figure 14-2. The transmitter output (TxD) idle state defaults to logic high (TXINV = 0 following reset). The transmitter output is inverted by setting TXINV = 1. The transmitter is enabled by setting the TE bit in SCIxC2. This queues a preamble character that is one full character frame of the idle state. The transmitter then remains idle until data is available in the transmit data buffer. Programs store data into the transmit data buffer by writing to the SCI data register (SCIxD). The central element of the SCI transmitter is the transmit shift register that is either 10 or 11 bits long depending on the setting in the M control bit. For the remainder of this section, we will assume M = 0, selecting the normal 8-bit data mode. In 8-bit data mode, the shift register holds a start bit, eight data bits, and a stop bit. When the transmit shift register is available for a new SCI character, the value waiting in the transmit data register is transferred to the shift register (synchronized with the baud rate clock) and the transmit data register empty (TDRE) status flag is set to indicate another character may be written to the transmit data buffer at SCIxD. If no new character is waiting in the transmit data buffer after a stop bit is shifted out the TxD pin, the transmitter sets the transmit complete flag and enters an idle mode, with TxD high, waiting for more characters to transmit.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 336 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 14 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV4)
Writing 0 to TE does not immediately release the pin to be a general-purpose I/O pin. Any transmit activity that is in progress must first be completed. This includes data characters in progress, queued idle characters, and queued break characters.
14.3.2.1
Send Break and Queued Idle
The SBK control bit in SCIxC2 is used to send break characters which were originally used to gain the attention of old teletype receivers. Break characters are a full character time of logic 0 (10 bit times including the start and stop bits). A longer break of 13 bit times can be enabled by setting BRK13 = 1. Normally, a program would wait for TDRE to become set to indicate the last character of a message has moved to the transmit shifter, then write 1 and then write 0 to the SBK bit. This action queues a break character to be sent as soon as the shifter is available. If SBK is still 1 when the queued break moves into the shifter (synchronized to the baud rate clock), an additional break character is queued. If the receiving device is another Freescale Semiconductor SCI, the break characters will be received as 0s in all eight data bits and a framing error (FE = 1) occurs. When idle-line wakeup is used, a full character time of idle (logic 1) is needed between messages to wake up any sleeping receivers. Normally, a program would wait for TDRE to become set to indicate the last character of a message has moved to the transmit shifter, then write 0 and then write 1 to the TE bit. This action queues an idle character to be sent as soon as the shifter is available. As long as the character in the shifter does not finish while TE = 0, the SCI transmitter never actually releases control of the TxD pin. If there is a possibility of the shifter finishing while TE = 0, set the general-purpose I/O controls so the pin that is shared with TxD is an output driving a logic 1. This ensures that the TxD line will look like a normal idle line even if the SCI loses control of the port pin between writing 0 and then 1 to TE. The length of the break character is affected by the BRK13 and M bits as shown below.
Table 14-9. Break Character Length
BRK13 0 0 1 1 M 0 1 0 1 Break Character Length 10 bit times 11 bit times 13 bit times 14 bit times
14.3.3
Receiver Functional Description
In this section, the receiver block diagram (Figure 14-3) is used as a guide for the overall receiver functional description. Next, the data sampling technique used to reconstruct receiver data is described in more detail. Finally, two variations of the receiver wakeup function are explained. The receiver input is inverted by setting RXINV = 1. The receiver is enabled by setting the RE bit in SCIxC2. Character frames consist of a start bit of logic 0, eight (or nine) data bits (LSB first), and a stop bit of logic 1. For information about 9-bit data mode, refer to Section 14.3.5.1, “8- and 9-Bit Data Modes.” For the remainder of this discussion, we assume the SCI is configured for normal 8-bit data mode. After receiving the stop bit into the receive shifter, and provided the receive data register is not already full, the data character is transferred to the receive data register and the receive data register full (RDRF) status
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 337
Chapter 14 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV4)
flag is set. If RDRF was already set indicating the receive data register (buffer) was already full, the overrun (OR) status flag is set and the new data is lost. Because the SCI receiver is double-buffered, the program has one full character time after RDRF is set before the data in the receive data buffer must be read to avoid a receiver overrun. When a program detects that the receive data register is full (RDRF = 1), it gets the data from the receive data register by reading SCIxD. The RDRF flag is cleared automatically by a 2-step sequence which is normally satisfied in the course of the user’s program that handles receive data. Refer to Section 14.3.4, “Interrupts and Status Flags” for more details about flag clearing.
14.3.3.1
Data Sampling Technique
The SCI receiver uses a 16× baud rate clock for sampling. The receiver starts by taking logic level samples at 16 times the baud rate to search for a falling edge on the RxD serial data input pin. A falling edge is defined as a logic 0 sample after three consecutive logic 1 samples. The 16× baud rate clock is used to divide the bit time into 16 segments labeled RT1 through RT16. When a falling edge is located, three more samples are taken at RT3, RT5, and RT7 to make sure this was a real start bit and not merely noise. If at least two of these three samples are 0, the receiver assumes it is synchronized to a receive character. The receiver then samples each bit time, including the start and stop bits, at RT8, RT9, and RT10 to determine the logic level for that bit. The logic level is interpreted to be that of the majority of the samples taken during the bit time. In the case of the start bit, the bit is assumed to be 0 if at least two of the samples at RT3, RT5, and RT7 are 0 even if one or all of the samples taken at RT8, RT9, and RT10 are 1s. If any sample in any bit time (including the start and stop bits) in a character frame fails to agree with the logic level for that bit, the noise flag (NF) will be set when the received character is transferred to the receive data buffer. The falling edge detection logic continuously looks for falling edges, and if an edge is detected, the sample clock is resynchronized to bit times. This improves the reliability of the receiver in the presence of noise or mismatched baud rates. It does not improve worst case analysis because some characters do not have any extra falling edges anywhere in the character frame. In the case of a framing error, provided the received character was not a break character, the sampling logic that searches for a falling edge is filled with three logic 1 samples so that a new start bit can be detected almost immediately. In the case of a framing error, the receiver is inhibited from receiving any new characters until the framing error flag is cleared. The receive shift register continues to function, but a complete character cannot transfer to the receive data buffer if FE is still set.
14.3.3.2
Receiver Wakeup Operation
Receiver wakeup is a hardware mechanism that allows an SCI receiver to ignore the characters in a message that is intended for a different SCI receiver. In such a system, all receivers evaluate the first character(s) of each message, and as soon as they determine the message is intended for a different receiver, they write logic 1 to the receiver wake up (RWU) control bit in SCIxC2. When RWU bit is set, the status flags associated with the receiver (with the exception of the idle bit, IDLE, when RWUID bit is set) are inhibited from setting, thus eliminating the software overhead for handling the unimportant
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 338 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 14 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV4)
message characters. At the end of a message, or at the beginning of the next message, all receivers automatically force RWU to 0 so all receivers wake up in time to look at the first character(s) of the next message. 14.3.3.2.1 Idle-Line Wakeup
When WAKE = 0, the receiver is configured for idle-line wakeup. In this mode, RWU is cleared automatically when the receiver detects a full character time of the idle-line level. The M control bit selects 8-bit or 9-bit data mode that determines how many bit times of idle are needed to constitute a full character time (10 or 11 bit times because of the start and stop bits). When RWU is one and RWUID is zero, the idle condition that wakes up the receiver does not set the IDLE flag. The receiver wakes up and waits for the first data character of the next message which will set the RDRF flag and generate an interrupt if enabled. When RWUID is one, any idle condition sets the IDLE flag and generates an interrupt if enabled, regardless of whether RWU is zero or one. The idle-line type (ILT) control bit selects one of two ways to detect an idle line. When ILT = 0, the idle bit counter starts after the start bit so the stop bit and any logic 1s at the end of a character count toward the full character time of idle. When ILT = 1, the idle bit counter does not start until after a stop bit time, so the idle detection is not affected by the data in the last character of the previous message. 14.3.3.2.2 Address-Mark Wakeup
When WAKE = 1, the receiver is configured for address-mark wakeup. In this mode, RWU is cleared automatically when the receiver detects a logic 1 in the most significant bit of a received character (eighth bit in M = 0 mode and ninth bit in M = 1 mode). Address-mark wakeup allows messages to contain idle characters but requires that the MSB be reserved for use in address frames. The logic 1 MSB of an address frame clears the RWU bit before the stop bit is received and sets the RDRF flag. In this case the character with the MSB set is received even though the receiver was sleeping during most of this character time.
14.3.4
Interrupts and Status Flags
The SCI system has three separate interrupt vectors to reduce the amount of software needed to isolate the cause of the interrupt. One interrupt vector is associated with the transmitter for TDRE and TC events. Another interrupt vector is associated with the receiver for RDRF, IDLE, RXEDGIF and LBKDIF events, and a third vector is used for OR, NF, FE, and PF error conditions. Each of these ten interrupt sources can be separately masked by local interrupt enable masks. The flags can still be polled by software when the local masks are cleared to disable generation of hardware interrupt requests. The SCI transmitter has two status flags that optionally can generate hardware interrupt requests. Transmit data register empty (TDRE) indicates when there is room in the transmit data buffer to write another transmit character to SCIxD. If the transmit interrupt enable (TIE) bit is set, a hardware interrupt will be requested whenever TDRE = 1. Transmit complete (TC) indicates that the transmitter is finished transmitting all data, preamble, and break characters and is idle with TxD at the inactive level. This flag is often used in systems with modems to determine when it is safe to turn off the modem. If the transmit complete interrupt enable (TCIE) bit is set, a hardware interrupt will be requested whenever TC = 1.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 339
Chapter 14 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV4)
Instead of hardware interrupts, software polling may be used to monitor the TDRE and TC status flags if the corresponding TIE or TCIE local interrupt masks are 0s. When a program detects that the receive data register is full (RDRF = 1), it gets the data from the receive data register by reading SCIxD. The RDRF flag is cleared by reading SCIxS1 while RDRF = 1 and then reading SCIxD. When polling is used, this sequence is naturally satisfied in the normal course of the user program. If hardware interrupts are used, SCIxS1 must be read in the interrupt service routine (ISR). Normally, this is done in the ISR anyway to check for receive errors, so the sequence is automatically satisfied. The IDLE status flag includes logic that prevents it from getting set repeatedly when the RxD line remains idle for an extended period of time. IDLE is cleared by reading SCIxS1 while IDLE = 1 and then reading SCIxD. After IDLE has been cleared, it cannot become set again until the receiver has received at least one new character and has set RDRF. If the associated error was detected in the received character that caused RDRF to be set, the error flags — noise flag (NF), framing error (FE), and parity error flag (PF) — get set at the same time as RDRF. These flags are not set in overrun cases. If RDRF was already set when a new character is ready to be transferred from the receive shifter to the receive data buffer, the overrun (OR) flag gets set instead the data along with any associated NF, FE, or PF condition is lost. At any time, an active edge on the RxD serial data input pin causes the RXEDGIF flag to set. The RXEDGIF flag is cleared by writing a “1” to it. This function does depend on the receiver being enabled (RE = 1).
14.3.5
Additional SCI Functions
The following sections describe additional SCI functions.
14.3.5.1
8- and 9-Bit Data Modes
The SCI system (transmitter and receiver) can be configured to operate in 9-bit data mode by setting the M control bit in SCIxC1. In 9-bit mode, there is a ninth data bit to the left of the MSB of the SCI data register. For the transmit data buffer, this bit is stored in T8 in SCIxC3. For the receiver, the ninth bit is held in R8 in SCIxC3. For coherent writes to the transmit data buffer, write to the T8 bit before writing to SCIxD. If the bit value to be transmitted as the ninth bit of a new character is the same as for the previous character, it is not necessary to write to T8 again. When data is transferred from the transmit data buffer to the transmit shifter, the value in T8 is copied at the same time data is transferred from SCIxD to the shifter. 9-bit data mode typically is used in conjunction with parity to allow eight bits of data plus the parity in the ninth bit. Or it is used with address-mark wakeup so the ninth data bit can serve as the wakeup bit. In custom protocols, the ninth bit can also serve as a software-controlled marker.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 340 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 14 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV4)
14.3.5.2
Stop Mode Operation
During all stop modes, clocks to the SCI module are halted. In stop1 and stop2 modes, all SCI register data is lost and must be re-initialized upon recovery from these two stop modes. No SCI module registers are affected in stop3 mode. The receive input active edge detect circuit is still active in stop3 mode, but not in stop2. . An active edge on the receive input brings the CPU out of stop3 mode if the interrupt is not masked (RXEDGIE = 1). Note, because the clocks are halted, the SCI module will resume operation upon exit from stop (only in stop3 mode). Software should ensure stop mode is not entered while there is a character being transmitted out of or received into the SCI module.
14.3.5.3
Loop Mode
When LOOPS = 1, the RSRC bit in the same register chooses between loop mode (RSRC = 0) or single-wire mode (RSRC = 1). Loop mode is sometimes used to check software, independent of connections in the external system, to help isolate system problems. In this mode, the transmitter output is internally connected to the receiver input and the RxD pin is not used by the SCI, so it reverts to a general-purpose port I/O pin.
14.3.5.4
Single-Wire Operation
When LOOPS = 1, the RSRC bit in the same register chooses between loop mode (RSRC = 0) or single-wire mode (RSRC = 1). Single-wire mode is used to implement a half-duplex serial connection. The receiver is internally connected to the transmitter output and to the TxD pin. The RxD pin is not used and reverts to a general-purpose port I/O pin. In single-wire mode, the TXDIR bit in SCIxC3 controls the direction of serial data on the TxD pin. When TXDIR = 0, the TxD pin is an input to the SCI receiver and the transmitter is temporarily disconnected from the TxD pin so an external device can send serial data to the receiver. When TXDIR = 1, the TxD pin is an output driven by the transmitter. In single-wire mode, the internal loop back connection from the transmitter to the receiver causes the receiver to receive characters that are sent out by the transmitter.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 341
Chapter 14 Serial Communications Interface (S08SCIV4)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 342 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 15 Real-Time Counter (S08RTCV1)
15.1 Introduction
The RTC module consists of one 8-bit counter, one 8-bit comparator, several binary-based and decimal-based prescaler dividers, three clock sources, and one programmable periodic interrupt. This module can be used for time-of-day, calendar or any task scheduling functions. It can also serve as a cyclic wake up from low power modes without the need of external components. All devices in the MC9S08DZ128 Series feature the RTC.
15.1.1
RTC Clock Signal Names
References to ERCLK and IRCLK in this chapter correspond to signals MCGERCLK and MCGIRCLK, respectively.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 343
Chapter 15 Real-Time Counter (S08RTCV1)
HCS08 CORE CPU BKGD/MS BDC BKP DEBUG MODULE (DBG) ANALOG COMPARATOR (ACMP1) ACMP1O ACMP1ACMP1+ PORT A
RESET
HCS08 SYSTEM CONTROL RESETS AND INTERRUPTS MODES OF OPERATION POWER MANAGEMENT IRQ COP INT LVD IRQ VOLTAGE REGULATOR
PTA7/PIA7/ADP7/IRQ PTA6/PIA6/ADP6 PTA5/PIA5/ADP5 PTA4/PIA4/ADP4 PTA3/PIA3/ADP3/ACMP1O PTA2/PIA2/ADP2/ACMP1PTA1/PIA1/ADP1/ACMP1+ PTA0/PIA0/ADP0/MCLK PTB7/PIB7/ADP15 PTB6/PIB6/ADP14 PTB5/PIB5/ADP13 PTB4/PIB4/ADP12 PTB3/PIB3/ADP11 PTB2/PIB2/ADP10 PTB1/PIB1/ADP9 PTB0/PIB0/ADP8
● ● ● ● ● ● ● ●
REAL-TIME COUNTER (RTC)
VDD VSS VREFH VREFL VDDA VSSA
8 24-CHANNEL,12-BIT ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER (ADC) ADP7-ADP0 ADP15-ADP8 ADP23-ADP16
PORT B
USER MEMORY FLASH _EEPROM _RAM MC9S08DZ128 = 128K_2K_8K MC9S08DZ96 = 96K_2K_6K MC9S08DV128 = 128K_0K_6K MC9S08DV96 = 96K_0K_4K PTJ7/PIJ7/TPM3CLK PTJ6/PIJ6 PTJ5/PIJ5 PTJ4/PIJ4 PTJ3/PIJ3/TMP3CH3 PTJ2/PIJ2/TPM3CH2 PTJ1/PIJ1/TPM3CH1 PTJ0/PIJ0/TMP3CH0 PTK7 PTK6 PTK5 PTK4 PTK3 PTK2 PTK1 PTK0 PTL7 PTL6 PTL5 PTL4 PTL3 PTL2 PTL1 PTL0 PTH7 PTH6 PTH5 PTH4 PTH3/MISO2 PTH2/MOSI2 PTH1/SPSCK2 PTH0/SS2 TPM3CLK PORT J TPM3CH0 TPM3CH3 6-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM1) 2-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM2) 4-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM3) CONTROLLER AREA NETWORK (MSCAN) PORT K SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE (SPI1) SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE (SCI1) ANALOG COMPARATOR (ACMP2) IIC MODULE (IIC1) SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE (SCI2) IIC MODULE (IIC2) PORT H MISO2 MOSI2 SPSCK2 SS2 RxCAN TXCAN MISO1 MOSI1 SPSCK1 SS1 RxD1 TxD1 ACMP2O ACMP2ACMP2+ SDA1 SCL1 RxD2 TxD2 SDA2 SCL2 MULTI-PURPOSE CLOCK GENERATOR (MCG) OSCILLATOR (XOSC) XTAL EXTAL TPM1CH5 TPM1CH0 6 TPM1CLK TPM2CH1, TPM2CH0 TPM2CLK
PTC7/ADP23 PTC6/ADP22 PTC5/ADP21 PTC4/ADP20 PTC3/ADP19 PTC2/ADP18 PTC1/ADP17 PTC0/ADP16 PTD7/PID7/TPM1CH5 PTD6/PID6/TPM1CH4 PTD5/PID5/TPM1CH3 PTD4/PID4/TPM1CH2 PTD3/PID3/TPM1CH1 PTD2/PID2/TPM1CH0 PTD1/PID1/TPM2CH1 PTD0/PID0/TPM2CH0 PTE7/RxD2/RXCAN PTE6/TxD2/TXCAN PTE5/SDA1/MISO1 PTE4/SCL1/MOSI1 PTE3/SPSCK1 PTE2/SS1 PTE1/RxD1 PTE0/TxD1
4
PORT E
●
●
PORT D
PORT C
PTF7 PTF6/ACMP2O PTF5/ACMP2PTF4/ACMP2+ PTF3/TPM2CLK/SDA1 PTF2/TPM1CLK/SCL1 PTF1/RxD2 PTF0/TxD2 PTG7/SDA2 PTG6/SCL2 PTG5 PTG4 PTG3 PTG2 PTG1/XTAL PTG0/EXTAL
PORT L
PORT F PORT G
● ● ● ●
SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE (SPI2)
- Pin not connected in 64-pin and 48-pin packages ● - Pin not available in the 48-pin package - In 48-pin package, VDDA and VREFH are internally connected to each other and VSSA and VREFL are internally connected to each other.
Figure 15-1. MC9S08DZ128 Block Diagram with RTC Highlighted
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 344 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 15 Real-Time Counter (S08RTCV1)
15.1.2
Features
Features of the RTC module include: • 8-bit up-counter — 8-bit modulo match limit — Software controllable periodic interrupt on match • Three software selectable clock sources for input to prescaler with selectable binary-based and decimal-based divider values — 1-kHz internal low-power oscillator (LPO) — External clock (ERCLK) — 32-kHz internal clock (IRCLK)
15.1.3
Modes of Operation
This section defines the operation in stop, wait and background debug modes.
15.1.3.1
Wait Mode
The RTC continues to run in wait mode if enabled before executing the appropriate instruction. Therefore, the RTC can bring the MCU out of wait mode if the real-time interrupt is enabled. For lowest possible current consumption, the RTC should be stopped by software if not needed as an interrupt source during wait mode.
15.1.3.2
Stop Modes
The RTC continues to run in stop2 or stop3 mode if the RTC is enabled before executing the STOP instruction. Therefore, the RTC can bring the MCU out of stop modes with no external components, if the real-time interrupt is enabled. The LPO clock can be used in stop2 and stop3 modes. ERCLK and IRCLK clocks are only available in stop3 mode. Power consumption is lower when all clock sources are disabled, but in that case, the real-time interrupt cannot wake up the MCU from stop modes.
15.1.3.3
Active Background Mode
The RTC suspends all counting during active background mode until the microcontroller returns to normal user operating mode. Counting resumes from the suspended value as long as the RTCMOD register is not written and the RTCPS and RTCLKS bits are not altered.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 345
Chapter 15 Real-Time Counter (S08RTCV1)
15.1.4
Block Diagram
The block diagram for the RTC module is shown in Figure 15-2.
LPO ERCLK IRCLK 8-Bit Modulo (RTCMOD)
VDD
Clock Source Select
RTCLKS
Background Mode
RTCLKS[0] RTCPS
D
Q
RTIF
RTC Interrupt Request
8-Bit Comparator
E R
Write 1 to RTIF RTIE
Prescaler Divide-By
RTC Clock
8-Bit Counter (RTCCNT)
Figure 15-2. Real-Time Counter (RTC) Block Diagram
15.2
External Signal Description
The RTC does not include any off-chip signals.
15.3
Register Definition
The RTC includes a status and control register, an 8-bit counter register, and an 8-bit modulo register. Refer to the direct-page register summary in the memory section of this document for the absolute address assignments for all RTC registers.This section refers to registers and control bits only by their names and relative address offsets. Table 15-1 is a summary of RTC registers.
Table 15-1. RTC Register Summary
Name R RTCSC W R RTCCNT W R RTCMOD W RTCMOD RTCCNT RTIF RTCLKS RTIE RTCPS
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 346 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 15 Real-Time Counter (S08RTCV1)
15.3.1
RTC Status and Control Register (RTCSC)
RTCSC contains the real-time interrupt status flag (RTIF), the clock select bits (RTCLKS), the real-time interrupt enable bit (RTIE), and the prescaler select bits (RTCPS).
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R RTIF W Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 RTCLKS RTIE RTCPS
Figure 15-3. RTC Status and Control Register (RTCSC) Table 15-2. RTCSC Field Descriptions
Field 7 RTIF Description Real-Time Interrupt Flag This status bit indicates the RTC counter register reached the value in the RTC modulo register. Writing a logic 0 has no effect. Writing a logic 1 clears the bit and the real-time interrupt request. Reset clears RTIF. 0 RTC counter has not reached the value in the RTC modulo register. 1 RTC counter has reached the value in the RTC modulo register. Real-Time Clock Source Select. These two read/write bits select the clock source input to the RTC prescaler. Changing the clock source clears the prescaler and RTCCNT counters. When selecting a clock source, ensure that the clock source is properly enabled (if applicable) to ensure correct operation of the RTC. Reset clears RTCLKS. 00 Real-time clock source is the 1-kHz low power oscillator (LPO) 01 Real-time clock source is the external clock (ERCLK) 1x Real-time clock source is the internal clock (IRCLK) Real-Time Interrupt Enable. This read/write bit enables real-time interrupts. If RTIE is set, then an interrupt is generated when RTIF is set. Reset clears RTIE. 0 Real-time interrupt requests are disabled. Use software polling. 1 Real-time interrupt requests are enabled. Real-Time Clock Prescaler Select. These four read/write bits select binary-based or decimal-based divide-by values for the clock source. See Table 15-3. Changing the prescaler value clears the prescaler and RTCCNT counters. Reset clears RTCPS.
6–5 RTCLKS
4 RTIE
3–0 RTCPS
Table 15-3. RTC Prescaler Divide-by values
RTCPS RTCLKS[0] 0 0 1 Off Off 1 23 210 2 25 211 3 26 212 4 27 213 5 28 214 6 29 215 7 210 216 8 1 103 9 2 10 22 11 10 104 12 24 13 102 14 5x102 105 15 103 2x105
2x103 5x103
2x104 5x104
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 347
Chapter 15 Real-Time Counter (S08RTCV1)
15.3.2
RTC Counter Register (RTCCNT)
RTCCNT is the read-only value of the current RTC count of the 8-bit counter.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset: 0 0 0 0
RTCCNT
0
0
0
0
Figure 15-4. RTC Counter Register (RTCCNT) Table 15-4. RTCCNT Field Descriptions
Field 7:0 RTCCNT Description RTC Count. These eight read-only bits contain the current value of the 8-bit counter. Writes have no effect to this register. Reset, writing to RTCMOD, or writing different values to RTCLKS and RTCPS clear the count to 0x00.
15.3.3
RTC Modulo Register (RTCMOD)
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R RTCMOD W Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Figure 15-5. RTC Modulo Register (RTCMOD) Table 15-5. RTCMOD Field Descriptions
Field Description
7:0 RTC Modulo. These eight read/write bits contain the modulo value used to reset the count to 0x00 upon a compare RTCMOD match and set the RTIF status bit. A value of 0x00 sets the RTIF bit on each rising edge of the prescaler output. Writing to RTCMOD resets the prescaler and the RTCCNT counters to 0x00. Reset sets the modulo to 0x00.
15.4
Functional Description
The RTC is composed of a main 8-bit up-counter with an 8-bit modulo register, a clock source selector, and a prescaler block with binary-based and decimal-based selectable values. The module also contains software selectable interrupt logic. After any MCU reset, the counter is stopped and reset to 0x00, the modulus register is set to 0x00, and the prescaler is off. The 1-kHz internal oscillator clock is selected as the default clock source. To start the prescaler, write any value other than zero to the prescaler select bits (RTCPS). Three clock sources are software selectable: the low power oscillator clock (LPO), the external clock (ERCLK), and the internal clock (IRCLK). The RTC clock select bits (RTCLKS) select the desired clock source. If a different value is written to RTCLKS, the prescaler and RTCCNT counters are reset to 0x00.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 348 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 15 Real-Time Counter (S08RTCV1)
RTCPS and the RTCLKS[0] bit select the desired divide-by value. If a different value is written to RTCPS, the prescaler and RTCCNT counters are reset to 0x00. Table 15-6 shows different prescaler period values.
Table 15-6. Prescaler Period
RTCPS 0000 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 0110 0111 1000 1001 1010 1011 1100 1101 1110 1111 1-kHz Internal Clock (RTCLKS = 00) Off 8 ms 32 ms 64 ms 128 ms 256 ms 512 ms 1.024 s 1 ms 2 ms 4 ms 10 ms 16 ms 0.1 s 0.5 s 1s 1-MHz External Clock 32-kHz Internal Clock 32-kHz Internal Clock (RTCLKS = 01) (RTCLKS = 10) (RTCLKS = 11) Off 1.024 ms 2.048 ms 4.096 ms 8.192 ms 16.4 ms 32.8 ms 65.5 ms 1 ms 2 ms 5 ms 10 ms 20 ms 50 ms 0.1 s 0.2 s Off 250 μs 1 ms 2 ms 4 ms 8 ms 16 ms 32 ms 31.25 μs 62.5 μs 125 μs 312.5 μs 0.5 ms 3.125 ms 15.625 ms 31.25 ms Off 32 ms 64 ms 128 ms 256 ms 512 ms 1.024 s 2.048 s 31.25 ms 62.5 ms 156.25 ms 312.5 ms 0.625 s 1.5625 s 3.125 s 6.25 s
The RTC modulo register (RTCMOD) allows the compare value to be set to any value from 0x00 to 0xFF. When the counter is active, the counter increments at the selected rate until the count matches the modulo value. When these values match, the counter resets to 0x00 and continues counting. The real-time interrupt flag (RTIF) is set when a match occurs. The flag sets on the transition from the modulo value to 0x00. Writing to RTCMOD resets the prescaler and the RTCCNT counters to 0x00. The RTC allows for an interrupt to be generated when RTIF is set. To enable the real-time interrupt, set the real-time interrupt enable bit (RTIE) in RTCSC. RTIF is cleared by writing a 1 to RTIF.
15.4.1
RTC Operation Example
This section shows an example of the RTC operation as the counter reaches a matching value from the modulo register.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 349
Chapter 15 Real-Time Counter (S08RTCV1)
Internal 1-kHz Clock Source RTC Clock (RTCPS = 0xA) RTCCNT 0x52 0x53 0x54 0x55 0x00 0x01
RTIF
RTCMOD
0x55
Figure 15-6. RTC Counter Overflow Example
In the example of Figure 15-6, the selected clock source is the 1-kHz internal oscillator clock source. The prescaler (RTCPS) is set to 0xA or divide-by-4. The modulo value in the RTCMOD register is set to 0x55. When the counter, RTCCNT, reaches the modulo value of 0x55, the counter overflows to 0x00 and continues counting. The real-time interrupt flag, RTIF, sets when the counter value changes from 0x55 to 0x00. A real-time interrupt is generated when RTIF is set, if RTIE is set.
15.5
Initialization/Application Information
This section provides example code to give some basic direction to a user on how to initialize and configure the RTC module. The example software is implemented in C language. The example below shows how to implement time of day with the RTC using the 1-kHz clock source to achieve the lowest possible power consumption. Because the 1-kHz clock source is not as accurate as a crystal, software can be added for any adjustments. For accuracy without adjustments at the expense of additional power consumption, the external clock (ERCLK) or the internal clock (IRCLK) can be selected with appropriate prescaler and modulo values.
/* Initialize the elapsed time counters */ Seconds = 0; Minutes = 0; Hours = 0; Days=0; /* Configure RTC to interrupt every 1 second from 1-kHz clock source */ RTCMOD.byte = 0x00; RTCSC.byte = 0x1F; /********************************************************************** Function Name : RTC_ISR Notes : Interrupt service routine for RTC module. **********************************************************************/
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 350 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 15 Real-Time Counter (S08RTCV1)
#pragma TRAP_PROC void RTC_ISR(void) { /* Clear the interrupt flag */ RTCSC.byte = RTCSC.byte | 0x80; /* RTC interrupts every 1 Second */ Seconds++; /* 60 seconds in a minute */ if (Seconds > 59){ Minutes++; Seconds = 0; } /* 60 minutes in an hour */ if (Minutes > 59){ Hours++; Minutes = 0; } /* 24 hours in a day */ if (Hours > 23){ Days ++; Hours = 0; }
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 351
Chapter 15 Real-Time Counter (S08RTCV1)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 352 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 16 Timer Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV3)
16.1 Introduction
The TPM uses one input/output (I/O) pin per channel, TPMxCHn, where x is the TPM number (for example, 1 or 2) and n is the channel number (for example, 0–4). The TPM shares its I/O pins with general-purpose I/O port pins (refer to the Pins and Connections chapter for more information). NOTE MC9S08DZ128 Series MCUs have three TPM modules. TPM3 channels are not bonded out in the 64-pin and 48-pin packages.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 353
Chapter 16 Timer Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV3) HCS08 CORE CPU BKGD/MS BDC BKP DEBUG MODULE (DBG) ANALOG COMPARATOR (ACMP1) ACMP1O ACMP1ACMP1+ PORT A PTA7/PIA7/ADP7/IRQ PTA6/PIA6/ADP6 PTA5/PIA5/ADP5 PTA4/PIA4/ADP4 PTA3/PIA3/ADP3/ACMP1O PTA2/PIA2/ADP2/ACMP1PTA1/PIA1/ADP1/ACMP1+ PTA0/PIA0/ADP0/MCLK PTB7/PIB7/ADP15 PTB6/PIB6/ADP14 PTB5/PIB5/ADP13 PTB4/PIB4/ADP12 PTB3/PIB3/ADP11 PTB2/PIB2/ADP10 PTB1/PIB1/ADP9 PTB0/PIB0/ADP8
● ● ● ● ● ● ● ●
RESET
HCS08 SYSTEM CONTROL RESETS AND INTERRUPTS MODES OF OPERATION POWER MANAGEMENT IRQ COP INT LVD IRQ VOLTAGE REGULATOR
REAL-TIME COUNTER (RTC)
VDD VSS VREFH VREFL VDDA VSSA
8 24-CHANNEL,12-BIT ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER (ADC) ADP7-ADP0 ADP15-ADP8 ADP23-ADP16
PORT B
USER MEMORY FLASH _EEPROM _RAM MC9S08DZ128 = 128K_2K_8K MC9S08DZ96 = 96K_2K_6K MC9S08DV128 = 128K_0K_6K MC9S08DV96 = 96K_0K_4K PTJ7/PIJ7/TPM3CLK PTJ6/PIJ6 PTJ5/PIJ5 PTJ4/PIJ4 PTJ3/PIJ3/TMP3CH3 PTJ2/PIJ2/TPM3CH2 PTJ1/PIJ1/TPM3CH1 PTJ0/PIJ0/TMP3CH0 PTK7 PTK6 PTK5 PTK4 PTK3 PTK2 PTK1 PTK0 PTL7 PTL6 PTL5 PTL4 PTL3 PTL2 PTL1 PTL0 PTH7 PTH6 PTH5 PTH4 PTH3/MISO2 PTH2/MOSI2 PTH1/SPSCK2 PTH0/SS2 TPM3CLK PORT J TPM3CH0 TPM3CH3 6-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM1) 2-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM2) 4-CHANNEL TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM3) CONTROLLER AREA NETWORK (MSCAN) PORT K SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE (SPI1) SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE (SCI1) ANALOG COMPARATOR (ACMP2) IIC MODULE (IIC1) SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE (SCI2) IIC MODULE (IIC2) PORT H MISO2 MOSI2 SPSCK2 SS2 RxCAN TXCAN MISO1 MOSI1 SPSCK1 SS1 RxD1 TxD1 ACMP2O ACMP2ACMP2+ SDA1 SCL1 RxD2 TxD2 SDA2 SCL2 MULTI-PURPOSE CLOCK GENERATOR (MCG) OSCILLATOR (XOSC) XTAL EXTAL TPM1CH5 TPM1CH0 6 TPM1CLK TPM2CH1, TPM2CH0 TPM2CLK
PTC7/ADP23 PTC6/ADP22 PTC5/ADP21 PTC4/ADP20 PTC3/ADP19 PTC2/ADP18 PTC1/ADP17 PTC0/ADP16 PTD7/PID7/TPM1CH5 PTD6/PID6/TPM1CH4 PTD5/PID5/TPM1CH3 PTD4/PID4/TPM1CH2 PTD3/PID3/TPM1CH1 PTD2/PID2/TPM1CH0 PTD1/PID1/TPM2CH1 PTD0/PID0/TPM2CH0 PTE7/RxD2/RXCAN PTE6/TxD2/TXCAN PTE5/SDA1/MISO1 PTE4/SCL1/MOSI1 PTE3/SPSCK1 PTE2/SS1 PTE1/RxD1 PTE0/TxD1
4
PORT E
●
●
PORT D
PORT C
PTF7 PTF6/ACMP2O PTF5/ACMP2PTF4/ACMP2+ PTF3/TPM2CLK/SDA1 PTF2/TPM1CLK/SCL1 PTF1/RxD2 PTF0/TxD2 PTG7/SDA2 PTG6/SCL2 PTG5 PTG4 PTG3 PTG2 PTG1/XTAL PTG0/EXTAL
PORT L
PORT F PORT G
● ● ● ●
SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE (SPI2)
- Pin not connected in 64-pin and 48-pin packages ● - Pin not available in the 48-pin package - In 48-pin package, VDDA and VREFH are internally connected to each other and VSSA and VREFL are internally connected to each other.
Figure 16-1. MC9S08DZ128 Block Diagram with TPM Highlighted
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 354 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
16.1.1
Features
The TPM includes these distinctive features: • One to eight channels: — Each channel may be input capture, output compare, or edge-aligned PWM — Rising-Edge, falling-edge, or any-edge input capture trigger — Set, clear, or toggle output compare action — Selectable polarity on PWM outputs • Module may be configured for buffered, center-aligned pulse-width-modulation (CPWM) on all channels • Timer clock source selectable as prescaled bus clock, fixed system clock, or an external clock pin — Prescale taps for divide-by 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, or 128 — Fixed system clock source are synchronized to the bus clock by an on-chip synchronization circuit — External clock pin may be shared with any timer channel pin or a separated input pin • 16-bit free-running or modulo up/down count operation • Timer system enable • One interrupt per channel plus terminal count interrupt
16.1.2
Modes of Operation
In general, TPM channels may be independently configured to operate in input capture, output compare, or edge-aligned PWM modes. A control bit allows the whole TPM (all channels) to switch to center-aligned PWM mode. When center-aligned PWM mode is selected, input capture, output compare, and edge-aligned PWM functions are not available on any channels of this TPM module. When the microcontroller is in active BDM background or BDM foreground mode, the TPM temporarily suspends all counting until the microcontroller returns to normal user operating mode. During stop mode, all system clocks, including the main oscillator, are stopped; therefore, the TPM is effectively disabled until clocks resume. During wait mode, the TPM continues to operate normally. Provided the TPM does not need to produce a real time reference or provide the interrupt source(s) needed to wake the MCU from wait mode, the user can save power by disabling TPM functions before entering wait mode. • Input capture mode When a selected edge event occurs on the associated MCU pin, the current value of the 16-bit timer counter is captured into the channel value register and an interrupt flag bit is set. Rising edges, falling edges, any edge, or no edge (disable channel) may be selected as the active edge which triggers the input capture. • Output compare mode When the value in the timer counter register matches the channel value register, an interrupt flag bit is set, and a selected output action is forced on the associated MCU pin. The output compare action may be selected to force the pin to zero, force the pin to one, toggle the pin, or ignore the pin (used for software timing functions).
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 355
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
•
•
Edge-aligned PWM mode The value of a 16-bit modulo register plus 1 sets the period of the PWM output signal. The channel value register sets the duty cycle of the PWM output signal. The user may also choose the polarity of the PWM output signal. Interrupts are available at the end of the period and at the duty-cycle transition point. This type of PWM signal is called edge-aligned because the leading edges of all PWM signals are aligned with the beginning of the period, which is the same for all channels within a TPM. Center-aligned PWM mode Twice the value of a 16-bit modulo register sets the period of the PWM output, and the channel-value register sets the half-duty-cycle duration. The timer counter counts up until it reaches the modulo value and then counts down until it reaches zero. As the count matches the channel value register while counting down, the PWM output becomes active. When the count matches the channel value register while counting up, the PWM output becomes inactive. This type of PWM signal is called center-aligned because the centers of the active duty cycle periods for all channels are aligned with a count value of zero. This type of PWM is required for types of motors used in small appliances.
This is a high-level description only. Detailed descriptions of operating modes are in later sections.
16.1.3
Block Diagram
The TPM uses one input/output (I/O) pin per channel, TPMxCHn (timer channel n) where n is the channel number (1-8). The TPM shares its I/O pins with general purpose I/O port pins (refer to I/O pin descriptions in full-chip specification for the specific chip implementation). Figure 16-2 shows the TPM structure. The central component of the TPM is the 16-bit counter that can operate as a free-running counter or a modulo up/down counter. The TPM counter (when operating in normal up-counting mode) provides the timing reference for the input capture, output compare, and edge-aligned PWM functions. The timer counter modulo registers, TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL, control the modulo value of the counter (the values 0x0000 or 0xFFFF effectively make the counter free running). Software can read the counter value at any time without affecting the counting sequence. Any write to either half of the TPMxCNT counter resets the counter, regardless of the data value written.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 356 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
BUS CLOCK FIXED SYSTEM CLOCK EXTERNAL CLOCK
SYNC
CLOCK SOURCE SELECT OFF, BUS, FIXED SYSTEM CLOCK, EXT
PRESCALE AND SELECT 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, or 128
CLKSB:CLKSA CPWMS 16-BIT COUNTER COUNTER RESET 16-BIT COMPARATOR TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL ELS0B ELS0A
PS2:PS1:PS0
TOF TOIE
INTERRUPT LOGIC
CHANNEL 0 16-BIT COMPARATOR TPMxC0VH:TPMxC0VL 16-BIT LATCH
PORT LOGIC CH0F INTERRUPT LOGIC
TPMxCH0
MS0B
MS0A
CH0IE
INTERNAL BUS
CHANNEL 1 16-BIT COMPARATOR TPMxC1VH:TPMxC1VL 16-BIT LATCH
ELS1B
ELS1A
PORT LOGIC CH1F INTERRUPT LOGIC
TPMxCH1
MS1B
MS1A
CH1IE
Up to 8 channels
CHANNEL 7 16-BIT COMPARATOR TPMxC7VH:TPMxC7VL 16-BIT LATCH
ELS7B
ELS7A
PORT LOGIC CH7F INTERRUPT LOGIC
TPMxCH7
MS7B
MS7A
CH7IE
Figure 16-2. TPM Block Diagram
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 357
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
The TPM channels are programmable independently as input capture, output compare, or edge-aligned PWM channels. Alternately, the TPM can be configured to produce CPWM outputs on all channels. When the TPM is configured for CPWMs, the counter operates as an up/down counter; input capture, output compare, and EPWM functions are not practical. If a channel is configured as input capture, an internal pullup device may be enabled for that channel. The details of how a module interacts with pin controls depends upon the chip implementation because the I/O pins and associated general purpose I/O controls are not part of the module. Refer to the discussion of the I/O port logic in a full-chip specification. Because center-aligned PWMs are usually used to drive 3-phase AC-induction motors and brushless DC motors, they are typically used in sets of three or six channels.
16.2
Signal Description
Table 16-1 shows the user-accessible signals for the TPM. The number of channels may be varied from one to eight. When an external clock is included, it can be shared with the same pin as any TPM channel; however, it could be connected to a separate input pin. Refer to the I/O pin descriptions in full-chip specification for the specific chip implementation.
Table 16-1. Signal Properties
Name EXTCLK1 TPMxCHn
1 2
Function External clock source which may be selected to drive the TPM counter. I/O pin associated with TPM channel n
When preset, this signal can share any channel pin; however depending upon full-chip implementation, this signal could be connected to a separate external pin. 2 n=channel number (1 to 8)
Refer to documentation for the full-chip for details about reset states, port connections, and whether there is any pullup device on these pins. TPM channel pins can be associated with general purpose I/O pins and have passive pullup devices which can be enabled with a control bit when the TPM or general purpose I/O controls have configured the associated pin as an input. When no TPM function is enabled to use a corresponding pin, the pin reverts to being controlled by general purpose I/O controls, including the port-data and data-direction registers. Immediately after reset, no TPM functions are enabled, so all associated pins revert to general purpose I/O control.
16.2.1
Detailed Signal Descriptions
This section describes each user-accessible pin signal in detail. Although Table 16-1 grouped all channel pins together, any TPM pin can be shared with the external clock source signal. Since I/O pin logic is not part of the TPM, refer to full-chip documentation for a specific derivative for more details about the interaction of TPM pin functions and general purpose I/O controls including port data, data direction, and pullup controls.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 358 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
16.2.1.1
EXTCLK — External Clock Source
Control bits in the timer status and control register allow the user to select nothing (timer disable), the bus-rate clock (the normal default source), a crystal-related clock, or an external clock as the clock which drives the TPM prescaler and subsequently the 16-bit TPM counter. The external clock source is synchronized in the TPM. The bus clock clocks the synchronizer; the frequency of the external source must be no more than one-fourth the frequency of the bus-rate clock, to meet Nyquist criteria and allowing for jitter. The external clock signal shares the same pin as a channel I/O pin, so the channel pin will not be usable for channel I/O function when selected as the external clock source. It is the user’s responsibility to avoid such settings. If this pin is used as an external clock source (CLKSB:CLKSA = 1:1), the channel can still be used in output compare mode as a software timer (ELSnB:ELSnA = 0:0).
16.2.1.2
TPMxCHn — TPM Channel n I/O Pin(s)
Each TPM channel is associated with an I/O pin on the MCU. The function of this pin depends on the channel configuration. The TPM pins share with general purpose I/O pins, where each pin has a port data register bit, and a data direction control bit, and the port has optional passive pullups which may be enabled whenever a port pin is acting as an input. The TPM channel does not control the I/O pin when (ELSnB:ELSnA = 0:0) or when (CLKSB:CLKSA = 0:0) so it normally reverts to general purpose I/O control. When CPWMS = 1 (and ELSnB:ELSnA not = 0:0), all channels within the TPM are configured for center-aligned PWM and the TPMxCHn pins are all controlled by the TPM system. When CPWMS=0, the MSnB:MSnA control bits determine whether the channel is configured for input capture, output compare, or edge-aligned PWM. When a channel is configured for input capture (CPWMS=0, MSnB:MSnA = 0:0 and ELSnB:ELSnA not = 0:0), the TPMxCHn pin is forced to act as an edge-sensitive input to the TPM. ELSnB:ELSnA control bits determine what polarity edge or edges will trigger input-capture events. A synchronizer based on the bus clock is used to synchronize input edges to the bus clock. This implies the minimum pulse width—that can be reliably detected—on an input capture pin is four bus clock periods (with ideal clock pulses as near as two bus clocks can be detected). TPM uses this pin as an input capture input to override the port data and data direction controls for the same pin. When a channel is configured for output compare (CPWMS=0, MSnB:MSnA = 0:1 and ELSnB:ELSnA not = 0:0), the associated data direction control is overridden, the TPMxCHn pin is considered an output controlled by the TPM, and the ELSnB:ELSnA control bits determine how the pin is controlled. The remaining three combinations of ELSnB:ELSnA determine whether the TPMxCHn pin is toggled, cleared, or set each time the 16-bit channel value register matches the timer counter. When the output compare toggle mode is initially selected, the previous value on the pin is driven out until the next output compare event—then the pin is toggled.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 359
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
When a channel is configured for edge-aligned PWM (CPWMS=0, MSnB=1 and ELSnB:ELSnA not = 0:0), the data direction is overridden, the TPMxCHn pin is forced to be an output controlled by the TPM, and ELSnA controls the polarity of the PWM output signal on the pin. When ELSnB:ELSnA=1:0, the TPMxCHn pin is forced high at the start of each new period (TPMxCNT=0x0000), and the pin is forced low when the channel value register matches the timer counter. When ELSnA=1, the TPMxCHn pin is forced low at the start of each new period (TPMxCNT=0x0000), and the pin is forced high when the channel value register matches the timer counter.
TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL = 0x0008 TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL = 0x0005
TPMxCNTH:TPMxCNTL TPMxCHn CHnF BIT TOF BIT
...
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
0
1
2
...
Figure 16-3. High-True Pulse of an Edge-Aligned PWM
TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL = 0x0008 TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL = 0x0005
TPMxCNTH:TPMxCNTL TPMxCHn CHnF BIT TOF BIT
...
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
0
1
2
...
Figure 16-4. Low-True Pulse of an Edge-Aligned PWM
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 360 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
When the TPM is configured for center-aligned PWM (and ELSnB:ELSnA not = 0:0), the data direction for all channels in this TPM are overridden, the TPMxCHn pins are forced to be outputs controlled by the TPM, and the ELSnA bits control the polarity of each TPMxCHn output. If ELSnB:ELSnA=1:0, the corresponding TPMxCHn pin is cleared when the timer counter is counting up, and the channel value register matches the timer counter; the TPMxCHn pin is set when the timer counter is counting down, and the channel value register matches the timer counter. If ELSnA=1, the corresponding TPMxCHn pin is set when the timer counter is counting up and the channel value register matches the timer counter; the TPMxCHn pin is cleared when the timer counter is counting down and the channel value register matches the timer counter.
TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL = 0x0008 TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL = 0x0005
TPMxCNTH:TPMxCNTL TPMxCHn CHnF BIT TOF BIT
...
7
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
7
6
5
...
Figure 16-5. High-True Pulse of a Center-Aligned PWM
TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL = 0x0008 TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL = 0x0005
TPMxCNTH:TPMxCNTL TPMxCHn CHnF BIT TOF BIT
...
7
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
7
6
5
...
Figure 16-6. Low-True Pulse of a Center-Aligned PWM
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 361
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
16.3
Register Definition
This section consists of register descriptions in address order. A typical MCU system may contain multiple TPMs, and each TPM may have one to eight channels, so register names include placeholder characters to identify which TPM and which channel is being referenced. For example, TPMxCnSC refers to timer (TPM) x, channel n. TPM1C2SC would be the status and control register for channel 2 of timer 1.
16.3.1
TPM Status and Control Register (TPMxSC)
TPMxSC contains the overflow status flag and control bits used to configure the interrupt enable, TPM configuration, clock source, and prescale factor. These controls relate to all channels within this timer module.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
TOF TOIE 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 CPWMS CLKSB CLKSA PS2 PS1 PS0
Figure 16-7. TPM Status and Control Register (TPMxSC) Table 16-2. TPMxSC Field Descriptions
Field 7 TOF Description Timer overflow flag. This read/write flag is set when the TPM counter resets to 0x0000 after reaching the modulo value programmed in the TPM counter modulo registers. Clear TOF by reading the TPM status and control register when TOF is set and then writing a logic 0 to TOF. If another TPM overflow occurs before the clearing sequence is complete, the sequence is reset so TOF would remain set after the clear sequence was completed for the earlier TOF. This is done so a TOF interrupt request cannot be lost during the clearing sequence for a previous TOF. Reset clears TOF. Writing a logic 1 to TOF has no effect. 0 TPM counter has not reached modulo value or overflow 1 TPM counter has overflowed Timer overflow interrupt enable. This read/write bit enables TPM overflow interrupts. If TOIE is set, an interrupt is generated when TOF equals one. Reset clears TOIE. 0 TOF interrupts inhibited (use for software polling) 1 TOF interrupts enabled Center-aligned PWM select. When present, this read/write bit selects CPWM operating mode. By default, the TPM operates in up-counting mode for input capture, output compare, and edge-aligned PWM functions. Setting CPWMS reconfigures the TPM to operate in up/down counting mode for CPWM functions. Reset clears CPWMS. 0 All channels operate as input capture, output compare, or edge-aligned PWM mode as selected by the MSnB:MSnA control bits in each channel’s status and control register. 1 All channels operate in center-aligned PWM mode.
6 TOIE
5 CPWMS
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 362 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
Table 16-2. TPMxSC Field Descriptions (continued)
Field Description
4–3 Clock source selects. As shown in Table 16-3, this 2-bit field is used to disable the TPM system or select one of CLKS[B:A] three clock sources to drive the counter prescaler. The fixed system clock source is only meaningful in systems with a PLL-based or FLL-based system clock. When there is no PLL or FLL, the fixed-system clock source is the same as the bus rate clock. The external source is synchronized to the bus clock by TPM module, and the fixed system clock source (when a PLL or FLL is present) is synchronized to the bus clock by an on-chip synchronization circuit. When a PLL or FLL is present but not enabled, the fixed-system clock source is the same as the bus-rate clock. 2–0 PS[2:0] Prescale factor select. This 3-bit field selects one of 8 division factors for the TPM clock input as shown in Table 16-4. This prescaler is located after any clock source synchronization or clock source selection so it affects the clock source selected to drive the TPM system. The new prescale factor will affect the clock source on the next system clock cycle after the new value is updated into the register bits.
Table 16-3. TPM-Clock-Source Selection
CLKSB:CLKSA 00 01 10 11 TPM Clock Source to Prescaler Input No clock selected (TPM counter disable) Bus rate clock Fixed system clock External source
Table 16-4. Prescale Factor Selection
PS2:PS1:PS0 000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 TPM Clock Source Divided-by 1 2 4 8 16 32 64 128
16.3.2
TPM-Counter Registers (TPMxCNTH:TPMxCNTL)
The two read-only TPM counter registers contain the high and low bytes of the value in the TPM counter. Reading either byte (TPMxCNTH or TPMxCNTL) latches the contents of both bytes into a buffer where they remain latched until the other half is read. This allows coherent 16-bit reads in either big-endian or little-endian order which makes this more friendly to various compiler implementations. The coherency mechanism is automatically restarted by an MCU reset or any write to the timer status/control register (TPMxSC).
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 363
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
Reset clears the TPM counter registers. Writing any value to TPMxCNTH or TPMxCNTL also clears the TPM counter (TPMxCNTH:TPMxCNTL) and resets the coherency mechanism, regardless of the data involved in the write.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
Any write to TPMxCNTH clears the 16-bit counter 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Figure 16-8. TPM Counter Register High (TPMxCNTH)
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Any write to TPMxCNTL clears the 16-bit counter 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Figure 16-9. TPM Counter Register Low (TPMxCNTL)
When BDM is active, the timer counter is frozen (this is the value that will be read by user); the coherency mechanism is frozen such that the buffer latches remain in the state they were in when the BDM became active, even if one or both counter halves are read while BDM is active. This assures that if the user was in the middle of reading a 16-bit register when BDM became active, it will read the appropriate value from the other half of the 16-bit value after returning to normal execution. In BDM mode, writing any value to TPMxSC, TPMxCNTH or TPMxCNTL registers resets the read coherency mechanism of the TPMxCNTH:L registers, regardless of the data involved in the write.
16.3.3
TPM Counter Modulo Registers (TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL)
The read/write TPM modulo registers contain the modulo value for the TPM counter. After the TPM counter reaches the modulo value, the TPM counter resumes counting from 0x0000 at the next clock, and the overflow flag (TOF) becomes set. Writing to TPMxMODH or TPMxMODL inhibits the TOF bit and overflow interrupts until the other byte is written. Reset sets the TPM counter modulo registers to 0x0000 which results in a free running timer counter (modulo disabled). Writing to either byte (TPMxMODH or TPMxMODL) latches the value into a buffer and the registers are updated with the value of their write buffer according to the value of CLKSB:CLKSA bits, so: • If (CLKSB:CLKSA = 0:0), then the registers are updated when the second byte is written • If (CLKSB:CLKSA not = 0:0), then the registers are updated after both bytes were written, and the TPM counter changes from (TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL - 1) to (TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL). If the TPM counter is a free-running counter, the update is made when the TPM counter changes from 0xFFFE to 0xFFFF The latching mechanism may be manually reset by writing to the TPMxSC address (whether BDM is active or not).
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 364 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
When BDM is active, the coherency mechanism is frozen (unless reset by writing to TPMxSC register) such that the buffer latches remain in the state they were in when the BDM became active, even if one or both halves of the modulo register are written while BDM is active. Any write to the modulo registers bypasses the buffer latches and directly writes to the modulo register while BDM is active.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 15 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8
Figure 16-10. TPM Counter Modulo Register High (TPMxMODH)
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
Figure 16-11. TPM Counter Modulo Register Low (TPMxMODL)
Reset the TPM counter before writing to the TPM modulo registers to avoid confusion about when the first counter overflow will occur.
16.3.4
TPM Channel n Status and Control Register (TPMxCnSC)
TPMxCnSC contains the channel-interrupt-status flag and control bits used to configure the interrupt enable, channel configuration, and pin function.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
CHnF CHnIE 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 MSnB MSnA ELSnB ELSnA
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 16-12. TPM Channel n Status and Control Register (TPMxCnSC)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 365
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
Table 16-5. TPMxCnSC Field Descriptions
Field 7 CHnF Description Channel n flag. When channel n is an input-capture channel, this read/write bit is set when an active edge occurs on the channel n pin. When channel n is an output compare or edge-aligned/center-aligned PWM channel, CHnF is set when the value in the TPM counter registers matches the value in the TPM channel n value registers. When channel n is an edge-aligned/center-aligned PWM channel and the duty cycle is set to 0% or 100%, CHnF will not be set even when the value in the TPM counter registers matches the value in the TPM channel n value registers. A corresponding interrupt is requested when CHnF is set and interrupts are enabled (CHnIE = 1). Clear CHnF by reading TPMxCnSC while CHnF is set and then writing a logic 0 to CHnF. If another interrupt request occurs before the clearing sequence is complete, the sequence is reset so CHnF remains set after the clear sequence completed for the earlier CHnF. This is done so a CHnF interrupt request cannot be lost due to clearing a previous CHnF. Reset clears the CHnF bit. Writing a logic 1 to CHnF has no effect. 0 No input capture or output compare event occurred on channel n 1 Input capture or output compare event on channel n Channel n interrupt enable. This read/write bit enables interrupts from channel n. Reset clears CHnIE. 0 Channel n interrupt requests disabled (use for software polling) 1 Channel n interrupt requests enabled Mode select B for TPM channel n. When CPWMS=0, MSnB=1 configures TPM channel n for edge-aligned PWM mode. Refer to the summary of channel mode and setup controls in Table 16-6. Mode select A for TPM channel n. When CPWMS=0 and MSnB=0, MSnA configures TPM channel n for input-capture mode or output compare mode. Refer to Table 16-6 for a summary of channel mode and setup controls. Note: If the associated port pin is not stable for at least two bus clock cycles before changing to input capture mode, it is possible to get an unexpected indication of an edge trigger. Edge/level select bits. Depending upon the operating mode for the timer channel as set by CPWMS:MSnB:MSnA and shown in Table 16-6, these bits select the polarity of the input edge that triggers an input capture event, select the level that will be driven in response to an output compare match, or select the polarity of the PWM output. Setting ELSnB:ELSnA to 0:0 configures the related timer pin as a general purpose I/O pin not related to any timer functions. This function is typically used to temporarily disable an input capture channel or to make the timer pin available as a general purpose I/O pin when the associated timer channel is set up as a software timer that does not require the use of a pin.
6 CHnIE 5 MSnB 4 MSnA
3–2 ELSnB ELSnA
Table 16-6. Mode, Edge, and Level Selection
CPWMS X MSnB:MSnA XX ELSnB:ELSnA 00 Mode Configuration
Pin not used for TPM - revert to general purpose I/O or other peripheral control
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 366 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
Table 16-6. Mode, Edge, and Level Selection
CPWMS 0 MSnB:MSnA 00 ELSnB:ELSnA 01 10 11 01 01 10 11 1X 10 X1 1 XX 10 X1 Center-aligned PWM Edge-aligned PWM Output compare Mode Input capture Configuration Capture on rising edge only Capture on falling edge only Capture on rising or falling edge Toggle output on compare Clear output on compare Set output on compare High-true pulses (clear output on compare) Low-true pulses (set output on compare) High-true pulses (clear output on compare-up) Low-true pulses (set output on compare-up)
16.3.5
TPM Channel Value Registers (TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL)
These read/write registers contain the captured TPM counter value of the input capture function or the output compare value for the output compare or PWM functions. The channel registers are cleared by reset.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 15 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8
Figure 16-13. TPM Channel Value Register High (TPMxCnVH)
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
Figure 16-14. TPM Channel Value Register Low (TPMxCnVL)
In input capture mode, reading either byte (TPMxCnVH or TPMxCnVL) latches the contents of both bytes into a buffer where they remain latched until the other half is read. This latching mechanism also resets
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 367
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
(becomes unlatched) when the TPMxCnSC register is written (whether BDM mode is active or not). Any write to the channel registers will be ignored during the input capture mode. When BDM is active, the coherency mechanism is frozen (unless reset by writing to TPMxCnSC register) such that the buffer latches remain in the state they were in when the BDM became active, even if one or both halves of the channel register are read while BDM is active. This assures that if the user was in the middle of reading a 16-bit register when BDM became active, it will read the appropriate value from the other half of the 16-bit value after returning to normal execution. The value read from the TPMxCnVH and TPMxCnVL registers in BDM mode is the value of these registers and not the value of their read buffer. In output compare or PWM modes, writing to either byte (TPMxCnVH or TPMxCnVL) latches the value into a buffer. After both bytes are written, they are transferred as a coherent 16-bit value into the timer-channel registers according to the value of CLKSB:CLKSA bits and the selected mode, so: • If (CLKSB:CLKSA = 0:0), then the registers are updated when the second byte is written. • If (CLKSB:CLKSA not = 0:0 and in output compare mode) then the registers are updated after the second byte is written and on the next change of the TPM counter (end of the prescaler counting). • If (CLKSB:CLKSA not = 0:0 and in EPWM or CPWM modes), then the registers are updated after the both bytes were written, and the TPM counter changes from (TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL - 1) to (TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL). If the TPM counter is a free-running counter then the update is made when the TPM counter changes from 0xFFFE to 0xFFFF. The latching mechanism may be manually reset by writing to the TPMxCnSC register (whether BDM mode is active or not). This latching mechanism allows coherent 16-bit writes in either big-endian or little-endian order which is friendly to various compiler implementations. When BDM is active, the coherency mechanism is frozen such that the buffer latches remain in the state they were in when the BDM became active even if one or both halves of the channel register are written while BDM is active. Any write to the channel registers bypasses the buffer latches and directly write to the channel register while BDM is active. The values written to the channel register while BDM is active are used for PWM & output compare operation once normal execution resumes. Writes to the channel registers while BDM is active do not interfere with partial completion of a coherency sequence. After the coherency mechanism has been fully exercised, the channel registers are updated using the buffered values written (while BDM was not active) by the user.
16.4
Functional Description
All TPM functions are associated with a central 16-bit counter which allows flexible selection of the clock source and prescale factor. There is also a 16-bit modulo register associated with the main counter. The CPWMS control bit chooses between center-aligned PWM operation for all channels in the TPM (CPWMS=1) or general purpose timing functions (CPWMS=0) where each channel can independently be configured to operate in input capture, output compare, or edge-aligned PWM mode. The CPWMS control bit is located in the main TPM status and control register because it affects all channels within the TPM and influences the way the main counter operates. (In CPWM mode, the counter changes to an up/down mode rather than the up-counting mode used for general purpose timer functions.)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 368 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
The following sections describe the main counter and each of the timer operating modes (input capture, output compare, edge-aligned PWM, and center-aligned PWM). Because details of pin operation and interrupt activity depend upon the operating mode, these topics will be covered in the associated mode explanation sections.
16.4.1
Counter
All timer functions are based on the main 16-bit counter (TPMxCNTH:TPMxCNTL). This section discusses selection of the clock source, end-of-count overflow, up-counting vs. up/down counting, and manual counter reset.
16.4.1.1
Counter Clock Source
The 2-bit field, CLKSB:CLKSA, in the timer status and control register (TPMxSC) selects one of three possible clock sources or OFF (which effectively disables the TPM). See Table 16-3. After any MCU reset, CLKSB:CLKSA=0:0 so no clock source is selected, and the TPM is in a very low power state. These control bits may be read or written at any time and disabling the timer (writing 00 to the CLKSB:CLKSA field) does not affect the values in the counter or other timer registers.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 369
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
Table 16-7. TPM Clock Source Selection
CLKSB:CLKSA 00 01 10 11 TPM Clock Source to Prescaler Input No clock selected (TPM counter disabled) Bus rate clock Fixed system clock External source
The bus rate clock is the main system bus clock for the MCU. This clock source requires no synchronization because it is the clock that is used for all internal MCU activities including operation of the CPU and buses. In MCUs that have no PLL and FLL or the PLL and FLL are not engaged, the fixed system clock source is the same as the bus-rate-clock source, and it does not go through a synchronizer. When a PLL or FLL is present and engaged, a synchronizer is required between the crystal divided-by two clock source and the timer counter so counter transitions will be properly aligned to bus-clock transitions. A synchronizer will be used at chip level to synchronize the crystal-related source clock to the bus clock. The external clock source may be connected to any TPM channel pin. This clock source always has to pass through a synchronizer to assure that counter transitions are properly aligned to bus clock transitions. The bus-rate clock drives the synchronizer; therefore, to meet Nyquist criteria even with jitter, the frequency of the external clock source must not be faster than the bus rate divided-by four. With ideal clocks the external clock can be as fast as bus clock divided by four. When the external clock source shares the TPM channel pin, this pin should not be used for other channel timing functions. For example, it would be ambiguous to configure channel 0 for input capture when the TPM channel 0 pin was also being used as the timer external clock source. (It is the user’s responsibility to avoid such settings.) The TPM channel could still be used in output compare mode for software timing functions (pin controls set not to affect the TPM channel pin).
16.4.1.2
Counter Overflow and Modulo Reset
An interrupt flag and enable are associated with the 16-bit main counter. The flag (TOF) is a software-accessible indication that the timer counter has overflowed. The enable signal selects between software polling (TOIE=0) where no hardware interrupt is generated, or interrupt-driven operation (TOIE=1) where a static hardware interrupt is generated whenever the TOF flag is equal to one. The conditions causing TOF to become set depend on whether the TPM is configured for center-aligned PWM (CPWMS=1). In the simplest mode, there is no modulus limit and the TPM is not in CPWMS=1 mode. In this case, the 16-bit timer counter counts from 0x0000 through 0xFFFF and overflows to 0x0000 on the next counting clock. TOF becomes set at the transition from 0xFFFF to 0x0000. When a modulus limit is set, TOF becomes set at the transition from the value set in the modulus register to 0x0000. When the TPM is in center-aligned PWM mode (CPWMS=1), the TOF flag gets set as the counter changes direction at the end of the count value set in the modulus register (that is, at the transition from the value set in the modulus register to the next lower count value). This corresponds to the end of a PWM period (the 0x0000 count value corresponds to the center of a period).
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 370 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
16.4.1.3
Counting Modes
The main timer counter has two counting modes. When center-aligned PWM is selected (CPWMS=1), the counter operates in up/down counting mode. Otherwise, the counter operates as a simple up counter. As an up counter, the timer counter counts from 0x0000 through its terminal count and then continues with 0x0000. The terminal count is 0xFFFF or a modulus value in TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL. When center-aligned PWM operation is specified, the counter counts up from 0x0000 through its terminal count and then down to 0x0000 where it changes back to up counting. Both 0x0000 and the terminal count value are normal length counts (one timer clock period long). In this mode, the timer overflow flag (TOF) becomes set at the end of the terminal-count period (as the count changes to the next lower count value).
16.4.1.4
Manual Counter Reset
The main timer counter can be manually reset at any time by writing any value to either half of TPMxCNTH or TPMxCNTL. Resetting the counter in this manner also resets the coherency mechanism in case only half of the counter was read before resetting the count.
16.4.2
Channel Mode Selection
Provided CPWMS=0, the MSnB and MSnA control bits in the channel n status and control registers determine the basic mode of operation for the corresponding channel. Choices include input capture, output compare, and edge-aligned PWM.
16.4.2.1
Input Capture Mode
With the input-capture function, the TPM can capture the time at which an external event occurs. When an active edge occurs on the pin of an input-capture channel, the TPM latches the contents of the TPM counter into the channel-value registers (TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL). Rising edges, falling edges, or any edge may be chosen as the active edge that triggers an input capture. In input capture mode, the TPMxCnVH and TPMxCnVL registers are read only. When either half of the 16-bit capture register is read, the other half is latched into a buffer to support coherent 16-bit accesses in big-endian or little-endian order. The coherency sequence can be manually reset by writing to the channel status/control register (TPMxCnSC). An input capture event sets a flag bit (CHnF) which may optionally generate a CPU interrupt request. While in BDM, the input capture function works as configured by the user. When an external event occurs, the TPM latches the contents of the TPM counter (which is frozen because of the BDM mode) into the channel value registers and sets the flag bit.
16.4.2.2
Output Compare Mode
With the output-compare function, the TPM can generate timed pulses with programmable position, polarity, duration, and frequency. When the counter reaches the value in the channel-value registers of an output-compare channel, the TPM can set, clear, or toggle the channel pin.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 371
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
In output compare mode, values are transferred to the corresponding timer channel registers only after both 8-bit halves of a 16-bit register have been written and according to the value of CLKSB:CLKSA bits, so: • If (CLKSB:CLKSA = 0:0), the registers are updated when the second byte is written • If (CLKSB:CLKSA not = 0:0), the registers are updated at the next change of the TPM counter (end of the prescaler counting) after the second byte is written. The coherency sequence can be manually reset by writing to the channel status/control register (TPMxCnSC). An output compare event sets a flag bit (CHnF) which may optionally generate a CPU-interrupt request.
16.4.2.3
Edge-Aligned PWM Mode
This type of PWM output uses the normal up-counting mode of the timer counter (CPWMS=0) and can be used when other channels in the same TPM are configured for input capture or output compare functions. The period of this PWM signal is determined by the value of the modulus register (TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL) plus 1. The duty cycle is determined by the setting in the timer channel register (TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL). The polarity of this PWM signal is determined by the setting in the ELSnA control bit. 0% and 100% duty cycle cases are possible. The output compare value in the TPM channel registers determines the pulse width (duty cycle) of the PWM signal (Figure 16-15). The time between the modulus overflow and the output compare is the pulse width. If ELSnA=0, the counter overflow forces the PWM signal high, and the output compare forces the PWM signal low. If ELSnA=1, the counter overflow forces the PWM signal low, and the output compare forces the PWM signal high.
OVERFLOW PERIOD PULSE WIDTH TPMxCHn OUTPUT COMPARE OUTPUT COMPARE OUTPUT COMPARE OVERFLOW OVERFLOW
Figure 16-15. PWM Period and Pulse Width (ELSnA=0)
When the channel value register is set to 0x0000, the duty cycle is 0%. 100% duty cycle can be achieved by setting the timer-channel register (TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL) to a value greater than the modulus setting. This implies that the modulus setting must be less than 0xFFFF in order to get 100% duty cycle. Because the TPM may be used in an 8-bit MCU, the settings in the timer channel registers are buffered to ensure coherent 16-bit updates and to avoid unexpected PWM pulse widths. Writes to any of the registers TPMxCnVH and TPMxCnVL, actually write to buffer registers. In edge-aligned PWM mode, values are transferred to the corresponding timer-channel registers according to the value of CLKSB:CLKSA bits, so: • If (CLKSB:CLKSA = 0:0), the registers are updated when the second byte is written • If (CLKSB:CLKSA not = 0:0), the registers are updated after the both bytes were written, and the TPM counter changes from (TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL - 1) to (TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL). If
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 372 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
the TPM counter is a free-running counter then the update is made when the TPM counter changes from 0xFFFE to 0xFFFF.
16.4.2.4
Center-Aligned PWM Mode
This type of PWM output uses the up/down counting mode of the timer counter (CPWMS=1). The output compare value in TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL determines the pulse width (duty cycle) of the PWM signal while the period is determined by the value in TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL. TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL should be kept in the range of 0x0001 to 0x7FFF because values outside this range can produce ambiguous results. ELSnA will determine the polarity of the CPWM output. pulse width = 2 x (TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL) period = 2 x (TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL); TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL=0x0001-0x7FFF If the channel-value register TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL is zero or negative (bit 15 set), the duty cycle will be 0%. If TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL is a positive value (bit 15 clear) and is greater than the (non-zero) modulus setting, the duty cycle will be 100% because the duty cycle compare will never occur. This implies the usable range of periods set by the modulus register is 0x0001 through 0x7FFE (0x7FFF if you do not need to generate 100% duty cycle). This is not a significant limitation. The resulting period would be much longer than required for normal applications. TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL=0x0000 is a special case that should not be used with center-aligned PWM mode. When CPWMS=0, this case corresponds to the counter running free from 0x0000 through 0xFFFF, but when CPWMS=1 the counter needs a valid match to the modulus register somewhere other than at 0x0000 in order to change directions from up-counting to down-counting. The output compare value in the TPM channel registers (times 2) determines the pulse width (duty cycle) of the CPWM signal (Figure 16-16). If ELSnA=0, a compare occurred while counting up forces the CPWM output signal low and a compare occurred while counting down forces the output high. The counter counts up until it reaches the modulo setting in TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL, then counts down until it reaches zero. This sets the period equal to two times TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL.
COUNT= 0 OUTPUT COUNT= COMPARE TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL (COUNT DOWN) OUTPUT COMPARE (COUNT UP) COUNT= TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL
TPMxCHn PULSE WIDTH 2 x TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL PERIOD 2 x TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL
Figure 16-16. CPWM Period and Pulse Width (ELSnA=0)
Center-aligned PWM outputs typically produce less noise than edge-aligned PWMs because fewer I/O pin transitions are lined up at the same system clock edge. This type of PWM is also required for some types of motor drives.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 373
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
Input capture, output compare, and edge-aligned PWM functions do not make sense when the counter is operating in up/down counting mode so this implies that all active channels within a TPM must be used in CPWM mode when CPWMS=1. The TPM may be used in an 8-bit MCU. The settings in the timer channel registers are buffered to ensure coherent 16-bit updates and to avoid unexpected PWM pulse widths. Writes to any of the registers TPMxMODH, TPMxMODL, TPMxCnVH, and TPMxCnVL, actually write to buffer registers. In center-aligned PWM mode, the TPMxCnVH:L registers are updated with the value of their write buffer according to the value of CLKSB:CLKSA bits, so: • If (CLKSB:CLKSA = 0:0), the registers are updated when the second byte is written • If (CLKSB:CLKSA not = 0:0), the registers are updated after the both bytes were written, and the TPM counter changes from (TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL - 1) to (TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL). If the TPM counter is a free-running counter, the update is made when the TPM counter changes from 0xFFFE to 0xFFFF. When TPMxCNTH:TPMxCNTL=TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL, the TPM can optionally generate a TOF interrupt (at the end of this count). Writing to TPMxSC cancels any values written to TPMxMODH and/or TPMxMODL and resets the coherency mechanism for the modulo registers. Writing to TPMxCnSC cancels any values written to the channel value registers and resets the coherency mechanism for TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL.
16.5
16.5.1
Reset Overview
General
The TPM is reset whenever any MCU reset occurs.
16.5.2
Description of Reset Operation
Reset clears the TPMxSC register which disables clocks to the TPM and disables timer overflow interrupts (TOIE=0). CPWMS, MSnB, MSnA, ELSnB, and ELSnA are all cleared which configures all TPM channels for input-capture operation with the associated pins disconnected from I/O pin logic (so all MCU pins related to the TPM revert to general purpose I/O pins).
16.6
16.6.1
Interrupts
General
The TPM generates an optional interrupt for the main counter overflow and an interrupt for each channel. The meaning of channel interrupts depends on each channel’s mode of operation. If the channel is configured for input capture, the interrupt flag is set each time the selected input capture edge is recognized. If the channel is configured for output compare or PWM modes, the interrupt flag is set each time the main timer counter matches the value in the 16-bit channel value register.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 374 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
All TPM interrupts are listed in Table 16-8 which shows the interrupt name, the name of any local enable that can block the interrupt request from leaving the TPM and getting recognized by the separate interrupt processing logic.
Table 16-8. Interrupt Summary
Interrupt TOF Local Enable TOIE Source Counter overflow Description Set each time the timer counter reaches its terminal count (at transition to next count value which is usually 0x0000) An input capture or output compare event took place on channel n
CHnF
CHnIE
Channel event
The TPM module will provide a high-true interrupt signal. Vectors and priorities are determined at chip integration time in the interrupt module so refer to the user’s guide for the interrupt module or to the chip’s complete documentation for details.
16.6.2
Description of Interrupt Operation
For each interrupt source in the TPM, a flag bit is set upon recognition of the interrupt condition such as timer overflow, channel-input capture, or output-compare events. This flag may be read (polled) by software to determine that the action has occurred, or an associated enable bit (TOIE or CHnIE) can be set to enable hardware interrupt generation. While the interrupt enable bit is set, a static interrupt will generate whenever the associated interrupt flag equals one. The user’s software must perform a sequence of steps to clear the interrupt flag before returning from the interrupt-service routine. TPM interrupt flags are cleared by a two-step process including a read of the flag bit while it is set (1) followed by a write of zero (0) to the bit. If a new event is detected between these two steps, the sequence is reset and the interrupt flag remains set after the second step to avoid the possibility of missing the new event.
16.6.2.1
Timer Overflow Interrupt (TOF) Description
The meaning and details of operation for TOF interrupts varies slightly depending upon the mode of operation of the TPM system (general purpose timing functions versus center-aligned PWM operation). The flag is cleared by the two step sequence described above. 16.6.2.1.1 Normal Case
Normally TOF is set when the timer counter changes from 0xFFFF to 0x0000. When the TPM is not configured for center-aligned PWM (CPWMS=0), TOF gets set when the timer counter changes from the terminal count (the value in the modulo register) to 0x0000. This case corresponds to the normal meaning of counter overflow.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 375
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
16.6.2.1.2
Center-Aligned PWM Case
When CPWMS=1, TOF gets set when the timer counter changes direction from up-counting to down-counting at the end of the terminal count (the value in the modulo register). In this case the TOF corresponds to the end of a PWM period.
16.6.2.2
Channel Event Interrupt Description
The meaning of channel interrupts depends on the channel’s current mode (input-capture, output-compare, edge-aligned PWM, or center-aligned PWM). 16.6.2.2.1 Input Capture Events
When a channel is configured as an input capture channel, the ELSnB:ELSnA control bits select no edge (off), rising edges, falling edges or any edge as the edge which triggers an input capture event. When the selected edge is detected, the interrupt flag is set. The flag is cleared by the two-step sequence described in Section 16.6.2, “Description of Interrupt Operation.” 16.6.2.2.2 Output Compare Events
When a channel is configured as an output compare channel, the interrupt flag is set each time the main timer counter matches the 16-bit value in the channel value register. The flag is cleared by the two-step sequence described Section 16.6.2, “Description of Interrupt Operation.” 16.6.2.2.3 PWM End-of-Duty-Cycle Events
For channels configured for PWM operation there are two possibilities. When the channel is configured for edge-aligned PWM, the channel flag gets set when the timer counter matches the channel value register which marks the end of the active duty cycle period. When the channel is configured for center-aligned PWM, the timer count matches the channel value register twice during each PWM cycle. In this CPWM case, the channel flag is set at the start and at the end of the active duty cycle period which are the times when the timer counter matches the channel value register. The flag is cleared by the two-step sequence described Section 16.6.2, “Description of Interrupt Operation.”
16.7
The Differences from TPM v2 to TPM v3
1. Write to TPMxCnTH:L registers (Section 16.3.2, “TPM-Counter Registers (TPMxCNTH:TPMxCNTL)) [SE110-TPM case 7] Any write to TPMxCNTH or TPMxCNTL registers in TPM v3 clears the TPM counter (TPMxCNTH:L) and the prescaler counter. Instead, in the TPM v2 only the TPM counter is cleared in this case. 2. Read of TPMxCNTH:L registers (Section 16.3.2, “TPM-Counter Registers (TPMxCNTH:TPMxCNTL)) — In TPM v3, any read of TPMxCNTH:L registers during BDM mode returns the value of the TPM counter that is frozen. In TPM v2, if only one byte of the TPMxCNTH:L registers was read before the BDM mode became active, then any read of TPMxCNTH:L registers during
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 376 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
BDM mode returns the latched value of TPMxCNTH:L from the read buffer instead of the frozen TPM counter value. — This read coherency mechanism is cleared in TPM v3 in BDM mode if there is a write to TPMxSC, TPMxCNTH or TPMxCNTL. Instead, in these conditions the TPM v2 does not clear this read coherency mechanism. 3. Read of TPMxCnVH:L registers (Section 16.3.5, “TPM Channel Value Registers (TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL)) — In TPM v3, any read of TPMxCnVH:L registers during BDM mode returns the value of the TPMxCnVH:L register. In TPM v2, if only one byte of the TPMxCnVH:L registers was read before the BDM mode became active, then any read of TPMxCnVH:L registers during BDM mode returns the latched value of TPMxCNTH:L from the read buffer instead of the value in the TPMxCnVH:L registers. — This read coherency mechanism is cleared in TPM v3 in BDM mode if there is a write to TPMxCnSC. Instead, in this condition the TPM v2 does not clear this read coherency mechanism. 4. Write to TPMxCnVH:L registers — Input Capture Mode (Section 16.4.2.1, “Input Capture Mode) In this mode the TPM v3 does not allow the writes to TPMxCnVH:L registers. Instead, the TPM v2 allows these writes. — Output Compare Mode (Section 16.4.2.2, “Output Compare Mode) In this mode and if (CLKSB:CLKSA not = 0:0), the TPM v3 updates the TPMxCnVH:L registers with the value of their write buffer at the next change of the TPM counter (end of the prescaler counting) after the second byte is written. Instead, the TPM v2 always updates these registers when their second byte is written. — Edge-Aligned PWM (Section 16.4.2.3, “Edge-Aligned PWM Mode) In this mode and if (CLKSB:CLKSA not = 00), the TPM v3 updates the TPMxCnVH:L registers with the value of their write buffer after that the both bytes were written and when the TPM counter changes from (TPMxMODH:L - 1) to (TPMxMODH:L). If the TPM counter is a free-running counter, then this update is made when the TPM counter changes from $FFFE to $FFFF. Instead, the TPM v2 makes this update after that the both bytes were written and when the TPM counter changes from TPMxMODH:L to $0000. — Center-Aligned PWM (Section 16.4.2.4, “Center-Aligned PWM Mode) In this mode and if (CLKSB:CLKSA not = 00), the TPM v3 updates the TPMxCnVH:L registers with the value of their write buffer after that the both bytes were written and when the TPM counter changes from (TPMxMODH:L - 1) to (TPMxMODH:L). If the TPM counter is a free-running counter, then this update is made when the TPM counter changes from $FFFE to $FFFF. Instead, the TPM v2 makes this update after that the both bytes were written and when the TPM counter changes from TPMxMODH:L to (TPMxMODH:L - 1). 5. Center-Aligned PWM (Section 16.4.2.4, “Center-Aligned PWM Mode) — TPMxCnVH:L = TPMxMODH:L [SE110-TPM case 1] In this case, the TPM v3 produces 100% duty cycle. Instead, the TPM v2 produces 0% duty cycle.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 377
Chapter 16 Timer/PWM Module (S08TPMV3)
— TPMxCnVH:L = (TPMxMODH:L - 1) [SE110-TPM case 2] In this case, the TPM v3 produces almost 100% duty cycle. Instead, the TPM v2 produces 0% duty cycle. — TPMxCnVH:L is changed from 0x0000 to a non-zero value [SE110-TPM case 3 and 5] In this case, the TPM v3 waits for the start of a new PWM period to begin using the new duty cycle setting. Instead, the TPM v2 changes the channel output at the middle of the current PWM period (when the count reaches 0x0000). — TPMxCnVH:L is changed from a non-zero value to 0x0000 [SE110-TPM case 4] In this case, the TPM v3 finishes the current PWM period using the old duty cycle setting. Instead, the TPM v2 finishes the current PWM period using the new duty cycle setting. 6. Write to TPMxMODH:L registers in BDM mode (Section 16.3.3, “TPM Counter Modulo Registers (TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL)) In the TPM v3 a write to TPMxSC register in BDM mode clears the write coherency mechanism of TPMxMODH:L registers. Instead, in the TPM v2 this coherency mechanism is not cleared when there is a write to TPMxSC register.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 378 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 17 Development Support
17.1 Introduction
Development support systems in the HCS08 include the background debug controller (BDC) and the on-chip debug module (DBG). The BDC provides a single-wire debug interface to the target MCU that provides a convenient interface for programming the on-chip FLASH and other nonvolatile memories. The BDC is also the primary debug interface for development and allows non-intrusive access to memory data and traditional debug features such as CPU register modify, breakpoints, and single instruction trace commands. In the HCS08 Family, address and data bus signals are not available on external pins (not even in test modes). Debug is done through commands fed into the target MCU via the single-wire background debug interface. The debug module provides a means to selectively trigger and capture bus information so an external development system can reconstruct what happened inside the MCU on a cycle-by-cycle basis without having external access to the address and data signals.
17.1.1
Forcing Active Background
The method for forcing active background mode depends on the specific HCS08 derivative. For the MC9S08DZ128 Series, you can force active background after a power-on reset by holding the BKGD pin low as the device exits the reset condition. You can also force active background by driving BKGD low immediately after a serial background command that writes a one to the BDFR bit in the SBDFR register. Other causes of reset including an external pin reset or an internally generated error reset ignore the state of the BKGD pin and reset into normal user mode. If no debug pod is connected to the BKGD pin, the MCU will always reset into normal operating mode.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 379
Chapter 17 Development Support
17.1.2
Features
Features of the BDC module include: • Single pin for mode selection and background communications • BDC registers are not located in the memory map • SYNC command to determine target communications rate • Non-intrusive commands for memory access • Active background mode commands for CPU register access • GO and TRACE1 commands • BACKGROUND command can wake CPU from stop or wait modes • One hardware address breakpoint built into BDC • Oscillator runs in stop mode, if BDC enabled • COP watchdog disabled while in active background mode
17.2
Background Debug Controller (BDC)
All MCUs in the HCS08 Family contain a single-wire background debug interface that supports in-circuit programming of on-chip nonvolatile memory and sophisticated non-intrusive debug capabilities. Unlike debug interfaces on earlier 8-bit MCUs, this system does not interfere with normal application resources. It does not use any user memory or locations in the memory map and does not share any on-chip peripherals. BDC commands are divided into two groups: • Active background mode commands require that the target MCU is in active background mode (the user program is not running). Active background mode commands allow the CPU registers to be read or written, and allow the user to trace one user instruction at a time, or GO to the user program from active background mode. • Non-intrusive commands can be executed at any time even while the user’s program is running. Non-intrusive commands allow a user to read or write MCU memory locations or access status and control registers within the background debug controller. Typically, a relatively simple interface pod is used to translate commands from a host computer into commands for the custom serial interface to the single-wire background debug system. Depending on the development tool vendor, this interface pod may use a standard RS-232 serial port, a parallel printer port, or some other type of communications such as a universal serial bus (USB) to communicate between the host PC and the pod. The pod typically connects to the target system with ground, the BKGD pin, RESET, and sometimes VDD. An open-drain connection to reset allows the host to force a target system reset, which is useful to regain control of a lost target system or to control startup of a target system before the on-chip nonvolatile memory has been programmed. Sometimes VDD can be used to allow the pod to use power from the target system to avoid the need for a separate power supply. However, if the pod is powered separately, it can be connected to a running target system without forcing a target system reset or otherwise disturbing the running application program.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 380 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 17 Development Support
BKGD 1 NO CONNECT 3 NO CONNECT 5
2 GND 4 RESET 6 VDD
Figure 17-1. BDM Tool Connector
17.2.1
BKGD Pin Description
BKGD is the single-wire background debug interface pin. The primary function of this pin is for bidirectional serial communication of active background mode commands and data. During reset, this pin is used to select between starting in active background mode or starting the user’s application program. This pin is also used to request a timed sync response pulse to allow a host development tool to determine the correct clock frequency for background debug serial communications. BDC serial communications use a custom serial protocol first introduced on the M68HC12 Family of microcontrollers. This protocol assumes the host knows the communication clock rate that is determined by the target BDC clock rate. All communication is initiated and controlled by the host that drives a high-to-low edge to signal the beginning of each bit time. Commands and data are sent most significant bit first (MSB first). For a detailed description of the communications protocol, refer to Section 17.2.2, “Communication Details.” If a host is attempting to communicate with a target MCU that has an unknown BDC clock rate, a SYNC command may be sent to the target MCU to request a timed sync response signal from which the host can determine the correct communication speed. BKGD is a pseudo-open-drain pin and there is an on-chip pullup so no external pullup resistor is required. Unlike typical open-drain pins, the external RC time constant on this pin, which is influenced by external capacitance, plays almost no role in signal rise time. The custom protocol provides for brief, actively driven speedup pulses to force rapid rise times on this pin without risking harmful drive level conflicts. Refer to Section 17.2.2, “Communication Details,” for more detail. When no debugger pod is connected to the 6-pin BDM interface connector, the internal pullup on BKGD chooses normal operating mode. When a debug pod is connected to BKGD it is possible to force the MCU into active background mode after reset. The specific conditions for forcing active background depend upon the HCS08 derivative (refer to the introduction to this Development Support section). It is not necessary to reset the target MCU to communicate with it through the background debug interface.
17.2.2
Communication Details
The BDC serial interface requires the external controller to generate a falling edge on the BKGD pin to indicate the start of each bit time. The external controller provides this falling edge whether data is transmitted or received. BKGD is a pseudo-open-drain pin that can be driven either by an external controller or by the MCU. Data is transferred MSB first at 16 BDC clock cycles per bit (nominal speed). The interface times out if 512 BDC clock cycles occur between falling edges from the host. Any BDC command that was in progress
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 381
Chapter 17 Development Support
when this timeout occurs is aborted without affecting the memory or operating mode of the target MCU system. The custom serial protocol requires the debug pod to know the target BDC communication clock speed. The clock switch (CLKSW) control bit in the BDC status and control register allows the user to select the BDC clock source. The BDC clock source can either be the bus or the alternate BDC clock source. The BKGD pin can receive a high or low level or transmit a high or low level. The following diagrams show timing for each of these cases. Interface timing is synchronous to clocks in the target BDC, but asynchronous to the external host. The internal BDC clock signal is shown for reference in counting cycles. Figure 17-2 shows an external host transmitting a logic 1 or 0 to the BKGD pin of a target HCS08 MCU. The host is asynchronous to the target so there is a 0-to-1 cycle delay from the host-generated falling edge to where the target perceives the beginning of the bit time. Ten target BDC clock cycles later, the target senses the bit level on the BKGD pin. Typically, the host actively drives the pseudo-open-drain BKGD pin during host-to-target transmissions to speed up rising edges. Because the target does not drive the BKGD pin during the host-to-target transmission period, there is no need to treat the line as an open-drain signal during this period.
BDC CLOCK (TARGET MCU)
HOST TRANSMIT 1
HOST TRANSMIT 0 10 CYCLES
EARLIEST START OF NEXT BIT
SYNCHRONIZATION UNCERTAINTY PERCEIVED START OF BIT TIME
TARGET SENSES BIT LEVEL
Figure 17-2. BDC Host-to-Target Serial Bit Timing
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 382 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 17 Development Support
Figure 17-3 shows the host receiving a logic 1 from the target HCS08 MCU. Because the host is asynchronous to the target MCU, there is a 0-to-1 cycle delay from the host-generated falling edge on BKGD to the perceived start of the bit time in the target MCU. The host holds the BKGD pin low long enough for the target to recognize it (at least two target BDC cycles). The host must release the low drive before the target MCU drives a brief active-high speedup pulse seven cycles after the perceived start of the bit time. The host should sample the bit level about 10 cycles after it started the bit time.
BDC CLOCK (TARGET MCU)
HOST DRIVE TO BKGD PIN
HIGH-IMPEDANCE
TARGET MCU SPEEDUP PULSE HIGH-IMPEDANCE PERCEIVED START OF BIT TIME R-C RISE BKGD PIN
HIGH-IMPEDANCE
10 CYCLES 10 CYCLES HOST SAMPLES BKGD PIN
EARLIEST START OF NEXT BIT
Figure 17-3. BDC Target-to-Host Serial Bit Timing (Logic 1)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 383
Chapter 17 Development Support
Figure 17-4 shows the host receiving a logic 0 from the target HCS08 MCU. Because the host is asynchronous to the target MCU, there is a 0-to-1 cycle delay from the host-generated falling edge on BKGD to the start of the bit time as perceived by the target MCU. The host initiates the bit time but the target HCS08 finishes it. Because the target wants the host to receive a logic 0, it drives the BKGD pin low for 13 BDC clock cycles, then briefly drives it high to speed up the rising edge. The host samples the bit level about 10 cycles after starting the bit time.
BDC CLOCK (TARGET MCU)
HOST DRIVE TO BKGD PIN
HIGH-IMPEDANCE
TARGET MCU DRIVE AND SPEED-UP PULSE PERCEIVED START OF BIT TIME
SPEEDUP PULSE
BKGD PIN 10 CYCLES 10 CYCLES
EARLIEST START OF NEXT BIT
HOST SAMPLES BKGD PIN
Figure 17-4. BDM Target-to-Host Serial Bit Timing (Logic 0)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 384 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 17 Development Support
17.2.3
BDC Commands
BDC commands are sent serially from a host computer to the BKGD pin of the target HCS08 MCU. All commands and data are sent MSB-first using a custom BDC communications protocol. Active background mode commands require that the target MCU is currently in the active background mode while non-intrusive commands may be issued at any time whether the target MCU is in active background mode or running a user application program. Table 17-1 shows all HCS08 BDC commands, a shorthand description of their coding structure, and the meaning of each command. Coding Structure Nomenclature This nomenclature is used in Table 17-1 to describe the coding structure of the BDC commands. Commands begin with an 8-bit hexadecimal command code in the host-to-target direction (most significant bit first) / = separates parts of the command d = delay 16 target BDC clock cycles AAAA = a 16-bit address in the host-to-target direction RD = 8 bits of read data in the target-to-host direction WD = 8 bits of write data in the host-to-target direction RD16 = 16 bits of read data in the target-to-host direction WD16 = 16 bits of write data in the host-to-target direction SS = the contents of BDCSCR in the target-to-host direction (STATUS) CC = 8 bits of write data for BDCSCR in the host-to-target direction (CONTROL) RBKP = 16 bits of read data in the target-to-host direction (from BDCBKPT breakpoint register) WBKP = 16 bits of write data in the host-to-target direction (for BDCBKPT breakpoint register)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 385
Chapter 17 Development Support
Table 17-1. BDC Command Summary
Command Mnemonic SYNC ACK_ENABLE ACK_DISABLE BACKGROUND READ_STATUS WRITE_CONTROL READ_BYTE READ_BYTE_WS READ_LAST WRITE_BYTE WRITE_BYTE_WS READ_BKPT WRITE_BKPT GO TRACE1 TAGGO READ_A READ_CCR READ_PC READ_HX READ_SP READ_NEXT READ_NEXT_WS WRITE_A WRITE_CCR WRITE_PC WRITE_HX WRITE_SP WRITE_NEXT WRITE_NEXT_WS
1
Active BDM/ Non-intrusive Non-intrusive Non-intrusive Non-intrusive Non-intrusive Non-intrusive Non-intrusive Non-intrusive Non-intrusive Non-intrusive Non-intrusive Non-intrusive Non-intrusive Non-intrusive Active BDM Active BDM Active BDM Active BDM Active BDM Active BDM Active BDM Active BDM Active BDM Active BDM Active BDM Active BDM Active BDM Active BDM Active BDM Active BDM Active BDM n/a1 D5/d D6/d 90/d E4/SS C4/CC
Coding Structure
Description Request a timed reference pulse to determine target BDC communication speed Enable acknowledge protocol. Refer to Freescale document order no. HCS08RMv1/D. Disable acknowledge protocol. Refer to Freescale document order no. HCS08RMv1/D. Enter active background mode if enabled (ignore if ENBDM bit equals 0) Read BDC status from BDCSCR Write BDC controls in BDCSCR Read a byte from target memory Read a byte and report status Re-read byte from address just read and report status Write a byte to target memory Write a byte and report status Read BDCBKPT breakpoint register Write BDCBKPT breakpoint register Go to execute the user application program starting at the address currently in the PC Trace 1 user instruction at the address in the PC, then return to active background mode Same as GO but enable external tagging (HCS08 devices have no external tagging pin) Read accumulator (A) Read condition code register (CCR) Read program counter (PC) Read H and X register pair (H:X) Read stack pointer (SP) Increment H:X by one then read memory byte located at H:X Increment H:X by one then read memory byte located at H:X. Report status and data. Write accumulator (A) Write condition code register (CCR) Write program counter (PC) Write H and X register pair (H:X) Write stack pointer (SP) Increment H:X by one, then write memory byte located at H:X Increment H:X by one, then write memory byte located at H:X. Also report status.
E0/AAAA/d/RD E1/AAAA/d/SS/RD E8/SS/RD C0/AAAA/WD/d C1/AAAA/WD/d/SS E2/RBKP C2/WBKP 08/d 10/d 18/d 68/d/RD 69/d/RD 6B/d/RD16 6C/d/RD16 6F/d/RD16 70/d/RD 71/d/SS/RD 48/WD/d 49/WD/d 4B/WD16/d 4C/WD16/d 4F/WD16/d 50/WD/d 51/WD/d/SS
The SYNC command is a special operation that does not have a command code.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 386 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 17 Development Support
The SYNC command is unlike other BDC commands because the host does not necessarily know the correct communications speed to use for BDC communications until after it has analyzed the response to the SYNC command. To issue a SYNC command, the host: • Drives the BKGD pin low for at least 128 cycles of the slowest possible BDC clock (The slowest clock is normally the reference oscillator/64 or the self-clocked rate/64.) • Drives BKGD high for a brief speedup pulse to get a fast rise time (This speedup pulse is typically one cycle of the fastest clock in the system.) • Removes all drive to the BKGD pin so it reverts to high impedance • Monitors the BKGD pin for the sync response pulse The target, upon detecting the SYNC request from the host (which is a much longer low time than would ever occur during normal BDC communications): • Waits for BKGD to return to a logic high • Delays 16 cycles to allow the host to stop driving the high speedup pulse • Drives BKGD low for 128 BDC clock cycles • Drives a 1-cycle high speedup pulse to force a fast rise time on BKGD • Removes all drive to the BKGD pin so it reverts to high impedance The host measures the low time of this 128-cycle sync response pulse and determines the correct speed for subsequent BDC communications. Typically, the host can determine the correct communication speed within a few percent of the actual target speed and the communication protocol can easily tolerate speed errors of several percent.
17.2.4
BDC Hardware Breakpoint
The BDC includes one relatively simple hardware breakpoint that compares the CPU address bus to a 16-bit match value in the BDCBKPT register. This breakpoint can generate a forced breakpoint or a tagged breakpoint. A forced breakpoint causes the CPU to enter active background mode at the first instruction boundary following any access to the breakpoint address. The tagged breakpoint causes the instruction opcode at the breakpoint address to be tagged so that the CPU will enter active background mode rather than executing that instruction if and when it reaches the end of the instruction queue. This implies that tagged breakpoints can only be placed at the address of an instruction opcode while forced breakpoints can be set at any address. The breakpoint enable (BKPTEN) control bit in the BDC status and control register (BDCSCR) is used to enable the breakpoint logic (BKPTEN = 1). When BKPTEN = 0, its default value after reset, the breakpoint logic is disabled and no BDC breakpoints are requested regardless of the values in other BDC breakpoint registers and control bits. The force/tag select (FTS) control bit in BDCSCR is used to select forced (FTS = 1) or tagged (FTS = 0) type breakpoints.
17.3
Register Definition
This section contains the descriptions of the BDC registers and control bits.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 387
Chapter 17 Development Support
This section refers to registers and control bits only by their names. A Freescale-provided equate or header file is used to translate these names into the appropriate absolute addresses.
17.3.1
BDC Registers and Control Bits
The BDC has two registers: • The BDC status and control register (BDCSCR) is an 8-bit register containing control and status bits for the background debug controller. • The BDC breakpoint match register (BDCBKPT) holds a 16-bit breakpoint match address. These registers are accessed with dedicated serial BDC commands and are not located in the memory space of the target MCU (so they do not have addresses and cannot be accessed by user programs). Some of the bits in the BDCSCR have write limitations; otherwise, these registers may be read or written at any time. For example, the ENBDM control bit may not be written while the MCU is in active background mode. (This prevents the ambiguous condition of the control bit forbidding active background mode while the MCU is already in active background mode.) Also, the four status bits (BDMACT, WS, WSF, and DVF) are read-only status indicators and can never be written by the WRITE_CONTROL serial BDC command. The clock switch (CLKSW) control bit may be read or written at any time.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 388 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 17 Development Support
17.3.1.1
BDC Status and Control Register (BDCSCR)
This register can be read or written by serial BDC commands (READ_STATUS and WRITE_CONTROL) but is not accessible to user programs because it is not located in the normal memory map of the MCU.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R ENBDM W Normal Reset Reset in Active BDM: 0 1
BDMACT BKPTEN 0 1 0 0 FTS 0 0 CLKSW 0 1
WS
WSF
DVF
0 0
0 0
0 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 17-5. BDC Status and Control Register (BDCSCR) Table 17-2. BDCSCR Register Field Descriptions
Field 7 ENBDM Description Enable BDM (Permit Active Background Mode) — Typically, this bit is written to 1 by the debug host shortly after the beginning of a debug session or whenever the debug host resets the target and remains 1 until a normal reset clears it. 0 BDM cannot be made active (non-intrusive commands still allowed) 1 BDM can be made active to allow active background mode commands Background Mode Active Status — This is a read-only status bit. 0 BDM not active (user application program running) 1 BDM active and waiting for serial commands BDC Breakpoint Enable — If this bit is clear, the BDC breakpoint is disabled and the FTS (force tag select) control bit and BDCBKPT match register are ignored. 0 BDC breakpoint disabled 1 BDC breakpoint enabled Force/Tag Select — When FTS = 1, a breakpoint is requested whenever the CPU address bus matches the BDCBKPT match register. When FTS = 0, a match between the CPU address bus and the BDCBKPT register causes the fetched opcode to be tagged. If this tagged opcode ever reaches the end of the instruction queue, the CPU enters active background mode rather than executing the tagged opcode. 0 Tag opcode at breakpoint address and enter active background mode if CPU attempts to execute that instruction 1 Breakpoint match forces active background mode at next instruction boundary (address need not be an opcode) Select Source for BDC Communications Clock — CLKSW defaults to 0, which selects the alternate BDC clock source. 0 Alternate BDC clock source 1 MCU bus clock
6 BDMACT 5 BKPTEN
4 FTS
3 CLKSW
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 389
Chapter 17 Development Support
Table 17-2. BDCSCR Register Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 2 WS Description Wait or Stop Status — When the target CPU is in wait or stop mode, most BDC commands cannot function. However, the BACKGROUND command can be used to force the target CPU out of wait or stop and into active background mode where all BDC commands work. Whenever the host forces the target MCU into active background mode, the host should issue a READ_STATUS command to check that BDMACT = 1 before attempting other BDC commands. 0 Target CPU is running user application code or in active background mode (was not in wait or stop mode when background became active) 1 Target CPU is in wait or stop mode, or a BACKGROUND command was used to change from wait or stop to active background mode Wait or Stop Failure Status — This status bit is set if a memory access command failed due to the target CPU executing a wait or stop instruction at or about the same time. The usual recovery strategy is to issue a BACKGROUND command to get out of wait or stop mode into active background mode, repeat the command that failed, then return to the user program. (Typically, the host would restore CPU registers and stack values and re-execute the wait or stop instruction.) 0 Memory access did not conflict with a wait or stop instruction 1 Memory access command failed because the CPU entered wait or stop mode Data Valid Failure Status — This status bit is not used in the MC9S08DZ128 Series because it does not have any slow access memory. 0 Memory access did not conflict with a slow memory access 1 Memory access command failed because CPU was not finished with a slow memory access
1 WSF
0 DVF
17.3.1.2
BDC Breakpoint Match Register (BDCBKPT)
This 16-bit register holds the address for the hardware breakpoint in the BDC. The BKPTEN and FTS control bits in BDCSCR are used to enable and configure the breakpoint logic. Dedicated serial BDC commands (READ_BKPT and WRITE_BKPT) are used to read and write the BDCBKPT register but is not accessible to user programs because it is not located in the normal memory map of the MCU. Breakpoints are normally set while the target MCU is in active background mode before running the user application program. For additional information about setup and use of the hardware breakpoint logic in the BDC, refer to Section 17.2.4, “BDC Hardware Breakpoint.”
17.3.2
System Background Debug Force Reset Register (SBDFR)
This register contains a single write-only control bit. A serial background mode command such as WRITE_BYTE must be used to write to SBDFR. Attempts to write this register from a user program are ignored. Reads always return 0x00.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 390 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 17 Development Support
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0 BDFR1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
1
BDFR is writable only through serial background mode debug commands, not from user programs.
Figure 17-6. System Background Debug Force Reset Register (SBDFR) Table 17-3. SBDFR Register Field Description
Field 0 BDFR Description Background Debug Force Reset — A serial active background mode command such as WRITE_BYTE allows an external debug host to force a target system reset. Writing 1 to this bit forces an MCU reset. This bit cannot be written from a user program.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 391
Chapter 17 Development Support
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 392 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
18.1 Introduction
The DBG module implements an on-chip ICE (in-circuit emulation) system and allows non-intrusive debug of application software by providing an on-chip trace buffer with flexible triggering capability. The trigger also can provide extended breakpoint capacity. The on-chip ICE system is optimized for the HCS08 8-bit architecture and supports 64K bytes or 128K bytes of memory space.
18.1.1
Features
The on-chip ICE system includes these distinctive features: • Three comparators (A, B, and C) with ability to match addresses in 128K space — Dual mode, Comparators A and B used to compare addresses — Full mode, Comparator A compares address and Comparator B compares data — Can be used as triggers and/or breakpoints — Comparator C can be used as a normal hardware breakpoint — Loop1 capture mode, Comparator C is used to track most recent COF event captured into FIFO • Tag and Force type breakpoints • Nine trigger modes —A — A Or B — A Then B — A And B, where B is data (Full mode) — A And Not B, where B is data (Full mode) — Event Only B, store data — A Then Event Only B, store data — Inside Range, A ≤ Address ≤ B — Outside Range, Address < Α or Address > B • FIFO for storing change of flow information and event only data — Source address of conditional branches taken — Destination address of indirect JMP and JSR instruction — Destination address of interrupts, RTI, RTC, and RTS instruction — Data associated with Event B trigger modes
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 393
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
•
Ability to End-trace until reset and Begin-trace from reset
18.1.2
Modes of Operation
The on-chip ICE system can be enabled in all MCU functional modes. The DBG module is disabled if the MCU is secure. The DBG module comparators are disabled when executing a Background Debug Mode (BDM) command.
18.1.3
Block Diagram
core_cpu_aob_14_t2 1 core_cpu_aob_15_t2 1 core_ppage_t2[2:0] 1 DBG Read Data Bus Address Bus[16:0]1 Write Data Bus Read Data Bus Read/Write DBG Module Enable mmu_ppage_sel1 core_cof[1:0] MCU in BDM MCU reset event only store Read DBGFL Read DBGFH Read DBGFX c o n t r o l Address/Data/Control Registers
Figure 18-1 shows the structure of the DBG module.
FIFO Data control Trigger Break Control Logic
Comparator A Comparator B Comparator C
match_A match_B match_C
Tag Force
Change of Flow Indicators
Instr. Lastcycle Bus Clk register subtract 2 Write Data Bus Read Data Bus m u x m u x m u x 8 deep FIFO
ppage_sel1 m u x addr[16:0]1 FIFO Data
Read/Write
1. In 64K versions of this module there are only 16 address lines [15:0], there are no core_cpu_aob_14_t2, core_cpu_aob_15_t2, core_ppage_t2[2:0], and ppage_sel signals.
Figure 18-1. DBG Block Diagram
18.2
Signal Description
The DBG module contains no external signals.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 394 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
18.3
Memory Map and Registers
This section provides a detailed description of all DBG registers accessible to the end user.
18.3.1
Module Memory Map
Table 18-1 shows the registers contained in the DBG module.
Table 18-1. Module Memory Map
Address Base + $0000 Base + $0001 Base + $0002 Base + $0003 Base + $0004 Base + $0005 Base + $0006 Base + $0007 Base + $0008 Base + $0009 Base + $000A Base + $000B Base + $000C Base + $000D Base + $000E Base + $000F Use Debug Comparator A High Register (DBGCAH) Debug Comparator A Low Register (DBGCAL) Debug Comparator B High Register (DBGCBH) Debug Comparator B Low Register (DBGCBL) Debug Comparator C High Register (DBGCCH) Debug Comparator C Low Register (DBGCCL) Debug FIFO High Register (DBGFH) Debug FIFO Low Register (DBGFL) Debug Comparator A Extension Register (DBGCAX) Debug Comparator B Extension Register (DBGCBX) Debug Comparator C Extension Register (DBGCCX) Debug FIFO Extended Information Register (DBGFX) Debug Control Register (DBGC) Debug Trigger Register (DBGT) Debug Status Register (DBGS) Debug FIFO Count Register (DBGCNT) Access Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write Read only Read only Read/write Read/write Read/write Read only Read/write Read/write Read only Read only
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 395
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
18.3.2
Table 18-2. Register Bit Summary
7 DBGCAH DBGCAL DBGCBH DBGCBL DBGCCH DBGCCL DBGFH DBGFL DBGCAX DBGCBX DBGCCX DBGFX DBGC DBGT DBGS DBGCNT Bit 15 Bit 7 Bit 15 Bit 7 Bit 15 Bit 7 Bit 15 Bit 7 RWAEN RWBEN RWCEN PPACC DBGEN TRGSEL AF 0 6 Bit 14 Bit 6 Bit 14 Bit 6 Bit 14 Bit 6 Bit 14 Bit 6 RWA RWB RWC 0 ARM BEGIN BF 0 5 Bit 13 Bit 5 Bit 13 Bit 5 Bit 13 Bit 5 Bit 13 Bit 5 PAGSEL PAGSEL PAGSEL 0 TAG 0 CF 0 4 Bit 12 Bit 4 Bit 12 Bit 4 Bit 12 Bit 4 Bit 12 Bit 4 0 0 0 0 BRKEN 0 0 0 0 0 CNT[3:0] 3 Bit 11 Bit 3 Bit 11 Bit 3 Bit 11 Bit 3 Bit 11 Bit 3 0 0 0 0 2 Bit 10 Bit 2 Bit 10 Bit 2 Bit 10 Bit 2 Bit 10 Bit 2 0 0 0 0 TRG[3:0] 0 ARMF 1 Bit 9 Bit 1 Bit 9 Bit 1 Bit 9 Bit 1 Bit 9 Bit 1 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 bit-16 bit-16 bit-16 bit-16 LOOP1
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 396 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
18.3.3
Register Descriptions
This section consists of the DBG register descriptions in address order. Note: For all registers below, consider: U = Unchanged, bit maintain its value after reset.
18.3.3.1
Debug Comparator A High Register (DBGCAH)
Module Base + 0x0000
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 15 W POR or nonend-run Reset end-run1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
Figure 18-2. Debug Comparator A High Register (DBGCAH)
1
In the case of an end-trace to reset where DBGEN=1 and BEGIN=0, the bits in this register do not change after reset.
Table 18-3. DBGCAH Field Descriptions
Field Bits 15–8 Description Comparator A High Compare Bits — The Comparator A High compare bits control whether Comparator A will compare the address bus bits [15:8] to a logic 1 or logic 0. 0 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic 0 1 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic 1
18.3.3.2
Debug Comparator A Low Register (DBGCAL)
Module Base + 0x0001
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 7 W POR or nonend-run Reset end-run1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
Figure 18-3. Debug Comparator A Low Register (DBGCAL)
1
In the case of an end-trace to reset where DBGEN=1 and BEGIN=0, the bits in this register do not change after reset.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 397
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
Table 18-4. DBGCAL Field Descriptions
Field Bits 7–0 Description Comparator A Low Compare Bits — The Comparator A Low compare bits control whether Comparator A will compare the address bus bits [7:0] to a logic 1 or logic 0. 0 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic 0 1 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic 1
18.3.3.3
Debug Comparator B High Register (DBGCBH)
Module Base + 0x0002
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 15 W POR or nonend-run Reset end-run1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
Figure 18-4. Debug Comparator B High Register (DBGCBH)
1
In the case of an end-trace to reset where DBGEN=1 and BEGIN=0, the bits in this register do not change after reset.
Table 18-5. DBGCBH Field Descriptions
Field Bits 15–8 Description Comparator B High Compare Bits — The Comparator B High compare bits control whether Comparator B will compare the address bus bits [15:8] to a logic 1 or logic 0. Not used in Full mode. 0 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic 0 1 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic 1
18.3.3.4
Debug Comparator B Low Register (DBGCBL)
Module Base + 0x0003
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 7 W POR or nonend-run Reset end-run1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
Figure 18-5. Debug Comparator B Low Register (DBGCBL)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 398 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
1
In the case of an end-trace to reset where DBGEN=1 and BEGIN=0, the bits in this register do not change after reset.
Table 18-6. DBGCBL Field Descriptions
Field Bits 7–0 Description Comparator B Low Compare Bits — The Comparator B Low compare bits control whether Comparator B will compare the address bus or data bus bits [7:0] to a logic 1 or logic 0. 0 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic 0, compares to data if in Full mode 1 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic 1, compares to data if in Full mode
18.3.3.5
Debug Comparator C High Register (DBGCCH)
Module Base + 0x0004
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 15 W POR or nonend-run Reset end-run1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
Figure 18-6. Debug Comparator C High Register (DBGCCH)
1
In the case of an end-trace to reset where DBGEN=1 and BEGIN=0, the bits in this register do not change after reset.
Table 18-7. DBGCCH Field Descriptions
Field Bits 15–8 Description Comparator C High Compare Bits — The Comparator C High compare bits control whether Comparator C will compare the address bus bits [15:8] to a logic 1 or logic 0. 0 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic 0 1 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic 1
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 399
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
18.3.3.6
Debug Comparator C Low Register (DBGCCL)
Module Base + 0x0005
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 7 W POR or nonend-run Reset end-run1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
Figure 18-7. Debug Comparator C Low Register (DBGCCL)
1
In the case of an end-trace to reset where DBGEN=1 and BEGIN=0, the bits in this register do not change after reset.
Table 18-8. DBGCCL Field Descriptions
Field Bits 7–0 Description Comparator C Low Compare Bits — The Comparator C Low compare bits control whether Comparator C will compare the address bus bits [7:0] to a logic 1 or logic 0. 0 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic 0 1 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic 1
18.3.3.7
Debug FIFO High Register (DBGFH)
Module Base + 0x0006
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W POR or nonend-run Reset end-run1
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 18-8. Debug FIFO High Register (DBGFH)
1
In the case of an end-trace to reset where DBGEN=1 and BEGIN=0, the bits in this register do not change after reset.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 400 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
Table 18-9. DBGFH Field Descriptions
Field Bits 15–8 Description FIFO High Data Bits — The FIFO High data bits provide access to bits [15:8] of data in the FIFO. This register is not used in event only modes and will read a $00 for valid FIFO words.
18.3.3.8
Debug FIFO Low Register (DBGFL)
Module Base + 0x0007
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W POR or nonend-run Reset end-run1
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 18-9. Debug FIFO Low Register (DBGFL)
1
In the case of an end-trace to reset where DBGEN=1 and BEGIN=0, the bits in this register do not change after reset.
Table 18-10. DBGFL Field Descriptions
Field Bits 7–0 Description FIFO Low Data Bits — The FIFO Low data bits contain the least significant byte of data in the FIFO. When reading FIFO words, read DBGFX and DBGFH before reading DBGFL because reading DBGFL causes the FIFO pointers to advance to the next FIFO location. In event-only modes, there is no useful information in DBGFX and DBGFH so it is not necessary to read them before reading DBGFL.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 401
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
18.3.3.9
Debug Comparator A Extension Register (DBGCAX)
Module Base + 0x0008
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R RWAEN W POR or nonend-run Reset end-run1 0 0 0 RWA PAGSEL
0
0
0
0 Bit 16
0
0
0
0
0
U
U
U
0
0
0
0
U
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 18-10. Debug Comparator A Extension Register (DBGCAX)
1
In the case of an end-trace to reset where DBGEN=1 and BEGIN=0, the bits in this register do not change after reset.
Table 18-11. DBGCAX Field Descriptions
Field 7 RWAEN Description Read/Write Comparator A Enable Bit — The RWAEN bit controls whether read or write comparison is enabled for Comparator A. 0 Read/Write is not used in comparison 1 Read/Write is used in comparison Read/Write Comparator A Value Bit — The RWA bit controls whether read or write is used in compare for Comparator A. The RWA bit is not used if RWAEN = 0. 0 Write cycle will be matched 1 Read cycle will be matched Comparator A Page Select Bit — This PAGSEL bit controls whether Comparator A will be qualified with the internal signal (mmu_ppage_sel) that indicates an extended access through the PPAGE mechanism. When mmu_ppage_sel = 1, the 17-bit core address is a paged program access, and the 17-bit core address is made up of PPAGE[2:0]:addr[13:0]. When mmu_ppage_sel = 0, the 17-bit core address is either a 16-bit CPU address with a leading 0 in bit 16, or a 17-bit linear address pointer value. 0 Match qualified by mmu_ppage_sel = 0 so address bits [16:0] correspond to a 17-bit CPU address with a leading zero at bit 16, or a 17-bit linear address pointer address 1 Match qualified by mmu_ppage_sel = 1 so address bits [16:0] compare to flash memory address made up of PPAGE[2:0]:addr[13:0] Comparator A Extended Address Bit 16 Compare Bit — The Comparator A bit 16 compare bit controls whether Comparator A will compare the core address bus bit 16 to a logic 1 or logic 0. 0 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic 0 1 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic 1
6 RWA
5 PAGSEL
0 Bit 16
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 402 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
18.3.3.10 Debug Comparator B Extension Register (DBGCBX)
Module Base + 0x0009
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R RWBEN W POR or nonend-run Reset end-run1 0 0 0 RWB PAGSEL
0
0
0
0 Bit 16
0
0
0
0
0
U
U
U
0
0
0
0
U
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 18-11. Debug Comparator B Extension Register (DBGCBX)
1
In the case of an end-trace to reset where DBGEN=1 and BEGIN=0, the bits in this register do not change after reset.
Table 18-12. DBGCBX Field Descriptions
Field 7 RWBEN Description Read/Write Comparator B Enable Bit — The RWBEN bit controls whether read or write comparison is enabled for Comparator B. In full modes, RWAEN and RWA are used to control comparison of R/W and RWBEN is ignored. 0 Read/Write is not used in comparison 1 Read/Write is used in comparison Read/Write Comparator B Value Bit — The RWB bit controls whether read or write is used in compare for Comparator B. The RWB bit is not used if RWBEN = 0. In full modes, RWAEN and RWA are used to control comparison of R/W and RWB is ignored. 0 Write cycle will be matched 1 Read cycle will be matched Comparator B Page Select Bit — This PAGSEL bit controls whether Comparator B will be qualified with the internal signal (mmu_papge_sel) that indicates an extended access through the PPAGE mechanism. When mmu_ppage_sel = 1, the 17-bit core address is a paged program access, and the 17-bit core address is made up of PPAGE[2:0]:addr[13:0]. When mmu_papge_sel = 0, the 17-bit core address is either a 16-bit CPU address with a leading 0 in bit 16, or a 17-bit linear address pointer value. This bit is not used in full modes where comparator B is used to match the data value. 0 Match qualified by mmu_ppage_sel = 0 so address bits [16:0] correspond to a 17-bit CPU address with a leading zero at bit 16, or a 17-bit linear address pointer address 1 Match qualified by mmu_ppage_sel = 1 so address bits [16:0] compare to flash memory address made up of PPAGE[2:0]:addr[13:0] Comparator B Extended Address Bit 16 Compare Bit — The Comparator B bit 16 compare bit controls whether Comparator B will compare the core address bus bit 16 to a logic 1 or logic 0. This bit is not used in full modes where comparator B is used to match the data value. 0 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic 0 1 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic 1
6 RWB
5 PAGSEL
0 Bit 16
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 403
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
18.3.3.11 Debug Comparator C Extension Register (DBGCCX)
Module Base + 0x000A
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R RWCEN W POR or nonend-run Reset end-run1 0 0 0 RWC PAGSEL
0
0
0
0 Bit 16
0
0
0
0
0
U
U
U
0
0
0
0
U
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 18-12. Debug Comparator C Extension Register (DBGCCX)
1
In the case of an end-trace to reset where DBGEN=1 and BEGIN=0, the bits in this register do not change after reset.
Table 18-13. DBGCCX Field Descriptions
Field 7 RWCEN Description Read/Write Comparator C Enable Bit — The RWCEN bit controls whether read or write comparison is enabled for Comparator C. 0 Read/Write is not used in comparison 1 Read/Write is used in comparison Read/Write Comparator C Value Bit — The RWC bit controls whether read or write is used in compare for Comparator C. The RWC bit is not used if RWCEN = 0. 0 Write cycle will be matched 1 Read cycle will be matched Comparator C Page Select Bit — This PAGSEL bit controls whether Comparator C will be qualified with the internal signal (mmu_papge_sel) that indicates an extended access through the PPAGE mechanism. When mmu_ppage_sel = 1, the 17-bit core address is a paged program access, and the 17-bit core address is made up of PPAGE[2:0]:addr[13:0]. When mmu_papge_sel = 0, the 17-bit core address is either a 16-bit CPU address with a leading 0 in bit 16, or a 17-bit linear address pointer value. 0 Match qualified by mmu_ppage_sel = 0 so address bits [16:0] correspond to a 17-bit CPU address with a leading zero at bit 16, or a 17-bit linear address pointer address 1 Match qualified by mmu_ppage_sel = 1 so address bits [16:0] compare to flash memory address made up of PPAGE[2:0]:addr[13:0] Comparator C Extended Address Bit 16 Compare Bit — The Comparator C bit 16 compare bit controls whether Comparator C will compare the core address bus bit 16 to a logic 1 or logic 0. 0 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic 0 1 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic 1
6 RWC
5 PAGSEL
0 Bit 16
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 404 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
18.3.3.12 Debug FIFO Extended Information Register (DBGFX)
Module Base + 0x000B
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W POR or nonend-run Reset end-run1
PPACC
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
U
0
0
0
0
0
0
U
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 18-13. Debug FIFO Extended Information Register (DBGFX)
1
In the case of an end-trace to reset where DBGEN=1 and BEGIN=0, the bits in this register do not change after reset.
Table 18-14. DBGFX Field Descriptions
Field 7 PPACC Description PPAGE Access Indicator Bit — This bit indicates whether the captured information in the current FIFO word is associated with an extended access through the PPAGE mechanism or not. This is indicated by the internal signal mmu_ppage_sel which is 1 when the access is through the PPAGE mechanism. 0 The information in the corresponding FIFO word is event-only data or an unpaged 17-bit CPU address with bit-16 = 0 1 The information in the corresponding FIFO word is a 17-bit flash address with PPAGE[2:0] in the three most significant bits and CPU address[13:0] in the 14 least significant bits Extended Address Bit 16 — This bit is the most significant bit of the 17-bit core address.
0 Bit 16
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 405
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
18.3.3.13 Debug Control Register (DBGC)
Module Base + 0x000C
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R DBGEN W POR or nonend-run Reset end-run1 1 1 0 0 ARM TAG BRKEN
0
0
0 LOOP1
0
0
0
0
U
0
U
0
0
0
0
U
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 18-14. Debug Control Register (DBGC)
1
In the case of an end-trace to reset where DBGEN=1 and BEGIN=0, the ARM and BRKEN bits are cleared but the remaining control bits in this register do not change after reset.
Table 18-15. DBGC Field Descriptions
Field 7 DBGEN Description DBG Module Enable Bit — The DBGEN bit enables the DBG module. The DBGEN bit is forced to zero and cannot be set if the MCU is secure. 0 DBG not enabled 1 DBG enabled Arm Bit — The ARM bit controls whether the debugger is comparing and storing data in FIFO. See Section 18.4.4.2, “Arming the DBG Module” for more information. 0 Debugger not armed 1 Debugger armed Tag or Force Bit — The TAG bit controls whether a debugger or comparator C breakpoint will be requested as a tag or force breakpoint to the CPU. The TAG bit is not used if BRKEN = 0. 0 Force request selected 1 Tag request selected Break Enable Bit — The BRKEN bit controls whether the debugger will request a breakpoint to the CPU at the end of a trace run, and whether comparator C will request a breakpoint to the CPU. 0 CPU break request not enabled 1 CPU break request enabled Select LOOP1 Capture Mode — This bit selects either normal capture mode or LOOP1 capture mode. LOOP1 is not used in event-only modes. 0 Normal operation - capture COF events into the capture buffer FIFO 1 LOOP1 capture mode enabled. When the conditions are met to store a COF value into the FIFO, compare the current COF address with the address in comparator C. If these addresses match, override the FIFO capture and do not increment the FIFO count. If the address does not match comparator C, capture the COF address, including the PPACC indicator, into the FIFO and into comparator C.
6 ARM
5 TAG
4 BRKEN
0 LOOP1
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 406 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
18.3.3.14 Debug Trigger Register (DBGT)
Module Base + 0x000D
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W2 POR or nonend-run Reset end-run1 TRGSEL BEGIN
0
0 TRG
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
U
U
0
0
U
U
U
U
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 18-15. Debug Trigger Register (DBGT)
1 2
In the case of an end-trace to reset where DBGEN=1 and BEGIN=0, the control bits in this register do not change after reset. The DBG trigger register (DBGT) can not be changed unless ARM=0.
Table 18-16. DBGT Field Descriptions
Field 7 TRGSEL Description Trigger Selection Bit — The TRGSEL bit controls the triggering condition for the comparators. See Section 18.4.4, “Trigger Break Control (TBC)” for more information. 0 Trigger on any compare address access 1 Trigger if opcode at compare address is executed Begin/End Trigger Bit — The BEGIN bit controls whether the trigger begins or ends storing of data in FIFO. 0 Trigger at end of stored data 1 Trigger before storing data Trigger Mode Bits — The TRG bits select the trigger mode of the DBG module as shown in Table 18-17.
6 BEGIN 3–0 TRG
Table 18-17. Trigger Mode Encoding
TRG Value 0000 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 0110 0111 1000 Meaning A Only A Or B A Then B Event Only B A Then Event Only B A And B (Full Mode) A And Not B (Full mode) Inside Range Outside Range
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 407
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
Table 18-17. Trigger Mode Encoding
TRG Value 1001 ↓ 1111 Meaning No Trigger
NOTE The DBG trigger register (DBGT) can not be changed unless ARM=0.
18.3.3.15 Debug Status Register (DBGS)
Module Base + 0x000E
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W POR or nonend-run Reset end-run1
AF
BF
CF
0
0
0
0
ARMF
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
U
U
U
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 18-16. Debug Status Register (DBGS)
1
In the case of an end-trace to reset where DBGEN=1 and BEGIN=0, ARMF gets cleared by reset but AF, BF, and CF do not change after reset.
Table 18-18. DBGS Field Descriptions
Field 7 AF 6 BF 5 CF 0 ARMF Description Trigger A Match Bit — The AF bit indicates if Trigger A match condition was met since arming. 0 Comparator A did not match 1 Comparator A match Trigger B Match Bit — The BF bit indicates if Trigger B match condition was met since arming. 0 Comparator B did not match 1 Comparator B match Trigger C Match Bit — The CF bit indicates if Trigger C match condition was met since arming. 0 Comparator C did not match 1 Comparator C match Arm Flag Bit — The ARMF bit indicates whether the debugger is waiting for trigger or waiting for the FIFO to fill. While DBGEN = 1, this status bit is a read-only image of the ARM bit in DBGC. See Section 18.4.4.2, “Arming the DBG Module” for more information. 0 Debugger not armed 1 Debugger armed
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 408 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
18.3.3.16 Debug Count Status Register (DBGCNT)
Module Base + 0x000F
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W POR or nonend-run Reset end-run1
0
0
0
0
CNT
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
U
U
U
U
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 18-17. Debug Count Status Register (DBGCNT)
1
In the case of an end-trace to reset where DBGEN=1 and BEGIN=0, the CNT[3:0] bits do not change after reset.
Table 18-19. DBGS Field Descriptions
Field 3–0 CNT Description FIFO Valid Count Bits — The CNT bits indicate the amount of valid data stored in the FIFO. Table 18-20 shows the correlation between the CNT bits and the amount of valid data in FIFO. The CNT will stop after a count to eight even if more data is being stored in the FIFO. The CNT bits are cleared when the DBG module is armed, and the count is incremented each time a new word is captured into the FIFO. The host development system is responsible for checking the value in CNT[3:0] and reading the correct number of words from the FIFO because the count does not decrement as data is read out of the FIFO at the end of a trace run.
Table 18-20. CNT Bits
CNT Value 0000 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 0110 0111 1000 Meaning No data valid 1 word valid 2 words valid 3 words valid 4 words valid 5 words valid 6 words valid 7 words valid 8 words valid
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 409
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
18.4
Functional Description
This section provides a complete functional description of the on-chip ICE system. The DBG module is enabled by setting the DBGEN bit in the DBGC register. Enabling the module allows the arming, triggering and storing of data in the FIFO. The DBG module is made up of three main blocks, the Comparators, Trigger Break Control logic and the FIFO.
18.4.1
Comparator
The DBG module contains three comparators, A, B, and C. Comparator A compares the core address bus with the address stored in the DBGCAX, DBGCAH, and DBGCAL registers. Comparator B compares the core address bus with the address stored in the DBGCBX, DBGCBH, and DBGCBL registers except in full mode, where it compares the data buses to the data stored in the DBGCBL register. Comparator C compares the core address bus with the address stored in the DBGCCX, DBGCCH, and DBGCCL registers. Matches on Comparators A, B, and C are signaled to the Trigger Break Control (TBC) block.
18.4.1.1
RWA and RWAEN in Full Modes
In full modes ("A And B" and "A And Not B") RWAEN and RWA are used to select read or write comparisons for both comparators A and B. To select write comparisons and the write data bus in Full Modes set RWAEN=1 and RWA=0, otherwise read comparisons and the read data bus will be selected. The RWBEN and RWB bits are not used and will be ignored in Full Modes.
18.4.1.2
Comparator C in LOOP1 Capture Mode
Normally comparator C is used as a third hardware breakpoint and is not involved in the trigger logic for the on-chip ICE system. In this mode, it compares the core address bus with the address stored in the DBGCCX, DBGCCH, and DBGCCL registers. However, in LOOP1 capture mode, comparator C is managed by logic in the DBG module to track the address of the most recent change-of-flow event that was captured into the FIFO buffer. In LOOP1 capture mode, comparator C is not available for use as a normal hardware breakpoint. When the ARM and DBGEN bits are set to one in LOOP1 capture mode, comparator C value registers are cleared to prevent the previous contents of these registers from interfering with the LOOP1 capture mode operation. When a COF event is detected, the address of the event is compared to the contents of the DBGCCX, DBGCCH, and DBGCCL registers to determine whether it is the same as the previous COF entry in the capture FIFO. If the values match, the capture is inhibited to prevent the FIFO from filling up with duplicate entries. If the values do not match, the COF event is captured into the FIFO and the DBGCCX, DBGCCH, and DBGCCL registers are updated to reflect the address of the captured COF event. When comparator C is updated, the PAGSEL bit (bit-7 of DBGCCX) is updated with the PPACC value that is captured into the FIFO. This bit indicates whether the COF address was a paged 17-bit program address using the PPAGE mechanism (PPACC=1) or a 17-bit CPU address that resulted from an unpaged CPU access.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 410 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
18.4.2
Breakpoints
A breakpoint request to the CPU at the end of a trace run can be created if the BRKEN bit in the DBGC register is set. The value of the BEGIN bit in DBGT register determines when the breakpoint request to the CPU will occur. If the BEGIN bit is set, begin-trigger is selected and the breakpoint request will not occur until the FIFO is filled with 8 words. If the BEGIN bit is cleared, end-trigger is selected and the breakpoint request will occur immediately at the trigger cycle. When traditional hardware breakpoints from comparators A or B are desired, set BEGIN=0 to select an end-trace run and set the trigger mode to either 0x0 (A-only) or 0x1 (A OR B) mode. There are two types of breakpoint requests supported by the DBG module, tag-type and force-type. Tagged breakpoints are associated with opcode addresses and allow breaking just before a specific instruction executes. Force breakpoints are not associated with opcode addresses and allow breaking at the next instruction boundary. The TAG bit in the DBGC register determines whether CPU breakpoint requests will be a tag-type or force-type breakpoints. When TAG=0, a force-type breakpoint is requested and it will take effect at the next instruction boundary after the request. When TAG=1, a tag-type breakpoint is registered into the instruction queue and the CPU will break if/when this tag reaches the head of the instruction queue and the tagged instruction is about to be executed.
18.4.2.1
Hardware Breakpoints
Comparators A, B, and C can be used as three traditional hardware breakpoints whether the on-chip ICE real-time capture function is required or not. To use any breakpoint or trace run capture functions set DBGEN=1. BRKEN and TAG affect all three comparators. When BRKEN=0, no CPU breakpoints are enabled. When BRKEN=1, CPU breakpoints are enabled and the TAG bit determines whether the breakpoints will be tag-type or force-type breakpoints. To use comparators A and B as hardware breakpoints, set DBGT=0x81 for tag-type breakpoints and 0x01 for force-type breakpoints. This sets up an end-type trace with trigger mode “A OR B”. Comparator C is not involved in the trigger logic for the on-chip ICE system.
18.4.3
Trigger Selection
The TRGSEL bit in the DBGT register is used to determine the triggering condition of the on-chip ICE system. TRGSEL applies to both trigger A and B except in the event only trigger modes. By setting the TRGSEL bit, the comparators will qualify a match with the output of opcode tracking logic. The opcode tracking logic is internal to each comparator and determines whether the CPU executed the opcode at the compare address. With the TRGSEL bit cleared a comparator match is all that is necessary for a trigger condition to be met. NOTE If the TRGSEL is set, the address stored in the comparator match address registers must be an opcode address for the trigger to occur.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 411
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
18.4.4
Trigger Break Control (TBC)
The TBC is the main controller for the DBG module. Its function is to decide whether data should be stored in the FIFO based on the trigger mode and the match signals from the comparator. The TBC also determines whether a request to break the CPU should occur. The TAG bit in DBGC controls whether CPU breakpoints are treated as tag-type or force-type breakpoints. The TRGSEL bit in DBGT controls whether a comparator A or B match is further qualified by opcode tracking logic. Each comparator has a separate circuit to track opcodes because the comparators could correspond to separate instructions that could be propagating through the instruction queue at the same time. In end-type trace runs (BEGIN=0), when the comparator registers match, including the optional R/W match, this signal goes to the CPU break logic where BRKEN determines whether a CPU break is requested and the TAG control bit determines whether the CPU break will be a tag-type or force-type breakpoint. When TRGSEL is set, the R/W qualified comparator match signal also passes through the opcode tracking logic. If/when it propagates through this logic, it will cause a trigger to the ICE logic to begin or end capturing information into the FIFO. In the case of an end-type (BEGIN=0) trace run, the qualified comparator signal stops the FIFO from capturing any more information. If a CPU breakpoint is also enabled, you would want TAG and TRGSEL to agree so that the CPU break occurs at the same place in the application program as the FIFO stopped capturing information. If TRGSEL was 0 and TAG was 1 in an end-type trace run, the FIFO would stop capturing as soon as the comparator address matched, but the CPU would continue running until a TAG signal could propagate through the CPUs instruction queue which could take a long time in the case where changes of flow caused the instruction queue to be flushed. If TRGSEL was one and TAG was zero in an end-type trace run, the CPU would break before the comparator match signal could propagate through the opcode tracking logic to end the trace run. In begin-type trace runs (BEGIN=1), the start of FIFO capturing is triggered by the qualified comparator signals, and the CPU breakpoint (if enabled by BRKEN=1) is triggered when the FIFO becomes full. Since this FIFO full condition does not correspond to the execution of a tagged instruction, it would not make sense to use TAG=1 for a begin-type trace run.
18.4.4.1
Begin- and End-Trigger
The definition of begin- and end-trigger as used in the DBG module are as follows: • Begin-trigger: Storage in FIFO occurs after the trigger and continues until 8 locations are filled. • End-trigger: Storage in FIFO occurs until the trigger with the least recent data falling out of the FIFO if more than 8 words are collected.
18.4.4.2
Arming the DBG Module
Arming occurs by enabling the DBG module by setting the DBGEN bit and by setting the ARM bit in the DBGC register. The ARM bit in the DBGC register and the ARMF bit in the DBGS register are cleared when the trigger condition is met in end-trigger mode or when the FIFO is filled in begin-trigger mode. In the case of an end-trace where DBGEN=1 and BEGIN=0, ARM and ARMF are cleared by any reset to
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 412 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
end the trace run that was in progress. The ARMF bit is also cleared if ARM is written to zero or when the DBGEN bit is low. The TBC logic determines whether a trigger condition has been met based on the trigger mode and the trigger selection.
18.4.4.3
Trigger Modes
The on-chip ICE system supports nine trigger modes. The trigger modes are encoded as shown in Table 18-17. The trigger mode is used as a qualifier for either starting or ending the storing of data in the FIFO. When the match condition is met, the appropriate flag AF or BF is set in DBGS register. Arming the DBG module clears the AF, BF, and CF flags in the DBGS register. In all trigger modes except for the event only modes change of flow addresses are stored in the FIFO. In the event only modes only the value on the data bus at the trigger event B comparator match address will be stored. 18.4.4.3.1 A Only
In the A Only trigger mode, if the match condition for A is met, the AF flag in the DBGS register is set. 18.4.4.3.2 A Or B
In the A Or B trigger mode, if the match condition for A or B is met, the corresponding flag(s) in the DBGS register are set. 18.4.4.3.3 A Then B
In the A Then B trigger mode, the match condition for A must be met before the match condition for B is compared. When the match condition for A or B is met, the corresponding flag in the DBGS register is set. 18.4.4.3.4 Event Only B
In the Event Only B trigger mode, if the match condition for B is met, the BF flag in the DBGS register is set. The Event Only B trigger mode is considered a begin-trigger type and the BEGIN bit in the DBGT register is ignored. 18.4.4.3.5 A Then Event Only B
In the A Then Event Only B trigger mode, the match condition for A must be met before the match condition for B is compared. When the match condition for A or B is met, the corresponding flag in the DBGS register is set. The A Then Event Only B trigger mode is considered a begin-trigger type and the BEGIN bit in the DBGT register is ignored. 18.4.4.3.6 A And B (Full Mode)
In the A And B trigger mode, Comparator A compares to the address bus and Comparator B compares to the data bus. In the A and B trigger mode, if the match condition for A and B happen on the same bus cycle, both the AF and BF flags in the DBGS register are set. If a match condition on only A or only B happens, no flags are set. For Breakpoint tagging operation with an end-trigger type trace, only matches from Comparator A will be used to determine if the Breakpoint conditions are met and Comparator B matches will be ignored.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 413
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
18.4.4.3.7
A And Not B (Full Mode)
In the A And Not B trigger mode, comparator A compares to the address bus and comparator B compares to the data bus. In the A And Not B trigger mode, if the match condition for A and Not B happen on the same bus cycle, both the AF and BF flags in the DBGS register are set. If a match condition on only A or only Not B occur no flags are set. For Breakpoint tagging operation with an end-trigger type trace, only matches from Comparator A will be used to determine if the Breakpoint conditions are met and Comparator B matches will be ignored. 18.4.4.3.8 Inside Range, A ≤ address ≤ B
In the Inside Range trigger mode, if the match condition for A and B happen on the same bus cycle, both the AF and BF flags in the DBGS register are set. If a match condition on only A or only B occur no flags are set. 18.4.4.3.9 Outside Range, address < A or address > B
In the Outside Range trigger mode, if the match condition for A or B is met, the corresponding flag in the DBGS register is set. The four control bits BEGIN and TRGSEL in DBGT, and BRKEN and TAG in DBGC, determine the basic type of debug run as shown in Table 1.21. Some of the 16 possible combinations are not used (refer to the notes at the end of the table).
Table 18-21. Basic Types of Debug Runs
BEGIN
0
TRGSEL
0
BRKEN
0
TAG
x (1)
Type of Debug Run
Fill FIFO until trigger address (No CPU breakpoint - keep running) Fill FIFO until trigger address, then force CPU breakpoint Do not use(2) Fill FIFO until trigger opcode about to execute (No CPU breakpoint - keep running) Do not use(3) Fill FIFO until trigger opcode about to execute (trigger causes CPU breakpoint) Start FIFO at trigger address (No CPU breakpoint - keep running) Start FIFO at trigger address, force CPU breakpoint when FIFO full Do not use(4) Start FIFO at trigger opcode (No CPU breakpoint - keep running) Start FIFO at trigger opcode, force CPU breakpoint when FIFO full Do not use(4)
0 0 0
0 0 1
1 1 0 x
0 1 (1)
0 0
1 1
1 1
0 1 (1)
1
0
0
x
1
0
1
0
1 1
0 1
1 0 x
1 (1)
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
1
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 414 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
1 2
When BRKEN = 0, TAG is do not care (x in the table).
In end trace configurations (BEGIN = 0) where a CPU breakpoint is enabled (BRKEN = 1), TRGSEL should agree with TAG. In this case, where TRGSEL = 0 to select no opcode tracking qualification and TAG = 1 to specify a tag-type CPU breakpoint, the CPU breakpoint would not take effect until sometime after the FIFO stopped storing values. Depending on program loops or interrupts, the delay could be very long. In end trace configurations (BEGIN = 0) where a CPU breakpoint is enabled (BRKEN = 1), TRGSEL should agree with TAG. In this case, where TRGSEL = 1 to select opcode tracking qualification and TAG = 0 to specify a force-type CPU breakpoint, the CPU breakpoint would erroneously take effect before the FIFO stopped storing values and the debug run would not complete normally. 4 In begin trace configurations (BEGIN = 1) where a CPU breakpoint is enabled (BRKEN = 1), TAG should not be set to 1. In begin trace debug runs, the CPU breakpoint corresponds to the FIFO full condition which does not correspond to a taggable instruction fetch.
3
18.4.5
FIFO
The FIFO is an eight word deep FIFO. In all trigger modes except for event only, the data stored in the FIFO will be change of flow addresses. In the event only trigger modes only the data bus value corresponding to the event is stored. In event only trigger modes, the high byte of the valid data from the FIFO will always read a 0x00 and the extended information byte in DBGFX will always read 0x00.
18.4.5.1
Storing Data in FIFO
In all trigger modes except for the event only modes, the address stored in the FIFO will be determined by the change of flow indicators from the core. The signal core_cof[1] indicates the current core address is the destination address of an indirect JSR or JMP instruction, or a RTS, RTC, or RTI instruction or interrupt vector and the destination address should be stored. The signal core_cof[0] indicates that a conditional branch was taken and that the source address of the conditional branch should be stored.
18.4.5.2
Storing with Begin-Trigger
Storing with Begin-Trigger can be used in all trigger modes. Once the DBG module is enabled and armed in the begin-trigger mode, data is not stored in the FIFO until the trigger condition is met. Once the trigger condition is met the DBG module will remain armed until 8 words are stored in the FIFO. If the core_cof[1] signal becomes asserted, the current address is stored in the FIFO. If the core_cof[0] signal becomes asserted, the address registered during the previous last cycle is decremented by two and stored in the FIFO.
18.4.5.3
Storing with End-Trigger
Storing with End-Trigger cannot be used in event-only trigger modes. Once the DBG module is enabled and armed in the end-trigger mode, data is stored in the FIFO until the trigger condition is met. If the core_cof[1] signal becomes asserted, the current address is stored in the FIFO. If the core_cof[0] signal becomes asserted, the address registered during the previous last cycle is decremented by two and stored in the FIFO. When the trigger condition is met, the ARM and ARMF will be cleared and no more data will be stored. In non-event only end-trigger modes, if the trigger is at a change of flow address the trigger event will be stored in the FIFO.
18.4.5.4
Reading Data from FIFO
The data stored in the FIFO can be read using BDM commands provided the DBG module is enabled and not armed (DBGEN=1 and ARM=0). The FIFO data is read out first-in-first-out. By reading the CNT bits
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 415
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
in the DBGCNT register at the end of a trace run, the number of valid words can be determined. The FIFO data is read by optionally reading the DBGFX and DBGFH registers followed by the DBGFL register. Each time the DBGFL register is read the FIFO is shifted to allow reading of the next word however the count does not decrement. In event-only trigger modes where the FIFO will contain only the data bus values stored, to read the FIFO only DBGFL needs to be accessed. The FIFO is normally only read while ARM and ARMF=0, however reading the FIFO while the DBG module is armed will return the data value in the oldest location of the FIFO and the TBC will not allow the FIFO to shift. This action could cause a valid entry to be lost because the unexpected read blocked the FIFO advance. If the DBG module is not armed and the DBGFL register is read, the TBC will store the current opcode address. Through periodic reads of the DBGFX, DBGFH, and DBGFL registers while the DBG module is not armed, host software can provide a histogram of program execution. This is called profile mode. Since the full 17-bit address and the signal that indicates whether an address is in paged extended memory are captured on each FIFO store, profile mode works correctly over the entire extended memory map.
18.4.6
Interrupt Priority
When TRGSEL is set and the DBG module is armed to trigger on begin- or end-trigger types, a trigger is not detected in the condition where a pending interrupt occurs at the same time that a target address reaches the top of the instruction pipe. In these conditions, the pending interrupt has higher priority and code execution switches to the interrupt service routine. When TRGSEL is clear and the DBG module is armed to trigger on end-trigger types, the trigger event is detected on a program fetch of the target address, even when an interrupt becomes pending on the same cycle. In these conditions, the pending interrupt has higher priority, the exception is processed by the core and the interrupt vector is fetched. Code execution is halted before the first instruction of the interrupt service routine is executed. In this scenario, the DBG module will have cleared ARM without having recorded the change-of-flow that occurred as part of the interrupt exception. Note that the stack will hold the return addresses and can be used to reconstruct execution flow in this scenario. When TRGSEL is clear and the DBG module is armed to trigger on begin-trigger types, the trigger event is detected on a program fetch of the target address, even when an interrupt becomes pending on the same cycle. In this scenario, the FIFO captures the change of flow event. Because the system is configured for begin-trigger, the DBG remains armed and does not break until the FIFO has been filled by subsequent change of flow events.
18.5
Resets
The DBG module cannot cause an MCU reset. There are two different ways this module will respond to reset depending upon the conditions before the reset event. If the DBG module was setup for an end trace run with DBGEN=1 and BEGIN=0, ARM, ARMF, and BRKEN are cleared but the reset function on most DBG control and status bits is overridden so a host development system can read out the results of the trace run after the MCU has been reset. In all other cases including POR, the DBG module controls are initialized to start a begin trace run starting from when the reset vector is fetched. The conditions for the default begin trace run are:
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 416 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
• • •
DBGCAX=0x00, DBGCAH=0xFF, DBGCAL=0xFE so comparator A is set to match when the 16-bit CPU address 0xFFFE appears during the reset vector fetch DBGC=0xC0 to enable and arm the DBG module DBGT=0x40 to select a force-type trigger, a BEGIN trigger, and A-only trigger mode
18.6
Interrupts
The DBG contains no interrupt source.
18.7
Electrical Specifications
The DBG module contain no electrical specifications.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 417
Chapter 18 Debug Module (S08DBGV3) (128K)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 418 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
A.1 Introduction
This section contains the most accurate electrical and timing information for the MC9S08DZ128 Series of microcontrollers available at the time of publication.
A.2
Parameter Classification
The electrical parameters shown in this supplement are guaranteed by various methods. To give the customer a better understanding the following classification is used and the parameters are tagged accordingly in the tables where appropriate:
Table A-1. Parameter Classifications P C
Those parameters are guaranteed during production testing on each individual device. Those parameters are achieved by the design characterization by measuring a statistically relevant sample size across process variations. Those parameters are achieved by design characterization on a small sample size from typical devices under typical conditions unless otherwise noted. All values shown in the typical column are within this category. Those parameters are derived mainly from simulations. NOTE The classification is shown in the column labeled “C” in the parameter tables where appropriate.
T
D
A.3
Absolute Maximum Ratings
Absolute maximum ratings are stress ratings only, and functional operation at the maxima is not guaranteed. Stress beyond the limits specified in Table A-2 may affect device reliability or cause permanent damage to the device. For functional operating conditions, refer to the remaining tables in this section. This device contains circuitry protecting against damage due to high static voltage or electrical fields; however, it is advised that normal precautions be taken to avoid application of any voltages higher than
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 419
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
maximum-rated voltages to this high-impedance circuit. Reliability of operation is enhanced if unused inputs are tied to an appropriate logic voltage level (for instance, either VSS or VDD).
y
Table A-2. Absolute Maximum Ratings
Num 1 2 3 4 5
1
Rating Supply voltage Input voltage Instantaneous maximum current Single pin limit (applies to all port pins)1, 2, 3 Maximum current into VDD Storage temperature
Symbol VDD VIn ID IDD Tstg
Value –0.3 to + 5.8 – 0.3 to VDD + 0.3 ± 25 120 –55 to +150
Unit V V mA mA °C
Input must be current limited to the value specified. To determine the value of the required current-limiting resistor, calculate resistance values for positive (VDD) and negative (VSS) clamp voltages, then use the larger of the two resistance values. 2 All functional non-supply pins are internally clamped to V SS and VDD. 3 Power supply must maintain regulation within operating V DD range during instantaneous and operating maximum current conditions. If positive injection current (VIn > VDD) is greater than IDD, the injection current may flow out of VDD and could result in external power supply going out of regulation. Ensure external VDD load will shunt current greater than maximum injection current. This will be the greatest risk when the MCU is not consuming power. Examples are: if no system clock is present, or if the clock rate is very low which would reduce overall power consumption.
A.4
Thermal Characteristics
This section provides information about operating temperature range, power dissipation, and package thermal resistance. Power dissipation on I/O pins is usually small compared to the power dissipation in on-chip logic and it is user-determined rather than being controlled by the MCU design. In order to take PI/O into account in power calculations, determine the difference between actual pin voltage and VSS or VDD and multiply by the pin current for each I/O pin. Except in cases of unusually high pin current (heavy loads), the difference between pin voltage and VSS or VDD will be very small.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 420 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
Table A-3. Thermal Characteristics
Num C D 1 Rating Operating temperature range (packaged) P1 V M 2 T Maximum junction temperature Thermal resistance Single-layer board D 3
2,3 2,3
Symbol
Value TL to TH
Unit
TA
–40 to 85 –40 to 105 –40 to 125 °C
TJ
135
100-pin LQFP 64-pin LQFP 48-pin LQFP Thermal resistance Four-layer board θJA
61 67 75 °C/W
4 D
100-pin LQFP 64-pin LQFP 48-pin LQFP θJA
48 49 52 °C/W
1
Freescale may eliminate a test insertion at a particular temperature from the production test flow once sufficient data has been collected and is approved. 2 Junction temperature is a function of die size, on-chip power dissipation, package thermal resistance, mounting site (board) temperature, ambient temperature, air flow, power dissipation of other components on the board, and board thermal resistance. 3 Junction to Ambient Natural Convection
The average chip-junction temperature (TJ) in °C can be obtained from:
TJ = TA + (PD × θJA) Eqn. A-1
where: TA = Ambient temperature, °C θJA = Package thermal resistance, junction-to-ambient, °C/W PD = Pint + PI/O Pint = IDD × VDD, Watts — chip internal power PI/O = Power dissipation on input and output pins — user determined For most applications, PI/O VSS 5V 3V 5V 3V Min 2.7 VDD – 1.5 VDD – 0.8 VDD – 0.8 VDD – 1.5 VDD – 0.8 VDD – 0.8 0 — — — — — — 0 0.65 x VDD 0.7 x VDD — — 0.06 x VDD VIn = VDD or VSS VIn = VDD or VSS, VIn = VDD or VSS — — — 0.1 0.1 0.2 1 1 2 Typ1 — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — Max 5.5 — — — — — — –100 1.5 0.8 0.8 1.5 0.8 0.8 100 — — 0.35 x VDD 0.35 x VDD V μA μA μA V mA V V mA V Unit V
— Operating voltage C P C Output high C voltage P C
2
3
D C P
4
C Output low C voltage P C
5 6 7 8 9 10
C
P Input high voltage; all digital inputs C P Input low voltage; all digital inputs C C Input hysteresis P Input leakage current (per pin) P Hi-Z (off-state) leakage current (per pin) input/output port pins PTG1/XTAL/PTE1/ Pullup or enabled Pulldown2 resistors; when
|IIn|
|IOZ|
11
P C D DC injection current
4, 5, 6, 7
I/O pins RPU,RPD PTE1/3 Single pin limit RPU VIN > VDD IIC Total MCU limit, includes sum of all stressed pins VIN < VSS, VIN > VDD VIN < VSS, CIn
17 17 0 0 0 0 —
37 37 — — — — —
52 52 2 –0.2 25 –5 8
kΩ kΩ mA mA mA mA pF
12
13
D Input Capacitance, all pins
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 423
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
Table A-6. DC Characteristics (continued)
Num C 14 15 16 Characteristic
8
Symbol VRAM VPOR tPOR VLVD1
Condition
Min — 0.9 10
Typ1 0.6 1.4 —
Max 1.0 2.0 —
Unit V V μs
D RAM retention voltage D POR re-arm voltage D POR re-arm time
9
17
P Low-voltage detection threshold — high range VDD falling VDD rising P Low-voltage detection threshold — low range VDD falling VDD rising P Low-voltage warning threshold — high range 1 VDD falling VDD rising P Low-voltage warning threshold — high range 0 VDD falling VDD rising P Low-voltage warning threshold low range 1 VDD falling VDD rising P Low-voltage warning threshold — low range 0 VDD falling VDD rising T Low-voltage inhibit reset/recover hysteresis
10 P Bandgap Voltage Reference
3.9 4.0 VLVD0 2.48 2.54 . VLVW3 4.5 4.6 VLVW2 4.2 4.3 VLVW1 2.84 2.90 VLVW0 2.66 2.72 Vlvihys VBG 5V 3V — — 1.19
4.0 4.1
4.1 4.2
V
18
2.56 2.62
2.64 2.70
V
19
4.6 4.7
4.7 4.8
V
20
4.3 4.4
4.4 4.5
V
21
2.92 2.98
3.00 3.06
V
22
2.74 2.80 100 60 1.20
2.82 2.88 — — 1.21
V
23 24
1 2
mV V
Typical values are measured at 25°C. Characterized, not tested. When a pin interrupt is configured to detect rising edges, pulldown resistors are used in place of pullup resistors. 3 The specified resistor value is the actual value internal to the device. The pullup value may measure higher when measured externally on the pin. 4 Power supply must maintain regulation within operating V DD range during instantaneous and operating maximum current conditions. If positive injection current (VIn > VDD) is greater than IDD, the injection current may flow out of VDD and could result in external power supply going out of regulation. Ensure external VDD load will shunt current greater than maximum injection current. This will be the greatest risk when the MCU is not consuming power. Examples are: if no system clock is present, or if clock rate is very low (which would reduce overall power consumption). 5 All functional non-supply pins are internally clamped to V SS and VDD. 6 Input must be current limited to the value specified. To determine the value of the required current-limiting resistor, calculate resistance values for positive and negative clamp voltages, then use the larger of the two values. 7 The PTE1 pin does not have a clamp diode to V . Do not drive this pin above V . DD DD 8 Maximum is highest voltage that POR will occur. 9 Simulated, not tested 10 Factory trimmed at V DD = 5.0 V, Temp = 25°C
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 424 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
2
125˚C 25˚C –40˚C
1.0 Max 1.5V@25mA 0.8 VOL (V) 0.6 0.4 0.2 0
125˚C 25˚C –40˚C
Max 0.8V@5mA
1.5 VOL (V)
1
0.5
0
0
5
10 15 IOL (mA) a) VDD = 5V, High Drive
20
25
0
2
4 6 IOL (mA) b) VDD = 3V, High Drive
8
10
Figure A-1. Typical VOL vs IOL, High Drive Strength
2
125˚C 25˚C –40˚C
1.0 Max 1.5V@4mA 0.8 VOL (V) 0.6 0.4 0.2 0
125˚C 25˚C –40˚C
Max 0.8V@1mA
1.5 VOL (V)
1
0.5
0
0
1
2 3 IOL (mA) a) VDD = 5V, Low Drive
4
5
0
0.4
0.8 1.2 IOL (mA) b) VDD = 3V, Low Drive
1.6
2.0
Figure A-2. Typical VOL vs IOL, Low Drive Strength
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 425
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
2
125˚C 25˚C –40˚C
1.0 Max 1.5V@20mA 0.8 VDD – VOH (V) 0.6 0.4 0.2 0
125˚C 25˚C –40˚C
Max 0.8V@5mA
1.5 VDD – VOH (V)
1
0.5
0
0
–5
–10 –15 –20 IOH (mA) a) VDD = 5V, High Drive
–25
0
–2
–4 –6 –8 IOH (mA) b) VDD = 3V, High Drive
–10
Figure A-3. Typical VDD – VOH vs IOH, High Drive Strength
2
125˚C 25˚C –40˚C
1.0 Max 1.5V@4mA 0.8 VDD – VOH (V) 0.6 0.4 0.2 0
125˚C 25˚C –40˚C
Max 0.8V@1mA
1.5 VDD – VOH (V)
1
0.5
0
0
–1
–2 –3 IOH (mA) a) VDD = 5V, Low Drive
–4
–5
0
–0.4
–0.8 –1.2 –1.6 IOH (mA) b) VDD = 3V, Low Drive
–2.0
Figure A-4. Typical VDD – VOH vs IOH, Low Drive Strength
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 426 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
A.7
Supply Current Characteristics
Table A-7. Supply Current Characteristics
Num C C 1 C C C P 3 C Parameter Run supply current measured at (CPU clock = 2 MHz, fBus = 1 MHz) Run supply current3 measured at (CPU clock = 16 MHz, fBus = 8 MHz) Run supply current measured at (CPU clock = 40 MHz, fBus = 20MHz) Stop3 mode supply current C P P5 P5 4 P5 C P P5 P5 P5 –40°C (C,V, & M suffix) 25°C (All parts) 85°C (C suffix only) 105°C (V suffix only) 125°C (M suffix only) –40°C (C,V, & M suffix) 25°C (All parts) 85°C (C suffix only) 105°C (V suffix only) 125°C (M suffix only) Stop2 mode supply current C P P5 P5 5 P5 C P P5 P5 P5 6 P P 7 P P LVD adder to stop3 (LVDE = LVDSE = 1) –40°C (C,M, & V suffix) 25°C (All parts) 85°C (C suffix only) 105°C (V suffix only) 125°C (M suffix only) –40°C (C,M, & V suffix) 25°C (All parts) 85°C (C suffix only) 105°C (V suffix only) 125°C (M suffix only) RTC adder to stop2 or stop36 S23IDDRTI S3IDDLVD 5 3 5 3 3 S2IDD 5 0.65 0.94 11.3 29.7 140 0.33 0.69 9.4 25 95 300 300 110 90 — — 14 37.4 220 — — 11.6 31.3 155 500 500 180 160 nA nA μA μA μA μA 3 S3IDD 5 0.7 1.1 14.8 38.8 172 0.34 0.79 12.7 33.6 159 — — 18.5 49 257 — — 15 42.4 208 μA μA
4 3
This section includes information about power supply current in various operating modes.
VDD (V) 5 RIDD 3 5 3 5 RIDD 3
Symbol
Typ1 2.1 2.0 8.4 8.3 17.9 17.8
Max2 34 2.5 94 8.7 24 23
Unit
mA 4.6
2
RIDD
mA
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 427
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
Table A-7. Supply Current Characteristics (continued)
Num 8 C P P
1 2 3 4 5
Parameter Adder to stop3 for oscillator enabled7 (EREFSTEN =1)
Symbol S3IDDOSC
VDD (V) 5 3
Typ1 5 5
Max2 8 8
Unit μA
6 7
Typical are measured at 25°C. See Figure A-8 through Figure A-10 for typical curves across voltage/temperature. Max values in this column apply for the full operating temperature range of the device unless otherwise noted. All modules except ADC active, ICS configured for FBE, and does not include any dc loads on port pins All modules except ADC active, ICS configured for FEI, and does not include any dc loads on port pins Stop currents are tested in production for 25°C on all parts. Tests at other temperatures depend upon the part number suffix and maturity of the product. Freescale may eliminate a test insertion at a particular temperature from the production test flow once sufficient data has been collected and approved. Most customers are expected to find that auto-wakeup from stop2 or stop3 can be used instead of the higher current wait mode. Values given under the following conditions: low range operation (RANGE = 0) with a 32.768kHz crystal and low power mode (HGO = 0).
18 16 14 12 Run IDD (mA) 10 8 6 4 2 0 012 4 8 fbus (MHz) Figure A-5. Typical Run IDD vs. Bus Frequency (VDD = 5V) 16 20
PEI or FEI (mid range DCO) FEI (low range DCO) FBE
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 428 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
20 18 16 14 Run IDD (mA) 12 10 8 6 4 2 0 –40 0
fbus = 20MHz
fbus = 8MHz
25 Temperature (˚C)
85
105
125
Figure A-6. Typical Run IDD vs. Temperature (VDD = 5V) 150 140 130 120 110 100 90 80 70 60 50 40 30 20 10 0 –40
STOP2 STOP3
STOP IDD (μA)
0
25 Temperature (˚C)
85
105
125
Figure A-7. Typical Stop IDD vs. Temperature (VDD = 5V)
A.8
Num 1
Analog Comparator (ACMP) Electricals
Table A-8. Analog Comparator Electrical Specifications
C — Supply voltage Rating Symbol VDD Min 2.7 Typical — Max 5.5 Unit V
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 429
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
Table A-8. Analog Comparator Electrical Specifications
Num 2 3 4 5 6 7 C D D D D D D Rating Supply current (active) Analog input voltage Analog input offset voltage Analog Comparator hysteresis Analog input leakage current Analog Comparator initialization delay Symbol IDDAC VAIN VAIO VH IALKG tAINIT 3.0 -— Min — VSS – 0.3 Typical 20 — 20 6.0 -— Max 35 VDD 40 20.0 1.0 1.0 Unit μA V mV mV μA μs
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 430 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
A.9
ADC Characteristics
Table A-9. 5 Volt 12-bit ADC Operating Conditions
Conditions Absolute Delta to VDD (VDD-VDDA)2 Symb VDDA ΔVDDA ΔVSSA VREFH Min 2.7 -100 -100 2.7 Typ1 — 0 0 VDDA Max 5.5 +100 +100 VDDA Unit V mV mV V • Applicable only in 100-pin and 64-pin packages. • Applicable only in 100-pin and 64-pin packages. Comment
Characteristic Supply voltage
Ground voltage Ref Voltage High
Delta to VSS (VSS-VSSA)2
Ref Voltage Low
VREFL
VSSA
VSSA
VSSA
V
Input Voltage Input Capacitance Input Resistance Analog Source Resistance 12 bit mode fADCK > 4MHz fADCK < 4MHz 10 bit mode fADCK > 4MHz fADCK < 4MHz 8 bit mode (all valid fADCK) ADC Conversion Clock Freq.
1
VADIN CADIN RADIN RAS
VREFL — —
— 4.5 3
VREFH 5.5 5
V pF kΩ kΩ External to MCU
— — — — — fADCK 0.4 0.4
— — — — — — —
2 5 5 10 10 8.0 4.0 MHz
High Speed (ADLPC=0) Low Power (ADLPC=1)
Typical values assume VDDAD = 5.0V, Temp = 25C, fADCK=1.0MHz unless otherwise stated. Typical values are for reference only and are not tested in production. 2 DC potential difference.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 431
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics SIMPLIFIED INPUT PIN EQUIVALENT CIRCUIT ZAS RAS Pad leakage due to input protection
ZADIN SIMPLIFIED CHANNEL SELECT CIRCUIT RADIN
ADC SAR ENGINE
+
VADIN VAS
+ –
CAS
–
RADIN INPUT PIN
RADIN
INPUT PIN
RADIN CADIN
INPUT PIN
Figure A-8. ADC Input Impedance Equivalency Diagram
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 432 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
Table A-10. 5 Volt 12-bit ADC Characteristics (VREFH = VDDA, VREFL = VSSA)
Characteristic Supply Current ADLPC=1 ADLSMP=1 ADCO=1 Supply Current ADLPC=1 ADLSMP=0 ADCO=1 Supply Current ADLPC=0 ADLSMP=1 ADCO=1 Supply Current ADLPC=0 ADLSMP=0 ADCO=1 Supply Current ADC Asynchronous Clock Source Conversion Time (Including sample time) Sample Time Stop, Reset, Module Off High Speed (ADLPC=0) Low Power (ADLPC=1) Short Sample (ADLSMP=0) Long Sample (ADLSMP=1) Short Sample (ADLSMP=0) D Long Sample (ADLSMP=1) Total Unadjusted Error 12 bit mode 10 bit mode 8 bit mode Differential Non-Linearity 12 bit mode 10 bit mode3 8 bit mode3 Integral Non-Linearity 12 bit mode 10 bit mode 8 bit mode Zero-Scale Error 12 bit mode 10 bit mode 8 bit mode T P T T P T T P T C P T EZS INL DNL ETUE D tADS D tADC Conditions C Symb IDDAD T Min — Typ1 133 Max — Unit μA Comment
IDDAD T
—
218
—
μA
IDDAD T
—
327
—
μA
IDDAD T
—
0.582
1
mA
T
IDDAD fADACK
— 2 1.25 — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
0.011 3.3 2 20 40 3.5 23.5 ±3.0 ±1 ±0.5 ±1.75 ±0.5 ±0.3 ±1.5 ±0.5 ±0.3 ±1.5 ±0.5 ±0.5
1 5 3.3 — — — — ±10 ±2.5 ±1.0 ±4.0 ±1.0 ±0.5 ±4.0 ±1.0 ±0.5 ±6.0 ±1.5 ±0.5
μA MHz tADACK = 1/fADACK See the ADC Chapter for conversion time variances
ADCK cycles ADCK cycles LSB2
Includes quantization
LSB2
LSB2
LSB2
VADIN = VSSAD
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 433
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
Table A-10. 5 Volt 12-bit ADC Characteristics (VREFH = VDDA, VREFL = VSSA) (continued)
Characteristic Full-Scale Error Conditions 12 bit mode 10 bit mode 8 bit mode Quantization Error 12 bit mode 10 bit mode 8 bit mode Input Leakage Error 12 bit mode 10 bit mode 8 bit mode Temp Sensor Slope Temp Sensor Voltage
1
C T T T D
Symb EFS
Min — — —
Typ1 ±1 ±0.5 ±0.5 -1 to 0 — — ±1 ±0.2 ±0.1 3.266 3.638 1.396
Max ±4.0 ±1 ±0.5 -1 to 0 ±0.5 ±0.5 ±10.0 ±2.5 ±1 — — —
Unit LSB2
Comment VADIN = VDDAD
EQ
— — —
LSB2
D
EIL
— — —
LSB2
Pad leakage4 * RAS
-40°C– 25°C 25°C– 125°C 25°C
D
m
— —
mV/°C
D
VTEMP25
—
V
Typical values assume VDDAD = 5.0V, Temp = 25C, fADCK=1.0MHz unless otherwise stated. Typical values are for reference only and are not tested in production. 2 1 LSB = (V N REFH - VREFL)/2 3 Monotonicity and No-Missing-Codes guaranteed in 10 bit and 8 bit modes 4 Based on input pad leakage current. Refer to pad electricals.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 434 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
A.10
Num C
External Oscillator (XOSC) Characteristics
Table A-11. Oscillator Electrical Specifications (Temperature Range = –40 to 125°C Ambient)
Rating Oscillator crystal or resonator (EREFS = 1, ERCLKEN = 1) Low range (RANGE = 0) flo
2 3
Symbol
Min 32 1 1 1 1
Typ1 — — — — —
Max 38.4 5 16 16 8
Unit kHz MHz MHz MHz MHz
1
C
High range (RANGE = 1) FEE or FBE mode High range (RANGE = 1) PEE or PBE mode
fhi-fll fhi-pll fhi-hgo fhi-lp C1 C2 RF
High range (RANGE = 1, HGO = 1) BLPE mode High range (RANGE = 1, HGO = 0) BLPE mode 2
– Load capacitors
Feedback resistor
See crystal or resonator manufacturer’s recommendation. MΩ MΩ
3
–
Low range (32 kHz to 38.4 kHz) High range (1 MHz to 16 MHz) Series resistor Low range, low gain (RANGE = 0, HGO = 0) Low range, high gain (RANGE = 0, HGO = 1) High range, low gain (RANGE = 1, HGO = 0)
— —
10 1
— —
— — — RS — — —
0 100 0
— — — kΩ
4
–
High range, high gain (RANGE = 1, HGO = 1) ≥ 8 MHz 4 MHz 1 MHz Crystal start-up time 4 Low range, low gain (RANGE = 0, HGO = 0)
t t
0 0 0
0 10 20
CSTL-LP
— — — —
200 400 5 20
— — — — ms
5
T
Low range, high gain (RANGE = 0, HGO = 1) High range, low gain (RANGE = 1, HGO = 0) 5 High range, high gain (RANGE = 1, HGO = 1) 5 Square wave input clock frequency (EREFS = 0, ERCLKEN = 1) FEE or FBE mode 2 PEE or PBE mode BLPE mode
3
CSTL-HGO t CSTH-LP
t CSTH-HGO
6
T
fextal
0.03125 1 0
— — —
5 16 40
MHz
Data in Typical column was characterized at 3.0 V, 25°C or is typical recommended value. When MCG is configured for FEE or FBE mode, input clock source must be divisible using RDIV to within the range of 31.25 kHz to 39.0625 kHz. 3 When MCG is configured for PEE or PBE mode, input clock source must be divisible using RDIV to within the range of 1 MHz to 2 MHz. 4 This parameter is characterized and not tested on each device. Proper PC board layout procedures must be followed to achieve specifications. This data varies based on crystal manufacturer and board design. The crystal should be characterized by the crystal manufacturer. 5 4 MHz crystal
2
1
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 435
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
MCU EXTAL XTAL RS
RF
C1
Crystal or Resonator
C2
A.11
Num C 1 2 3 4
MCG Specifications
Table A-12. MCG Frequency Specifications (Temperature Range = –40 to 125°C Ambient)
Rating Symbol fint_ft fint_ut fint_t tirefst Min — 25 31.25 — 12.8 fdco_ut 25.6 36.86 42.66 Typical 31.25 36 — 55 18.43 Max — 41.66 39.0625 100 21.33 MHz Unit kHz kHz kHz us
Internal reference frequency - factory trimmed at P VDD=5.0V and temperature=25C P Internal reference frequency - untrimmed 1 P Internal reference frequency - user trimmed D Internal reference startup time Low range (DRS=0, DMX32=0) fdco_ut = 512X fint_ut DCO output frequency range 1 untrimmed Mid range (DRS=1, DMX32=0) — fdco_ut = 1024 X fint_ut — P Low range (DRS=0, DMX32=0) fdco_ut = 512X fint_ut DCO output frequency range 2 trimmed Mid range (DRS=1, DMX32=0) P fdco_ut = 1024 X fint_ut Resolution of trimmed DCO output frequency at fixed voltage and temperature (using FTRIM) Resolution of trimmed DCO output frequency at fixed voltage and temperature (not using FTRIM) Total deviation of trimmed DCO output frequency over voltage and temperature Total deviation of trimmed DCO output frequency over fixed voltage and temperature range of 0 - 70 °C
4
5
16 fdco_t 32 Δfdco_res_t Δfdco_res_t Δfdco_t Δfdco_t tfll_acquire tpll_acquire CJitter fvco
—
20 MHz
6
— ± 0.1 ± 0.2 + 0.5 -1.0 ± 0.5 — — 0.02 —
40 ± 0.2 ± 0.4 ±2 ±1 1 1 0.2 55.0 %fdco %fdco %fdco %fdco ms ms %fdco MHz
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
C C P C
— — — — — — — 7.0
C FLL acquisition time 3 D PLL acquisition time C Long term Jitter of DCO output clock (averaged over 2mS interval) 5
D VCO operating frequency
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 436 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
Table A-12. MCG Frequency Specifications (Temperature Range = –40 to 125°C Ambient) (continued)
Num C 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
1 2 3
Rating
Symbol fpll_ref fpll_cycjit_2ms fpll_maxjit_2ms
Min 1.0 — — — — ± 1.49 ± 4.47 —
Typical — 0.5905 0.001 0.5665 0.113 — — —
Max 2.0 — — — — ± 2.98 ± 5.97 tfll_acquire+ 1075(1/fint_t)
Unit MHz %fpll %fpll %fpll %fpll % % s
D PLL reference frequency range T T T T RMS frequency variation of a single clock cycle measured 2 ms after reference edge.6 Maximum frequency variation averaged over 2 ms window.
RMS frequency variation of a single clock cycle measured fpll_cycjit_625ns 625 ns after reference edge.7 Maximum frequency variation averaged over 625 ns window. fpll_maxjit_625ns Dlock Dunl tfll_lock
D Lock entry frequency tolerance 8 D Lock exit frequency tolerance 9 D Lock time - FLL
4
5
6 7 8
This applies when TRIM register at value (0x80) and FTRIM control bit at value (0x0). These values load when in BDM modes. The resulting bus clock frequency should not exceed the maximum specified bus clock frequency of the device. This specification applies to any time the FLL reference source or reference divider is changed, trim value is changed, DMX32 bit is changed, DRS bit is changed, or changing from FLL disabled (BLPE, BLPI) to FLL enabled (FEI, FEE, FBE, FBI). If a crystal/resonator is being used as the reference, this specification assumes it is already running. This specification applies to any time the PLL VCO divider or reference divider is changed, or changing from PLL disabled (BLPE, BLPI) to PLL enabled (PBE, PEE). If a crystal/resonator is being used as the reference, this specification assumes it is already running. Jitter is the average deviation from the programmed frequency measured over the specified interval at maximum fBUS. Measurements are made with the device powered by filtered supplies and clocked by a stable external clock signal. Noise injected into the FLL circuitry via VDD and VSS and variation in crystal oscillator frequency increase the CJitter percentage for a given interval. These jitter measurements are based upon a 40 MHz MCGOUT clock frequency. In some specifications, this value is described as, “Long term accuracy of PLL output clock (averaged over 2 ms)” with symbol “fpll_jitter_2ms.” The parameter is unchanged, but the description has been changed for clarification purposes. In some specifications, this value is described as “Jitter of PLL output clock measured over 625 ns” with symbol “fpll_jitter_625ns.” The parameter is unchanged, but the description has been changed for clarification purposes. Below Dlock minimum, the MCG is guaranteed to enter lock. Above Dlock maximum, the MCG will not enter lock. But if the MCG is already in lock, then the MCG may stay in lock. Below Dunl minimum, the MCG will not exit lock if already in lock. Above Dunl maximum, the MCG is guaranteed to exit lock.
9
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 437
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
Deviation from Trimmed Frequency
+2% +1% 0 –1% –2%
–40
0
25 Temperature (˚C)
85
105
125
Figure A-9. Typical Frequency Deviation vs Temperature (ICS Trimmed to 16MHz bus@25˚C, 5V, FEI)1
A.12
AC Characteristics
This section describes ac timing characteristics for each peripheral system.
A.12.1
Num 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 C D D D D D D D
Control Timing
Table A-13. Control Timing
Rating Bus frequency (tcyc = 1/fBus) Internal low-power oscillator period External reset pulse width2 Reset low drive3 Active background debug mode latch setup time Active background debug mode latch hold time IRQ/PIAx/ PIBx/PIDx/PIJx pulse width Asynchronous path2 Synchronous path3 Port rise and fall time (load = 50 pF)4 Symbol fBus tLPO textrst trstdrv tMSSU tMSH tILIH, tIHIL Min dc 800 100 34 x tcyc 500 100 100 1.5 tcyc — Typical1 — Max 20 1500 — — — — — Unit MHz μs ns ns ns ns ns
8
C
Slew rate control disabled Slew rate control enabled
tRise, tFall
— —
3 30
ns
1 2
Typical data was characterized at 5.0 V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. This is the shortest pulse that is guaranteed to be recognized as a RESET pin or pin interrupt request. Shorter pulses are not guaranteed to override reset requests from internal sources.
1. Based on the average of several hundred units from a typical characterization lot. MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 438 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
3
When any reset is initiated, internal circuitry drives the RESET pin low for about 34 cycles of fsys. After POR reset, the bus clock frequency changes to the untrimmed DCO frequency (freset = (fdco_ut)/4) because TRIM is reset to 0x80, FTRIM is reset to 0, and there is an extra divide-by-two because BDIV is reset to 0:1. After other resets, trim stays at the pre-reset value. 4 Timing is shown with respect to 20% VDD and 80% VDD levels. Temperature range –40°C to 125°C.
textrst RESET PIN
Figure A-10. Reset Timing
BKGD/MS
RESET tMSH tMSSU
Figure A-11. Active Background Debug Mode Latch Timing
tIHIL PIAx/PIBx/PIDx/PIJx
Q/PIAx/PIBx/PIDx/PIJx tILIH
Figure A-12. Pin Interrupt Timing
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 439
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
A.12.2
Timer/PWM
Synchronizer circuits determine the shortest input pulses that can be recognized or the fastest clock that can be used as the optional external source to the timer counter. These synchronizers operate from the current bus rate clock.
Table A-14. TPM Input Timing
Num 1 2 3 4 5 C — — D D D Rating External clock frequency External clock period External clock high time External clock low time Input capture pulse width Symbol fTPMext tTPMext tclkh tclkl tICPW Min dc 4 1.5 1.5 1.5 Max fBus/4 — — — — Unit MHz tcyc tcyc tcyc tcyc
tText tclkh
TPMxCHn tclkl
Figure A-13. Timer External Clock
tICPW TPMxCHn
TPMxCHn tICPW
Figure A-14. Timer Input Capture Pulse
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 440 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
A.12.3
MSCAN
Table A-15. MSCAN Wake-up Pulse Characteristics
Num C 1 2
Rating
Symbol tWUP tWUP
Min — 5
Typ — —
Max 2 —
Unit μs μs
D MSCAN Wake-up dominant pulse filtered D MSCAN Wake-up dominant pulse pass
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 441
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
A.12.4
SPI
Table A-16. SPI Electrical Characteristic
Num1 1 C Cycle time D Enable lead time 2 D Enable lag time 3 D Master Slave Clock (SPSCK) high time Master and Slave Clock (SPSCK) low time Master and Slave Data setup time (inputs) 6 D Data hold time (inputs) 7 8 9 10 D D D D Access time, slave3 Disable time, slave4 Master Slave Master Slave Master Slave Master Slave tSCK tSCK 2 2.5 — 1/2 2048 Rating2 Symbol Min Max Unit tcyc tcyc
Table A-16 and Figure A-15 through Figure A-18 describe the timing requirements for the SPI system.
— 1/2 — 1/2 —
— — — —
tLead tLead tLag tLag tSCKH tSCKL tSI(M) tSI(S) tHI(M) tHI(S) tA tdis tSO tSO tHO tHO fop fop
tSCK tSCK tSCK tSCK
ns ns ns ns
— 1/2
4 5
D D
1/2 tSCK – 25 1/2 tSCK – 25 30 30
30 30 0 — 25 25
— — 40 40 — —
ns ns ns ns ns ns
Data setup time (outputs) Master Slave Data hold time (outputs)
11
D Operating Frequency5
Master Slave
–10 –10
— —
ns ns
12
1
D
Master Slave
fBus/2048 DC
fBus/2 fBus/4
Hz
Refer to Figure A-15 through Figure A-18. All timing is shown with respect to 20% VDD and 70% VDD, unless noted; 100 pF load on all SPI pins. All timing assumes slew rate control disabled and high drive strength enabled for SPI output pins. 3 Time to data active from high-impedance state. 4 Hold time to high-impedance state. 5 Maximum baud rate must be limited to 5 MHz due to input filter characteristics.
2
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 442 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics SS1 (OUTPUT) 2 SCK (CPOL = 0) (OUTPUT) SCK (CPOL = 1) (OUTPUT) 6 MISO (INPUT) MSB IN2 10 MOSI (OUTPUT) MSB OUT2 7 BIT 6 . . . 1 10 BIT 6 . . . 1 LSB OUT LSB IN 11 1 5 4 3
5 4
NOTES: 1. SS output mode (MODFEN = 1, SSOE = 1). 2. LSBF = 0. For LSBF = 1, bit order is LSB, bit 1, ..., bit 6, MSB.
Figure A-15. SPI Master Timing (CPHA = 0)
SS(1) (OUTPUT) 1 2 SCK (CPOL = 0) (OUTPUT) SCK (CPOL = 1) (OUTPUT) MISO (INPUT) 10 MOSI (OUTPUT) MSB OUT(2) 5 4 5 4 6 7 MSB IN(2) BIT 6 . . . 1 11 BIT 6 . . . 1 LSB OUT LSB IN 3
NOTES: 1. SS output mode (MODFEN = 1, SSOE = 1). 2. LSBF = 0. For LSBF = 1, bit order is LSB, bit 1, ..., bit 6, MSB.
Figure A-16. SPI Master Timing (CPHA = 1)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 443
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics SS (INPUT) 1 SCK (CPOL = 0) (INPUT) 2 SCK (CPOL = 1) (INPUT) 8 MISO (OUTPUT) SLAVE 6 MOSI (INPUT)
NOTE:
3 5
4
5 4 10 MSB OUT 7 MSB IN BIT 6 . . . 1 LSB IN BIT 6 . . . 1 11 SLAVE LSB OUT SEE NOTE 9
1. Not defined but normally MSB of character just received
Figure A-17. SPI Slave Timing (CPHA = 0)
SS (INPUT) 1 2 SCK (CPOL = 0) (INPUT) SCK (CPOL = 1) (INPUT) MISO (OUTPUT) SEE NOTE 8 MOSI (INPUT) 5 4 5 4 10 SLAVE 6 MSB IN MSB OUT 7 BIT 6 . . . 1 LSB IN 11 BIT 6 . . . 1 SLAVE LSB OUT 9 3
NOTE: 1. Not defined but normally LSB of character just received
Figure A-18. SPI Slave Timing (CPHA = 1)
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 444 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
A.13
FLASH and EEPROM
This section provides details about program/erase times and program-erase endurance for the FLASH and EEPROM memory. Program and erase operations do not require any special power sources other than the normal VDD supply. For more detailed information about program/erase operations, see Chapter 4, “Memory.” NOTE All values shown in Table A-17 are preliminary and subject to further characterization.
Table A-17. FLASH and EEPROM Characteristics
Num 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 C — — — — — — — — Rating Supply voltage for program/erase Supply voltage for read operation Internal FCLK frequency1 Internal FCLK period (1/FCLK) Byte program time (random location)(2) Byte program time (burst mode)(2) Page erase time2 Mass erase time(2) FLASH Program/erase endurance3 TL to TH = –40°C to + 125°C T = 25°C EEPROM Program/erase endurance3 TL to TH = –40°C to + 0°C TL to TH = 0°C to + 125°C T = 25°C Data retention4 Symbol Vprog/erase VRead fFCLK tFcyc tprog tBurst tPage tMass Min 2.7 2.7 150 5 9 4 4000 20,000 Typical Max 5.5 5.5 200 6.67 Unit V V kHz μs tFcyc tFcyc tFcyc tFcyc
9
C
nFLPE
10,000 100,000
— —
cycles
10
C
nEEPE
10,000 50,000 300,000
— — — —
cycles
11
1 2
C
tD_ret
15
100
years
The frequency of this clock is controlled by a software setting. These values are hardware state machine controlled. User code does not need to count cycles. This information supplied for calculating approximate time to program and erase. 3 Typical endurance for FLASH and EEPROM is based on the intrinsic bitcell performance. For additional information on how Freescale Semiconductor defines typical endurance, please refer to Engineering Bulletin EB619, Typical Endurance for Nonvolatile Memory. 4 Typical data retention values are based on intrinsic capability of the technology measured at high temperature and de-rated to 25°C using the Arrhenius equation. For additional information on how Freescale Semiconductor defines typical data retention, please refer to Engineering Bulletin EB618, Typical Data Retention for Nonvolatile Memory.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 445
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
A.14
EMC Performance
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) performance is highly dependant on the environment in which the MCU resides. Board design and layout, circuit topology choices, location and characteristics of external components as well as MCU software operation all play a significant role in EMC performance. The system designer should consult Freescale applications notes such as AN2321, AN1050, AN1263, AN2764, and AN1259 for advice and guidance specifically targeted at optimizing EMC performance.
A.14.1
Radiated Emissions
Microcontroller radiated RF emissions are measured from 150 kHz to 1 GHz using the TEM/GTEM Cell method in accordance with the IEC 61967-2 and SAE J1752/3 standards. The measurement is performed with the microcontroller installed on a custom EMC evaluation board while running specialized EMC test software. The radiated emissions from the microcontroller are measured in a TEM cell in two package orientations (North and East). For more detailed information concerning the evaluation results, conditions and setup, please refer to the EMC Evaluation Report for this device. The maximum radiated RF emissions of the tested configuration in all orientations are less than or equal to the reported emissions levels.
Table A-18. Radiated Emissions
Parameter Symbol VRE_TEM Conditions VDD = 5V TA = +25oC 100 LQFP Frequency 0.15 – 50 MHz 50 – 150 MHz 150 – 500 MHz 500 – 1000 MHz IEC Level SAE Level
1
fosc/fCPU
Level1 (Max) 14 21
Unit dBμV
Radiated emissions, electric field
16 MHz Crystal 20 MHz Bus
6 -5 L 3 — —
Data based on qualification test results.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 446 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix B Ordering Information and Mechanical Drawings
B.1 Ordering Information
This section contains ordering information for MC9S08DZ128 Series devices. Example of the device numbering system:
MC
Status - S = Auto Qualified - MC = Fully Qualified Main Memory Type - 9 = Flash-based Core Family
- DZ - DV
9
S08
DZ 128 F2
C
xx
Package Designator Two letter descriptor (refer to Table B-2). Temperature Option - C = -40 to 85 °C - V = -40 to 105 °C - M = -40 to 125 °C Mask Set Identifier Only appears for “Auto Qualified” part numbers beginning with “S.” F2 = 2M78G mask set in this case. Flash Memory Size
-128 KBytes - 96 KBytes
Figure 18-18. Device Numbering Scheme
B.1.1
MC9S08DZ128 Series Devices
Table B-1. Devices in the MC9S08DZ128 Series
Memory Device Number FLASH MC9S08DZ128 MC9S08DZ96 MC9S08DV128 MC9S08DV96
1
Available Packages1 EEPROM 2K 2K — — 100 LQFP 64 LQFP 48 LQFP
RAM 8K 6K 6K 4K
128K 96K 128K 96K
See Table B-2 for package information.
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 Freescale Semiconductor 447
Appendix B Ordering Information and Mechanical Drawings
B.2
Mechanical Drawings
The following pages are mechanical drawings for the packages described in the following table:
Table B-2. Package Descriptions
Pin Count 100 64 48 Type Low-profile Quad Flat Package Low-profile Quad Flat Package Low-profile Quad Flat Package Abbreviation LQFP LQFP LQFP Designator LL LH LF Document No. 98ASS23308W 98ASS23234W 98ASH00962A
MC9S08DZ128 Series Data Sheet, Rev. 1 448 Freescale Semiconductor
How to Reach Us:
Home Page: www.freescale.com E-mail: support@freescale.com USA/Europe or Locations Not Listed: Freescale Semiconductor Technical Information Center, CH370 1300 N. Alma School Road Chandler, Arizona 85224 +1-800-521-6274 or +1-480-768-2130 support@freescale.com Europe, Middle East, and Africa: Freescale Halbleiter Deutschland GmbH Technical Information Center Schatzbogen 7 81829 Muenchen, Germany +44 1296 380 456 (English) +46 8 52200080 (English) +49 89 92103 559 (German) +33 1 69 35 48 48 (French) support@freescale.com Japan: Freescale Semiconductor Japan Ltd. Headquarters ARCO Tower 15F 1-8-1, Shimo-Meguro, Meguro-ku, Tokyo 153-0064 Japan 0120 191014 or +81 3 5437 9125 support.japan@freescale.com Asia/Pacific: Freescale Semiconductor Hong Kong Ltd. Technical Information Center 2 Dai King Street Tai Po Industrial Estate Tai Po, N.T., Hong Kong +800 2666 8080 support.asia@freescale.com For Literature Requests Only: Freescale Semiconductor Literature Distribution Center P.O. Box 5405 Denver, Colorado 80217 1-800-441-2447 or 303-675-2140 Fax: 303-675-2150 LDCForFreescaleSemiconductor@hibbertgroup.com
Information in this document is provided solely to enable system and software implementers to use Freescale Semiconductor products. There are no express or implied copyright licenses granted hereunder to design or fabricate any integrated circuits or integrated circuits based on the information in this document. Freescale Semiconductor reserves the right to make changes without further notice to any products herein. Freescale Semiconductor makes no warranty, representation or guarantee regarding the suitability of its products for any particular purpose, nor does Freescale Semiconductor assume any liability arising out of the application or use of any product or circuit, and specifically disclaims any and all liability, including without limitation consequential or incidental damages. “Typical” parameters that may be provided in Freescale Semiconductor data sheets and/or specifications can and do vary in different applications and actual performance may vary over time. All operating parameters, including “Typicals”, must be validated for each customer application by customer’s technical experts. Freescale Semiconductor does not convey any license under its patent rights nor the rights of others. Freescale Semiconductor products are not designed, intended, or authorized for use as components in systems intended for surgical implant into the body, or other applications intended to support or sustain life, or for any other application in which the failure of the Freescale Semiconductor product could create a situation where personal injury or death may occur. Should Buyer purchase or use Freescale Semiconductor products for any such unintended or unauthorized application, Buyer shall indemnify and hold Freescale Semiconductor and its officers, employees, subsidiaries, affiliates, and distributors harmless against all claims, costs, damages, and expenses, and reasonable attorney fees arising out of, directly or indirectly, any claim of personal injury or death associated with such unintended or unauthorized use, even if such claim alleges that Freescale Semiconductor was negligent regarding the design or manufacture of the part. Freescale™ and the Freescale logo are trademarks of Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. All other product or service names are the property of their respective owners. © Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. 2007, 2008. All rights reserved.
MC9S08DZ128
Rev. 1, 5/2008